This file is indexed.

/usr/share/libreoffice/help/sk/simpress.ht is in libreoffice-help-sk 1:4.2.7-0ubuntu1.

This file is owned by root:root, with mode 0o644.

The actual contents of the file can be viewed below.

   1
   2
   3
   4
   5
   6
   7
   8
   9
  10
  11
  12
  13
  14
  15
  16
  17
  18
  19
  20
  21
  22
  23
  24
  25
  26
  27
  28
  29
  30
  31
  32
  33
  34
  35
  36
  37
  38
  39
  40
  41
  42
  43
  44
  45
  46
  47
  48
  49
  50
  51
  52
  53
  54
  55
  56
  57
  58
  59
  60
  61
  62
  63
  64
  65
  66
  67
  68
  69
  70
  71
  72
  73
  74
  75
  76
  77
  78
  79
  80
  81
  82
  83
  84
  85
  86
  87
  88
  89
  90
  91
  92
  93
  94
  95
  96
  97
  98
  99
 100
 101
 102
 103
 104
 105
 106
 107
 108
 109
 110
 111
 112
 113
 114
 115
 116
 117
 118
 119
 120
 121
 122
 123
 124
 125
 126
 127
 128
 129
 130
 131
 132
 133
 134
 135
 136
 137
 138
 139
 140
 141
 142
 143
 144
 145
 146
 147
 148
 149
 150
 151
 152
 153
 154
 155
 156
 157
 158
 159
 160
 161
 162
 163
 164
 165
 166
 167
 168
 169
 170
 171
 172
 173
 174
 175
 176
 177
 178
 179
 180
 181
 182
 183
 184
 185
 186
 187
 188
 189
 190
 191
 192
 193
 194
 195
 196
 197
 198
 199
 200
 201
 202
 203
 204
 205
 206
 207
 208
 209
 210
 211
 212
 213
 214
 215
 216
 217
 218
 219
 220
 221
 222
 223
 224
 225
 226
 227
 228
 229
 230
 231
 232
 233
 234
 235
 236
 237
 238
 239
 240
 241
 242
 243
 244
 245
 246
 247
 248
 249
 250
 251
 252
 253
 254
 255
 256
 257
 258
 259
 260
 261
 262
 263
 264
 265
 266
 267
 268
 269
 270
 271
 272
 273
 274
 275
 276
 277
 278
 279
 280
 281
 282
 283
 284
 285
 286
 287
 288
 289
 290
 291
 292
 293
 294
 295
 296
 297
 298
 299
 300
 301
 302
 303
 304
 305
 306
 307
 308
 309
 310
 311
 312
 313
 314
 315
 316
 317
 318
 319
 320
 321
 322
 323
 324
 325
 326
 327
 328
 329
 330
 331
 332
 333
 334
 335
 336
 337
 338
 339
 340
 341
 342
 343
 344
 345
 346
 347
 348
 349
 350
 351
 352
 353
 354
 355
 356
 357
 358
 359
 360
 361
 362
 363
 364
 365
 366
 367
 368
 369
 370
 371
 372
 373
 374
 375
 376
 377
 378
 379
 380
 381
 382
 383
 384
 385
 386
 387
 388
 389
 390
 391
 392
 393
 394
 395
 396
 397
 398
 399
 400
 401
 402
 403
 404
 405
 406
 407
 408
 409
 410
 411
 412
 413
 414
 415
 416
 417
 418
 419
 420
 421
 422
 423
 424
 425
 426
 427
 428
 429
 430
 431
 432
 433
 434
 435
 436
 437
 438
 439
 440
 441
 442
 443
 444
 445
 446
 447
 448
 449
 450
 451
 452
 453
 454
 455
 456
 457
 458
 459
 460
 461
 462
 463
 464
 465
 466
 467
 468
 469
 470
 471
 472
 473
 474
 475
 476
 477
 478
 479
 480
 481
 482
 483
 484
 485
 486
 487
 488
 489
 490
 491
 492
 493
 494
 495
 496
 497
 498
 499
 500
 501
 502
 503
 504
 505
 506
 507
 508
 509
 510
 511
 512
 513
 514
 515
 516
 517
 518
 519
 520
 521
 522
 523
 524
 525
 526
 527
 528
 529
 530
 531
 532
 533
 534
 535
 536
 537
 538
 539
 540
 541
 542
 543
 544
 545
 546
 547
 548
 549
 550
 551
 552
 553
 554
 555
 556
 557
 558
 559
 560
 561
 562
 563
 564
 565
 566
 567
 568
 569
 570
 571
 572
 573
 574
 575
 576
 577
 578
 579
 580
 581
 582
 583
 584
 585
 586
 587
 588
 589
 590
 591
 592
 593
 594
 595
 596
 597
 598
 599
 600
 601
 602
 603
 604
 605
 606
 607
 608
 609
 610
 611
 612
 613
 614
 615
 616
 617
 618
 619
 620
 621
 622
 623
 624
 625
 626
 627
 628
 629
 630
 631
 632
 633
 634
 635
 636
 637
 638
 639
 640
 641
 642
 643
 644
 645
 646
 647
 648
 649
 650
 651
 652
 653
 654
 655
 656
 657
 658
 659
 660
 661
 662
 663
 664
 665
 666
 667
 668
 669
 670
 671
 672
 673
 674
 675
 676
 677
 678
 679
 680
 681
 682
 683
 684
 685
 686
 687
 688
 689
 690
 691
 692
 693
 694
 695
 696
 697
 698
 699
 700
 701
 702
 703
 704
 705
 706
 707
 708
 709
 710
 711
 712
 713
 714
 715
 716
 717
 718
 719
 720
 721
 722
 723
 724
 725
 726
 727
 728
 729
 730
 731
 732
 733
 734
 735
 736
 737
 738
 739
 740
 741
 742
 743
 744
 745
 746
 747
 748
 749
 750
 751
 752
 753
 754
 755
 756
 757
 758
 759
 760
 761
 762
 763
 764
 765
 766
 767
 768
 769
 770
 771
 772
 773
 774
 775
 776
 777
 778
 779
 780
 781
 782
 783
 784
 785
 786
 787
 788
 789
 790
 791
 792
 793
 794
 795
 796
 797
 798
 799
 800
 801
 802
 803
 804
 805
 806
 807
 808
 809
 810
 811
 812
 813
 814
 815
 816
 817
 818
 819
 820
 821
 822
 823
 824
 825
 826
 827
 828
 829
 830
 831
 832
 833
 834
 835
 836
 837
 838
 839
 840
 841
 842
 843
 844
 845
 846
 847
 848
 849
 850
 851
 852
 853
 854
 855
 856
 857
 858
 859
 860
 861
 862
 863
 864
 865
 866
 867
 868
 869
 870
 871
 872
 873
 874
 875
 876
 877
 878
 879
 880
 881
 882
 883
 884
 885
 886
 887
 888
 889
 890
 891
 892
 893
 894
 895
 896
 897
 898
 899
 900
 901
 902
 903
 904
 905
 906
 907
 908
 909
 910
 911
 912
 913
 914
 915
 916
 917
 918
 919
 920
 921
 922
 923
 924
 925
 926
 927
 928
 929
 930
 931
 932
 933
 934
 935
 936
 937
 938
 939
 940
 941
 942
 943
 944
 945
 946
 947
 948
 949
 950
 951
 952
 953
 954
 955
 956
 957
 958
 959
 960
 961
 962
 963
 964
 965
 966
 967
 968
 969
 970
 971
 972
 973
 974
 975
 976
 977
 978
 979
 980
 981
 982
 983
 984
 985
 986
 987
 988
 989
 990
 991
 992
 993
 994
 995
 996
 997
 998
 999
1000
1001
1002
1003
1004
1005
1006
1007
1008
1009
1010
1011
1012
1013
1014
1015
1016
1017
1018
1019
1020
1021
1022
1023
1024
1025
1026
1027
1028
1029
1030
1031
1032
1033
1034
1035
1036
1037
1038
1039
1040
1041
1042
1043
1044
1045
1046
1047
1048
1049
1050
1051
1052
1053
1054
1055
1056
1057
1058
1059
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064
1065
1066
1067
1068
1069
1070
1071
1072
1073
1074
1075
1076
1077
1078
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084
1085
1086
1087
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095
1096
1097
1098
1099
1100
1101
1102
1103
1104
1105
1106
1107
1108
1109
1110
1111
1112
1113
1114
1115
1116
1117
1118
1119
1120
1121
1122
1123
1124
1125
1126
1127
1128
1129
1130
1131
1132
1133
1134
1135
1136
1137
1138
1139
1140
1141
1142
1143
1144
1145
1146
1147
1148
1149
1150
1151
1152
1153
1154
1155
1156
1157
1158
1159
1160
1161
1162
1163
1164
1165
1166
1167
1168
1169
1170
1171
1172
1173
1174
1175
1176
1177
1178
1179
1180
1181
1182
1183
1184
1185
1186
1187
1188
1189
1190
1191
1192
1193
1194
1195
1196
1197
1198
1199
1200
1201
1202
1203
1204
1205
1206
1207
1208
1209
1210
1211
1212
1213
1214
1215
1216
1217
1218
1219
1220
1221
1222
1223
1224
1225
1226
1227
1228
1229
1230
1231
1232
1233
1234
1235
1236
1237
1238
1239
1240
1241
1242
1243
1244
1245
1246
1247
1248
1249
1250
1251
1252
1253
1254
1255
1256
1257
1258
1259
1260
1261
1262
1263
1264
1265
1266
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271
1272
1273
1274
1275
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282
1283
1284
1285
1286
1287
1288
1289
1290
1291
1292
1293
1294
1295
1296
1297
1298
1299
1300
1301
1302
1303
1304
1305
1306
1307
1308
1309
1310
1311
1312
1313
1314
1315
1316
1317
1318
1319
1320
1321
1322
1323
1324
1325
1326
1327
1328
1329
1330
1331
1332
1333
1334
1335
1336
1337
1338
1339
1340
1341
1342
1343
1344
1345
1346
1347
1348
1349
1350
1351
1352
1353
1354
1355
1356
1357
1358
1359
1360
1361
1362
1363
1364
1365
1366
1367
1368
1369
1370
1371
1372
1373
1374
1375
1376
1377
1378
1379
1380
1381
1382
1383
1384
1385
1386
1387
1388
1389
1390
1391
1392
1393
1394
1395
1396
1397
1398
1399
1400
1401
1402
1403
1404
1405
1406
1407
1408
1409
1410
1411
1412
1413
1414
1415
1416
1417
1418
1419
1420
1421
1422
1423
1424
1425
1426
1427
1428
1429
1430
1431
1432
1433
1434
1435
1436
1437
1438
1439
1440
1441
1442
1443
1444
1445
1446
1447
1448
1449
1450
1451
1452
1453
1454
1455
1456
1457
1458
1459
1460
1461
1462
1463
1464
1465
1466
1467
1468
1469
1470
1471
1472
1473
1474
1475
1476
1477
1478
1479
1480
1481
1482
1483
1484
1485
1486
1487
1488
1489
1490
1491
1492
1493
1494
1495
1496
1497
1498
1499
1500
1501
1502
1503
1504
1505
1506
1507
1508
1509
1510
1511
1512
1513
1514
1515
1516
1517
1518
1519
1520
1521
1522
1523
1524
1525
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530
1531
1532
1533
1534
1535
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548
1549
1550
1551
1552
1553
1554
1555
1556
1557
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562
1563
1564
1565
1566
1567
1568
1569
1570
1571
1572
1573
1574
1575
1576
1577
1578
1579
1580
1581
1582
1583
1584
1585
1586
1587
1588
1589
1590
1591
1592
1593
1594
1595
1596
1597
1598
1599
1600
1601
1602
1603
1604
1605
1606
1607
1608
1609
1610
1611
1612
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618
1619
1620
1621
1622
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636
1637
1638
1639
1640
1641
1642
1643
1644
1645
1646
1647
1648
1649
1650
1651
1652
1653
1654
1655
1656
1657
1658
1659
1660
1661
1662
1663
1664
1665
1666
1667
1668
1669
1670
1671
1672
1673
1674
1675
1676
1677
1678
1679
1680
1681
1682
1683
1684
1685
1686
1687
1688
1689
1690
1691
1692
1693
1694
1695
1696
1697
1698
1699
1700
1701
1702
1703
1704
1705
1706
1707
1708
1709
1710
1711
1712
1713
1714
1715
1716
1717
1718
1719
1720
1721
1722
1723
1724
1725
1726
1727
1728
1729
1730
1731
1732
1733
1734
1735
1736
1737
1738
1739
1740
1741
1742
1743
1744
1745
1746
1747
1748
1749
1750
1751
1752
1753
1754
1755
1756
1757
1758
1759
1760
1761
1762
1763
1764
1765
1766
1767
1768
1769
1770
1771
1772
1773
1774
1775
1776
1777
1778
1779
1780
1781
1782
1783
1784
1785
1786
1787
1788
1789
1790
1791
1792
1793
1794
1795
1796
1797
1798
1799
1800
1801
1802
1803
1804
1805
1806
1807
1808
1809
1810
1811
1812
1813
1814
1815
1816
1817
1818
1819
1820
1821
1822
1823
1824
1825
1826
1827
1828
1829
1830
1831
1832
1833
1834
1835
1836
1837
1838
1839
1840
1841
1842
1843
1844
1845
1846
1847
1848
1849
1850
1851
1852
1853
1854
1855
1856
1857
1858
1859
1860
1861
1862
1863
1864
1865
1866
1867
1868
1869
1870
1871
1872
1873
1874
1875
1876
1877
1878
1879
1880
1881
1882
1883
1884
1885
1886
1887
1888
1889
1890
1891
1892
1893
1894
1895
1896
1897
1898
1899
1900
1901
1902
1903
1904
1905
1906
1907
1908
1909
1910
1911
1912
1913
1914
1915
1916
1917
1918
1919
1920
1921
1922
1923
1924
1925
1926
1927
1928
1929
1930
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935
1936
1937
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942
1943
1944
1945
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954
1955
1956
1957
1958
1959
1960
1961
1962
1963
1964
1965
1966
1967
1968
1969
1970
1971
1972
1973
1974
1975
1976
1977
1978
1979
1980
1981
1982
1983
1984
1985
1986
1987
1988
1989
1990
1991
1992
1993
1994
1995
1996
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
2024
2025
2026
2027
2028
2029
2030
2031
2032
2033
2034
2035
2036
2037
2038
2039
2040
2041
2042
2043
2044
2045
2046
2047
2048
2049
2050
2051
2052
2053
2054
2055
2056
2057
2058
2059
2060
2061
2062
2063
2064
2065
2066
2067
2068
2069
2070
2071
2072
2073
2074
2075
2076
2077
2078
2079
2080
2081
2082
2083
2084
2085
2086
2087
2088
2089
2090
2091
2092
2093
2094
2095
2096
2097
2098
2099
2100
2101
2102
2103
2104
2105
2106
2107
2108
2109
2110
2111
2112
2113
2114
2115
2116
2117
2118
2119
2120
2121
2122
2123
2124
2125
2126
2127
2128
2129
2130
2131
2132
2133
2134
2135
2136
2137
2138
2139
2140
2141
2142
2143
2144
2145
2146
2147
2148
2149
2150
2151
2152
2153
2154
2155
2156
2157
2158
2159
2160
2161
2162
2163
2164
2165
2166
2167
2168
2169
2170
2171
2172
2173
2174
2175
2176
2177
2178
2179
2180
2181
2182
2183
2184
2185
2186
2187
2188
2189
2190
2191
2192
2193
2194
2195
2196
2197
2198
2199
2200
2201
2202
2203
2204
2205
2206
2207
2208
2209
2210
2211
2212
2213
2214
2215
2216
2217
2218
2219
2220
2221
2222
2223
2224
2225
2226
2227
2228
2229
2230
2231
2232
2233
2234
2235
2236
2237
2238
2239
2240
2241
2242
2243
2244
2245
2246
2247
2248
2249
2250
2251
2252
2253
2254
2255
2256
2257
2258
2259
2260
2261
2262
2263
2264
2265
2266
2267
2268
2269
2270
2271
2272
2273
2274
2275
2276
2277
2278
2279
2280
2281
2282
2283
2284
2285
2286
2287
2288
2289
2290
2291
2292
2293
2294
2295
2296
2297
2298
2299
2300
2301
2302
2303
2304
2305
2306
2307
2308
2309
2310
2311
2312
2313
2314
2315
2316
2317
2318
2319
2320
2321
2322
2323
2324
2325
2326
2327
2328
2329
2330
2331
2332
2333
2334
2335
2336
2337
2338
2339
2340
2341
2342
2343
2344
2345
2346
2347
2348
2349
2350
2351
2352
2353
2354
2355
2356
2357
2358
2359
2360
2361
2362
2363
2364
2365
2366
2367
2368
2369
2370
2371
2372
2373
2374
2375
2376
2377
2378
2379
2380
2381
2382
2383
2384
2385
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390
2391
2392
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397
2398
2399
2400
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409
2410
2411
2412
2413
2414
2415
2416
2417
2418
2419
2420
2421
2422
2423
2424
2425
2426
2427
2428
2429
2430
2431
2432
2433
2434
2435
2436
2437
2438
2439
2440
2441
2442
2443
2444
2445
2446
2447
2448
2449
2450
2451
2452
2453
2454
2455
2456
2457
2458
2459
2460
2461
2462
2463
2464
2465
2466
2467
2468
2469
2470
2471
2472
2473
2474
2475
2476
2477
2478
2479
2480
2481
2482
2483
2484
2485
2486
2487
2488
2489
2490
2491
2492
2493
2494
2495
2496
2497
2498
2499
2500
2501
2502
2503
2504
2505
2506
2507
2508
2509
2510
2511
2512
2513
2514
2515
2516
2517
2518
2519
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524
2525
2526
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531
2532
2533
2534
2535
2536
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547
2548
2549
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554
2555
2556
2557
2558
2559
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568
2569
2570
2571
2572
2573
2574
2575
2576
2577
2578
2579
2580
2581
2582
2583
2584
2585
2586
2587
2588
2589
2590
2591
2592
2593
2594
2595
2596
2597
2598
2599
2600
2601
2602
2603
2604
2605
2606
2607
2608
2609
2610
2611
2612
2613
2614
2615
2616
2617
2618
2619
2620
2621
2622
2623
2624
2625
2626
2627
2628
2629
2630
2631
2632
2633
2634
2635
2636
2637
2638
2639
2640
2641
2642
2643
2644
2645
2646
2647
2648
2649
2650
2651
2652
2653
2654
2655
2656
2657
2658
2659
2660
2661
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671
2672
2673
2674
2675
2676
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693
2694
2695
2696
2697
2698
2699
2700
2701
2702
2703
2704
2705
2706
2707
2708
2709
2710
2711
2712
2713
2714
2715
2716
2717
2718
2719
2720
2721
2722
2723
2724
2725
2726
2727
2728
2729
2730
2731
2732
2733
2734
2735
2736
2737
2738
2739
2740
2741
2742
2743
2744
2745
2746
2747
2748
2749
2750
2751
2752
2753
2754
2755
2756
2757
2758
2759
2760
2761
2762
2763
2764
2765
2766
2767
2768
2769
2770
2771
2772
2773
2774
2775
2776
2777
2778
2779
2780
2781
2782
2783
2784
2785
2786
2787
2788
2789
2790
2791
2792
2793
2794
2795
2796
2797
2798
2799
2800
2801
2802
2803
2804
2805
2806
2807
2808
2809
2810
2811
2812
2813
2814
2815
2816
2817
2818
2819
2820
2821
2822
2823
2824
2825
2826
2827
2828
2829
2830
2831
2832
2833
2834
2835
2836
2837
2838
2839
2840
2841
2842
2843
2844
2845
2846
2847
2848
2849
2850
2851
2852
2853
2854
2855
2856
2857
2858
2859
2860
2861
2862
2863
2864
2865
2866
2867
2868
2869
2870
2871
2872
2873
2874
2875
2876
2877
2878
2879
2880
2881
2882
2883
2884
2885
2886
2887
2888
2889
2890
2891
2892
2893
2894
2895
2896
2897
2898
2899
2900
2901
2902
2903
2904
2905
2906
2907
2908
2909
2910
2911
2912
2913
2914
2915
2916
2917
2918
2919
2920
2921
2922
2923
2924
2925
2926
2927
2928
2929
2930
2931
2932
2933
2934
2935
2936
2937
2938
2939
2940
2941
2942
2943
2944
2945
2946
2947
2948
2949
2950
2951
2952
2953
2954
2955
2956
2957
2958
2959
2960
2961
2962
2963
2964
2965
2966
2967
2968
2969
2970
2971
2972
2973
2974
2975
2976
2977
2978
2979
2980
2981
2982
2983
2984
2985
2986
2987
2988
2989
2990
2991
2992
2993
2994
2995
2996
2997
2998
2999
3000
3001
3002
3003
3004
3005
3006
3007
3008
3009
3010
3011
3012
3013
3014
3015
3016
3017
3018
3019
3020
3021
3022
3023
3024
3025
3026
3027
3028
3029
3030
3031
3032
3033
3034
3035
3036
3037
3038
3039
3040
3041
3042
3043
3044
3045
3046
3047
3048
3049
3050
3051
3052
3053
3054
3055
3056
3057
3058
3059
3060
3061
3062
3063
3064
3065
3066
3067
3068
3069
3070
3071
3072
3073
3074
3075
3076
3077
3078
3079
3080
3081
3082
3083
3084
3085
3086
3087
3088
3089
3090
3091
3092
3093
3094
3095
3096
3097
3098
3099
3100
3101
3102
3103
3104
3105
3106
3107
3108
3109
3110
3111
3112
3113
3114
3115
3116
3117
3118
3119
3120
3121
3122
3123
3124
3125
3126
3127
3128
3129
3130
3131
3132
3133
3134
3135
3136
3137
3138
3139
3140
3141
3142
3143
3144
3145
3146
3147
3148
3149
3150
3151
3152
3153
3154
3155
3156
3157
3158
3159
3160
3161
3162
3163
3164
3165
3166
3167
3168
3169
3170
3171
3172
3173
3174
3175
3176
3177
3178
3179
3180
3181
3182
3183
3184
3185
3186
3187
3188
3189
3190
3191
3192
3193
3194
3195
3196
3197
3198
3199
3200
3201
3202
3203
3204
3205
3206
3207
3208
3209
3210
3211
3212
3213
3214
3215
3216
3217
3218
3219
3220
3221
3222
3223
3224
3225
3226
3227
3228
3229
3230
3231
3232
3233
3234
3235
3236
3237
3238
3239
3240
3241
3242
3243
3244
3245
3246
3247
3248
3249
3250
3251
3252
3253
3254
3255
3256
3257
3258
3259
3260
3261
3262
3263
3264
3265
3266
3267
3268
3269
3270
3271
3272
3273
3274
3275
3276
3277
3278
3279
3280
3281
3282
3283
3284
3285
3286
3287
3288
3289
3290
3291
3292
3293
3294
3295
3296
3297
3298
3299
3300
3301
3302
3303
3304
3305
3306
3307
3308
3309
3310
3311
3312
3313
3314
3315
3316
3317
3318
3319
3320
3321
3322
3323
3324
3325
3326
3327
3328
3329
3330
3331
3332
3333
3334
3335
3336
3337
3338
3339
3340
3341
3342
3343
3344
3345
3346
3347
3348
3349
3350
3351
3352
3353
3354
3355
3356
3357
3358
3359
3360
3361
3362
3363
3364
3365
3366
3367
3368
3369
3370
3371
3372
3373
3374
3375
3376
3377
3378
3379
3380
3381
3382
3383
3384
3385
3386
3387
3388
3389
3390
3391
3392
3393
3394
3395
3396
3397
3398
3399
3400
3401
3402
3403
3404
3405
3406
3407
3408
3409
3410
3411
3412
3413
3414
3415
3416
3417
3418
3419
3420
3421
3422
3423
3424
3425
3426
3427
3428
3429
3430
3431
3432
3433
3434
3435
3436
3437
3438
3439
3440
3441
3442
3443
3444
3445
3446
3447
3448
3449
3450
3451
3452
3453
3454
3455
3456
3457
3458
3459
3460
3461
3462
3463
3464
3465
3466
3467
3468
3469
3470
3471
3472
3473
3474
3475
3476
3477
3478
3479
3480
3481
3482
3483
3484
3485
3486
3487
3488
3489
3490
3491
3492
3493
3494
3495
3496
3497
3498
3499
3500
3501
3502
3503
3504
3505
3506
3507
3508
3509
3510
3511
3512
3513
3514
3515
3516
3517
3518
3519
3520
3521
3522
3523
3524
3525
3526
3527
3528
3529
3530
3531
3532
3533
3534
3535
3536
3537
3538
3539
3540
3541
3542
3543
3544
3545
3546
3547
3548
3549
3550
3551
3552
3553
3554
3555
3556
3557
3558
3559
3560
3561
3562
3563
3564
3565
3566
3567
3568
3569
3570
3571
3572
3573
3574
3575
3576
3577
3578
3579
3580
3581
3582
3583
3584
3585
3586
3587
3588
3589
3590
3591
3592
3593
3594
3595
3596
3597
3598
3599
3600
3601
3602
3603
3604
3605
3606
3607
3608
3609
3610
3611
3612
3613
3614
3615
3616
3617
3618
3619
3620
3621
3622
3623
3624
3625
3626
3627
3628
3629
3630
3631
3632
3633
3634
3635
3636
3637
3638
3639
3640
3641
3642
3643
3644
3645
3646
3647
3648
3649
3650
3651
3652
3653
3654
3655
3656
3657
3658
3659
3660
3661
3662
3663
3664
3665
3666
3667
3668
3669
3670
3671
3672
3673
3674
3675
3676
3677
3678
3679
3680
3681
3682
3683
3684
3685
3686
3687
3688
3689
3690
3691
3692
3693
3694
3695
3696
3697
3698
3699
3700
3701
3702
3703
3704
3705
3706
3707
3708
3709
3710
3711
3712
3713
3714
3715
3716
3717
3718
3719
3720
3721
3722
3723
3724
3725
3726
3727
3728
3729
3730
3731
3732
3733
3734
3735
3736
3737
3738
3739
3740
3741
3742
3743
3744
3745
3746
3747
3748
3749
3750
3751
3752
3753
3754
3755
3756
3757
3758
3759
3760
3761
3762
3763
3764
3765
3766
3767
3768
3769
3770
3771
3772
3773
3774
3775
3776
3777
3778
3779
3780
3781
3782
3783
3784
3785
3786
3787
3788
3789
3790
3791
3792
3793
3794
3795
3796
3797
3798
3799
3800
3801
3802
3803
3804
3805
3806
3807
3808
3809
3810
3811
3812
3813
3814
3815
3816
3817
3818
3819
3820
3821
3822
3823
3824
3825
3826
3827
3828
3829
3830
3831
3832
3833
3834
3835
3836
3837
3838
3839
3840
3841
3842
3843
3844
3845
3846
3847
3848
3849
3850
3851
3852
3853
3854
3855
3856
3857
3858
3859
3860
3861
3862
3863
3864
3865
3866
3867
3868
3869
3870
3871
3872
3873
3874
3875
3876
3877
3878
3879
3880
3881
3882
3883
3884
3885
3886
3887
3888
3889
3890
3891
3892
3893
3894
3895
3896
3897
3898
3899
3900
3901
3902
3903
3904
3905
3906
3907
3908
3909
3910
3911
3912
3913
3914
3915
3916
3917
3918
3919
3920
3921
3922
3923
3924
3925
3926
3927
3928
3929
3930
3931
3932
3933
3934
3935
3936
3937
3938
3939
3940
3941
3942
3943
3944
3945
3946
3947
3948
3949
3950
3951
3952
3953
3954
3955
3956
3957
3958
3959
3960
3961
3962
3963
3964
3965
3966
3967
3968
3969
3970
3971
3972
3973
3974
3975
3976
3977
3978
3979
3980
3981
3982
3983
3984
3985
3986
3987
3988
3989
3990
3991
3992
3993
3994
3995
3996
3997
3998
3999
4000
4001
4002
4003
4004
4005
4006
4007
4008
4009
4010
4011
4012
4013
4014
4015
4016
4017
4018
4019
4020
4021
4022
4023
4024
4025
4026
4027
4028
4029
4030
4031
4032
4033
4034
4035
4036
4037
4038
4039
4040
4041
4042
4043
4044
4045
4046
4047
4048
4049
4050
4051
4052
4053
4054
4055
4056
4057
4058
4059
4060
4061
4062
4063
4064
4065
4066
4067
4068
4069
4070
4071
4072
4073
4074
4075
4076
4077
4078
4079
4080
4081
4082
4083
4084
4085
4086
4087
4088
4089
4090
4091
4092
4093
4094
4095
4096
4097
4098
4099
4100
4101
4102
4103
4104
4105
4106
4107
4108
4109
4110
4111
4112
4113
4114
4115
4116
4117
4118
4119
4120
4121
4122
4123
4124
4125
4126
4127
4128
4129
4130
4131
4132
4133
4134
4135
4136
4137
4138
4139
4140
4141
4142
4143
4144
4145
4146
4147
4148
4149
4150
4151
4152
4153
4154
4155
4156
4157
4158
4159
4160
4161
4162
4163
4164
4165
4166
4167
4168
4169
4170
4171
4172
4173
4174
4175
4176
4177
4178
4179
4180
4181
4182
4183
4184
4185
4186
4187
4188
4189
4190
4191
4192
4193
4194
4195
4196
4197
4198
4199
4200
4201
4202
4203
4204
4205
4206
4207
4208
4209
4210
4211
4212
4213
4214
4215
4216
4217
4218
4219
4220
4221
4222
4223
4224
4225
4226
4227
4228
4229
4230
4231
4232
4233
4234
4235
4236
4237
4238
4239
4240
4241
4242
4243
4244
4245
4246
4247
4248
4249
4250
4251
4252
4253
4254
4255
4256
4257
4258
4259
4260
4261
4262
4263
4264
4265
4266
4267
4268
4269
4270
4271
4272
4273
4274
4275
4276
4277
4278
4279
4280
4281
4282
4283
4284
4285
4286
4287
4288
4289
4290
4291
4292
4293
4294
4295
4296
4297
4298
4299
4300
4301
4302
4303
4304
4305
4306
4307
4308
4309
4310
4311
4312
4313
4314
4315
4316
4317
4318
4319
4320
4321
4322
4323
4324
4325
4326
4327
4328
4329
4330
4331
4332
4333
4334
4335
4336
4337
4338
4339
4340
4341
4342
4343
4344
4345
4346
4347
4348
4349
4350
4351
4352
4353
4354
4355
4356
4357
4358
4359
4360
4361
4362
4363
4364
4365
4366
4367
4368
4369
4370
4371
4372
4373
4374
4375
4376
4377
4378
4379
4380
4381
4382
4383
4384
4385
4386
4387
4388
4389
4390
4391
4392
4393
4394
4395
4396
4397
4398
4399
4400
4401
4402
4403
4404
4405
4406
4407
4408
4409
4410
4411
4412
4413
4414
4415
4416
4417
4418
4419
4420
4421
4422
4423
4424
4425
4426
4427
4428
4429
4430
4431
4432
4433
4434
4435
4436
4437
4438
4439
4440
4441
4442
4443
4444
4445
4446
4447
4448
4449
4450
4451
4452
4453
4454
4455
4456
4457
4458
4459
4460
4461
4462
4463
4464
4465
4466
4467
4468
4469
4470
4471
4472
4473
4474
4475
4476
4477
4478
4479
4480
4481
4482
4483
4484
4485
4486
4487
4488
4489
4490
4491
4492
4493
4494
4495
4496
4497
4498
4499
4500
4501
4502
4503
4504
4505
4506
4507
4508
4509
4510
4511
4512
4513
4514
4515
4516
4517
4518
4519
4520
4521
4522
4523
4524
4525
4526
4527
4528
4529
4530
4531
4532
4533
4534
4535
4536
4537
4538
4539
4540
4541
4542
4543
4544
4545
4546
4547
4548
4549
4550
4551
4552
4553
4554
4555
4556
4557
4558
4559
4560
4561
4562
4563
4564
4565
4566
4567
4568
4569
4570
4571
4572
4573
4574
4575
4576
4577
4578
4579
4580
4581
4582
4583
4584
4585
4586
4587
4588
4589
4590
4591
4592
4593
4594
4595
4596
4597
4598
4599
4600
4601
4602
4603
4604
4605
4606
4607
4608
4609
4610
4611
4612
4613
4614
4615
4616
4617
4618
4619
4620
4621
4622
4623
4624
4625
4626
4627
4628
4629
4630
4631
4632
4633
4634
4635
4636
4637
4638
4639
4640
4641
4642
4643
4644
4645
4646
4647
4648
4649
4650
4651
4652
4653
4654
4655
4656
4657
4658
4659
4660
4661
4662
4663
4664
4665
4666
4667
4668
4669
4670
4671
4672
4673
4674
4675
4676
4677
4678
4679
4680
4681
4682
4683
4684
4685
4686
4687
4688
4689
4690
4691
4692
4693
4694
4695
4696
4697
4698
4699
4700
4701
4702
4703
4704
4705
4706
4707
4708
4709
4710
4711
4712
4713
4714
4715
4716
4717
4718
4719
4720
4721
4722
4723
4724
4725
4726
4727
4728
4729
4730
4731
4732
4733
4734
4735
4736
4737
4738
4739
4740
4741
4742
4743
4744
4745
4746
4747
4748
4749
4750
4751
4752
4753
4754
4755
4756
4757
4758
4759
4760
4761
4762
4763
4764
4765
4766
4767
4768
4769
4770
4771
4772
4773
4774
4775
4776
4777
4778
4779
4780
4781
4782
4783
4784
4785
4786
4787
4788
4789
4790
4791
4792
4793
4794
4795
4796
4797
4798
4799
4800
4801
4802
4803
4804
4805
4806
4807
4808
4809
4810
4811
4812
4813
4814
4815
4816
4817
4818
4819
4820
4821
4822
4823
4824
4825
4826
4827
4828
4829
4830
4831
4832
4833
4834
4835
4836
4837
4838
4839
4840
4841
4842
4843
4844
4845
4846
4847
4848
4849
4850
4851
4852
4853
4854
4855
4856
4857
4858
4859
4860
4861
4862
4863
4864
4865
4866
4867
4868
4869
4870
4871
4872
4873
4874
4875
4876
4877
4878
4879
4880
4881
4882
4883
4884
4885
4886
4887
4888
4889
4890
4891
4892
16 .uno%3ACustomAnimation 30 Otvorte okno Vlastná animácia na paneli úloh.
12 .uno%3ASaveGraphic 74 Otvorte dialóg pre uloženie zvolenej bitmapy ako súboru. Východzí formát súboru je interný formát obrázku.
10 .uno%3APageSetup 4c Určí orientáciu strany, okraje, pozadie a ďalšie možnosti rozloženia.
16 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_LB 34 Zobrazuje zoznam dostupných súborov $[officename].
24 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_SHAPE_FILTER 101 V podponuke si môžete zvoliť medzi zobrazením všetkých tvarov alebo iba vymenovaných tvarov. Tvary v zozname môžete preskupiť pretiahnutím. Keď nastavíte kurzor do snímky a stlačíte klávesu Tab, označí sa ďalší tvar v určenom poradí.
20 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_DRAGTYPE 5e Snímky a pomenované objekty môžete vložiť do aktívneho objektu metódou ťahaj a pusti.
1c SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_LAST 29 Prejde na poslednú snímku prezentácie.
1c SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_PREV 24 Posunie sa o jeden snímok naspäť.
1c SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_NEXT 23 Posunie sa o jeden snímok dopredu.
1b SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_PEN 63 Prepne ukazovateľ myši na pero, s ktorým si môžete písať do snímok v priebehu prezentácie.
1d SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TBI_FIRST 25 Prejde na prvú snímku prezentácie.
13 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR 62 Otvorí Navigátor, kde si môžete rýchlo listovať medzi stránkami alebo otvorenými súbormi.
17 SD_HID_SD_NAVIGATOR_TLB 43 Zobrazuje zoznam dostupných snímok. Snímka vyberiete dvojklikom.
10 .uno%3ANavigator 62 Otvorí Navigátor, kde si môžete rýchlo listovať medzi stránkami alebo otvorenými súbormi.
24 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fend 76 Choose a color for the duplicate object. If you are making more than one copy, this color is applied to the last copy.
26 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fstart 27 Choose a color for the selected object.
27 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fheight 5b Enter the amount by which you want to enlarge or reduce the height of the duplicate object.
26 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fwidth 5a Enter the amount by which you want to enlarge or reduce the width of the duplicate object.
26 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fangle ce Enter the angle (0 to 359 degrees) by which you want to rotate the duplicate object. Positive values rotate the duplicate object in a clockwise direction and negative values in a counterclockwise direction.
22 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fy c3 Enter the vertical distance between the centers of the selected object and the duplicate object. Positive values shift the duplicate object down and negative values shift the duplicate object up.
22 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fx d6 Enter the horizontal distance between the centers of the selected object and the duplicate object. Positive values shift the duplicate object to the right and negative values shift the duplicate object to the left.
29 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fviewdata a7 Enters the width and the height values of the selected object in the X axis and the Y axis boxes respectively as well as the fill color of the object in the Start box.
27 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fcopies 2c Enter the number of copies you want to make.
30 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2FDuplicateDialog 2e Makes one or more copies of a selected object.
12 .uno%3ACopyObjects 2e Makes one or more copies of a selected object.
11 .uno%3ARenamePage 1b Premenuje vybranú stranu .
11 .uno%3ADeletePage 2b Odstráni aktuálny snímok alebo stránku.
12 .uno%3ADeleteLayer 1b Odstráni aktuálnu vrstvu.
33 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcrossfadedialog%2Fattributes 46 Aplikuje prechod medzi tvarmi na ich vlastnosti, tj. výplne a čiary.
34 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcrossfadedialog%2Forientation 31 Vykoná plynulý prechod medzi vybranými tvarmi.
33 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcrossfadedialog%2Fincrements 40 Určuje koľko tvarov sa má vytvoriť medzi zadanými objektmi.
38 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcrossfadedialog%2FCrossFadeDialog 43 Vytvorí nové tvary a rovnomerne ich rozmiestni medzi dva objekty.
f .uno%3AMorphing 43 Vytvorí nové tvary a rovnomerne ich rozmiestni medzi dva objekty.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdlgfield%2FformatLB 21 Vyberte formát zobrazenia poľa.
2f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdlgfield%2FlanguageLB 17 Vyberte jazyk pre pole.
2c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdlgfield%2FfixedRB 28 Zobrazí obsah poľa pri jeho vložení.
35 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdlgfield%2FEditFieldsDialog 25 Upraví vlastnosti vloženého poľa.
2a modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdlgfield%2FvarRB 21 Zobrazí aktuálnu hodnotu poľa.
12 .uno%3AModifyField 25 Upraví vlastnosti vloženého poľa.
10 .uno%3AShowRuler 4e Zobrazí alebo skryje pravítka z horného a ľavého okraja pracovnej plochy.
1b .uno%3ACommonTaskBarVisible 1d Bežné príkazy pre snímky.
17 .uno%3ASelectBackground b9 Otvorí dialóg pre výber obrázku. Pri obrázku sa upraví veľkosť a vloží sa ako pozadie predlohy aktuálneho snímku. Obrázok odstránite v dialógu Formát - Strana - Pozadie.
1b .uno%3ADisplayMasterObjects 55 Pokiaľ je to povolené, zobrazujú sa v aktuálnej snímke objekty predlohy snímku.
1e .uno%3ADisplayMasterBackground 5d Pokiaľ je to povolené, zobrazuje sa v aktuálnej snímke obrázok pozadia predlohy snímku.
f .uno%3APageMenu 31 Otvorí ponuku s príkazmi pre aktuálny snímok.
19 .uno%3ANormalMultiPaneGUI 51 Prepne do náhľadu Normálny, v ktorom môžete snímky vytvárať a upravovať.
12 SD_HID_SD_BTN_DRAW 51 Prepne do náhľadu Normálny, v ktorom môžete snímky vytvárať a upravovať.
12 .uno%3ADrawingMode 51 Prepne do náhľadu Normálny, v ktorom môžete snímky vytvárať a upravovať.
15 SD_HID_SD_BTN_OUTLINE 73 Prepne do náhľadu Osnova, v ktorom môžete snímky preusporiadať a môžte upravovať ich položky a záhlavia.
12 .uno%3AOutlineMode 73 Prepne do náhľadu Osnova, v ktorom môžete snímky preusporiadať a môžte upravovať ich položky a záhlavia.
13 SD_HID_SD_BTN_SLIDE 1b Zobrazí náhľady snímok.
e .uno%3ADiaMode 1b Zobrazí náhľady snímok.
10 .uno%3ANotesMode 53 Prepne sa do náhľadu Poznámky, kde ich môžete do snímky pridávať poznámky.
13 SD_HID_SD_BTN_NOTES 53 Prepne sa do náhľadu Poznámky, kde ich môžete do snímky pridávať poznámky.
12 .uno%3AHandoutMode 7f Prepne sa na predlohu pre tlač, kde si môžete nastaviť počet snímok, ktoré sa majú vôjsť na jednu tlačenú stránku.
15 SD_HID_SD_BTN_HANDOUT 7f Prepne sa na predlohu pre tlač, kde si môžete nastaviť počet snímok, ktoré sa majú vôjsť na jednu tlačenú stránku.
1a SD_HID_SD_BTN_PRESENTATION 15 Spustí prezentáciu.
13 .uno%3APresentation 15 Spustí prezentáciu.
18 SD_HID_SD_BTN_MASTERPAGE 87 Prepne na jednu z niekoľkých predlôh. Tu môžete pridať prvky, ktoré chcete mať zobrazené vo všetkých snímkach prezentácie.
11 .uno%3AMasterPage 87 Prepne na jednu z niekoľkých predlôh. Tu môžete pridať prvky, ktoré chcete mať zobrazené vo všetkých snímkach prezentácie.
16 .uno%3ACloseMasterPage 18 Zavrie predlohu snímok.
17 .uno%3ARenameMasterPage 44 Vyberte predlohu snímok a kliknutím na túto ikonu ju premenujete.
17 .uno%3ADeleteMasterPage 50 Vyberte predlohu snímok a kliknutím na túto ikonu ju odstránite z dokumentu.
17 .uno%3AInsertMasterPage 86 Vloží do dokumentu novú predlohu snímok. Pokiaľ na novú predlohu dvoj-kliknete v časti Snímky, použije sa na všetky snímky.
16 .uno%3ASlideMasterPage 86 Prepne do zobrazenia predlohy snímok, kde môžete pridať prvky, ktoré chcete mať zobrazené vo všetkých snímkach prezentácie.
16 .uno%3ANotesMasterPage 61 Zobrazí predlohu poznámok, kde môžete nastaviť pôvodné formátovanie všetkých poznámok.
14 .uno%3AMasterLayouts 53 Pridá pole hlavičiek, pätičiek, dátum a číslo stránky do predlohy stránok.
36 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fmasterlayoutdlg%2Fpagenumber 3b Pridá zástupné pole číslo snímku do predlohy snímok.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fmasterlayoutdlg%2Ffooter 35 Pridá zástupné pole pätičky do predlohy snímok.
34 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fmasterlayoutdlg%2Fdatetime 37 Pridá zástupné pole dátum/čas do predlohy snímok.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fmasterlayoutdlg%2Fheader 3b Pridá zástupné pole hlavičky do predlôh pre poznámky.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fmasterlayoutdlg%2FMasterLayoutDialog 72 Pridá alebo odstráni zástupné pole pre hlavičku, pätu, dátum a číslo snímku v návrhu predlohy stránky.
34 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfooterdialog%2Fapply 32 Použije aktuálne nastavenie na vybrané snímky.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfooterdialog%2Fapply_all 5e Použije nastavenia na všetky snímky v prezentácii, vrátane príslušnej predlohy snímok.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Fnot_on_title 4a Nezobrazí informácie, ktoré ste vybrali, na prvej snímke prezentácie.
33 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Frb_auto 58 Zobrazí dátum a čas, kedy bol snímok vytvorený. Vyberte formát dátumu zo zoznamu.
39 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Flanguage_list 2a Vyberte jazyk pre formát dátumu a času.
3a modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Fdatetime_value 3e Zobrazí dátum a čas, ktoré ste zadali do textového poľa.
17 .uno%3AInsertPageNumber 24 Pridá číslo snímku alebo strany.
18 .uno%3AInsertDateAndTime 20 Pridá dátum a čas do snímky.
35 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Fheader_cb 3b Pridá text, ktorý ste napísali do hornej časti snímku.
34 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Frb_fixed 3e Zobrazí dátum a čas, ktoré ste zadali do textového poľa.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Fdatetime_cb 20 Pridá dátum a čas do snímky.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Ffooter_text 3c Pridá text, ktorý ste napísali do spodnej časti snímku.
35 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Ffooter_cb 51 Pridá text, ktorý ste zadali do poľa Text pätičky do spodnej časti snímku.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfooterdialog%2FHeaderFooterDialog 6e Pridá alebo zmení text v zástupných poliach v dolnej a hornej oblasti snímku a tiež v predlohe stránky.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Fdatetime_format_list 58 Zobrazí dátum a čas, kedy bol snímok vytvorený. Vyberte formát dátumu zo zoznamu.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Fheader_text 3b Pridá text, ktorý ste napísali do hornej časti snímku.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fheaderfootertab%2Fslide_number 24 Pridá číslo snímku alebo strany.
16 .uno%3AHeaderAndFooter 6e Pridá alebo zmení text v zástupných poliach v dolnej a hornej oblasti snímku a tiež v predlohe stránky.
1e .uno%3AOutputQualityBlackWhite 33 Zobrazí snímky iba čiernobielo, bez tieňovania.
1d .uno%3AOutputQualityGrayscale 25 Zobrazí snímky v odtieňoch šedej.
19 .uno%3AOutputQualityColor 19 Zobrazí snímky farebne.
11 .uno%3AInsertPage 31 Inserts a page after the currently selected page.
2b modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Finsertlayer%2Flocked 26 Zabraňuje úpravám prvkov vo vrstve.
2e modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Finsertlayer%2Fprintable 27 Tlačiť túto vrstvu alebo netlačiť.
2c modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Finsertlayer%2Fvisible 1e Zobraziť alebo skryť vrstvu.
29 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Finsertlayer%2Fname 1a Zadajte meno novej vrstvy.
36 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Finsertlayer%2FInsertLayerDialog 59 Vloží novú vrstvu do dokumentu. Vrstvy sú dostupné iba v Draw, nie však v Impresse.
12 .uno%3AInsertLayer 59 Vloží novú vrstvu do dokumentu. Vrstvy sú dostupné iba v Draw, nie však v Impresse.
25 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fdlgsnap%2Fvert 1f Vloží zvislú vodiacu čiaru.
26 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fdlgsnap%2Fpoint 1b Vloží prichytávací bod.
22 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fdlgsnap%2Fy 5b Zadajte koľko miesta chcete medzi prichytávacím bodom, čiarou a horným okrajom strany.
25 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fdlgsnap%2Fhorz 22 Vloží vodorovnú vodiacu čiaru.
22 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fdlgsnap%2Fx 5b Zadajte koľko miesta chcete medzi prichytávacím bodom, čiarou a ľavým okrajom strany.
31 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fdlgsnap%2FSnapObjectDialog 7a Vloží riadiaci bod alebo riadiacu čiaru (známu tiež ako vodítko), ktoré vám umožnia rýchle zarovnávať objekty.
13 .uno%3ACapturePoint 7a Vloží riadiaci bod alebo riadiacu čiaru (známu tiež ako vodítko), ktoré vám umožnia rýchle zarovnávať objekty.
11 .uno%3AInsertRows 95 Inserts a new row above the active cell. The number of rows inserted correspond to the number of rows selected. The existing rows are moved downward.
15 .uno%3ADeleteSnapItem 2a Odstráni prichytávací bod alebo čiaru.
27 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fdlgsnap%2Fdelete 2a Odstráni prichytávací bod alebo čiaru.
12 .uno%3ASetSnapItem 75 Nastaví pozície vybraných prichytávacích bodov alebo prichytávacích čiar relatívne k ľavému hornému rohu.
14 .uno%3AInsertColumns ae Inserts a new column to the left of the active cell. The number of columns inserted correspond to the number of columns selected. The existing columns are moved to the right.
12 .uno%3AInsertTable 3d Vloží novú tabuľku do aktuálneho snímku alebo stránky.
18 .uno%3AInsertSpreadsheet 3d Vloží novú tabuľku do aktuálneho snímku alebo stránky.
15 .uno%3AImportFromFile 87 Inserts a file into the active slide. You can insert $[officename] Draw or Impress files, or text from an HTML document or a text file.
37 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Finsertslidesdialog%2Fbackgrounds 3a Predlohy stránky, ktoré sa nepoužili nebudú vložené.
31 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Finsertslidesdialog%2Flinks 73 Vloží súbor alebo časti súboru ako odkazy, ktoré sa automaticky obnovujú pokiaľ sa zdrojový súbor zmení.
3e modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Finsertslidesdialog%2FInsertSlidesDialog 73 Vloží súbor alebo časti súboru ako odkazy, ktoré sa automaticky obnovujú pokiaľ sa zdrojový súbor zmení.
14 .uno%3ADuplicatePage 2c Vloží kópiu snímku za aktuálny snímok.
11 .uno%3AExpandPage c1 Vytvorí nový snímok z každého hlavného nadpisu osnovy (jedna úroveň pod titulom v hierarchii nadpisov) vo vybranej snímke. Vybraný nadpis sa automaticky stane titulom nového snímku.
12 .uno%3ASummaryPage c0 Vytvorí nový snímok, ktorý obsahuje odrážkový zoznam z titulov snímok, ktoré sú za aktuálne vybraným snímkam. Súhrnný snímok je následne nato vložený na koniec prezentácie.
19 .uno%3AInsertDateFieldFix 4e Vloží pole s aktuálnym dátumom do snímky. Dátum už potom neaktualizuje.
19 .uno%3AInsertDateFieldVar 7c Vloží aktuálny dátum do snímky ako premenné poľa. Dátum je automaticky aktualizovaný pri každom otvorení súboru.
19 .uno%3AInsertTimeFieldFix 69 Vloží aktuálny čas do snímky ako nemenné pole. Tento časový údaj sa následne už neaktualizuje.
19 .uno%3AInsertTimeFieldVar 8e Vloží aktuálny čas do snímky ako premenné pole. Čas je následne automaticky aktualizovaný pri každom opätovnom načítaní súboru.
16 .uno%3AInsertPageField 22 Vloží do snímky číslo strany.
18 .uno%3AInsertAuthorField 69 Vloží priezvisko a krstné meno z karty údajov o používateľovi $[officename] do aktívneho snímku.
16 .uno%3AInsertFileField 4f Vloží meno aktívneho súboru. Meno sa zobrazí iba pokiaľ súbor uložíte.
12 .uno%3ATableDialog 73 Určenie vlastností vybranej tabuľky, napríklad názov, zarovnanie, rozostup, šírku stĺpca, okraje a pozadie.
15 SFX2_HID_TEMPLATE_FMT 36 Vytvorte, upravte, použite a spravujte svoje štýly.
1e SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_NEWBYEXAMPLE 4a Vytvorí nový štýl prebraním vlastností štýlu z vybraného objektu.
21 SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_UPDATEBYEXAMPLE 70 Zmení formátovanie vybraného štýlu v okne štýlov a formátovanie podľa formátovania vybraného objektu.
1a SFX2_HID_TEMPLDLG_WATERCAN bf Použije vybraný štýl na objekt. Kliknite na ikonku vedierka s farbou a následne na objekt pre použitie štýlu. Ďalším kliknutím na ikonku vedierka s farbou tento režim ukončíte.
10 .uno%3AParaStyle 4b Štýly pre formátovanie grafických prvkov, vrátane textových objektov.
10 .uno%3AListStyle 46 Štýly použité v automatických rozvrhnutiach %PRODUCTNAME Impress.
11 .uno%3ADeleteRows 30 Zmazanie vybraného(ých) riadka(ov) z tabuľky.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidedesigndialog%2Fload 5a Zobrazí dialóg Načítať design snímku, kde môžete zvoliť ďalšie návrhy snímok.
3a modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidedesigndialog%2Fcheckmasters 3c Odstráni nepoužité pozadie a návrhy snímok z dokumentu.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidedesigndialog%2Fmasterpage 4d Použije pozadie z vybraného návrhu snímku na všetky snímky v dokumente.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidedesigndialog%2FSlideDesignDialog 97 Zobrazí dialóg Návrh snímky, kde môžete vybrať jeho vzhľad. Všetky objekty z návrhu snímku sa vložia za už existujúce objekty vo snímku.
19 .uno%3APresentationLayout 97 Zobrazí dialóg Návrh snímky, kde môžete vybrať jeho vzhľad. Všetky objekty z návrhu snímku sa vložia za už existujúce objekty vo snímku.
25 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3AED_THEMA 4b Zobrazí predmet šablóny, niektoré šablóny sú podľa neho zoskupené.
25 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3AED_TITLE 1a Zobrazí nadpis šablóny.
2c sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3ABTN_PREVIEW 18 Zapne náhľad šablón.
2d sfx2%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3AED_DESC 2f Stručný popis vlastností vybranej šablóny.
2a sfx2%3AMoreButton%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3ABT_MORE 3a Zobrazí alebo skryje náhľad šablóny a jej vlastnosti.
2b sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3ALB_TEMPLATE 2b Zobrazí šablóny pre vybranú kategóriu.
28 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3AED_KEYWORDS 2f Zobrazí kľúčové slová pre vyhľadávanie.
29 sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_NEW_FILE%3ALB_REGION 2e Zobrazí dostupné kategórie designu snímok.
14 .uno%3ADeleteColumns 32 Vymazanie vybraného(ých) stĺpca(ov) z tabuľky.
11 .uno%3AModifyPage 32 Otvorí panel Rozvrhnutia snímku na ploche úloh.
12 .uno%3ARenameLayer 1a Premenuje aktívnu vrstvu.
12 .uno%3AModifyLayer 22 Zmení vlastnosti vybranej vrstvy.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FTSB_AUTOPOSV 3f Určí optimálnu vertikálnu vzdialenosť pre kótovací text.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FCTL_POSITION 4d Určí pozíciu kótovacieho textu vzhľadom na kótovaciu čiaru a vodítka.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FMTR_FLD_DECIMALPLACES 4e Určí počet desatinných miest použitých na zobrazenie vlastností čiary.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FTSB_BELOW_REF_EDGE 29 Obráti nastavenie zadané v poli Čiara.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FMTR_FLD_HELPLINE2_LEN c0 Určí dĺžku pravého vodítka, ktoré začína od kótovacej čiary. Kladné hodnoty predĺžia vodítko smerom ku kótovanému objektu a záporné udávajú odstup od kótovaného objektu.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FMTR_FLD_HELPLINE1_LEN c0 Určí dĺžku ľavého vodítka, ktoré začína od kótovacej čiary. Kladné hodnoty predĺži vodítko smerom ku kótovanému objektu a záporné udávajú odstup od kótovaného objektu..
31 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FMTR_FLD_HELPLINE_DIST dc Určí odstup pravého a ľavého vodítka začínajúcich od kótovacej čiary ku kótovanému objektu. Kladné hodnoty vytvoria medzeru medzi vodítkom a objektom, záporné hodnoty vytvoria prieťah kótovacích čar.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FTSB_SHOW_UNIT 74 Zobrazí alebo skryje merné jednotky kótovania. Výber jednotky môžete uskutočniť aj prostredníctvom zoznamu.
35 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FMTR_FLD_HELPLINE_OVERHANG d8 Určí jednotne dĺžku pravého a ľavého vodítka od základnej čiary (odstup od čiary = 0). Kladné hodnoty predĺžia vodítka nad základný riadok a záporné vytvoria odstup vodítok od základného riadku.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FTSB_PARALLEL 4d Zobrazí text rovnobežne alebo v pravom uhle vzhľadom ku kótovacej čiare.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FLB_UNIT 74 Zobrazí alebo skryje merné jednotky kótovania. Výber jednotky môžete uskutočniť aj prostredníctvom zoznamu.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FMTR_LINE_DIST 5a Určí vzdialenosť medzi kótovaciu čiarou a základným riadkom (odstup od čiary = 0).
18 .uno%3AMeasureAttributes 4c Zmení dĺžku, rozmer a ďalšie vlastnosti vybraných  kótovacích čiar.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FTSB_AUTOPOSH 3d Určí optimálnu horizontálnu pozíciu pre kótovací text.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fdimensionlines%2FDimensionLines 4c Zmení dĺžku, rozmer a ďalšie vlastnosti vybraných  kótovacích čiar.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FMTR_FLD_HORZ_2 41 Zadajte hodnotu o ktorú sa skosí horizontálny koniec spojnice.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LINE_3 26 Zadajte hodnotu skosenia pre čiaru 3.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LINE_2 26 Zadajte hodnotu skosenia pre čiaru 2.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LINE_1 26 Zadajte hodnotu skosenia pre čiaru 1.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FMTR_FLD_VERT_2 3b Zadajte hodnotu o ktorú sa skosí zvislý koniec spojnice.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FMTR_FLD_VERT_1 3e Zadajte hodnotu o ktorú sa skosí zvislý začiatok spojnice.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FMTR_FLD_HORZ_1 41 Zadajte hodnotu o ktorú sa skosí vodorovný začiatok spojnice.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FLB_TYPE 2f Zobrazí zoznam spojníc, ktoré sú dostupné.
11 .uno%3ANewRouting 35 Vráti nastavenie skosenia čiary späť na pôvodné
2e cui%2Fui%2Fconnectortabpage%2FConnectorTabPage 1e Nastaví vlastností spojnice.
1a .uno%3AConnectorAttributes 1e Nastaví vlastností spojnice.
13 .uno%3ABeforeObject 8b Poradie objektov zmeníte ťahom vybraného objektu pred objekt, ktorý ste si určili. Umiestnenie objektu na obrazovke sa pritom nezmení
13 .uno%3ABehindObject 8a Poradie objektov zmeníte ťahom vybraného objektu za objekt, ktorý ste si určili. Umiestnenie objektu na obrazovke sa pritom nezmení.
13 .uno%3AReverseOrder 34 Preusporiada poradie všetkých vybraných objektov.
12 .uno%3AHyphenation 3d Zapne alebo vypne možnosť delenia slov pre vybraný objekt.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Fslide_show 2b Spustí prezentáciu od vybraného snímku.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Fplay 26 Zobrazí náhľad vybraného prechodu.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Fapply_to_all 44 Použije vybraný prechod snímku na všetky snímky v prezentácii.
43 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Fauto_after_value 6f Vyberte pre automatický posun snímku v zadanom časovom intervale. Hodnotu intervalu zadávajte v sekundách.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Frb_mouse_click 38 Vyberte pre posun na ďalšiu snímku kliknutím myšou.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Floop_sound 52 Vyberte pre neustále opakovanie zvuku až do spustenia nového zvukového efektu.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Frb_auto_after 6f Vyberte pre automatický posun snímku v zadanom časovom intervale. Hodnotu intervalu zadávajte v sekundách.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Fsound_list 40 Vyberte zvuk, ktorý sa prehrá počas prechodu medzi snímkami.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Fauto_preview 48 Vyberte pokiaľ chcete vidieť prechody snímok v dokumente automaticky.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Fspeed_list 2b Určí rýchlosť prechodu medzi snímkami.
43 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionsspanel%2Ftransitions_list 25 Vyberte typ prechodu medzi snímkami.
a .uno%3ADia 6c Definuje špeciálne efekty, ktoré sa prehrávajú počas zobrazenia snímku pri prehliadaní prezentácie.
47 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fslidetransitionspanel%2FSlideTransitionsPanel 6c Definuje špeciálne efekty, ktoré sa prehrávajú počas zobrazenia snímku pri prehliadaní prezentácie.
f .uno%3ADiaSpeed 2b Určí rýchlosť prechodu medzi snímkami.
18 .uno%3ASlideChangeWindow 6c Definuje špeciálne efekty, ktoré sa prehrávajú počas zobrazenia snímku pri prehliadaní prezentácie.
35 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_REMOVE_ALL 27 Odstráni všetky obrázky v animácii.
30 sd%3ARadioButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ARBT_GROUP ad Zlúči objekty do jedného, takže môžu byť posúvané ako skupina. Jednotlivé objekty môžete i naďalej ľubovolne upravovať, dvoj-kliknutím na skupinu vo snímku.
38 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_REMOVE_BITMAP 33 Odstráni vybraný obrázok zo sekvencie animácie.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ARBT_BITMAP 2e Zlúči všetky vybrané obrázky do jedného.
3a sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_GET_ALL_OBJECTS 30 Pridá obrázok ku každému vybranému objektu.
36 sd%3APushButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_CREATE_GROUP 29 Vloží animáciu do aktuálneho snímku.
39 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_GET_ONE_OBJECT 3e Pridá vybraný objekt alebo objekty ako samostatný obrázok.
30 sd%3AListBox%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ALB_ADJUSTMENT 1e Zarovná obrázky v animácii.
30 sd%3AListBox%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ALB_LOOP_COUNT 2e Zadajte koľkokrát chcete animáciu prehrať.
2f sd%3ATimeField%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ATIME_FIELD a1 Zadajte čas v sekundách, počas ktorého sa zobrazí obrázok. Toto nastavenie je prístupné iba pokiaľ vyberiete Bitmapový objekt v poli Skupina animácie.
2f sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_STOP 20 Ukončí prehrávanie animácie.
32 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_REVERSE 12 Spustí animáciu.
36 sd%3ANumericField%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ANUM_FLD_BITMAP 3c Zobrazí pozíciu vybraného obrázku v sekvencii animácie.
30 sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_FIRST 32 Preskočí na prvý obrázok animačnej sekvencie.
2f sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_LAST 2d Preskočí na posledný obrázok v animácii.
2f sd%3AImageButton%3AFLT_WIN_ANIMATION%3ABTN_PLAY 12 Spustí animáciu.
17 .uno%3AAnimationObjects 31 Vytvorí vlastnú animáciu v aktuálnej snímke.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fauto_preview 5b Vyberte pre náhľad nového alebo upraveného efektu snímku, potom, čo ste ho priradili.
36 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fplay 2d Prehrá vybraný efekt animácie v náhľade.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fmove_down 51 Kliknite na jedno z dvoch tlačidiel pre zmenu poradia hore alebo dole v zozname.
43 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Feffect_speed_list 3c Určí rýchlosť alebo trvanie vybraného efektu animácie.
46 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Feffect_property_list a0 Umožní nastaviť ďalšie vlastnosti animácie. Kliknite na tlačidlo ... pre otvorenie dialógu Možnosti efektu, kde môžete vybrať a použiť vlastnosti.
43 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fstart_effect_list 3a Zobrazí nastavenie spustenia vybraného efektu animácie.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fremove_effect 39 Odstráni vybrané efekty animácie zo zoznamu animácii.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fchange_effect 73 Otvorí dialóg Vlastná animácia kde môžete zmeniť efekt animácie pre vybranú položku zo zoznamu animácii.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fslideshow 2b Spustí prezentáciu od vybraného snímku.
39 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fmove_up 51 Kliknite na jedno z dvoch tlačidiel pre zmenu poradia hore alebo dole v zozname.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fadd_effect 61 Otvorí dialóg Vlastná animácia pre pridanie ďalšieho efektu animácie k vybranému objektu.
46 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2FCustomAnimationPanel 23 Priradí efekty vybraným objektom.
16 .uno%3ACustomAnimation 23 Priradí efekty vybraným objektom.
26 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_PROGRAM 65 Zadajte cestu k programu, ktorý chcete spustiť, alebo kliknite na Nájsť pre vyhľadanie programu.
24 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_MACRO 5f Zadajte cestu k makru, ktoré chcete spustiť, alebo kliknite na Nájsť pre vyhľadanie makra.
24 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_SOUND 6c Zadajte cestu ku zvukovému súboru, ktorý chcete otvoriť, alebo kliknite na Nájsť pre jeho vyhľadanie.
2b sd%3APushButton%3ATP_ANIMATION%3ABTN_SEARCH 34 Určite umiestnenie súboru. ktorý chcete otvoriť.
17 SD_HID_CTL_ACTION_DLG_2 aa Otvorí a zobrazí súbor počas prezentácie. Pokiaľ vyberiete súbor $[officename] ako cieľový dokument, môžete taktiež určiť stránku na ktorej bude otvorený.
29 sd%3APushButton%3ATP_ANIMATION%3ABTN_SEEK 28 Vyhľadá určený snímok alebo objekt.
27 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_BOOKMARK 3d Zadajte meno snímku alebo objektu, ktorý chcete vyhľadať.
27 sd%3AEdit%3ATP_ANIMATION%3AEDT_DOCUMENT 6a Zadajte cestu k súboru, ktorý chcete otvoriť, alebo pre jeho vyhľadanie kliknite na tlačidlo Nájsť.
17 SD_HID_CTL_ACTION_DLG_1 3c Zobrazí zoznam snímok a objektov, ktoré môžete vybrať.
27 sd%3AListBox%3ATP_ANIMATION%3ALB_ACTION 58 Určí akciu, ktorá sa spustí pokiaľ kliknete počas prezentácie na vybraný objekt.
17 .uno%3AAnimationEffects 53 Určuje ako sa daný objekt zachová, pokiaľ na neho počas prezentácie kliknete.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fpresdisplay_cb 5e Vyberte monitor, ktorý bude použitý pre zobrazenie prezentácie v móde na celú obrazovku.
3a modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Falwaysontop 9c Okno $[officename] sa počas prezentácie bude zobrazovať nad ostatnými oknami. Počas prezentácie sa žiadny iný program nezobrazí pred prezentáciou.
42 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fchangeslidesbyclick 45 Presunie sa na ďalšiu snímku, pokiaľ kliknete na pozadie snímku.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fanimationsallowed 49 V priebehu premietania zobraz všetky snímky animovaných súborov GIF .
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fnavigatorvisible 28 Zobrazí Navigátor počas prezentácie.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fpointervisible 2d Viditeľný kurzor myši počas prezentácie.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fshowlogo 27 Zobrazí  $[officename] logo pri pauze.
33 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fauto b2 Znovu spustí prezentáciu po zadanom intervale pauzy. Medzi počiatočným a koncovým snímkam je zobrazený snímok pauzy. Stlačte klávesu Esc pre pozastavenie prezentácie.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fcustomslideshow_cb 6e Spustí vlastnú prezentáciu, v poradí, ktoré ste zadali v nastavení Prezentácia - Vlastná prezentácia.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fpointeraspen 58 Zmení kurzor myši na pero, s ktorým môžete kresliť na snímky počas prezentácie.
33 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Ffrom 20 Zadajte číslo prvého snímku.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fpauseduration a5 Zadajte interval pauzy pre prezentáciu pokiaľ sa prezentácia opäť spustí. Pokiaľ zadáte nulu prezentácia sa spustí okamžite, bez zobrazenia snímku pauzy.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fcustomslideshow 6e Spustí vlastnú prezentáciu, v poradí, ktoré ste zadali v nastavení Prezentácia - Vlastná prezentácia.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2FPresentationDialog 99 Určí nastavenia prezentácie, vrátane snímku, ktorým začína, spôsobu prechádzania medzi snímkami, druhu prezentácie a nastavenia ukazovateľa.
36 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Ffrom_cb 20 Zadajte číslo prvého snímku.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fmanualslides 51 Pokiaľ je zaškrtnuté toto políčko, snímky sa nebudú posúvať automaticky.
36 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fdefault 29 Snímka je zobrazený na celú obrazovku.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fallslides 27 Zahrnie všetky snímky v prezentácii.
35 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fpresentationdialog%2Fwindow 38 Prezentácia je spustená v okne programu $[officename].
19 .uno%3APresentationDialog 99 Určí nastavenia prezentácie, vrátane snímku, ktorým začína, spôsobu prechádzania medzi snímkami, druhu prezentácie a nastavenia ukazovateľa.
36 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2Fstartshow 6c Runs the slide show. Ensure that Use Custom Slide Show is selected if you want to run a custom presentation.
31 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2Fcopy 67 Creates a copy of the selected custom slide show. You can modify the name of the show by clicking Edit.
31 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2Fedit 5b Add, remove or reorder slides as well as change the name of the selected custom slide show.
30 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2Fnew 5b Add, remove or reorder slides as well as change the name of the selected custom slide show.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2Fusecustomshows 6a Runs the custom slide show you selected when you click Start. Otherwise, the entire presentation is shown.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2Fcustomshowlist 30 Lists the custom slide shows that are available.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2FCustomSlideShows bd Defines a custom slide show using slides within the current presentation. You can then pick slides to meet the needs of your audience. You can create as many custom slide shows as you want.
17 .uno%3ACustomShowDialog bd Defines a custom slide show using slides within the current presentation. You can then pick slides to meet the needs of your audience. You can create as many custom slide shows as you want.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdefinecustomslideshow%2Fcustompages 92 Zobrazí zoznam všetkých snímok vo vlastnej prezentácii. Pokiaľ chcete, môžete zmeniť ich poradie v zozname pretiahnutím hore alebo dole.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdefinecustomslideshow%2Fcustomname 50 Zobrazí meno vlastnej prezentácie. Pokiaľ chcete, môžete zadať nové meno.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdefinecustomslideshow%2Fpages 3e Zobrazí všetky snímky v ich poradí v aktuálnom dokumente.
38 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdefinecustomslideshow%2Fremove 85 Removes a slide from the Selected slides list. You need to choose a slide in the Selected slides list before you can use this button.
35 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdefinecustomslideshow%2Fadd 98 Adds an existing slide to the bottom of the Selected slides list. You need to select a slide in the Existing slides list before you can use this button.
47 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fdefinecustomslideshow%2FDefineCustomSlideShow 1f Vytvorí vlastnú prezentáciu.
13 .uno%3AChangeBezier 2e Prevedie vybraný objekt na Beziérovu krivku.
28 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fvectorize%2Ftiles 2d Zadajte veľkosť pravouhlej výplne pozadia.
2c modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fvectorize%2Ffillholes 4b Vyplní medzery vo farbách, ktoré vznikli pri použití bodovej redukcie.
29 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fvectorize%2Fpoints 5b Odstráni farebné polygóny, ktoré sú menšie ako hodnota v pixeloch, ktorú ste zadali.
29 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fvectorize%2Fcolors 78 Zadajte výsledný počet farieb pre konvertovaný obrázok. $[officename] vytvorí pre každú farbu vlastný polygón.
32 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fvectorize%2FVectorizeDialog 61 Prevedie vybraný objekt na mnohouholník, čo je uzavrený objekt ohraničený rovnými čarami.
2a modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fvectorize%2Fpreview 42 Zobrazí náhľad konvertovaného obrázka, bez aplikovania zmien.
14 .uno%3AChangePolygon 61 Prevedie vybraný objekt na mnohouholník, čo je uzavrený objekt ohraničený rovnými čarami.
14 .uno%3AConvertInto3D 3b Prevedie vybraný objekt na trojdimenzionálny (3D) objekt.
1d .uno%3AConvertInto3DLatheFast 4c Vytvorí tretí rozmer otočením vybraného objektu okolo jeho zvislej osy.
18 .uno%3AConvertIntoBitmap 49 Prevedie vybraný objekt na bitmapu (mriežka pixelov tvoriaca obrázok).
1a .uno%3AConvertIntoMetaFile 83 Prevedie vybraný objekt na metasúbor - Windows Metafile Format (WMF) ten obsahuje obidvoje, bitmapové aj vektorové informácie.
19 .uno%3Aconvert_to_contour 3e Prevedie vybraný objekt na polygón alebo skupinu polygónov.
e .uno%3ACombine 2f Zloží dva a viac objektov do jediného tvaru.
10 .uno%3ADismantle 30 Rozdelí zložený objekt na jednotlivé časti.
e .uno%3AConnect 70 Vytvorí čiaru alebo Beziérovu krivku spojením dvoch alebo viac čiar, kriviek alebo iných objektov čiarou.
c .uno%3ABreak 2b Rozpojí čiary spojené príkazom Spojiť.
c .uno%3AMerge 94 Pridá plochu vybraného objektu ku ploche najnižšieho objektu z výberu. Tento príkaz sa dá najlepšie využiť u prekrývajúcich sa objektov.
10 .uno%3ASubstract 47 Odčíta plochu vybraného objektu od najnižšie položeného objektu.
10 .uno%3AIntersect 34 Vytvorí tvar z plôch prekrývajúcich sa objektov.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationcreatetab%2Fauto_preview 41 Vyberte náhľad nového alebo upravte existujúci efekt snímku.
46 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationcreatetab%2Feffect_speed_list 28 Určite rýchlosť alebo dobu animácie.
4d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationcreatedialog%2FCustomAnimationCreate 2e Vyberte efekt a priraďte ho kliknutím na OK.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationspanel%2Fmore_properties 47 Určí ďalšie možnosti vybraného prvku v paneli Vlastná animácia.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Ftext_delay 45 Zadajte percentuálne zdržanie medzi animáciami slov alebo písmen.
43 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Fdim_color_list 18 Vyberte farbu stmavenia.
48 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Ftext_animation_list 34 Zvoľte spôsob animácie textu pre vybraný objekt.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Faeffect_list 63 Vyberte farbu, ktorá má byť zobrazená po skončení efektu alebo iný spôsob jeho zakončenia.
42 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Fsound_preview 21 Prehrá vybraný zvukový súbor.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Fsound_list 44 Vyberte zvuk z Galérie alebo zvoľte jednu z ďalších možností.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Fsmooth_end 48 Umožní realizovať koniec efektu stále zmenšujúcou sa rýchlosťou.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Fsmooth_start 41 Umožní realizovať začiatok efektu vzrastajúcou rýchlosťou.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationeffecttab%2Fprop_list1 21 Udáva smer uskutočnenia efektu.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationtexttab%2Freverse_order 2d Odseky sa budú animovať v opačnom poradí.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationtexttab%2Fanimate_shape 58 Odznačte toto políčko, pokiaľ chcete nechať animovať text bez priloženého tvaru.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fcustomanimationtexttab%2Fauto_after_value 4c Pre animáciu ďalších odsekov zadajte dodatočné zdržanie v sekundách.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationtexttab%2Fauto_after 67 Pokiaľ je vybrané "Zoskupiť text - Podľa prvého odseku" odseky sa budú animovať jeden po druhom.
42 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationtexttab%2Fgroup_text_list 32 Určuje, akým spôsobom sa budú animovať odseky
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fcustomanimationtimingtab%2Ftrigger_list 35 Objekt vyberte zo zoznamu prostredníctvom jeho mena.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fcustomanimationtimingtab%2Frb_click_sequence 58 Určí či sa animácia začne prehrávať klasickým spôsobom, sekvenciu po kliknutí.
36 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fcustomanimationtimingtab%2Frewind 65 Určí či sa animovaný objekt vráti do svojho počiatočného stavu, potom čo animácia skončí.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fcustomanimationtimingtab%2Frb_interactive 48 Určí či sa animácia začne prehrávať po kliknutí na zadaný tvar.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationtimingtab%2Frepeat_list 33 Určí, či a ako sa bude aktuálny efekt opakovať
42 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationtimingtab%2Fduration_list 1c Určuje dobu trvania efektu.
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationtimingtab%2Fdelay_value 44 Určuje dodatočné zdržanie v sekundách, pokým sa spustí efekt.
3f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomanimationtimingtab%2Fstart_list 31 Zobrazí možnosti pre spustenie efektu animácie
13 .uno%3ALeftPaneDraw 21 Zapína a vypína Panel snímok .
16 .uno%3ALeftPaneImpress 21 Zapína a vypína Panel snímok .
23 SD_HID_SD_TASK_PANE_PREVIEW_CURRENT 7b Kliknite ľavým tlačidlom na použitie predlohy stránky na všetky snímky. Pravým tlačidlom vyvoláte miestnu ponuku.
1f SD_HID_SD_TASK_PANE_PREVIEW_ALL 7b Kliknite ľavým tlačidlom na použitie predlohy stránky na všetky snímky. Pravým tlačidlom vyvoláte miestnu ponuku.
23 SD_HID_SD_TASK_PANE_PREVIEW_LAYOUTS 6c Kliknite pre použitie rozvrhnutia snímku na vybrané snímky. Pravým tlačidlom vyvoláte miestnu ponuku.
12 .uno%3ATableDesign 45 Opens the Table Design. Double-click a preview to insert a new table.
1f .uno%3ATaskPaneShowSmallPreview 2e Upraví veľkosť náhľadu predlohy stránky.
1f .uno%3ATaskPaneShowLargePreview 2e Upraví veľkosť náhľadu predlohy stránky.
24 .uno%3ATaskPaneApplyToSelectedSlides 49 Použije predlohu stránky alebo jej rozvrhnutie len na vybrané snímky.
17 SD_HID_SD_SLIDE_DESIGNS 5c Otvorí záložku rozvrhnutia, kde aplikujte rozvrhnutie na vybrané snímky alebo stránky.
18 SD_HID_SD_RECENT_MASTERS 2f Zobrazí naposledy použité predlohy stránok.
1f .uno%3ATaskPaneApplyToAllSlides 2e Použije predlohu stránky na všetky snímky.
16 SD_HID_SD_TABLE_DESIGN 45 Opens the Table Design. Double-click a preview to insert a new table.
1b SD_HID_SD_CUSTOM_ANIMATIONS 58 Otvorí panel vlastných animácií, kde môžete aplikovať efekty na vybrané snímky.
22 SD_HID_SD_TASK_PANE_PREVIEW_RECENT 7b Kliknite ľavým tlačidlom na použitie predlohy stránky na všetky snímky. Pravým tlačidlom vyvoláte miestnu ponuku.
1b SD_HID_SD_SLIDE_TRANSITIONS 59 Otvorí panel prechodov medzi snímkami, kde ich môžete aplikovať na vybrané snímky.
19 SD_HID_SD_CURRENT_MASTERS 3a Zobrazí predlohy stránok použité v tejto prezentácii.
14 SC_HID_SC_DPLAY_DATA bf Otvorí predlohu stránok, kde vyberiete či ju chcete použiť(iba pozadie), na všetky snímky (kliknutím ľavého tlačidla) alebo len na vybrané snímky (kliknutím pravého tlačidla).
15 SD_HID_SD_ALL_MASTERS 2d Zobrazí všetky dostupné predlohy stránok.
10 .uno%3ARightPane 37 Zobrazí alebo skryje panel úloh %PRODUCTNAME Impress.
10 .uno%3AHideSlide 43 Skryje zvolený snímok tak, aby sa nezobrazil počas prezentácie.
12 .uno%3APagesPerRow 53 Zadajte počet snímok, koľko sa zobrazí v každom riadku v Zoraďovači snímok.
10 .uno%3ADiaEffect 4f Zvoľte efekt prechodu, ktorý sa spustí pred zobrazením aktuálneho snímku.
e .uno%3ADiaTime 54 Zadajte čas, po uplznutí ktorého sa prezentácia posunie na nastedujúcu snímku.
16 .uno%3ARehearseTimings 37 Spusti prezentáciu s časovačom v ľavom dolnom rohu.
f .uno%3APosition 49 Zobrazí X-ovú a Y-ovú pozíciu kurzora a veľkosť vybraného objektu.
11 .uno%3APageStatus 3f Zobrazí číslo aktuálneho snímku a celkový počet snímok.
12 .uno%3AZoomPanning 25 Posunie snímok v okne $[officename].
f .uno%3AZoomPage 24 Zobrazí celý snímok na obrazovku.
12 .uno%3AZoomObjects 4e Zmení veľkosť priblíženia, aby boli viditeľné všetky vybrané objekty.
14 .uno%3AZoomPageWidth 56 Zobrazí celú šírku snímku na obrazovku. Horný a dolný okraj nemusí byť vidno.
f .uno%3AZoomNext 2d Zruší príkaz Zväčšiť predchádazjúci.
13 .uno%3AZoomPrevious 34 Vráti zobrazenie na predchádzajúce priblíženie.
12 .uno%3AZoomOptimal 51 Upraví veľkosť priblíženia, aby boli viditeľné všetky objekty na snímku.
15 .uno%3AZoom100Percent 28 Zobrazí snímok v skutočnej veľkosti.
d .uno%3AZoomIn 3b Zobrazí snímok v polovičnej veľkosti oproti súčasnej.
f .uno%3AZoomPlus 35 Zobrazí aktuálny snímok v dvojnásobnej veľkosti.
12 .uno%3AZoomToolBox 69 Zmenší alebo zväčší náhľad na aktuálny dokument. Kliknutím vedľa ikony sa otvorí lišta Lupa.
1a .uno%3AInteractiveGradient 88 Upravuje výplň prechodom vybraného objektu. Tento príkaz je k dispozícii, len ak ste vybraný objekt vyplnili vo Formát - Oblasť.
1e .uno%3AInteractiveTransparence 37 Applies a transparency gradient to the selected object.
c .uno%3AShear 49 Môžete pretiahnuť úchyty vybraného objektu a tým zmeniť jeho tvar.
11 .uno%3ACrookSlant 7f Zdeformuje vybraný objekt tak, že ho obalí okolo imaginárnej kružnice. Vybraný objekt zdeformujete pretiahnutím úchytu.
12 .uno%3ACrookRotate 8d Zdeformuje vybraný objekt otočením okolo imaginárnej kružnice a pridá perspektívu. Vybraný objekt zdeformujete pretiahnutím úchytu.
19 .uno%3AConvertInto3DLathe 4e Konvertuje vybrané 2D objekt(y) na 3D objekt(y) rotáciou okolo osi symetrie.
d .uno%3AMirror e5 Prevráti vybraný objekt (objekty) okolo osy, ktorú môžeme umiestniť kamkoľvek na snímku. Pretiahnutím úchytu objektu okolo osy objekt prevrátite. Pre zmenu orientácie osy, pretiahnite jeden jej koniec na nové miesto.
13 .uno%3AAdvancedMode 3c Upraví tvar, orientáciu alebo výplň vybraných objektov.
17 .uno%3AGlueVertAlignTop 63 Pri zmene veľkosti objektu ostane súčasný záchytný bod prichytený pri pravom okraji objektu.
19 .uno%3AGlueHorzAlignRight 63 Pri zmene veľkosti objektu ostane súčasný záchytný bod prichytený pri pravom okraji objektu.
1a .uno%3AGlueHorzAlignCenter 63 Pri zmene veľkosti objektu ostane súčasný záchytný bod prichytený pri pravom okraji objektu.
1f .uno%3AGlueEscapeDirectionRight 3f Connector attaches to the right edge of the selected gluepoint.
18 .uno%3AGlueHorzAlignLeft 63 Pri zmene veľkosti objektu ostane súčasný záchytný bod prichytený pri pravom okraji objektu.
20 .uno%3AGlueEscapeDirectionBottom 40 Connector attaches to the bottom edge of the selected gluepoint.
1d .uno%3AGlueEscapeDirectionTop 3d Connector attaches to the top edge of the selected gluepoint.
1e .uno%3AGlueEscapeDirectionLeft 3e Connector attaches to the left edge of the selected gluepoint.
1a .uno%3AGlueVertAlignBottom 63 Pri zmene veľkosti objektu ostane súčasný záchytný bod prichytený pri pravom okraji objektu.
1a .uno%3AGlueVertAlignCenter 63 Pri zmene veľkosti objektu ostane súčasný záchytný bod prichytený pri pravom okraji objektu.
12 .uno%3AGluePercent 52 Maintains the relative position of a selected gluepoint when you resize an object.
16 .uno%3AGlueInsertPoint 31 Inserts a gluepoint where you click in an object.
20 .uno%3AVerticalTextFitToSizeTool d6 Nakreslí textový rámec so zvislou orientáciou textu na miesto kliknutia alebo pretiahnutia. Veľkosť vloženého textu sa  automaticky upraví podľa rozmerov rámca. (Treba povoliť podporu ázijského textu)
18 .uno%3ATextFitToSizeTool 96 Nakreslí textové pole v dokumente na mieste kliknutia alebo pretiahnutia. Veľkosť vloženého textu sa automaticky upravuje podľa rozmerov poľa.
b .uno%3AText 72 Nakreslí textový rámec v dokumente. Kilknite na požadované miesto v dokumente a napíšte alebo vložte text.
12 .uno%3ATextToolbox 54 Panel nástrojov Text obsahuje ikony pre vkladanie rôznych druhov textových polí.
1c .uno%3ARect_Rounded_Unfilled 105 Nakreslí prázdny zaoblený obdĺžnik na určené miesto v dokumente. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť roh zaobleného obdĺžnika, a potom natiahnite na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť zaoblený štvorec, podržte počas ťahania Shift.
16 .uno%3ASquare_Unfilled e2 Nakreslí prázdny štvorec na určené miesto v dokumente. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť roh štvorca, a potom natiahnite na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť obdĺžnik, podržte počas ťahania Shift.
15 .uno%3ASquare_Rounded 103 Nakreslí vyplnený zaoblený štvorec na určené miesto v dokumente. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť roh zaobleného štvorca, a potom natiahnite na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť zaoblený obdĺžnik, podržte počas ťahania Shift.
13 .uno%3ARect_Rounded 106 Nakreslí vyplnený zaoblený obdĺžnik na určené miesto v dokumente. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť roh zaobleného obdĺžnika, a potom natiahnite na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť zaoblený štvorec, podržte počas ťahania Shift.
d .uno%3ASquare e3 Nakreslí vyplnený štvorec na určené miesto v dokumente. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť roh štvorca, a potom natiahnite na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť obdĺžnik, podržte počas ťahania Shift.
1e .uno%3ASquare_Rounded_Unfilled 102 Nakreslí prázdny zaoblený štvorec na určené miesto v dokumente. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť roh zaobleného štvorca, a potom natiahnite na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť zaoblený obdĺžnik, podržte počas ťahania Shift.
14 .uno%3ARect_Unfilled e5 Nakreslí prázdny obdĺžnik na určené miesto v dokumente. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť roh obdĺžnika, a potom natiahnite na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť štvorec, podržte počas ťahania Shift.
17 .uno%3ARectangleToolbox 5a Pomocou Nástroje - Prispôsobiť - Panely nástrojov, môžete pridať panel Obdĺžniky.
19 .uno%3ACircleCut_Unfilled 1a7 Nakreslí nevyplnený útvar, ktorý je definovaný kruhovým oblúkom a jednou úsečkou. Na vykreslenie kruhového odseku, natiahnite kruh do požadovanej veľkosti a potom kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť počiatočný bod úsečky. Posuňte kurzor na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť koncový bod úsečky a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť priamo na kruh. Ak chcete eliptický odsek, počas ťahania podržte Shift.
1a .uno%3AEllipseCut_Unfilled 1ad Nakreslí nevyplnený útvar, ktorý je definovaný eliptickým oblúkom a jednou úsečkou. Na vykreslenie eliptického odseku, natiahnite elipsu do požadovanej veľkosti a potom kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť počiatočný bod úsečky. Posuňte kurzor na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť koncový bod úsečky a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť priamo na elipsu. Ak chcete kruhový odsek, počas ťahania podržte Shift.
13 .uno%3APie_Unfilled 1a6 Nakreslí nevyplnený útvar, ktorý je definovaný oválnym oblúkom a dvomi radiálnymi úsečkami. Na vykreslenie eliptického odseku, natiahnite elipsu do požadovanej veľkosti  a potom kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť prvú úsečku. Posuňte kurzor na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť druhú úsečku a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť priamo na elipsu. Ak chcete kruhový výsek, počas ťahania podržte Shift.
10 .uno%3ACircleArc 14c V dokumente nakreslí kruhový oblúk. Ak chcete nakresliť oblúk, natiahnite kruh do požadovanej veľkosti a kliknutím určite začiatočný bod. Presuňte kurzor na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť koncový bod a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť presne na kruh. Ak chcete nakresliť eliptický oblúk, počas ťahania podržte Shift.
16 .uno%3ACircle_Unfilled c2 Nakreslí prázdny kruh na určené miesto. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete nakresliť kruh a natiahnite ho na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť elipsu, počas ťahania podržte Shift.
19 .uno%3ACirclePie_Unfilled 1a2 Nakreslí nevyplnený útvar, ktorý je definovaný kruhovým oblúkom a dvomi radiálnymi úsečkami. Na vykreslenie kruhového výseku, natiahnite kruh do požadovanej veľkosti a potom kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť prvú úsečku. Posuňte kurzor na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť druhú úsečku a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť priamo na kruh. Ak chcete eliptický odsek, počas ťahania podržte Shift.
11 .uno%3AEllipseCut 1be Nakreslí vyplnený útvar, ktorý je definovaný oválnym oblúkom a jednou úsečkou, na miesto v dokumente. Na vykreslenie eliptického odseku, natiahnite elipsu do požadovanej veľkosti a potom kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť počiatočný bod úsečky. Posuňte kurzor na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť koncový bod úsečky a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť priamo na elipsu. Ak chcete kruhový odsek, počas ťahania podržte Shift
10 .uno%3ACirclePie 1b8 Nakreslí vyplnený útvar, ktorý je definovaný kruhovým oblúkom a dvomi radiálnymi čiarami, na miesto v dokumente. Na vykreslenie kruhového výrezu, natiahnite ovál do požadovanej veľkosti a potom kliknite, aby ste nastavili prvú radiálnu čiaru. Posuňte kurzor na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť druhú radiálnu čiaru a kliknite. Na kruh nie je potrebné kliknúť. Ak chcete eliptický výrez, počas ťahania podržte Shift
17 .uno%3AEllipse_Unfilled c4 Nakreslí prázdnu elipsu na určené miesto. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete nakresliť elipsu a natiahnite ju na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť kruh, počas ťahania podržte Shift.
d .uno%3ACircle c6 Nakreslí vyplnený kruh na určené miesto. Kliknite na miesto, kam chcete umiestniť kruh, a potom natiahnite na požadovanú veľkosť. Ak chcete nakresliť elipsu, počas ťahania podržte Shift
15 .uno%3AEllipseToolbox 7a Pomocou Nástroje - Prispôsobiť - Panely nástrojov, môžete pridať ikonu Elipsy, ktorá otvorí panel Kruhy a ovály.
1e .uno%3APolygon_Diagonal_Unfill 145 Draws a line composed of a series of straight line segments, that are constrained by angles of 45 degree. Drag to draw a line segment, click to define the endpoint of the line segment, and then drag to draw a new line segment. Double-click to finish drawing the line. To create a closed shape, hold down Alt and double-click.
f .uno%3AFreeline 100 Nakreslí čiaru voľnou rukou podľa pohybu kurzora. Keď uvoľníte tlačidlo myši, $[officename] vytvorí uzavrený tvar tak, že nakreslí rovnú čiaru z koncového do počiatočného bodu. Tvar vo vnútri čiary sa vyplní aktuálnou farbou oblasti.
17 .uno%3APolygon_Diagonal 1c9 Nakreslí uzavrený tvar zložený z rovných čiar, ktoré su obmedzené na 45-stupňové uhly. Kliknite na miesto, kde chcete začať mnohouholník a potiahnutím nakreslite čiaru. Kliknutím určíte koniec čiary a rovnako pokračujte pri určovaní ďalších častí mnohouholníka. Dvojklikom ukončíte kresbu mnohouholníka. Ak chcete nakresliť mnohouholník, ktorý nie je obmedzený na 45-stupňové uhly, podržte pri kliknutí klávesu Shift.
e .uno%3APolygon 182 Nakreslí uzavrený tvar zložený z rovných čiar. Kliknite na miesto, kde chcete začať mnohouholník a potiahnutím nakreslite čiaru. Kliknutím určíte koniec čiary a rovnako pokračujte pri určovaní ďalších častí mnohouholníka. Dvojklikom ukončíte kresbu mnohouholníka. Ak chcete obmedziť mnohouholník na 45-stupňové uhly, podržte pri kliknutí klávesu Shift.
11 .uno%3ABezierFill 142 Nakreslí vyplnený uzavretý tvar založený na Bézierovej krivke. Kliknite na miesto, odkiaľ chcete krivku začať, ťahajte, uvoľnite tlačidlo myši a potom presuňte kurzor na miesto, kde chcete krivku ukončiť a kliknite. Presunutím kurzora a kliknutím pridáte na krivku rovný úsek. Dvojklik uzavrie krivku.
12 .uno%3ALineToolbox 73 Ikona Krivka na paneli Kresba otvorí panel nástrojov Čiary, pomocou ktorého môžete pridávať čiary a tvary.
11 .uno%3AHalfSphere 58 Nakreslí polguľu. Ak chcete nakresliť polovicu sferoidu, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
c .uno%3ATorus 75 Nakreslí prstencovitý objekt založený na kruhu. Ak chcete torus založený na kruhu, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
e .uno%3ACyramid 158 Nakreslí ihlan so štvorcovou podstavou. Ak chcete ihlan so obdĺžnikovou podstavou, pri ťahaní podržte Shift. Ak chcete ako podstavu ihlanu definovať iný tvar, otvorte dialóg 3D Efekty a kliknite na záložku Geometria. V sekcii Časti, zadajte počet strán mnohouholníka do poľa Vodorovne a kliknite na zelené tlačidlo priradiť.
b .uno%3ACone 77 Nakreslí kužeľ s kruhovou podstavou. Ak chcete nakresliť kužeľ s oválnou podstavou, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
e .uno%3AShell3D 59 Nakreslí časť plášťa gule. Ak chcete oválny plášť, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
f .uno%3ACylinder 5a Nakreslí kruhový valec. Ak chcete nakresliť oválny valec, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
d .uno%3ASphere 59 Nakreslí vyplnenú guľu. Ak chcete nakresliť 3D sféroid, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
b .uno%3ACube 58 Nakreslí vyplnenú kocku. Ak chcete nakresliť 3D kváder, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
17 .uno%3AObjects3DToolbox 6a Opens the 3D Objects toolbar. The objects are three dimensional, with depth, illumination, and reflection.
1d .uno%3AConnectorCurveArrowEnd 95 Draws a curved line connector with an arrow at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1f .uno%3AConnectorCurveArrowStart 9b Draws a curved line connector with an arrow at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
15 .uno%3AConnectorCurve 77 Draws a curved line connector. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1d .uno%3AConnectorLineCircleEnd 97 Draws a straight line connector with a circle at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1f .uno%3AConnectorLineCircleStart 9d Draws a straight line connector with a circle at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1a .uno%3AConnectorLineArrows 92 Draws a straight line connector with arrows at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1c .uno%3AConnectorLineArrowEnd 97 Draws a straight line connector with an arrow at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
14 .uno%3AConnectorLine 79 Draws a straight line connector. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
18 .uno%3AConnectorArrowEnd af Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and an arrow at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1c .uno%3AConnectorLinesCircles 120 Draws a connector that bends near a gluepoint and has circles at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
10 .uno%3AConnector 92 Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1e .uno%3AConnectorLinesCircleEnd 11a Draws a connector that ends with a circle and bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
1b .uno%3AConnectorLinesArrows 11f Draws a connector that bends near a gluepoint and has arrows at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
19 .uno%3AConnectorCircleEnd af Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and a circle at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1e .uno%3AConnectorLineArrowStart 9d Draws a straight line connector with an arrow at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1d .uno%3AConnectorLinesArrowEnd 11a Draws a connector that ends with an arrow and bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
1c .uno%3AConnectorCurveCircles 91 Draws a curved line connector with circles at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
15 .uno%3AConnectorLines 103 Draws a connector that bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
17 .uno%3AConnectorCircles ab Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and circles at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1b .uno%3AConnectorCurveArrows 90 Draws a curved line connector with arrows at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1b .uno%3AConnectorLineCircles 93 Draws a straight line connector with circles at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1a .uno%3AConnectorArrowStart b5 Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and an arrow at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1b .uno%3AConnectorCircleStart b5 Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and a circle at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
20 .uno%3AConnectorCurveCircleStart 9b Draws a curved line connector with a circle at the starting point. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
1f .uno%3AConnectorLinesArrowStart 11c Draws a connector that starts with an arrow and bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
1e .uno%3AConnectorCurveCircleEnd 95 Draws a curved line connector with a circle at the endpoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
20 .uno%3AConnectorLinesCircleStart 11c Draws a connector that starts with a circle and bends near a gluepoint. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release. To adjust the length of the line segment between a bend point and a gluepoint, click the connector and drag the bend point.
16 .uno%3AConnectorArrows aa Draws a connector with one or more 90-degree angle bends and arrows at both ends. Click a gluepoint on an object, drag to a gluepoint on another object, and then release.
17 .uno%3AConnectorToolbox f2 Otvorte panel Spojnice, kde môžete pridávať spojnice k objektom na aktuálnej snímke. Spojnica je čiara, ktorá spája objekty a ostáva s nimi spojená pri presune objektu. Ak kopírujete objekt so spojnicou, skopíruje sa aj spojnica.
14 .uno%3AInsertToolbox 6d Otvorte panel Vložiť, odkiaľ môžete vkladať objekty do dokumentu, napr. grafy, tabuľky alebo obrázky.
11 .uno%3ALineArrows 9f Na mieste, ktoré určíte myšou, nakreslí čiaru so šípkami na oboch koncoch. Ak chcete čiaru obmedziť na uhly 45 stupňov, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
12 .uno%3AMeasureLine 26 Nakreslí čiaru zobrazujúcu rozmery.
16 .uno%3ALineSquareArrow ae Na mieste, ktoré určíte myšou, nakreslí čiaru začínajúcu štvorcom a končiacu šípkou. Ak chcete čiaru obmedziť na uhly 45 stupňov, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
16 .uno%3ALineCircleArrow af Na mieste, ktoré určíte myšou, nakreslí čiaru začínajúcu kružnicou a končiacu šípkou. Ak chcete čiaru obmedziť na uhly 45 stupňov, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
15 .uno%3ALineArrowStart 99 Na mieste, ktoré určíte myšou, nakreslí čiaru začínajúcu šípkou. Ak chcete čiaru obmedziť na uhly 45 stupňov, pri ťahaní podržte Shift..
14 .uno%3ALine_Diagonal 3d Nakreslí čiaru, ktorá je obmedzená na 45-stupňové uhly.
16 .uno%3ALineArrowSquare ae Na mieste, ktoré určíte myšou, nakreslí čiaru začínajúcu šípkou a končiacu štvorcom. Ak chcete čiaru obmedziť na uhly 45 stupňov, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
16 .uno%3ALineArrowCircle af Na mieste, ktoré určíte myšou, nakreslí čiaru začínajúcu šípkou a končiacu kružnicou. Ak chcete čiaru obmedziť na uhly 45 stupňov, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
13 .uno%3ALineArrowEnd 94 Na mieste, ktoré určíte myšou, nakreslí čiaru končiacu šípkou. Ak chcete čiaru obmedziť na uhly 45 stupňov, pri ťahaní podržte Shift.
14 .uno%3AArrowsToolbox 6a Otvorte panel Šípky, odkiaľ môžete pridávať rovné čiary, čiary so šípkami a kótovacie čiary.
19 .uno%3AOutlineCollapseAll cb Na aktuálnej snímke skryje všetky nadpisy okrem nadpisu snímku. Skryté nadpisy sú naznačené čiernou čiarou pred titulkej snímke. Ak chcete zobraziť nadpisy, kliknite na ikonu Všetky úrovne.
17 .uno%3AOutlineExpandAll 9d Zobrazí skryté nadpisy v aktuálnej snímke. Ak chcete skryť všetky nadpisy v aktuálnej snímke okrem titulku snímku, kliknite na ikonu Prvá úroveň.
16 .uno%3AOutlineCollapse ca Skryje všetky podnadpisy vybraného nadpisu. Skryté podnadpisy sú označené čiernou čiarou pred nadpisom. Ak chcete zobraziť nižšie úrovne nadpisov, kliknite na ikonu Zobraziť podčasti icon.
14 .uno%3AOutlineExpand 83 Zobrazí skryté podnadpisy zvoleného nadpisu. Ak chcete skryť podnadpisy zvoleného nadpisu, kliknite na ikonu Skryť podčasti.
14 .uno%3AOutlineFormat a4 Zobrazí alebo skryje formátovanie nadpisov snímku. Ak chcete zmeniť štýl, otvorte okno štýly a formátovanie, pravým kliknite na štýl a zvoľte Upraviť.
10 .uno%3AColorView 1e Zobrazí snímky čiernobielo.
13 .uno%3AGlueEditMode 7f Vloží záchytný bod alebo upraví jeho vlastnosti. Záchytný bod je voliteľný bod, ktorý môžete pripojiť ku spojnici.
1a .uno%3AClickChangeRotation 84 Mení chovanie pri kliknutí myšou tak, že keď kliknete na objekt a potom naň kliknete ešte raz, zobrazia sa rotačné úchyty.
14 .uno%3AAnimationMode b4 Plays a preview of an animation effect that is assigned to an object, when you click the object in the slide. To select an object for editing, hold down the Alt key when you click.
11 .uno%3AActionMode af Runs a preview of the interaction that is assigned to an object, when you click the object in the slide. To select an object for editing, hold down the Alt key when you click.
17 .uno%3AHelplinesVisible a1 Zobrazí alebo skryje vodiace čiary, podľa ktorých môžete zarovnávať objekty na snímku. Ak chcete vodiacu čiaru odstrániť, pretianite ju myšou preč.
1a .uno%3ADoubleClickTextEdit 66 Zmení správanie myši, pri dvojkliku, keď kliknete na objekt, môžete pridať alebo upraviť text.
12 .uno%3ASolidCreate 8e If this icon on the Options bar is activated, objects are shown with their attributes, but with 50% transparency, while you move or draw them.
15 .uno%3ALeaveAllGroups 3e Opustí všetky skupiny a vráti sa do normálneho zobrazenia.
14 .uno%3ADeleteColumns 35 All columns of the current selection will be deleted.
15 .uno%3AAlignObjetMenu 29 Align the table within the page or slide.
14 .uno%3AInsertColumns d4 If currently no cell is selected, a new column will be inserted at the right border of the table. If currently cells are selected, as many new columns as the selection has will be inserted right of the selection.
11 .uno%3AColumnMenu 30 Choose commands for the selected or all columns.
18 .uno%3ADistributeColumns 6d Distributes the width of the selected or all columns to the same size. The width of the table is not changed.
11 .uno%3AInsertRows c5 If currently no cell is selected, a new row will be inserted at the bottom of the table. If currently cells are selected, as many new rows as the selection has will be inserted below the selection.
10 .uno%3ASplitCell 52 The selected cell is split into several cells. You see the Split Cells dialog box.
15 .uno%3ADistributeRows 6c Distributes the height of the selected or all rows to the same size. The height of the table is not changed.
e .uno%3ARowMenu 2d Choose commands for the selected or all rows.
11 .uno%3ADeleteRows 32 All rows of the current selection will be deleted.
13 .uno%3AEntireColumn 9c If currently no cell is selected, all columns will be selected. If currently cells are selected, all columns containing the selected cells will be selected.
12 .uno%3ACellVertTop 34 The cell contents are align at the top of the cells.
10 .uno%3AEntireRow 96 If currently no cell is selected, all rows will be selected. If currently cells are selected, all rows containing the selected cells will be selected.
15 .uno%3ACellVertBottom 39 The cell contents are aligned at the bottom of the cells.
15 .uno%3ACellVertCenter 3f The cell contents are aligned vertically centered in the cells.
12 .uno%3ASelectTable 1d Vyberte databázu a tabuľku.
f .uno%3ACellMenu 55 Define the vertical alignment of selected or all cell contents. Split or merge cells.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnewtabledialog%2FNewTableDialog 27 Zadajte počet stĺpcov novej tabuľky.
11 .uno%3AMergeCells 2c All selected cells are merged into one cell.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fnewtabledialog%2Frows 26 Zadajte počet riadkov novej tabuľky.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fnewtabledialog%2Fcolumns 27 Zadajte počet stĺpcov novej tabuľky.
f .uno%3AFileMenu 73 Tieto príkazy umožňujú prácu s aktuálnym dokumentom, otvorenie nového dokumentu alebo ukončenie aplikácie.
f .uno%3AEditMenu 44 Toto Menu obsahuje príkazy na úpravu obsahu aktuálneho dokumentu.
f .uno%3AViewMenu 4b Toto menu obsahuje príkazy ovládajúce zobrazenie dokumentu na obrazovke.
11 .uno%3AInsertMenu a1 Menu obsahuje príkazy na vkladanie nových prvkov do dokumentu, čo zahrňuje, okrem iného, sekcie, poznámky pod čiarou, zvláštne znaky a ďalšie súbory.
11 .uno%3AFormatMenu 4a Obsahuje príkazy na formátovanie rozloženia a obsahu vášho dokumentu.
10 .uno%3AToolsMenu ae Obsahuje nástroje na kontrolu pravopisu, galériu obrázkov, ktoré môžete pridať do svojho dokumentu a nástroje na prispôsobenie menu a nastavenia predvolieb programu.
11 .uno%3AWindowList 40 Obsahuje príkazy na manipuláciu a zobrazenie okien dokumentov.
11 .uno%3AModifyMenu 32 Obsahuje príkazy na úpravy objektov v dokumente.
14 .uno%3ASlideShowMenu 2c Obsahuje príkazy na spustenie prezentácie.
d .uno%3AShrink 2d Zmenší veľkosť písma označeného textu.
b .uno%3AGrow 2f Zväčší veľkosť písma označeného textu.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_SWAP_ROW 2c Zamení aktuálny riadok s riadkom pod ním.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_SWAP_COL 2d Zamení aktuálny stĺpec so stĺpcom vpravo.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_DELETE_COL 48 Odstráni aktuálny riadok. Riadok hlavičky nie je možné odstrániť.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_DELETE_ROW 48 Odstráni aktuálny riadok. Riadok hlavičky nie je možné odstrániť.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATA_SERIES_LABEL 20 Zadajte názvy dátových radov.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_INSERT_TEXT_COL 56 Inserts a new text column after the current column for hierarchical axes descriptions.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_INSERT_COL 2a Vloží nový riadok pod aktuálny riadok.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_TBI_DATA_INSERT_ROW 2a Vloží nový riadok pod aktuálny riadok.
12 .uno%3ADiagramData 46 Otvorí dialóg Tabuľka dát, v ktorom môžete upraviť dáta grafu.
16 .uno%3AToggleAxisTitle 60 Kliknutím na ikonu Názvy osí zap/vyp na paneli Formát zobrazíte alebo skryjete názvy osí.
12 .uno%3AToggleTitle 62 Kliknutím na ikonu Titulky zap/vyp na paneli Formát zobrazíte alebo skryjete nadpis a podtitul.
17 .uno%3AInsertMenuTitles 38 Opens a dialog to enter or modify the titles in a chart.
34 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_LEGEND_POS%3ALB_LEGEND_TEXTDIR 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_BOTTOM 1a Umiestni legendu pod graf.
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_RIGHT 21 Umiestni legendu vpravo od grafu.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_LEFT 21 Umiestni legendu vľavo od grafu.
13 .uno%3AToggleLegend 60 Pre zobrazenie alebo skrytie legendy, kliknite na ikonu Legenda zap/vyp na paneli Formátovanie.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_TOP 1a Umiestni legendu nad graf.
17 .uno%3AInsertMenuLegend 89 Opens the Legend dialog, which allows you to change the position of legends in the chart, and to specify whether the legend is displayed.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_ROTATION_EDIT 3e Enter the counterclockwise rotation angle for the data labels.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_ROTATION_KNOB 42 Click in the dial to set the text orientation for the data labels.
1c CHART2_HID_SCH_TEXTDIRECTION 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_SEPARATOR 52 Vyberie oddeľovač medzi viacnásobnými textovými reťazcami v rovnakom objekte
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_SYMBOL 41 Zobrazí vedľa každého popisu dátového bodu ikonu z legendy.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_PB_PERCENT_NUMBERFORMAT 2b Otvorí dialóg pre výber formátu percent
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_PLACEMENT 35 Vyberie relatívne umiestnenie popisov dát v objekte
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_PERCENT 42 Zobrazí percentuálne hodnoty dátových bodov v každom stĺpci.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_PB_NUMBERFORMAT 2b Otvorí dialóg pre výber formátu čísla
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_VALUE 2d Zobrazí absolútne hodnoty dátových bodov.
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_NUMBER 2d Zobrazí absolútne hodnoty dátových bodov.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_DATALABEL_TEXT 21 Zobrazí popisy dátových bodov.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuDataLabels 47 Opens the Data Labels dialog, which enables you to set the data labels.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FsecondaryY 22 Zobrazí v grafe sekundárnu os Y.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FprimaryY 2b Zobrazí os Y s pododdielovým rozdelením.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FprimaryX 2b Zobrazí os X s pododdielovým rozdelením.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FsecondaryX 22 Zobrazí v grafe sekundárnu os X.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FprimaryZ 2b Zobrazí os Z s pododdielovým rozdelením.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertaxisdlg%2FInsertAxisDialog 30 Specifies the axes to be displayed in the chart.
15 .uno%3AInsertMenuAxes 30 Specifies the axes to be displayed in the chart.
1a CHART2_HID_SCH_CT_INDICATE 21 Špecifikuje chybový indikátor.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SAME_FOR_BOTH c4 Povolí použiť kladnú chybovú hodnotu ako aj zápornú chybovú hodnotu. Meniť môžete iba hodnoty "Kladného(+)" poľa. Tieto hodnoty sa automaticky prekopírujú do "Záporného(-)" poľa.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_POSITIVE_RANGE 82 Vložte adresu oblasti, z ktorej sa má získať kladná chybová hodnota. Použite tlačidlo Zmenšiť pre výber oblasti v liste
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_NO_ERROR 24 Nezobrazuje žiadne chybové čiary.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_PERCENT_VALUE 75 Zobrazí percentá. Toto zobrazenie odkazuje na zodpovedajúci dátový bod. Nastavte percentá v oblasti Parametrov.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_BIGERROR_VALUE 87 Hranica chyby: Zobrazí hranicu chyby v percentách podľa najvyššej hodnoty v skupine dát. Nastavte percentá v oblasti Parametrov.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_POSITIVE_VALUE 54 Vložte hodnotu na pripočítanie k zobrazenej hodnote ako kladnú chybovú hodnotu.
24 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_FUNCTION_LB 2f Vyberte funkciu pre výpočet chybových čiar.
2f CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_NEGATIVE_RANGE_CHOOSER ac Kliknite na tlačidlo zmenšiť dialóg, potom použite myš pre výber oblasti buniek v zošite. Pre obnovenie dialógu do pôvodnej veľkosti kliknite znovu na tlačidlo.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SHOW_POSITIVE 24 Ukáže iba kladné chybové čiary.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_NEGATIVE_RANGE 85 Vložte adresu oblasti, z ktorej sa má získať záporná chybová hodnota. Použite tlačidlo Zmenšiť pre výber oblasti v liste.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_RANGE 88 Kliknite na oblasť buniek a potom špecifikujte oblasť buniek, z ktorej chcete definovať kladné a záporné hodnoty chybovej čiary.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SIGMA 53 Štandardná odchýlka: Zobrazí štandardnú odchýlku (druhá mocnina odchýlky).
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_FUNCTION 2f Vyberte funkciu pre výpočet chybových čiar.
2f CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_POSITIVE_RANGE_CHOOSER ac Kliknite na tlačidlo zmenšiť dialóg, potom použite myš pre výber oblasti buniek v zošite. Pre obnovenie dialógu do pôvodnej veľkosti kliknite znovu na tlačidlo.
27 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_NEGATIVE_VALUE 54 Vložte hodnotu na odčítanie od zobrazenej hodnoty ako zápornú chybovú hodnotu.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_VARIANT 5f Odchýlka: Zobrazí odchýlku vypočítanú z počtu dátových bodov a príslušných hodnôt.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_PERCENT 75 Zobrazí percentá. Toto zobrazenie odkazuje na zodpovedajúci dátový bod. Nastavte percentá v oblasti Parametrov.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuYErrorBars 40 Use the Y Error Bars dialog to display error bars for 2D charts.
24 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_MINUS_VALUE 49 Zobrazí konštantné hodnoty, ktoré špecifikujete v oblasti Parametre.
21 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_BIGERROR 87 Hranica chyby: Zobrazí hranicu chyby v percentách podľa najvyššej hodnoty v skupine dát. Nastavte percentá v oblasti Parametrov.
26 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SHOW_NEGATIVE 26 Ukáže iba záporné chybové čiary.
23 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_CONSTERROR 49 Zobrazí konštantné hodnoty, ktoré špecifikujete v oblasti Parametre.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_SHOW_BOTH 2c Ukáže kladné a záporné chybové čiary.
23 CHART2_HID_SCH_STATISTIK_PLUS_VALUE 49 Zobrazí konštantné hodnoty, ktoré špecifikujete v oblasti Parametre.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuMeanValues 8c Mean Value Lines are special trend lines that show the mean value. Use Insert - Mean Value Lines to insert mean value lines for data series.
41 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FshowCorrelationCoefficient 39 Ukazuje rovnicu trendovej krivky vedľa regresnej krivky.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FshowEquation 39 Ukazuje rovnicu trendovej krivky vedľa regresnej krivky.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flogarithmic 35 Je zobrazený logaritmický priebeh trendovej krivky.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Flinear 29 Je zobrazená lineárna trendová krivka.
2c modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Fpower 32 Je zobrazený mocninový priebeh trendovej krivky.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2Fexponential 36 Je zobrazený exponenciálny priebeh trendovej krivky.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Trendline%2FTP_TRENDLINE 8f Regresné krivky, tiež známe ako Trendové krivky, môžu byť pridané do všetkých typov 2D grafu okrem Koláčového a Burzového grafu .
1e .uno%3AInsertTrendlineEquation a3 Pre zobrazenie rovnice krivky trendu vyberte krivku trendu v grafe, kliknite na ňu pravým tlačidlom a z lokálnej ponuky vyberte Vložiť Rovnicu Krivky Trendu.
1b .uno%3AInsertMenuTrendlines 8f Regresné krivky, tiež známe ako Trendové krivky, môžu byť pridané do všetkých typov 2D grafu okrem Koláčového a Burzového grafu .
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRB_CONTINUE_LINE 75 For a missing value, the interpolation from the neighbor values will be shown. This is the default for chart type XY.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRB_ASSUME_ZERO 60 For a missing value, the y-value will be shown as zero. This is the default for chart type Area.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRB_DONT_PAINT 67 For a missing value, no data will be shown. This is the default for chart types Column, Bar, Line, Net.
32 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_POLAROPTIONS%3ACB_CLOCKWISE c9 Východzí smer v ktorom sú kúsky koláčového grafu usporiadané, je proti smeru hodinových ručičiek. Zaškrtnite možnosť v smere hodinových ručičiek pre vykreslenie grafu v opačnom smere.
22 CHART2_HID_SCH_STARTING_ANGLE_DIAL 165 Presuňte malú bodku na kruhu alebo kliknite na ľubovoľnom mieste na kruh pre nastavenie počiatočného uhlu koláčového nebo prstencového grafu. Počiatočný uhol je matematická poloha uhlu, kde bude vykreslená prvá časť grafu. Hodnota 90 stupňov vykreslí prvú časť na pozícii 12 hodín. Hodnota 0 stupňov začína na pozícii 3 hodiny.
36 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FCB_CONNECTOR 8b For "stacked" and "percent" column (vertical bar) charts, mark this check box to connect the column layers that belong together with lines.
3b chart2%3ANumericField%3ATP_POLAROPTIONS%3ANF_STARTING_ANGLE 74 Vložte počiatočný uhol medzi 0 a 359 stupňami. Pre zmenu hodnôt veľkosti môžete tiež kliknúť na šípky.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FMT_OVERLAP 3e Určuje nevyhnutné nastavenia pre presahujúce dátové rady.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FMT_GAP 33 Určuje vzdialenosť medzi stĺpcami v percentách.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRBT_OPT_AXIS_2 7f Zmení mierku osi Y. Táto os je viditeľná len ak je k nej priradený aspoň jeden dátový rad a je zapnuté jej zobrazenie.
41 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FCB_INCLUDE_HIDDEN_CELLS 51 Check to also show values of currently hidden cells within the source cell range.
3e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FCB_BARS_SIDE_BY_SIDE 5d Stĺpce z rôznych dátových radov sa zobrazujú, ako keby boli pripojené len k jednej osi.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FRBT_OPT_AXIS_1 5b Táto možnosť je implicitne zapnutá. Všetky riadky dát sú zarovnané k hlavnej osi Y.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_SeriesToAxis%2FTP_OPTIONS 5b Táto možnosť je implicitne zapnutá. Všetky riadky dát sú zarovnané k hlavnej osi Y.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FsecondaryX 38 Pridá mriežku, ktorá rozdelí os X na menšie časti.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FsecondaryY 38 Pridá mriežku, ktorá rozdelí os Y na menšie časti.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FprimaryZ 1f Pridá do grafu mriežku osi Z.
19 .uno%3AToggleGridVertical d2 Ikona Zvislá mriežka zap/vyp na paneli Formátovanie prepína zobrazenie mriežky pre os Y. Poznámka: Funguje iba pokiaľ nie je zaškrtnuté políčko Vedľajšie mriežky osi X v ponuke Vložiť -Mriežky.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FprimaryY 1f Pridá do grafu mriežku osi Y.
1b .uno%3AToggleGridHorizontal cd Ikona Vodorovná mriežka zap/vyp na paneli Formátovanie prepína zobrazenie mriežky pre os X. Poznámka: Funguje iba pokiaľ nie sú zaškrtnuté polia Vedľajšie mriežky v ponuke Vložiť - Mriežky.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FsecondaryZ 38 Pridá mriežku, ktorá rozdelí os Z na menšie časti.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FprimaryX 1f Pridá do grafu mriežku osi X.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Finsertgriddlg%2FInsertGridDialog ad You can divide the axes into sections by assigning gridlines to them. This allows you to get a better overview of the chart, especially if you are working with large charts.
16 .uno%3AInsertMenuGrids ad You can divide the axes into sections by assigning gridlines to them. This allows you to get a better overview of the chart, especially if you are working with large charts.
16 .uno%3AFormatSelection 1c Formats the selected object.
16 .uno%3ASecondaryYTitle 26 Upraví vlastnosti vybraného nadpisu.
16 .uno%3ASecondaryXTitle 26 Upraví vlastnosti vybraného nadpisu.
f .uno%3ASubTitle 26 Upraví vlastnosti vybraného nadpisu.
d .uno%3AZTitle 26 Upraví vlastnosti vybraného nadpisu.
d .uno%3AXTitle 26 Upraví vlastnosti vybraného nadpisu.
10 .uno%3AMainTitle 26 Upraví vlastnosti vybraného nadpisu.
d .uno%3AYTitle 4b Upraví vlastnosti vybraného nadpisu alebo vlastnosti všetkých nadpisov.
10 .uno%3AAllTitles 4b Upraví vlastnosti vybraného nadpisu alebo vlastnosti všetkých nadpisov.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2Fauto 26 Automaticky rozmiestni čísla na osi.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2Feven 45 Rozloží čísla na osi, nepárne čísla budú nižšie ako párne.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FbreakCB 18 Povolí zalomenie textu.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FOrientDegree 28 Môžete ručne zadať uhol orientácie.
3b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftitlerotationtabpage%2FOrientDegree 28 Môžete ručne zadať uhol orientácie.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftitlerotationtabpage%2FtextdirLB 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FoverlapCB 43 Určuje, že text v bunkách môže pretiecť do ďalších buniek.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FstackedCB 2b Text v bunkách sa bude zobrazovať zvislo.
38 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftitlerotationtabpage%2FstackedCB 2b Text v bunkách sa bude zobrazovať zvislo.
33 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FshowlabelsCB 38 Určuje,či sa majú zobraziť alebo skryť názvy osí.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FtextdirLB 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
2a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2Fodd 45 Rozloží čísla na osi, párne čísla budú nižšie ako nepárne.
2b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2Ftile 24 Umiestni čísla na osi vedľa seba.
16 .uno%3AToggleAxisDescr 6b Ikona Zobraziť/Skryť nadpisy osí na paneli Formátovanie zapína alebo vypína zobrazenie nadpisov osí.
37 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_axisLabel%2FAxisLabelTabPage 38 Určuje,či sa majú zobraziť alebo skryť názvy osí.
43 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftitlerotationtabpage%2FTitleRotationTabPage 38 Určuje,či sa majú zobraziť alebo skryť názvy osí.
d .uno%3ALegend 34 Určuje okraje, výplň a vlastnosti znakov legendy.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisB 96 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom môžete upraviť vlastnosti sekundárnej osi Y. Pre vloženie sekundárnej osi Y vyberte Vložiť - Osi a zaškrtnite Os Y.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisA 96 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom môžete upraviť vlastnosti sekundárnej osi X. Pre vloženie sekundárnej osi X vyberte Vložiť - Osi a zaškrtnite Os X.
15 .uno%3ADiagramAxisAll 44 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom môžete upraviť vlastnosti zvolenej osi.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisZ 44 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom môžete upraviť vlastnosti zvolenej osi.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisX 44 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom môžete upraviť vlastnosti zvolenej osi.
13 .uno%3ADiagramAxisY 42 Otvorí dialóg Os Y, v ktorom môžete upraviť vlastnosti osi Y.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FLB_MAIN_TIME_UNIT 3c Zaokrúhľuje číslo na určitý počet desatinných miest.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FMT_STEPHELP 35 Defines the interval for the subdivision of the axes.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FLB_TIME_RESOLUTION 47 Resolution can be set to show days, months, or years as interval steps.
3b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_AUTO_TIME_RESOLUTION 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FLB_AXIS_TYPE 6e For some types of axes, you can select to format an axis as text or date, or to detect the type automatically.
2e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_REVERSE 81 Defines where the lower and where the higher values are displayed at the axis. The unchecked state is the mathematical direction.
32 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_AUTO_ORIGIN 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_LOGARITHM 42 Specifies that you want the axis to be subdivided logarithmically.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_AUTO_STEP_HELP 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
35 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_AUTO_STEP_MAIN 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_AUTO_MIN 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
2f modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FCBX_AUTO_MAX 4b You must first deselect the Automatic option in order to modify the values.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FMT_MAIN_DATE_STEP 3c Zaokrúhľuje číslo na určitý počet desatinných miest.
34 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FLB_HELP_TIME_UNIT 3c Zaokrúhľuje číslo na určitý počet desatinných miest.
2d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FEDT_ORIGIN 41 Specifies at which position to display the values along the axis.
30 modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FEDT_STEP_MAIN 37 Defines the interval for the main division of the axes.
2a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FEDT_MAX 32 Defines the maximum value for the end of the axis.
2a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Ftp_Scale%2FEDT_MIN 38 Defines the minimum value for the beginning of the axis.
35 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ALB_PLACE_TICKS 4b Select where to place the marks: at labels, at axis, or at axis and labels.
3f chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ALB_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 5f Select where to cross the other axis: at start, at end, at a specified value, or at a category.
30 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_CB_MINOR_OUTER 52 Určuje, že sa značky vedľajšieho intervalu zobrazia na vonkajšej strane osi.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ACB_MINOR_INNER 52 Určuje, že sa značky vedľajšieho intervalu zobrazia na vnútornej strane osi.
30 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_CB_MINOR_INNER 52 Určuje, že sa značky vedľajšieho intervalu zobrazia na vnútornej strane osi.
39 CHART2_LISTBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_LB_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 5f Select where to cross the other axis: at start, at end, at a specified value, or at a category.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ACB_TICKS_OUTER 3a Určuje, že sa značky zobrazia na vonkajšej strane osi.
42 chart2%3ASpinField%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3AEDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 40 Enter the value where the axis line should cross the other axis.
30 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_CB_TICKS_OUTER 3a Určuje, že sa značky zobrazia na vonkajšej strane osi.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ACB_TICKS_INNER 3a Určuje, že sa značky zobrazia na vnútornej strane osi.
30 CHART2_CHECKBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_CB_TICKS_INNER 3a Určuje, že sa značky zobrazia na vnútornej strane osi.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ACB_MINOR_OUTER 52 Určuje, že sa značky vedľajšieho intervalu zobrazia na vonkajšej strane osi.
36 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3ALB_PLACE_LABELS 63 Select where to place the labels: near axis, near axis (other side), outside start, or outside end.
30 CHART2_LISTBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_LB_PLACE_LABELS 63 Select where to place the labels: near axis, near axis (other side), outside start, or outside end.
2f CHART2_LISTBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_LB_PLACE_TICKS 4b Select where to place the marks: at labels, at axis, or at axis and labels.
3c CHART2_SPINFIELD_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_EDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT 40 Enter the value where the axis line should cross the other axis.
44 CHART2_COMBOBOX_TP_AXIS_POSITIONS_EDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT_CATEGORY 44 Select the category where the axis line should cross the other axis.
4a chart2%3AComboBox%3ATP_AXIS_POSITIONS%3AEDT_CROSSES_OTHER_AXIS_AT_CATEGORY 44 Select the category where the axis line should cross the other axis.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridZHelp 43 Otvorí dialóg Mriežka, kde môžete určiť vlastnosti mriežky.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridYHelp 43 Otvorí dialóg Mriežka, kde môžete určiť vlastnosti mriežky.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridXHelp 43 Otvorí dialóg Mriežka, kde môžete určiť vlastnosti mriežky.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridZMain 43 Otvorí dialóg Mriežka, kde môžete určiť vlastnosti mriežky.
15 .uno%3ADiagramGridAll 43 Otvorí dialóg Mriežka, kde môžete určiť vlastnosti mriežky.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridYMain 43 Otvorí dialóg Mriežka, kde môžete určiť vlastnosti mriežky.
17 .uno%3ADiagramGridXMain 43 Otvorí dialóg Mriežka, kde môžete určiť vlastnosti mriežky.
12 .uno%3ADiagramWall 88 Otvorí dialóg Stena grafu, kde môžete upraviť vlastnosti steny grafu. Stena grafu je "zvislé" pozadie za dátovou oblasťou grafu.
13 .uno%3ADiagramFloor a7 Otvorí dialóg Päta grafu, kde môžete upraviť vlastnosti päty grafu. Päta grafu je dolná oblasť v 3D grafoch. Táto funkcia je k dispozícii len pre 3D grafy.
12 .uno%3ADiagramArea 81 Otvorí dialóg Plocha grafu, kde môžete upraviť vlastnosti plochy grafu. Plocha grafu je pozadie za všetkými prvkami grafu.
3e modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsmoothlinesdlg%2FPolynomialsSpinButton 17 Nastaviť rozlíšenie.
3d modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsmoothlinesdlg%2FResolutionSpinbutton 17 Nastaviť rozlíšenie.
3b modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsmoothlinesdlg%2FSplineTypeComboBox 19 Apply a line curve model.
3a modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsmoothlinesdlg%2FSmoothLinesDialog 19 Apply a line curve model.
3c modules%2Fschart%2Fui%2Fsteppedlinesdlg%2FSteppedLinesDialog 3d Start with horizontal line and step up vertically at the end.
42 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_AMBIENT_COLOR 30 Vyberte farbu pomocou dialógu pre výber farby.
46 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHTSOURCE_COLOR 30 Vyberte farbu pomocou dialógu pre výber farby.
3b chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ALB_LIGHTSOURCE 28 Vyberte farbu pre vybraný zdroj svetla.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_8 38 Kliknutím vypnete alebo zapnete jednotný zdroj svetla.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_6 38 Kliknutím vypnete alebo zapnete jednotný zdroj svetla.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_5 38 Kliknutím vypnete alebo zapnete jednotný zdroj svetla.
3f chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3AMTR_FLD_Y_ROTATION 4f Nastavuje rotáciu grafu na osi y. Náhľad sa mení podľa nových nastavení.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_4 38 Kliknutím vypnete alebo zapnete jednotný zdroj svetla.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_3 38 Kliknutím vypnete alebo zapnete jednotný zdroj svetla.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_1 4c Kliknutím zapnete alebo vypnete odrazový svetelný zdroj so zvýraznením.
3a chart2%3ACheckbox%3ATP_3D_SCENEAPPEARANCE%3ACB_ROUNDEDEDGE 17 Okraje sa o 5% zaoblia.
40 chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3AMTR_FLD_PERSPECTIVE d6 Zaškrtnite pole Perspektíva pre zobrazenie grafu ako cez objektív kamery. V rolovacom poli nastavte percentá. Pri vyššom percentuálnom nastavení vyzerajú bližšie objekty väčšie ako tie vzdialenejšie.
3a chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEAPPEARANCE%3ACB_OBJECTLINES 45 Nastavením štýlu čiary na plný sa zobrazia okraje okolo oblasti.
34 chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEAPPEARANCE%3ALB_SCHEME 4b Vyberte schému zo zoznamu alebo kliknite na zaškrtávacie polia nižšie.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_7 38 Kliknutím vypnete alebo zapnete jednotný zdroj svetla.
39 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3ACBX_PERSPECTIVE d6 Zaškrtnite pole Perspektíva pre zobrazenie grafu ako cez objektív kamery. V rolovacom poli nastavte percentá. Pri vyššom percentuálnom nastavení vyzerajú bližšie objekty väčšie ako tie vzdialenejšie.
3f chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3AMTR_FLD_X_ROTATION 4f Nastavuje rotáciu grafu na osi x. Náhľad sa mení podľa nových nastavení.
3c chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ABTN_LIGHT_2 38 Kliknutím vypnete alebo zapnete jednotný zdroj svetla.
d .uno%3AView3D 9f Opens a dialog to edit the properties of a three dimensional view for Column, Bar, Pie, and Area charts. For Line and XY (Scatter) charts you can see 3D lines.
3f chart2%3AMetricField%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3AMTR_FLD_Z_ROTATION 4f Nastavuje rotáciu grafu na osi z. Náhľad sa mení podľa nových nastavení.
3f chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEGEOMETRY%3ACBX_RIGHT_ANGLED_AXES fb Pokiaľ sú zapnuté Pravouhlé osi, môžete rotovať obsah grafu len v smere osí X a Y, tj. paralelne s okrajmi grafu. Pre novo vytvorené 3D grafy sú pravouhlé osi implicitne zapnuté. Koláčové a Prstencové grafy nepodporujú pravouhlé osi.
3c chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEILLUMINATION%3ALB_AMBIENTLIGHT 24 Vyberte farbu okolitého osvetlenia.
36 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_3D_SCENEAPPEARANCE%3ACB_SHADING 62 Pokiaľ je zaškrtnuté, použije sa Gouraudovo tieňovanie, inak sa použije ploché tieňovanie.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_SECONDARY_Y 69 Vloží popis pre druhú os y. Táto možnosť je dostupná iba pre grafy, ktoré podporujú druhú os y.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_SECONDARY_X 69 Vloží popis pre druhú os x. Táto možnosť je dostupná iba pre grafy, ktoré podporujú druhú os x.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_ZGRID 4b Zadajte popis osi z. Táto voľba je dostupná len pre trojrozmerné grafy.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_YGRID 39 Displays grid lines that are perpendicular to the y-axis.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CB_XGRID 39 Displays grid lines that are perpendicular to the x-axis.
20 CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_BOTTOM 1f Umiestni legendu dole pod graf.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_TOP 1f Umiestni legendu hore nad graf.
1a CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_SHOW 19 Zobrazí legendu v grafe.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_LEFT 25 Umiestni legendu vľavo vedľa grafu.
16 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_Z 4b Zadajte popis osi z. Táto voľba je dostupná len pre trojrozmerné grafy.
16 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_Y 1e Zadajte popis osi y (zvislá).
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_LEGEND_POS_RIGHT 26 Umiestni legendu doprava vedľa grafu.
16 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_X 21 Zadajte popis osi x (vodorovná).
18 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_SUB 18 Zadajte podnadpis grafu.
19 CHART2_HID_SCH_TITLE_MAIN 15 Zadajte nadpis grafu.
12 .uno%3ADiagramType 1a Otvorí dialóg Typ grafu.
34 chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ACB_XVALUE_SORTING 67 V XY bodovom grafe spojí body podľa vzostupných hodnôt X, aj keď je poradie hodnôt pôvodne iné.
35 chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3APB_SPLINE_DIALOG 33 Opens a dialog to set the line or curve properties.
2d chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ALB_LINETYPE 20 Choose the type of line to draw.
38 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ARB_STACK_Y_PERCENT 30 Skladané rady zobrazujú hodnoty ako percentá.
30 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ARB_STACK_Y 2c Zložené rady zobrazujú hodnoty nad sebou.
2d chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ACB_STACKED 2d Zobrazuje zložené rady pre Čiarové grafy.
1e CHART2_HID_SCH_LB_BAR_GEOMETRY 18 Vyberte tvar zo zoznamu.
2d chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ACB_3D_LOOK 21 Zapne 3D vzhľad hodnôt údajov.
1a CHART2_HID_SCH_CTL_VARIANT 29 Zvoľte variantu základného typu grafu.
1b CHART2_HID_SCH_NUM_OF_LINES 3d Určenie počtu čiar pre typy grafov Stĺpcový a Čiarový.
17 CHART2_HID_SCH_CTL_TYPE 1d Zvoľte základný typ grafu.
2e chart2%3AListBox%3ATP_CHARTTYPE%3ALB_3D_SCHEME 1a Zvoľte typ 3D zobrazenia.
1d CHART2_HID_SCH_WIZARD_ROADMAP 33 Po kliknutí prejdete na danú stránku sprievodcu.
3e chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3ACB_FIRST_COLUMN_ASLABELS 12e Pre dátové rady v stĺpcoch: Prvý stĺpec v rozsahu sa použije pre názvy dátových radov. Pre dátové rady v riadkoch: Prvý stĺpec v rozsahu sa použije ako kategória. Ďalšie stĺpce predstavujú dátové stĺpce. Pokiaľ nie je toto pole zaškrtnuté, všetky stĺpce sú dátové stĺpce.
3b chart2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3ACB_FIRST_ROW_ASLABELS 122 Pre dátové rady v stĺpcoch: Prvý riadok v rozsahu sa použije pre názvy dátových radov. Pre dátové rady v riadkoch: Prvý riadok rozsahu sa použije ako kategória. Ďalšie riadky predstavujú dátové rady. Pokiaľ nie je toto pole zaškrtnuté, všetky riadky sú dátové rady.
34 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3ARB_DATAROWS f5 Dátové rady získavajú údaje z po sebe idúcich riadkov v určenom rozsahu. Pre bodové grafy obsahuje prvá dátová rada hodnoty x pre všetky dátové rady. Všetky ostatné dátové rady sa použijú ako hodnoty y, jedna pre každý rad.
34 chart2%3ARadioButton%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3ARB_DATACOLS f3 Dátové rady získavajú údaje z po sebe idúcich stĺpcov v určenom rozsahu. Pre bodové grafy obsahuje prvý dátový stĺpec hodnoty x pre všetky rady. Všetky ostatné dátové stĺpce sa použijú ako hodnoty y, jeden pre každý rad.
31 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3AIB_RANGE a8 Zadajte rozsah dát, ktorý chcete použiť v grafe. V Calc kliknite na ikonu Vybrať rozsah dát, ak chcete minimalizovať tento dialóg pokiaľ vyberáte rozsah dát.
2a chart2%3AEdit%3ATP_RANGECHOOSER%3AED_RANGE a8 Zadajte rozsah dát, ktorý chcete použiť v grafe. V Calc kliknite na ikonu Vybrať rozsah dát, ak chcete minimalizovať tento dialóg pokiaľ vyberáte rozsah dát.
11 .uno%3ADataRanges 50 Otvorí dialóg Rozsahy dát, kde môžete upraviť Rozsah dát a Dátové rady.
2d chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3ABTN_UP 3f Posunie označený záznam v zozname Dátových radov vyššie.
31 chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3ABTN_REMOVE 39 Odstráni označený záznam zo zoznamu Dátových radov.
2f chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3ABTN_DOWN 3f Posunie označený záznam v zozname Dátových radov nižšie.
2e chart2%3APushButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3ABTN_ADD 91 Pridá nový záznam pod aktuálny záznam v zozname Dátové rady. Pokiaľ je vybraný nejaký záznam, nový dátový rad bude rovnakého typu.
35 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3AIMB_RANGE_CAT 14e Zobrazuje zdrojový rozsah pre kategórie (texty, ktoré sa zobrazia na osi X). Pre graf XY toto textové pole obsahuje zdrojový rozsah pre popisky dát, ktoré sa zobrazujú pri dátových bodoch. V Calc kliknite na tlačidlo Vybrať rozsah dát, ak chcete minimalizovať tento dialóg pokiaľ budete označovať rozsah dát myšou.
2f chart2%3AEdit%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3AEDT_CATEGORIES 14e Zobrazuje zdrojový rozsah pre kategórie (texty, ktoré sa zobrazia na osi X). Pre graf XY toto textové pole obsahuje zdrojový rozsah pre popisky dát, ktoré sa zobrazujú pri dátových bodoch. V Calc kliknite na tlačidlo Vybrať rozsah dát, ak chcete minimalizovať tento dialóg pokiaľ budete označovať rozsah dát myšou.
36 chart2%3AImageButton%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3AIMB_RANGE_MAIN 11c Zobrazuje zdrojový rozsah dát z druhého stĺpca zoznamu Rozsah dát. Rozsah môžete upraviť v textovom poli alebo označiť myšou v dokumente. V Calc kliknite na tlačidlo Vybrať rozsah dát, ak chcete minimalizovať tento dialóg pokiaľ budete označovať rozsah dát myšou.
2a chart2%3AEdit%3ATP_DATA_SOURCE%3AEDT_RANGE 11c Zobrazuje zdrojový rozsah dát z druhého stĺpca zoznamu Rozsah dát. Rozsah môžete upraviť v textovom poli alebo označiť myšou v dokumente. V Calc kliknite na tlačidlo Vybrať rozsah dát, ak chcete minimalizovať tento dialóg pokiaľ budete označovať rozsah dát myšou.
1f CHART2_HID_SCH_DATA_RANGES_LIST b9 Zobrazí všetky rozsahy dát používané dátovými radmi, ktoré sú vybrané v zozname Dátových radov. Pre každý rozsah dát sa zobrazuje názov oblasti a zdrojový rozsah dát.
1a CHART2_HID_SCH_SERIES_LIST c0 Zobrazuje zoznam všetkých dátových radov grafu. Po kliknutí na záznam sa tento zobrazí a môžete ho upraviť. Kliknutím na Pridať vložíte nové rady do zoznamu za vybraný záznam.
11 .uno%3ADataInRows 1f Zmení usporiadanie dát grafu.
14 .uno%3ADataInColumns 1f Zmení usporiadanie dát grafu.
10 .uno%3AScaleText 3b Zmení mierku textu v grafe, keď zmeníte veľkosť grafu.
15 .uno%3ANewArrangement 93 Presunie všetky objekty grafu na ich začiatočnú pozíciu. Táto funkcia nemení typ grafu ani žiadny iný atribút okrem umiestnenia objektov.
12 .uno%3AContextType 28 Zobrazuje názov typu aktuálneho grafu.
15 .uno%3AResetDataPoint 49 Vráti formát vybraného dátového bodu do východiskového nastavenia.
17 .uno%3ADeleteYErrorBars 20 Odstráni chybové čiary osi Y.
16 .uno%3ADeleteDataLabel 1e Odstráni vybraný popis dát.
14 .uno%3ADeleteR2Value 16 Odstráni hodnotu R².
1e .uno%3ADeleteTrendlineEquation 23 Odstráni rovnicu trendovej línie.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMinorGrid 1f Odstráni vedľajšiu mriežku.
19 .uno%3AResetAllDataPoints 47 Vráti formát všetkých dátových bodov do predvoleného nastavenia.
11 .uno%3ADeleteAxis 16 Odstráni vybranú os.
17 .uno%3ADeleteDataLabels 1e Odstráni všetky popisy dát.
13 .uno%3ADeleteLegend 18 Odstráni legendu grafu.
18 .uno%3AInsertObjectChart 11a Vytvorí graf v aktuálnom dokumente. Spojitú oblasť buniek použijete ako zdroj dát pre graf tak, že kliknete dovnútra oblasti buniek a použijete tento príkaz. Prípadne môžete označiť len vybrané bunky a použiť tento príkaz na vytvorenie grafu len z týchto buniek.
17 .uno%3AInsertRemoveAxes 35 Otvorí dialóg pre vloženie alebo odstránenie ôs.
16 .uno%3AFormatChartArea 19 Formátuje oblasť grafu.
16 .uno%3AInsertMajorGrid 19 Vloží hlavnú mriežku.
16 .uno%3AInsertAxisTitle 2a Otvorí dialóg pre vloženie nadpisu osi.
17 .uno%3AInsertDataLabels 14 Vloží popisy dát.
13 .uno%3AInsertTitles 2d Otvorí dialóg pre vloženie nadpisov grafu.
16 .uno%3AInsertMinorGrid 1d Vloží vedľajšiu mriežku.
10 .uno%3ADrawChart 11a Vytvorí graf v aktuálnom dokumente. Spojitú oblasť buniek použijete ako zdroj dát pre graf tak, že kliknete dovnútra oblasti buniek a použijete tento príkaz. Prípadne môžete označiť len vybrané bunky a použiť tento príkaz na vytvorenie grafu len z týchto buniek.
1e .uno%3AFormatTrendlineEquation 25 Formátuje rovnicu trendovej priamky.
16 .uno%3AFormatMeanValue 23 Formátuje líniu strednej hodnoty.
11 .uno%3AInsertAxis 22 Otvorí dialóg pre vloženie osi.
13 SW_HID_INSERT_CHART 11a Vytvorí graf v aktuálnom dokumente. Spojitú oblasť buniek použijete ako zdroj dát pre graf tak, že kliknete dovnútra oblasti buniek a použijete tento príkaz. Prípadne môžete označiť len vybrané bunky a použiť tento príkaz na vytvorenie grafu len z týchto buniek.
16 .uno%3AStarChartDialog 11a Vytvorí graf v aktuálnom dokumente. Spojitú oblasť buniek použijete ako zdroj dát pre graf tak, že kliknete dovnútra oblasti buniek a použijete tento príkaz. Prípadne môžete označiť len vybrané bunky a použiť tento príkaz na vytvorenie grafu len z týchto buniek.
16 .uno%3AFormatTrendline 19 Formátuje líniu trendu.
16 .uno%3AFormatStockGain 28 Formátuje indikátory akciového zisku.
14 .uno%3AInsertR2Value 25 Vloží koeficient determinácie R².
16 .uno%3AFormatMinorGrid 20 Formátuje vedľajšiu mriežku.
16 .uno%3AFormatDataPoint 18 Formátuje dátový bod.
16 .uno%3AInsertDataLabel 19 Vloží jeden popis dát.
23 .uno%3AInsertTrendlineEquationAndR2 3d Vloží rovnicu línie trendu a koeficient determinácie R².
16 .uno%3AFormatMajorGrid 1c Formátuje hlavnú mriežku.
12 .uno%3AFormatTitle 1b Formátuje vybraný nadpis.
11 .uno%3AFormatAxis 17 Formátuje vybranú os.
17 .uno%3AFormatDataSeries 19 Formátuje dátové rady.
17 .uno%3AFormatYErrorBars 24 Formátuje rozptyl hodnôt na osi Y.
12 .uno%3AFormatFloor 17 Formátuje pätu grafu.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMeanValue 22 Odstráni líniu strednej hodnoty.
16 .uno%3ADeleteMajorGrid 1b Odstráni hlavnú mriežku.
13 .uno%3AFormatLegend 19 Formátuje legendu grafu.
16 .uno%3AFormatStockLoss 27 Formátuje indikátory akciovej straty.
11 .uno%3AFormatWall 17 Formátuje stenu grafu.
17 .uno%3AFormatDataLabels 17 Formátuje popisy dát.
16 .uno%3AFormatDataLabel 1f Formátuje vybraný popis dát.
1b .uno%3AChartElementSelector b3 Vyberte prvok grafu, ktorý chcete formátovať. Vybraný prvok sa zvýrazní v náhľade grafu. Kliknutím na Formátovať výber sa otvorí dialóg vlastností vybraného prvku.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDPREV 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_PREVIOUS 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DBWIZ_PREVIOUS 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_PREVIOUS 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged.
1c SFX2_HID_TABDLG_STANDARD_BTN 50 Resets the values visible in the dialog back to the default installation values.
19 SFX2_HID_TABDLG_RESET_BTN 97 Resets changes made to the current tab to those applicable when this dialog was opened. A confirmation query does not appear when you close the dialog.
11 WIZARDS_HID0_PREV 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDPREV 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
17 DBACCESS_HID_DBWIZ_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
17 SVX_HID_GALLERY_PREVIEW 2c Displays a preview of the current selection.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fadvancedfilterdialog%2Frbcopyarea f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
1b CUI_HID_MEASURE_CTL_PREVIEW 2c Displays a preview of the current selection.
38 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Frbcopyarea f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
1c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_BACK 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged.
3a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fadvancedfilterdialog%2Frbfilterarea f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fmanagenamesdialog%2Fassign f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND3_2 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDFINISH 2a Applies all changes and closes the wizard.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND1_2 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fprintareasdialog%2Frbrepeatrow f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
15 SW_HID_MD_GLOS_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconsolidatedialog%2Frbdestarea f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_0_CMDPREV 63 View the selections in the dialog made in the previous step. The current settings remain unchanged.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fnamerangesdialog%2Frbassign2 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
1c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fgoalseekdlg%2Fvarbutton f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
36 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_PIVOT_LAYOUT%3ARB_OUTAREA f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
2d modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fcatalogdialog%2Finsert 43 Applies the modified or selected values without closing the dialog.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDNEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fdelabbrev 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND1_1 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
2a sw%3APushButton%3ADLG_BIB_BASE%3APB_DELETE 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconsolidatedialog%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fnamerangesdialog%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fmanagenamesdialog%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
1a ui%2Fgradientpage%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND2_1 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
2f sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_TABOP%3ARB_COLCELL f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fdeldouble 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBTN_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
23 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_DLGS%3ARID_PB_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
28 modules%2Fsdraw%2Fui%2Fcopydlg%2Fdefault 50 Resets the values visible in the dialog back to the default installation values.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
1c WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_CANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
33 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_AUTOFORMAT%3ABTN_REMOVE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fconsolidatedialog%2Frbdataarea f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND3_1 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fnamerangesdialog%2Frbassign f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
2b sw%3APushButton%3ATP_STD_FONT%3APB_STANDARD 50 Resets the values visible in the dialog back to the default installation values.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_CANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
1e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CREATE 2a Applies all changes and closes the wizard.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDCANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
3b cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_MULTIPATH%3ABTN_DEL_MULTIPATH 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fprintareasdialog%2Frbprintarea f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
33 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fcustomslideshows%2Fdelete 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
3b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fdefinedatabaserangedialog%2Fassignrb f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fprintareasdialog%2Frbrepeatcol f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
39 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fdefinedatabaserangedialog%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
2f sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_TABOP%3ARB_ROWCELL f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_0_CMDCANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONDFORMAT%3ARB_COND2_2 f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDCANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FbuttonBTN_DEL 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
23 hid%2Fcui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fdelete 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
34 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFADLG_OPTIONS_TREE%3APB_BACK 40 Resets modified values back to the $[officename] default values.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fgoalseekdlg%2Fformulabutton f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
11 WIZARDS_HID0_NEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
34 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_TABOP%3ARB_FORMULARANGE f9 Click the Shrink icon to reduce the dialog to the size of the input field. It is then easier to mark the required reference in the sheet. The icons then automatically convert to the Maximize icon. Click it to restore the dialog to its original size.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDCANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
13 WIZARDS_HID0_CANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDNEXT 9e Click the Next button, and the wizard uses the current dialog settings and proceeds to the next step. If you are on the last step, this button becomes Create.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_CANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_MODULS%3ARID_PB_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_DELETE 3c Deletes the selected element or elements after confirmation.
1e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CANCEL 53 Kliknutím na Zrušiť zavriete okno bez uloženia akýchkoľvek vykonaných zmien.
19 SVX_HID_GALLERY_ACTUALIZE 39 Updates the view in the window or in the selected object.
1f SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_OPEN_OBJECT 3f Use the Open command to open the selected object in a new task.
18 SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_OPEN 3f Use the Open command to open the selected object in a new task.
1b SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_DESTROY 99 Deletes the current selection. If multiple objects are selected, all will be deleted. In most cases, a security query appears before objects are deleted.
1a SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_RENAME 28 Enables a selected object to be renamed.
1f SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_OPEN_FOLDER 3f Use the Open command to open the selected object in a new task.
18 SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_COPY 2d Copies the selected element to the clipboard.
1d SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_BACKGROUND 35 Inserts the selected picture as a background graphic.
19 SID_EXPLORERCONTENT_PASTE 46 Inserts the element that you moved to the clipboard into the document.
1c SFX2_HID_DID_SAVE_PACKED_XML 50 By default, $[officename] loads and saves files in the OpenDocument file format.
11 .uno%3AActiveHelp 53 Enables the display of a brief description of menus and icons at the mouse pointer.
e .uno%3AHelpTip 4f Enables the display of icon names at the mouse pointer and other Help contents.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcolor1rb 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
26 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcompresslzw 2e Upraví veľkosť náhľadu predlohy stránky.
2e svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fresolutionmf-nospin 2c Vloží pozdrav. Vyberte pozdrav zo zoznamu.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Flevel1rb 8f Otvorí dialóg Štítky, kde je možné upraviť nastavenia pre štítky a následne vytvoriť nový textový dokument ($[officename] Writer).
27 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Finterlacedcb 21 Určiť poradie dátových bodov.
28 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fepsipreviewcb b6 Specifies whether a monochrome preview graphic in EPSI format is exported together with the PostScript file. This format only contains printable characters from the 7-bit ASCII code.
28 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Ftiffpreviewcb 2e Upraví veľkosť náhľadu predlohy stránky.
27 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcompressnone 34 Vyberte túto ikonku, ak chcete prechádzať sekcie.
2b svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcompressionpngnf 62 Sets the compression for the export. A high compression means a smaller, but slower to load image.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fbinarycb 3c Otvorí Sprievodcu databázou na vytvorenie novej databázy.
27 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcolordepthlb 28 Vyberte farbu pre vybraný zdroj svetla.
20 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Frlecb 36 Vyberte túto ikonku, ak chcete prechádzať obrázky.
2b svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcompressionjpgnf 79 Sets the quality for the export. Choose from a low quality with minimal file size, up to a high quality and big file size
2d svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fsavetransparencycb ba Specifies whether to save the background of the picture as transparent. Only objects will be visible in the GIF image. Use the Color Replacer to set the transparent color in the picture.
22 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fwidthlb 18 Zavrie dialógové okno.
21 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Ftextcb 35 Vygeneruje názov súboru podľa údajov v databáze.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fcolor2rb 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
23 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Flevel2rb 36 Vyberte túto ikonku, ak chcete prechádzať obrázky.
27 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fresolutionlb 2c Vloží pozdrav. Vyberte pozdrav zo zoznamu.
2a svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fheightmf-nospin 18 Zavrie dialógové okno.
29 svt%2Fui%2Fgraphicexport%2Fwidthmf-nospin 17 Nastaviť rozlíšenie.
2c sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ALB_FONT 41 Select the character set from the options used for import/export.
33 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ACB_FIXEDWIDTH 2b Exports all data fields with a fixed width.
31 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ACB_QUOTEALL c0 Exports all text cells with leading and trailing quote characters as set in the Text delimiter box. If not checked, only those text cells get quoted that contain the Field delimiter character.
30 sc%3AComboBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3AED_TEXTSEP 44 Choose or enter the text delimiter, which encloses every data field.
31 sc%3AComboBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3AED_FIELDSEP 41 Choose or enter the field delimiter, which separates data fields.
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ACB_SAVESHOWN bc Enabled by default, data will be saved as displayed, including applied number formats. If this checkbox is not marked, raw data content will be saved, as in older versions of the software.
2e sc%3AListBox%3ARID_SCDLG_IMPORTOPT%3ADDLB_FONT 2c Specifies the character set for text export.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ftextdelimiter 5c Select a character to delimit text data. You can can also enter a character in the text box.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Finputother 88 Separates data into columns using the custom separator that you specify. Note: The custom separator must also be contained in your data.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fother 88 Separates data into columns using the custom separator that you specify. Note: The custom separator must also be contained in your data.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fspace 30 Separates data delimited by spaces into columns.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fcolumntype 5f Choose a column in the preview window and select the data type to be applied the imported data.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fcomma 30 Separates data delimited by commas into columns.
3b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fdetectspecialnumbers 9e When this option is enabled, Calc will automatically detect all number formats, including special number formats such as dates, time, and scientific notation.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fsemicolon 34 Separates data delimited by semicolons into columns.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fmergedelimiters 3e Combines consecutive delimiters and removes blank data fields.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ftab 2e Separates data delimited by tabs into columns.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ftoseparatedby 27 Select the separator used in your data.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ftofixedwidth 45 Separates fixed-width data (equal number of characters) into columns.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Ffromrow 35 Specifies the row where you want to start the import.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Flanguage 21 Vytlačí čísla strán v päte.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2Fcharset b2 When this option is enabled, fields or cells whose values are quoted in their entirety (the first and last characters of the value equal the text delimiter) are imported as text.
3a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftextimportcsv%2FTextImportCsvDialog 2b Sets the import options for delimited data.
2f sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PRINT_WARNINGS%3ARBT_CUT 72 Specifies that anything extending beyond the maximum print range will be cut off and not included in the printing.
32 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PRINT_WARNINGS%3ARBT_POSTER 3f Specifies whether to distribute the printout on multiple pages.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PRINT_WARNINGS%3ARBT_SCALE 3f Specifies whether to distribute the printout on multiple pages.
25 sd%3AModalDialog%3ADLG_PRINT_WARNINGS 64 The Warning Print Options dialog appears when the page setup does not match the defined print range.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Flf 2d Produces a "Linefeed" as the paragraph break.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Fcr 34 Produces a "Carriage Return" as the paragraph break.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Fcrlf 4a Produces a "Carriage Return" and a "Linefeed". This option is the default.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Flanguage 78 Specifies the language of the text, if this has not already been defined. This setting is only available when importing.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Ffont 93 By setting a default font, you specify that the text should be displayed in a specific font. The default fonts can only be selected when importing.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2Fcharset 3d Specifies the character set of the file for export or import.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fasciifilterdialog%2FAsciiFilterDialog 3d Specifies the character set of the file for export or import.
19 SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_DELETE 30 Deletes the selected graphic after confirmation.
15 SVX_HID_GALLERY_TITLE 2d Assigns a title to a selected Gallery object.
1a SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_PREVIEW 32 The Preview command displays the selected graphic.
1b SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_ADD_LINK 27 Inserts the selected graphic as a link.
16 SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_ADD 49 Inserts a copy of the selected graphic object directly into the document.
1a SVX_HID_GALLERY_MN_ADDMENU 42 Defines how a selected graphic object is inserted into a document.
21 SW_HID_MN_READONLY_SAVEBACKGROUND 30 Allows you to save the background of a Web page.
1c SW_HID_MN_READONLY_PLUGINOFF 1b Disables inserted plug-ins.
1d SW_HID_MN_READONLY_GRAPHICOFF 32 Sets all graphics in the document to be invisible.
1e SW_HID_MN_READONLY_LOADGRAPHIC 64 If you have deactivated the graphics display, choose the Load Graphics command to make them visible.
1e SW_HID_MN_READONLY_COPYGRAPHIC 2b Copies a selected graphic to the clipboard.
1b SW_HID_MN_READONLY_COPYLINK 36 Copies the link at the mouse pointer to the clipboard.
1e SW_HID_MN_READONLY_SAVEGRAPHIC 38 Opens a dialog where you can save the selected graphics.
22 CUI_HID_GALLERY_PROPERTIES_GENERAL 1f Displays the name of the theme.
b slot%3A5500 4f Vytvorí nový dokument s použitím šablóny alebo otvorí vzorový dokument.
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21052 84 Otvorí dialóg Vizitky, kde je možné upraviť nastavenia pre vizitky a následne vytvoriť nový dokument ($[officename] Writer).
19 private%3Afactory%2Fsmath 2b Vytvorí nový vzorec ($[officename] Math).
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21051 8f Otvorí dialóg Štítky, kde je možné upraviť nastavenia pre štítky a následne vytvoriť nový textový dokument ($[officename] Writer).
2c private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%2FGlobalDocument 20 Vytvorí nový hlavný dokument.
28 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%3Fslot=21053 1f Vytvorí nový XForms dokument.
2b private%3Afactory%2Fsdatabase%3FInteractive 3c Otvorí Sprievodcu databázou na vytvorenie novej databázy.
19 private%3Afactory%2Fsdraw 2b Vytvorí novú kresbu ($[officename] Draw).
21 private%3Afactory%2Fswriter%2Fweb 1d Vytvorí nový HTML dokument.
28 private%3Afactory%2Fsimpress%3Fslot=6686 72 Creates a new presentation document ($[officename] Impress). If activated, the Presentation Wizard dialog appears.
19 private%3Afactory%2Fscalc 37 Vytvorí nový tabuľkový zošit ($[officename] Calc).
1b private%3Afactory%2Fswriter 38 Vytvorí nový textový dokument ($[officename] Writer).
d .uno%3ANewDoc 49 If you want to create a document from a template, choose New - Templates.
2f service%3Acom.sun.star.sdb.DatabaseWizardDialog 3c Otvorí Sprievodcu databázou na vytvorenie novej databázy.
1b SFX2_HID_TBXCONTROL_FILENEW 5c Vytvorí nový $[officename] dokument. Typ dokumentu môžete zmeniť kliknutím na šípku.
10 .uno%3AAddDirect 26 Vytvorí nový dokument $[officename].
3d svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOCTEMPLATE%3ABTN_DOCTEMPLATE_EDIT 26 Otvorí vybranú šablónu na úpravu.
3f svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOCTEMPLATE%3ABTN_DOCTEMPLATE_MANAGE 45 Pridá, odstráni alebo usporiada šablóny alebo vzorové dokumenty.
1e SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_DOCINFO 37 Zobrazí vlastnosti vybranej šablóny alebo dokumentu.
1e SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_PREVIEW 42 Povoľuje pozrieť si náhľad vybranej šablóny alebo dokumentu.
1b SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_PREV 45 Presunie sa do priečinku o jednu úroveň vyššie, ak je dostupný.
1b SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_BACK 32 Presun späť na predchádzajúce okno v dialógu.
1c SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_FILEVIEW da Zoznam všetkých dostupných šablón alebo dokumentov pre vybranú kategóriu. Vyberte šablónu alebo dokument a potom kliknite na Otvoriť. Pre náhľad dokumentu kliknite na tlačidlo Náhľad nad pravou časťou.
1c SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_TB_PRINT 2c Vytlačí vybranú šablónu alebo dokument.
1c SVT_HID_TEMPLATEDLG_ICONCTRL a6 Kategórie sa zobrazujú v ľavej časti dialógu  Šablóny a Dokumenty. Po kliknutí na kategóriu sa v časti Nadpis zobrazia súbory spojené s touto kategóriou.
29 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeldialog%2Fok 23 Creates a new document for editing.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeldialog%2FLabelDialog 51 Povoľuje vám vytvárať štítky. Štítky sa vytvárajú v textovom dokumente.
13 .uno%3AInsertLabels 51 Povoľuje vám vytvárať štítky. Štítky sa vytvárajú v textovom dokumente.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Ftype f0 Vyberte formát rozmerov, ktoré chcete použiť. Dostupné formáty závisia od značky vybranej v zozname Značka. Ak chcete použiť vlastný formát štítkov, vyberte [Požívateľský] a potom kliknite na formát na záložke Formát.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Fbrand 30 Vyberte značku papiera, ktorú chcete použiť.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Finsert 7b Vyberte pole databázy, ktoré chcete a kliknite na šípku vľavo od tohoto poľa. Takto vložíte pole do Textu štítku.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Ffield 7b Vyberte pole databázy, ktoré chcete a kliknite na šípku vľavo od tohoto poľa. Takto vložíte pole do Textu štítku.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Fcontinuous 26 Tlačí štítky na jednotlivé listy.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Fdatabase 4c Vyberte databázu, ktorú chcete použiť ako zdroj dát pre vaše štítky.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Ftable 65 Vyberte databázovú tabuľku obsahujúcu pole (polia), ktorú chcete použiť na vašich štítkoch.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Faddress 5f Vytvorí štítok s vašou spätnou adresou. Text, ktorý je v poli Text štítku sa prepíše.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2Ftextview 5f Zadajte text, ktorý sa má zobraziť na štítku. Tiež je možné vložiť databázové pole.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardmediumpage%2FCardMediumPage 32 Zadajte text štítku a vyberte veľkosť papiera.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsavelabeldialog%2Ftype 24 Zadajte alebo vyberte druh štítku.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsavelabeldialog%2Fbrand 2b Zadajte alebo vyberte požadovanú značku.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fsavelabeldialog%2FSaveLabelDialog 2b Zadajte alebo vyberte požadovanú značku.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fsave 33 Uloží aktuálny formát štítkov alebo vizitiek.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Frows 4c Zadajte počet štítkov alebo vizitiek, ktoré budú na stránke pod sebou.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Ftop ad Zobrazí vzdialenosť medzi horným okrajom stránky a horným okrajom prvého štítku alebo vizitky. Pokiaľ nastavujete vlastný formát, na tomto mieste zadajte hodnotu.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fleft ad Zobrazí vzdialenosť medzi ľavým okrajom stránky a ľavým okrajom prvého štítku alebo vizitky. Pokiaľ nastavujete vlastný formát, na tomto mieste zadajte hodnotu.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fwidth 6f Zobrazí šírku štítku alebo vizitky. Pokiaľ nastavujete vlastný formát, zadajte na tomto mieste hodnotu.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fvert b3 Vzdialenosť medzi horným okrajom štítku alebo vizitky a horným okrajom štítku alebo vizitky pod ním. Pokiaľ nastavujete vlastný formát, zadajte na tomto mieste hodnotu.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fcols 4e Zadajte počet štítkov alebo vizitiek, ktoré budú vedľa seba na stránke.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fheight 6f Zobrazí šírku štítku alebo vizitky. Pokiaľ nastavujete vlastný formát, zadajte na tomto mieste hodnotu.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2Fhori 90 Vzdialenosť medzi ľavými okrajmi susediacich štítkov alebo vizitiek. Pokiaľ nastavujete vlastný formát, zadajte na tomto mieste hodnotu.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabelformatpage%2FLabelFormatPage 19 Nastaví formát papiera.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fsynchronize af Allows you to edit a single label or business card and updates the contents of the remaining labels or business cards on the page when you click the Synchronize Labels button.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fcols 58 Zadajte počet štítkov alebo vizitiek, ktoré chcete mať na stránke v jednom riadku.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fsinglelabel 33 Vytlačí jeden štítok alebo vizitku na stránku.
29 sw%3APushButton%3ADLG_SYNC_BTN%3ABTN_SYNC 6d Skopíruje obsah ľavého horného štítku alebo vizitky do ostatných štítkov alebo vizitiek na stránke.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fentirepage 31 Vytvorí celú stránku štítkov alebo vizitiek.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Fsetup 1f Opens the Printer Setup dialog.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2Frows 50 Zadajte počet riadkov štítkov alebo vizitiek, ktoré chcete mať na stránke.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Flabeloptionspage%2FLabelOptionsPage 69 Ďalšie možnosti nastavení štítkov alebo vizitiek, napr. synchronizácia textu a voľby tlačiarne .
19 .uno%3AInsertBusinessCard 2d Umožní vám navrhnúť a vytvoriť vizitky.
1d SW_HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_TYPE ec Vyberte formát rozmerov, ktorý chcete použiť. Dostupné formáty závisia na značke vybranej v zozname Značka. Ak chcete použiť vlastný formát štítku, vyberte [Používateľský], a potom určte formát na záložke Formát.
1e SW_HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_BRAND 30 Vyberte značku papiera, ktorý chcete použiť.
1e SW_HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_SHEET 27 Vytlačí vizitky na jednotlivé listy.
1d SW_HID_BUSINESS_FMT_PAGE_CONT 26 Vytlačí vizitky na súvislý papier.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardformatpage%2Fautotext 4d Select a business card category, and then click a layout in the Content list.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardformatpage%2Ftreeview 67 Select a business card category in AutoText - Section box, and then click a layout in the Content list.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcardformatpage%2FCardFormatPage 21 Určite vzhľad svojich vizitiek.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fphone 29 Zadajte svoje domáce telefónne číslo.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fjob 16 Zadajte svoju funkciu.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fmobile 2a Zadajte svoje mobilné telefónne číslo.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fcountry 22 Zadajte krajinu, v ktorej žijete.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fshortname2 43 Zadajte iniciály osoby, ktorú chcete použiť ako druhý kontakt.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Furl 36 Zadajte adresu svojej internetovej domovskej stránky.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Flastname2 44 Zadajte priezvisko osoby, ktorú chcete použiť ako druhý kontakt.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Ffirstname2 46 Zadajte krstné meno osoby, ktorú chcete použiť ako druhý kontakt.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Furl 26 Vložte domovskú adresu vašej firmy.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fmobile 2d Vložte číslo vášho mobilného telefónu.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fphone 2f Vložte číslo vášho služobného telefónu.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fstate 41 Vložte názov krajiny, v ktorej sa vaša spoločnosť nachádza.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fslogan 22 Vložte motto vašej spoločnosti.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fcompany2 33 Vložte ďalšie informácie o vašej spoločnosti.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2FBusinessDataPage 33 Vložte ďalšie informácie o vašej spoločnosti.
19 SVT_HID_FILEOPEN_READONLY 23 Otvorí v režime iba na čítanie.
18 SVT_HID_FILEOPEN_VERSION 5e Pokiaľ vybraný súbor existuje vo viacerých verziách, vyberte tú, ktorú chcete otvoriť.
20 SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_FOLDER_FILENAME 81 Zadajte názov súboru alebo cestu k súboru. Tiež môžete zadať URL, ktoré začína názvom protokolu ftp, http alebo https.
34 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_SVT_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_ALL 2d Kliknutím zmažete všetky vybrané súbory.
33 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_SVT_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_NO 3d Kliknutím na Zrušiť zrušíte zmazanie vybraného súboru.
1b SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_INSERT_BTN 45 Vloží vybraný súbor na aktuálnu pozíciu v súčasnom dokumente.
23 FPICKER_HID_FILEDLG_AUTOCOMPLETEBOX 81 Zadajte názov súboru alebo cestu k súboru. Tiež môžete zadať URL, ktoré začína názvom protokolu ftp, http alebo https.
34 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_SVT_QUERYDELETE%3ABTN_YES 38 Kliknutím zmažete súbor vybraného názvu v dialógu.
1c SVT_HID_FILEVIEW_MENU_RENAME 5b Ak chcete premenovať súbor, kliknite naň pravým tlačidlom myši a zvoľte Premenovať.
43 fpicker%3AListBox%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ALB_EXPLORERFILE_FILETYPE 78 Select the file type that you want to open, or select All Files (*) to display a list of all of the files in the folder.
1c SVT_HID_FILEVIEW_MENU_DELETE 5b Ak chcete odstrániť súbor, kliknite naň pravým tlačidlom myši a zvoľte Odstrániť.
49 fpicker%3AImageButton%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_NEWFOLDER 15 Creates a new folder.
41 fpicker%3AMenuButton%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_UP 57 Move up one folder in the folder hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level folders.
18 SVT_HID_EXPLORERDLG_FILE 1f Otvorí alebo importuje súbor.
b .uno%3AOpen 1f Otvorí alebo importuje súbor.
1e SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_PATH_FILENAME 27 Zadajte cestu alebo vyberte zo zoznamu.
19 SFX2_HID_FILEDLG_PATH_BTN 18 Zvolí označenú cestu.
2e uui%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTER_SELECT%3ALB_FILTERS 3b Vyberte vstupný filter pre súbor, ktorý chcete otvoriť.
f .uno%3ACloseDoc 34 Zatvorí aktuálny dokument bez ukončenia programu.
b .uno%3ASave 1b Uloží aktuálny dokument.
20 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_CUSTOMIZEFILTER 4e Allows you to set the spreadsheet saving options for some types of data files.
21 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_SAVEWITHPASSWORD 57 Protects the file with a password that must be entered before a user can open the file.
17 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_DOSAVE f Saves the file.
19 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_FILETYPE 3c Select the file format for the document that you are saving.
18 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_FILEURL 42 Enter a file name or a path for the file. You can also enter a URL
19 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_FILEVIEW 3d Displays the files and folders in the folder that you are in.
49 fpicker%3AListBox%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ALB_EXPLORERFILE_PLACES_LISTBOX 49 Displays "favourite" places, i.e. shortcuts to local or remote locations.
20 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_CREATEDIRECTORY 15 Creates a new folder.
18 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_LEVELUP 57 Move up one folder in the folder hierarchy. Long-click to see the higher level folders.
1a SVT_HID_FILESAVE_SELECTION 9a Exports only the selected graphic objects in %PRODUCTNAME Draw and Impress to another format. If this box is not checked, the entire document is exported.
50 fpicker%3APushButton%3ADLG_SVT_EXPLORERFILE%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_CONNECT_TO_SERVER 7f Opens a dialog where you can set up connection to various types of servers, including WebDAV, FTP, SSH, Windows Share and CMIS.
17 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_DIALOG 56 Uloží aktuálny dokument na iné miesto, s iným názvom alebo ako iný typ súboru.
d .uno%3ASaveAs 56 Uloží aktuálny dokument na iné miesto, s iným názvom alebo ako iný typ súboru.
d SID_SAVEASDOC 56 Uloží aktuálny dokument na iné miesto, s iným názvom alebo ako iný typ súboru.
f .uno%3AExportTo 5b Saves the current document with a different name and format to a location that you specify.
1c .uno%3ASetDocumentProperties 78 Displays the properties for the current file, including statistics such as word count and the date the file was created.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2Fcomments 3b Zadajte poznámku, ktorá pomôže identifikovať dokument.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2Fkeywords ad Enter the words that you want to use to index the content of your document. Keywords must be separated by commas. A keyword can contain white space characters or semicolons.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2Ftitle 19 Zadajte nadpis dokumentu.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2Fsubject 5f Zadajte predmet dokumentu. Pomocou predmetu je možné zoskupiť dokumenty s podobným obsahom.
34 sfx%2Fui%2Fdescriptioninfopage%2FDescriptionInfoPage 29 Obsahuje informácie s popisom dokumentu.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentinfopage%2Fuserdatacb 78 Saves the user's full name with the file. You can edit the name by choosing Tools - Options - $[officename] - User Data.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentinfopage%2Freset a3 Resets the editing time to zero, the creation date to the current date and time, and the version number to 1. The modification and printing dates are also deleted.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentinfopage%2Fnameed 19 Zobrazuje názov súboru.
2e sfx%2Fui%2Fdocumentinfopage%2FDocumentInfoPage 2a Obsahuje základné informácie o súbore.
20 sfx2%2Fui%2Fcustominfopage%2Fadd 2e Click to add a new row to the Properties list.
27 sfx2%2Fui%2Fcustominfopage%2Fproperties ae Enter your custom contents. You can change the name, type, and contents of each row. You can add or remove rows. The items will be exported as metadata to other file formats.
2b sfx2%2Fui%2Fcustominfopage%2FCustomInfoPage 40 Allows you to assign custom information fields to your document.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fstatisticsinfopage%2FStatisticsInfoPage 29 Displays statistics for the current file.
1e sc%3ATabPage%3ARID_SCPAGE_STAT 29 Displays statistics for the current file.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2Fprotect d7 Protects the change recording state with a password. If change recording is protected for the current document, the button is named Unprotect. Click Unprotect and type the correct password to disable the protection.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2Funprotect d7 Protects the change recording state with a password. If change recording is protected for the current document, the button is named Unprotect. Click Unprotect and type the correct password to disable the protection.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2Frecordchanges 50 Select to enable recording changes. This is the same as Edit - Changes - Record.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2Freadonly 42 Select to allow this document to be opened in read-only mode only.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityinfopage%2FSecurityInfoPage 2f Sets password options for the current document.
13 .uno%3ATemplateMenu 5a Lets you organize and edit your templates, as well as save the current file as a template.
28 svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2Fadmin 36 Add a new data source to the Address Book Source list.
2c svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2Fdatatable 2c Select the data table for your address book.
2d svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2Fdatasource 2d Select the data source for your address book.
38 svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2FAddressTemplateDialog 45 Edit the field assignments and the data source for your address book.
29 svt%2Fui%2Faddresstemplatedialog%2Fassign 4e Select the field in the data table that corresponds to the address book entry.
18 .uno%3AAddressBookSource 45 Edit the field assignments and the data source for your address book.
32 sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3ABT_ORGANIZE 54 Opens the Template Management dialog where you can organize or create new templates.
2e sfx2%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3ABT_EDIT 26 Otvorí vybranú šablónu na úpravu.
32 sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3ALB_STYLESHEETS 28 Lists the available template categories.
2e sfx2%3AListBox%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3ALB_SECTION 34 Select a category in which to save the new template.
28 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_DOC_TEMPLATE%3AED_NAME 1e Enter a name for the template.
15 .uno%3ASaveAsTemplate 29 Saves the current document as a template.
13 .uno%3AOpenTemplate 3b Opens a dialog where you can select a template for editing.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A3 a8 Specifies that pages are to be printed in tiled format. If the pages or slides are smaller than the paper, several pages or slides will be printed on one page of paper.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A2 2e Hľadá cez všetky listy vo vybranom zošite.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A0 18 Vyberte tvar zo zoznamu.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A2 1d Vyberte databázu a tabuľku.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A1 21 Určiť poradie dátových bodov.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintHidden%3ACheckBox 2e Použije predlohu stránky na všetky snímky.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A0 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageContentType%3AListBox 24 Vyberte farbu okolitého osvetlenia.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpagerows 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintDateTime%3ACheckBox 2e Hľadá cez všetky listy vo vybranom zošite.
2e .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageRange%3AEdit c3 To print a range of pages, use a format like 3-6. To print single pages, use a format like 7;9;11. You can print a combination of page ranges and single pages, by using a format like 3-6;8;10;12.
34 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsPrintName%3ACheckBox 2e Použije predlohu stránky na všetky snímky.
27 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fsingleprintjob 39 Kliknutím vytvoríte jeden dokument pre každý záznam.
29 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpagespersheetbtn 20 Zadajte názvy dátových radov.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpagecols 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
26 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fsheetmarginsb 33 Po kliknutí prejdete na danú stránku sprievodcu.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A2 2e Upraví veľkosť náhľadu predlohy stránky.
20 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Forderlb 1d Zvoľte základný typ grafu.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspectRTL%3AListBox 5e For brochure printing, you can select a left-to-right order of pages or a right-to-left order.
25 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Freverseorder 21 Určiť poradie dátových bodov.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintLeftRightPages%3AListBox 17 Nastaviť rozlíšenie.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fprinters f9 The list box shows the installed printers. Click the printer to use for the current print job. Click the Printer details button to see some information about the selected printer. Click the Properties button to change some of the printer properties.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fexpander 39 Ukazuje rovnicu trendovej krivky vedľa regresnej krivky.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AQuality%3ARadioButton%3A0 21 Určiť poradie dátových bodov.
1e vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fsetup 6a Opens the printer properties dialog. The printer properties vary according to the printer that you select.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPaperFromSetup%3ACheckBox 59 Otvorí panel prechodov medzi snímkami, kde ich môžete aplikovať na vybrané snímky.
22 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fcopycount 32 Enter the number of copies that you want to print.
24 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2FPrintDialog 83 Prints the current document, selection, or the pages that you specify. You can also set the print options for the current document.
3d .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AFixedText 21 Určiť poradie dátových bodov.
26 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Forientationlb 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AListBox 21 Určiť poradie dátových bodov.
40 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPicturesAndObjects%3ACheckBox 3b Nastaví kurzor na predchádzajúci objekt vybraného typu.
24 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fprinttofile 21 Určiť poradie dátových bodov.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 182 If this option is enabled automatically inserted blank pages are printed. This is best if you are printing double-sided. For example, in a book, a "chapter" paragraph style has been set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to print that even numbered page.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A1 48 Náhľad stránky ukončíte kliknutím na tlačidlo Zatvoriť náhľad.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPageBackground%3ACheckBox b9 Otvorí dialóg pre výber obrázku. Pri obrázku sa upraví veľkosť a vloží sa ako pozadie predlohy aktuálneho snímku. Obrázok odstránite v dialógu Formát - Strana - Pozadie.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintControls%3ACheckBox 1c Zarovná obsah bunky vpravo.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintHiddenText%3ACheckBox 3d Vyberte túto ikonku, ak chcete prechádzať textové rámce.
36 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspect%3ACheckBox 42 Vyberte túto ikonku, ak chcete prechádzať vzorce v tabuľkách.
21 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fbordercb 33 Po kliknutí prejdete na danú stránku sprievodcu.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AIsIncludeEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 39 Kliknutím vytvoríte jeden dokument pre každý záznam.
37 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintScale%3ANumericField 2e Upraví veľkosť náhľadu predlohy stránky.
29 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpaperspersheetlb 1d Vyberte operátor zo zoznamu.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A1 25 Umiestni legendu vľavo vedľa grafu.
35 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ASlidesPerPage%3AListBox 1d Zvoľte základný typ grafu.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintProspectInclude%3AListBox 18 Vyberte tvar zo zoznamu.
25 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fpagemarginsb 29 Zvoľte variantu základného typu grafu.
2f .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ABorder%3ACheckBox 1c Zarovná obsah bunky vpravo.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintBlackFonts%3ACheckBox 21 Určiť poradie dátových bodov.
3a .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ASlidesPerPageOrder%3AListBox 2e Upraví veľkosť náhľadu predlohy stránky.
31 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3ATitleRow%3ACheckBox 1c Zarovná obsah bunky vpravo.
3d .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintTextPlaceholder%3ACheckBox 50 Vyberte predlohu snímok a kliknutím na túto ikonu ju odstránite z dokumentu.
34 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3AFormulaText%3ACheckBox 1c Zarovná obsah bunky vpravo.
20 vcl%2Fui%2Fprintdialog%2Fcollate 32 Preserves the page order of the original document.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APageOptions%3ARadioButton%3A1 1c Zarovná obsah bunky vpravo.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintFormat%3ARadioButton%3A0 31 Otvorí ponuku s príkazmi pre aktuálny snímok.
3c .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintContent%3ARadioButton%3A2 46 Prints only the selected area(s) or object(s) in the current document.
c .uno%3APrint 83 Prints the current document, selection, or the pages that you specify. You can also set the print options for the current document.
39 svtools%3AListBox%3ADLG_SVT_PRNDLG_PRNSETUPDLG%3ALB_NAMES 7a Lists the installed printers on your operating system. To change the default printer, select a printer name from the list.
32 svtools%3AModalDialog%3ADLG_SVT_PRNDLG_PRNSETUPDLG 34 Select the default printer for the current document.
13 .uno%3APrinterSetup 34 Select the default printer for the current document.
16 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsMS 8e Otvorí sa nové okno v predvolenej e-mailovej aplikácii, pričom aktuálny dokument sa pripojí ako príloha. Použije sa formát Microsoft.
17 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsOOo 91 Otvorí sa nové okno v predvolenej e-mailovej aplikácii, pričom aktuálny dokument sa pripojí ako príloha. Použije sa formát OpenDocument.
11 .uno%3ASendToMenu 3f Sends a copy of the current document to different applications.
f .uno%3ASendMail 8e Otvorí sa nové okno v predvolenej e-mailovej aplikácii, pričom aktuálny dokument sa pripojí ako príloha. Použije sa aktuálny formát.
19 SVT_HID_FILESAVE_TEMPLATE 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
28 SW_HID_SEND_MASTER_CTRL_LISTBOX_TEMPLATE 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
24 SW_HID_SEND_MASTER_CTRL_EDIT_FILEURL 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
28 SW_HID_SEND_MASTER_CTRL_CONTROL_FILEVIEW 74 Select the paragraph style or outline level that you want to use to separate the source document into sub-documents.
13 .uno%3ANewGlobalDoc b1 Creates a master document from the current Writer document. A new sub-document is created at each occurrence of a chosen paragraph style or outline level in the source document.
b .uno%3AQuit 22 Zastavenie behu aktuálneho makra.
e .uno%3ASaveAll 2b Saves all modified $[officename] documents.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fdelete 1d Deletes the selected version.
22 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fshow 35 Displays the entire comment for the selected version.
22 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fopen 31 Opens the selected version in a read-only window.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fversions 85 Lists the existing versions of the current document, the date and the time they were created, the author and the associated comments.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Falways 77 If you have made changes to your document, $[officename] automatically saves a new version when you close the document.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fcompare 33 Compare the changes that were made in each version.
36 sfx%2Fui%2Fversioncommentdialog%2FVersionCommentDialog 7d Enter a comment here when you are saving a new version. If you clicked Show to open this dialog, you cannot edit the comment.
22 sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2Fsave a8 Saves the current state of the document as a new version. If you want, you can also enter comments in the Insert Version Comment dialog before you save the new version.
2e sfx%2Fui%2Fversionsofdialog%2FVersionsOfDialog 89 Saves and organizes multiple versions of the current document in the same file. You can also open, delete, and compare previous versions.
14 .uno%3AVersionDialog 89 Saves and organizes multiple versions of the current document in the same file. You can also open, delete, and compare previous versions.
15 .uno%3ARecentFileList 51 Lists the most recently opened files. To open a file in the list, click its name.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_UNDO a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar.
b .uno%3AUndo a1 Reverses the last command or the last entry you typed. To select the command that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Undo icon on the Standard bar.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_REDO 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar.
b .uno%3ARedo 9a Reverses the action of the last Undo command. To select the Undo step that you want to reverse, click the arrow next to the Redo icon on the Standard bar.
d .uno%3ARepeat 47 Repeats the last command. This command is available in Writer and Calc.
13 .uno%3ARepeatAction 47 Repeats the last command. This command is available in Writer and Calc.
a .uno%3ACut 32 Removes and copies the selection to the clipboard.
b .uno%3ACopy 26 Copies the selection to the clipboard.
c .uno%3APaste 6f Inserts the contents of the clipboard at the location of the cursor, and replaces any selected text or objects.
17 SC_HID_SC_REPLCELLSWARN 6f Inserts the contents of the clipboard at the location of the cursor, and replaces any selected text or objects.
33 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_MV_RIGHT 0 
32 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_MV_DOWN 0 
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_SKIP_EMPTY 0 
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_MUL 0 
31 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_TRANSPOSE 0 
1e cui%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Flist 42 Select a format for the clipboard contents that you want to paste.
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_SUB 0 
15 .uno%3APasteClipboard 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify.
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_ADD 0 
32 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_NOOP 0 
30 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSATTRS 0 
33 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSDATETIME 0 
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSNUMBERS 0 
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSSTRINGS 0 
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSALL 0 
2c sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_LINK 0 
20 cui%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2Fsource 2e Displays the source of the clipboard contents.
33 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSFORMULAS 0 
15 .uno%3AInsertContents 0 
30 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSNOTES 0 
32 sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_INSOBJECTS 0 
31 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_OP_DIV 0 
2c cui%2Fui%2Fpastespecial%2FPasteSpecialDialog 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify.
32 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_INSCONT%3ABTN_MV_NONE 0 
13 .uno%3APasteSpecial 5d Inserts the contents of the clipboard into the current file in a format that you can specify.
d .uno%3ASelect 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object.
10 .uno%3ASelectAll 46 Selects the entire content of the current file, frame, or text object.
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fallsheets 2e Hľadá cez všetky listy vo vybranom zošite.
23 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Frows 1f Hľadá zhora dole cez stĺpce.
2b svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fcalcsearchin 9b Searches for the characters that you specify in formulas and in fixed (not calculated) values. For example, you could look for formulas that contain 'SUM'.
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fexpander1 60 Shows more or fewer search options. Click this button again to hide the extended search options.
26 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Freplace 60 Nahradí označený text alebo formát, ktorý ste vyhľadali, a potom hľadá ďalší výskyt.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Freplaceall 4f Replaces all of the occurrences of the text or format that you want to replace.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsearch 5a Nájde a označí v dokumente nasledujúci výskyt textu alebo formátu, ktorý hľadáte.
40 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3APB_SOUNDSLIKESETTINGS 3c Nastavuje možnosti pre podobnú notáciu v japonskom texte.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Flayout b5 Hľadá text formátovaný štýlom, ktorý určíte. Zaškrtnite toto políčko, a potom vyberte štýl zo zoznamu Hľadať. Nový štýl je možné vybrať v zozname Nahradiť za.
2c svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsoundslikebtn 3c Nastavuje možnosti pre podobnú notáciu v japonskom texte.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ACB_SOUNDSLIKECJK ac Je možné určiť, či sa v japonskom texte hľadá podobná notácia. Zaškrtnite toto políčko a potom kliknite na tlačidlo ... pre určenie možností vyhľadávania.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsoundslike ac Je možné určiť, či sa v japonskom texte hľadá podobná notácia. Zaškrtnite toto políčko a potom kliknite na tlačidlo ... pre určenie možností vyhľadávania.
27 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fnoformat 7b Click in the Search for or the Replace with box, and then click this button to remove the search criteria based on formats.
13 .uno%3ASearchDialog 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document.
30 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2FFindReplaceDialog 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document.
2d svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fmatchcharwidth 45 Rozlišuje medzi formami znaku v polovičnej šírke a plnej šírke.
f .uno%3AFindText 50 Type the text to search in the current document. Press Enter to search the text.
f .uno%3AUpSearch 38 Click to search the next occurrence in upward direction.
25 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fregexp 2b Allows you to use wildcards in your search.
23 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fcols 1f Hľadá zhora dole cez stĺpce.
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fselection 27 Vyhľadá iba vybraný text alebo bunky
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsearchall 75 Nájde a označí v dokumentoch všetky texty alebo formáty, ktoré hľadáte (iba pre dokumenty Writer alebo Calc).
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fmatchcase 30 Rozlišuje medzi veľkými a malými písmenami.
24 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fnotes 48 In Writer, you can select to include the comment texts in your searches.
28 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fbackwards 5d Search starts at the current cursor position and goes backwards to the beginning of the file.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ACB_HALFFULLFORMS 45 Rozlišuje medzi formami znaku v polovičnej šírke a plnej šírke.
11 .uno%3ADownSearch 3a Click to search the next occurrence in downward direction.
2a svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Freplacelist 57 Enter the replacement text, or select a recent replacement text or style from the list.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fwholewords 48 Searches for whole words or cells that are identical to the search text.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsearchlist 56 Enter the text that you want to search for, or select a previous search from the list.
17 .uno%3ASearchProperties 41 Searches for or replaces text or formats in the current document.
2a svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Freplaceterm 57 Enter the replacement text, or select a recent replacement text or style from the list.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsearchterm 56 Enter the text that you want to search for, or select a previous search from the list.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2Frelaxbox 53 Searches for a term that matches any combination of the similarity search settings.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2Flongerfld 6e Enter the maximum number of characters by which a word can exceed the number of characters in the search term.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2Fotherfld 48 Enter the number of characters in the search term that can be exchanged.
2c svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsimilaritybtn 2a Set the options for the similarity search.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2Fshorterfld 53 Enter the number of characters by which a word can be shorter than the search term.
15 CUI_HID_SEARCH_APPROX 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options.
1d CUI_HID_SEARCH_APPROXSETTINGS 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options.
3a cui%2Fui%2Fsimilaritysearchdialog%2FSimilaritySearchDialog 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options.
29 svx%2Fui%2Ffindreplacedialog%2Fsimilarity 89 Find terms that are similar to the Search for text. Select this checkbox, and then click the ... button to define the similarity options.
1b CUI_HID_SEARCHATTR_CTL_ATTR 32 Select the attributes that you want to search for.
12 CUI_HID_SEARCHATTR 32 Select the attributes that you want to search for.
34 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_ATTRIBUTE 122 Choose the text attributes that you want to search for. For example, if you search for the Font attribute, all instances of text that do not use the default font are found. All text that has a directly coded font attribute, and all text where a style switches the font attribute, are found.
31 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCH%3ABTN_FORMAT 69 Finds specific text formatting features, such as font types, font effects, and text flow characteristics.
13 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_DEL 2e Deletes the selection from the Navigator list.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX22 3a Moves the selection up one position in the Navigator list.
19 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_EDIT_LINK 32 Changes the link properties for the selected file.
18 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INS_TEXT 90 Inserts a new paragraph in the master document where you can enter text. You cannot insert text next to an existing text entry in the Navigator.
14 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_EDIT b8 Edit the contents of the component selected in the Navigator list. If the selection is a file, the file is opened for editing. If the selection is an index, the index dialog is opened.
18 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INS_FILE 3c Inserts one or more existing files into the master document.
16 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INSERT 45 Inserts a file, an index, or a new document into the master document.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX21 a7 Saves a copy of the contents of the linked files in the master document. This ensures that the current contents are available when the linked files cannot be accessed.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX20 45 Inserts a file, an index, or a new document into the master document.
16 SW_HID_GLBLTREEUPD_ALL 15 Updates all contents.
17 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INS_IDX 41 Inserts an index or a table of contents into the master document.
18 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_LINK 12 Updates all links.
17 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_IDX 14 Updates all indexes.
17 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_UPD_SEL 26 Updates the contents of the selection.
16 SW_HID_GLBLTREE_UPDATE 36 Click and choose the contents that you want to update.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX19 36 Click and choose the contents that you want to update.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX18 b8 Edit the contents of the component selected in the Navigator list. If the selection is a file, the file is opened for editing. If the selection is an index, the index dialog is opened.
1c SW_HID_GLBLTREE_INS_NEW_FILE 27 Creates and inserts a new sub-document.
11 SW_HID_NAVI_TBX23 3c Moves the selection down one position in the Navigator list.
1e SW_HID_NAVIGATOR_GLOB_TREELIST b8 The Navigator lists the main components of the master document. If you rest the mouse pointer over a name of a sub-document in the list, the full path of the sub-document is displayed.
39 cui%3APushButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3APB_CHANGE_SOURCE 2d Change the source file for the selected link.
36 cui%3APushButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3APB_UPDATE_NOW 7a Updates the selected link so that the most recently saved version of the linked file is displayed in the current document.
33 cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3ARB_MANUAL 37 Only updates the link when you click the Update button.
36 cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3ARB_AUTOMATIC d1 Automatically updates the contents of the link when you open the file. Any changes made in the source file are then displayed in the file containing the link. Linked graphic files can only be updated manually.
15 CUI_HID_LINKDLG_TABLB 68 Double-click a link in the list to open a file dialog where you can select another object for this link.
12 .uno%3AManageLinks c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files.
10 .uno%3AEditLinks c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files.
36 cui%3APushButton%3AMD_UPDATE_BASELINKS%3APB_BREAK_LINK 99 Breaks the link between the source file and the current document. The most recently updated contents of the source file are kept in the current document.
11 .uno%3ALinkDialog c6 Lets you edit the properties of each link in the current document, including the path to the source file. This command is not available if the current document does not contain links to other files.
14 .uno%3APlugInsActive 124 Allows you to edit plug-ins in your file. Choose this command to enable or disable this feature. When enabled, a check mark appears beside this command, and you find commands to edit the plug-in in its context menu. When disabled, you find commands to control the plug-in in its context menu.
13 .uno%3AOriginalSize 28 Resizes the object to the original size.
12 .uno%3AObjectMenue 60 Lets you edit a selected object in your file that you inserted with the Insert - Object command.
3e cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_FRMBORDER_OFF 27 Hides the border of the floating frame.
3e cui%3ANumericField%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ANM_MARGINHEIGHT dc Enter the amount of vertical space that you want to leave between the top and bottom edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents.
3e cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_SCROLLINGAUTO 59 Mark this option if the currently active floating frame can have a scrollbar when needed.
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_SCROLLINGOFF 2b Hides the scrollbar for the floating frame.
41 cui%3ACheckBox%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ACB_MARGINHEIGHTDEFAULT 1c Applies the default spacing.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_SCROLLINGON 2e Displays the scrollbar for the floating frame.
3d cui%3ANumericField%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ANM_MARGINWIDTH e2 Enter the amount of horizontal space that you want to leave between the right and the left edges of the floating frame and the contents of the frame. Both documents inside and outside the floating frame must be HTML documents.
38 cui%3APushButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ABT_FILEOPEN 5d Locate the file that you want to display in the selected floating frame, and then click Open.
2d cui%3AEdit%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3AED_URL a7 Enter the path and the name of the file that you want to display in the floating frame. You can also click the ... button and locate the file that you want to display.
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3ARB_FRMBORDER_ON 2a Displays the border of the floating frame.
33 cui%3AEdit%3AMD_INSERT_OBJECT_IFRAME%3AED_FRAMENAME 7b Enter a name for the floating frame. The name cannot contain spaces, special characters, or begin with an underscore ( _ ).
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_GRAPHWND 0 
2a svx%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAP%3ACBB_URL 55 Enter the URL for the file that you want to open when you click the selected hotspot.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_OPEN 5b Loads an existing image map in the MAP-CERN, MAP-NCSA or SIP StarView ImageMap file format.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_PROPERTY 3c Allows you to define the properties of the selected hotspot.
27 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_IMAP%3AEDT_TEXT 59 Enter the text that you want to display when the mouse rests on the hotspot in a browser.
1a SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLYDELETE 22 Deletes the selected anchor point.
15 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_MACRO 53 Lets you assign a macro that runs when you click the selected hotspot in a browser.
1a SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLYINSERT 43 Adds an anchor point where you click on the outline of the hotspot.
16 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_SAVEAS 53 Saves the image map in the MAP-CERN, MAP-NCSA or SIP StarView ImageMap file format.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLYMOVE 43 Lets you move the individual anchor points of the selected hotspot.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLYEDIT 4f Lets you change the shape of the selected hotspot by editing the anchor points.
18 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_FREEPOLY 122 Draws a hotspot that is based on a freeform polygon. Click this icon and move to where you want to draw the hotspot. Drag a freeform line and release to close the shape. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_POLY 1bb Draws a polygonal hotspot in the graphic. Click this icon, drag in the graphic, and then click to define one side of the polygon. Move to where you want to place the end of the next side, and then click. Repeat until you have drawn all of the sides of the polygon. When you are finished, double-click to close the polygon. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
16 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_ACTIVE 5e Disables or enables the hyperlink for the selected hotspot. A disabled hotspot is transparent.
14 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_RECT b3 Draws a rectangular hotspot where you drag in the graphic. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
16 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_SELECT 2f Selects a hotspot in the image map for editing.
16 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_CIRCLE b3 Draws an elliptical hotspot where you drag in the graphic. After, you can enter the Address and the Text for the hotspot, and then select the Frame where you want the URL to open.
15 SVX_HID_IMAPDLG_APPLY 33 Applies the changes that you made to the image map.
15 .uno%3AImageMapDialog 93 Allows you to attach URLs to specific areas, called hotspots, on a graphic or a group of graphics. An image map is a group of one or more hotspots.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2FdescTV 24 Enter a description for the hotspot.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2Fnameentry 1b Enter a name for the image.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2FframeCB a0 Enter the name of the target frame that you want to open the URL in. You can also select a standard frame name that is recognized by all browsers from the list.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2Ftextentry 59 Enter the text that you want to display when the mouse rests on the hotspot in a browser.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2Furlentry 55 Enter the URL for the file that you want to open when you click the selected hotspot.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fcuiimapdlg%2FIMapDialog 2e Lists the properties for the selected hotspot.
12 .uno%3AChangesMenu 48 Lists the commands that are available for tracking changes in your file.
16 .uno%3ATraceChangeMode 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date.
13 .uno%3ATrackChanges 4b Tracks each change that is made in the current document by author and date.
1d .uno%3AProtectTraceChangeMode 87 Prevents a user from deactivating the record changes feature, or from accepting or rejecting changes unless the user enters a password.
12 SC_HID_CHG_PROTECT 87 Prevents a user from deactivating the record changes feature, or from accepting or rejecting changes unless the user enters a password.
12 .uno%3AShowChanges 20 Shows or hides recorded changes.
19 .uno%3AShowTrackedChanges 20 Shows or hides recorded changes.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fcomment%2FCommentDialog 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
14 .uno%3ACommentChange 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
1c .uno%3ACommentChangeTracking 28 Enter a comment for the recorded change.
14 .uno%3AAcceptChanges 22 Accept or reject recorded changes.
1b .uno%3AAcceptTrackedChanges 22 Accept or reject recorded changes.
13 SW_HID_SORT_COMMENT 4a Sorts the list according to the comments that are attached to the changes.
12 SW_HID_SORT_ACTION 2f Sorts the list according to the type of change.
12 SW_HID_SORT_AUTHOR 27 Sorts the list according to the Author.
14 SC_HID_SORT_POSITION 82 Sorts the list in a descending order according to the position of the changes in the document. This is the default sorting method.
19 SC_HID_SC_CHANGES_COMMENT 29 Edit the comment for the selected change.
13 SW_HID_EDIT_COMMENT 29 Edit the comment for the selected change.
2b svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Fundo 29 Edit the comment for the selected change.
30 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Facceptall 4a Accepts all of the changes and removes the highlighting from the document.
13 SC_HID_SC_SORT_DATE 31 Lists the date and time that the change was made.
2d svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Freject 59 Rejects the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
19 .uno%3ARejectTracedChange 59 Rejects the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
2d svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Faccept 59 Accepts the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fredlineviewpage%2Fchanges b0 Lists the changes that were recorded in the document. When you select an entry in the list, the change is highlighted in the document. To sort the list, click a column heading.
30 svx%2Fui%2Facceptrejectchangesdialog%2Frejectall 4a Rejects all of the changes and removes the highlighting from the document.
10 SW_HID_SORT_DATE 2e Sorts the list according to the date and time.
15 SC_HID_SC_SORT_AUTHOR 23 Lists the user who made the change.
15 SC_HID_SC_SORT_ACTION 31 Lists the changes that were made in the document.
19 .uno%3AAcceptTracedChange 59 Accepts the selected change and removes the highlighting from the change in the document.
16 SC_HID_SC_SORT_COMMENT 33 Lists the comments that are attached to the change.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fredlineviewpage%2FRedlineViewPage 24 Accept or reject individual changes.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fcommentedit 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fstartdate 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Faction 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
32 sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_SIMPLEREF%3ARB_ASSIGN 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fcomment 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fdotdotdot 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Factionlist 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Frange 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Frangeedit 3b Select the range of cells that you want to use as a filter.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fauthorlist 5e Filters the list of changes according to the name of the author that you select from the list.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fendclock 3e Enters the current date and time into the corresponding boxes.
3a sc%3AImageButton%3ARID_SCDLG_HIGHLIGHT_CHANGES%3ARB_ASSIGN 4f Filters the comments of the changes according to the keyword(s) that you enter.
25 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fauthor 5e Filters the list of changes according to the name of the author that you select from the list.
29 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fstartclock 3e Enters the current date and time into the corresponding boxes.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fendtime 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
26 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fenddate 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
28 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fstarttime 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
27 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fdatecond 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
30 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2FRedlineFilterPage 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
23 svx%2Fui%2Fredlinefilterpage%2Fdate 50 Filters the list of changes according to the date and the time that you specify.
15 .uno%3AMergeDocuments 92 Imports changes made to copies of the same document into the original document. Changes made to footnotes, headers, frames and fields are ignored.
17 .uno%3ACompareDocuments 3e Compares the current document with a document that you select.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FInsertRecord 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_MAPPINGDLG bd Lets you map the column headings to data fields from a different data source. To define a different data source for your bibliography, click the Data Source button on the record Object Bar.
14 .uno%3ABib%2FMapping bd Lets you map the column headings to data fields from a different data source. To define a different data source for your bibliography, click the Data Source button on the record Object Bar.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_SERIES_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ISBN_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_MONTH_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_DB_TBX 48 Insert, delete, edit, and organize records in the bibliography database.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ADDRESS_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_NUMBER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_REPORTTYPE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1b .uno%3ABib%2FstandardFilter 4b Use the Standard Filter to refine and to combine AutoFilter search options.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ORGANIZATIONS_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_PUBLISHER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
17 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEW 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_EDITOR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_INSTITUTION_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_AUTHOR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
15 SVX_HID_FM_DELETEROWS 1c Deletes the selected record.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_EDITION_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_IDENTIFIER_POS 6a Enter a short name for the record. The short name appears in the Identifier column in the list of records.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_TITLE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
17 .uno%3ABib%2FautoFilter 96 Long-click to select the data field that you want to search using the term that you entered in the Search Key box. You can only search one data field.
12 .uno%3ABib%2Fquery 17e Type the information that you want to search for, and then press Enter. To change the filter options for the search, long-click the AutoFilter icon, and then select a different data field. You can use wildcards such as % or * for any number of characters, and _ or ? for one character in your search. To display all of the records in the table, clear this box, and then press Enter.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_PREV 27 Go to the previous record in the table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_ANNOTE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FDeleteRecord 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_HOWPUBLISHED_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_NOTE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_FIRST 24 Go to the first record in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_LAST 23 Go to the last record in the table.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_AUTHORITYTYPE_POS a5 Select the type of record that you want to create. $[officename] inserts a number in the Type column of the record that corresponds to the type that you select here.
16 .uno%3ABib%2Fsdbsource 35 Select the data source for the bibliography database.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_VOLUME_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_ABSOLUTE 4d Type the number of the record that you want to display, and then press Enter.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_PAGES_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_BOOKTITLE_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
19 .uno%3ABib%2FremoveFilter 46 To display all of the records in a table, click the Reset Filter icon.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_YEAR_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_URL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEXT 23 Go to the next record in the table.
13 .uno%3ABib%2Fsource 73 Lists the available tables in the current database. Click a name in the list to display the records for that table.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_SCHOOL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_CHAPTER_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_BIB_JOURNAL_POS 8e Enter additional information for the selected record. If you want, you can also enter the information in the corresponding field in the table.
1c .uno%3ABibliographyComponent 48 Insert, delete, edit, and organize records in the bibliography database.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fbookmode 83 In book mode view layout you see two pages side by side as in an open book. The first page is a right page with an odd page number.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fzoomsb 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fautomatic 59 The automatic view layout displays pages side by side, as many as the zoom factor allows.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fcolumns 6c In columns view layout you see pages in a given number of columns side by side. Enter the number of columns.
18 SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_OPTIMAL 36 Zahrnie objekty z predlohy stránky do novej stránky.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fvariable 5f Enter the zoom factor at which you want to display the document. Enter a percentage in the box.
1b SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_PAGE_WIDTH 6a Displays the complete width of the document page. The top and bottom edges of the page may not be visible.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2F100pc 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
14 SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_100 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
1c cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Ffitw 6a Displays the complete width of the document page. The top and bottom edges of the page may not be visible.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Ffitwandh 34 Nastaví novej stránke pozadie z predlohy stránky.
1b SVX_HID_MNU_ZOOM_WHOLE_PAGE 34 Nastaví novej stránke pozadie z predlohy stránky.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fsinglepage 56 The single page view layout displays pages beneath each other, but never side by side.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Fcolumnssb 6c In columns view layout you see pages in a given number of columns side by side. Enter the number of columns.
e .uno%3AView100 29 Displays the document at its actual size.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2Foptimal 36 Zahrnie objekty z predlohy stránky do novej stránky.
b .uno%3AZoom 37 Reduces or enlarges the screen display of %PRODUCTNAME.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fzoomdialog%2FZoomDialog 37 Reduces or enlarges the screen display of %PRODUCTNAME.
19 .uno%3AFunctionBarVisible 20 Shows or hides the Standard Bar.
1a .uno%3AShowImeStatusWindow 99 Zobrazí alebo skryje stavové okno externého programu - editora vstupnej metódy (IME - Input Method Engine), ktorý sa používa pre vkladanie znakov.
15 .uno%3AToolBarVisible 1d Shows or hides the Tools bar.
17 .uno%3AStatusBarVisible 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window.
15 .uno%3ATaskBarVisible 3f Shows or hides the Status Bar at the bottom edge of the window.
1a SFX2_HID_FULLSCREENTOOLBOX 76 In Writer and Calc, you can also use the shortcut keys Ctrl+Shift+J to switch between the normal and full screen mode.
11 .uno%3AFullScreen 7b Shows or hides the menus and toolbars in Writer or Calc. To exit the full screen mode, click the Full Screen On/Off button.
18 SVX_HID_COLOR_CTL_COLORS 145 Click the color that you want to use. To change the fill color of an object in the current file, select the object and then click a color. To change the line color of the selected object, right-click a color. To change the color of text in a text object, double-click the text-object, select the text, and then click a color.
13 .uno%3AColorControl 8b Show or hides the Color Bar. To modify or change the color table that is displayed, choose Format - Area, and then click on the Colors tab.
18 .cmd%3ARestoreVisibility aa Choose View - Toolbars - Reset to reset the toolbars to their default context sensitive behavior. Now some toolbars will be shown automatically, dependent on the context.
18 .uno%3AAvailableToolbars 2a Opens a submenu to show and hide toolbars.
16 .uno%3AShowAnnotations 49 Use View - Comments to show or hide all comments (not available in Calc).
1a .uno%3ADeleteAllAnnotation 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
15 .uno%3ADeleteAllNotes 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
22 .uno%3ADeleteAllAnnotationByAuthor 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
13 .uno%3ADeleteAuthor 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
17 .uno%3ADeleteAnnotation 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
11 .uno%3ADeleteNote 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
17 .uno%3AInsertAnnotation 12 Inserts a comment.
b .uno%3AScan 2b Inserts a scanned image into your document.
12 .uno%3ATwainSelect 29 Selects the scanner that you want to use.
14 .uno%3ATwainTransfer 82 Scans an image, and then inserts the result into the document. The scanning dialog is provided by the manufacturer of the scanner.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fspecialcharacters%2Fdelete 4b Clears the current selection of special characters that you want to insert.
1b CUI_HID_CHARMAP_CTL_SHOWSET 4a Click the special character(s) that you want to insert, and then click OK.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fspecialcharacters%2Fsubsetlb 2f Select a Unicode category for the current font.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fspecialcharacters%2Ffontlb 4c Select a font to display the special characters that are associated with it.
36 cui%2Fui%2Fspecialcharacters%2FSpecialCharactersDialog 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts.
d .uno%3ABullet 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts.
13 .uno%3AInsertSymbol 34 Inserts special characters from the installed fonts.
1a SVT_HID_FILEDLG_PREVIEW_CB 30 Displays a preview of the selected graphic file.
15 HID_IMPGRF_CB_PREVIEW 30 Displays a preview of the selected graphic file.
17 SVT_HID_FILEDLG_LINK_CB 2c Inserts the selected graphic file as a link.
1d SVX_HID_OFA_HYPERLINK_URL_TXT 2c Inserts the selected graphic file as a link.
1f SVT_HID_FILEOPEN_IMAGE_TEMPLATE 27 Select the frame style for the graphic.
14 .uno%3AInsertGraphic 2c Inserts a picture into the current document.
11 .uno%3AObjectMenu 62 Inserts an object into your document. For movies and sounds, use Insert - Movie and Sound instead.
13 .uno%3AInsertObject 6c Inserts an OLE object into the current document. The OLE object is inserted as a link or an embedded object.
32 cui%2Fui%2Finsertoleobject%2FInsertOLEObjectDialog 6c Inserts an OLE object into the current document. The OLE object is inserted as a link or an embedded object.
13 .uno%3AInsertPlugin 2c Inserts a plug-in into the current document.
2c cui%2Fui%2Finsertplugin%2FInsertPluginDialog 2c Inserts a plug-in into the current document.
12 .uno%3AInsertSound 2f Inserts a sound file into the current document.
12 .uno%3AInsertVideo 2f Inserts a video file into the current document.
1b .uno%3AInsertObjectStarMath 2c Inserts a formula into the current document.
11 .uno%3AInsertMath 2c Inserts a formula into the current document.
20 .uno%3AInsertObjectFloatingFrame ad Tu vkladáte do dokumentu odkazy alebo odkazované polia. Odkazy sú tvorené odkazovanými poľami v rámci rovnakého dokumentu alebo v poddokumentoch hlavného dokumentu.
1c .uno%3AViewDataSourceBrowser 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases.
11 .uno%3ADataImport 6a Lists the databases that are registered in %PRODUCTNAME and lets you manage the contents of the databases.
12 .uno%3AGraphicMenu 38 Select the source for a picture that you want to insert.
1d .uno%3AStandardTextAttributes 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
11 .uno%3ASetDefault 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
16 .uno%3AResetAttributes 50 Removes direct formatting and formatting by character styles from the selection.
11 .uno%3AFontDialog 45 Changes the font and the font formatting for the selected characters.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fctlsizelb 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fwestsizelb-nocjk 6c Enter or select the font size that you want to apply. For scalable fonts, you can also enter decimal values.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Feastsizelb 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fwestsizelb-cjk 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fweststylelb-nocjk 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Feaststylelb 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fctlfontnamelb 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fctlsizelb-nocjk 9c Sets the language that the spellchecker uses for the selected text or the text that you type. Available language modules have a check mark in front of them.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fctlstylelb 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fwestfontnamelb-nocjk 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fweststylelb-cjk 2d Select the formatting that you want to apply.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Feastfontnamelb 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2Fwestfontnamelb-cjk 59 Enter the name of an installed font that you want to use, or select a font from the list.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fcharnamepage%2FCharNamePage 3b Specify the formatting and the font that you want to apply.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Fpositionlb 2c Specify where to display the emphasis marks.
2a cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Findividualwordscb 3d Applies the selected effect only to words and ignores spaces.
29 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Funderlinecolorlb 25 Select the color for the underlining.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Foverlinelb 7b Select the overlining style that you want to apply. To apply the overlining to words only, select the Individual Words box.
f .uno%3AOverline 81 Overlines or removes overlining from the selected text. If the cursor is not in a word, the new text that you enter is overlined.
21 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Fshadowcb 4b Adds a shadow that casts below and to the right of the selected characters.
22 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Foutlinecb 5b Displays the outline of the selected characters. This effect does not work with every font.
21 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Frelieflb cd Vyberte efekt reliéfu, ktorý sa použije na označený text. Pri efekte "Reliéf" znaky vyzerajú, akoby boli zdvihnuté nad stránkou. Pri efekte "Rytina" vyzerajú, ako by boli zatlačené do stránky.
22 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Feffectslb cd Vyberte efekt reliéfu, ktorý sa použije na označený text. Pri efekte "Reliéf" znaky vyzerajú, akoby boli zdvihnuté nad stránkou. Pri efekte "Rytina" vyzerajú, ako by boli zatlačené do stránky.
10 .uno%3AFontColor cf Click to apply the current font color to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text color. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font color toolbar.
c .uno%3AColor cf Click to apply the current font color to the selected characters. You can also click here, and then drag a selection to change the text color. Click the arrow next to the icon to open the Font color toolbar.
23 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Femphasislb 53 Select a character to display over or below the entire length of the selected text.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Fstrikeoutlb 33 Select a strikethrough style for the selected text.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Ffontcolorlb 96 Sets the color for the selected text. If you select Automatic, the text color is set to black for light backgrounds and to white for dark backgrounds.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Funderlinelb 7d Select the underlining style that you want to apply. To apply the underlining to words only, select the Individual Words box.
28 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2Foverlinecolorlb 24 Select the color for the overlining.
24 cui%2Fui%2Feffectspage%2FEffectsPage 2e Specify the font effects that you want to use.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fcommented 50 Enter a comment for the selected number format, and then click outside this box.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fformated 5c Displays the number format code for the selected format. You can also enter a custom format.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fthousands 6c Inserts a separator between thousands. The type of separator that is used depends on your language settings.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fnegnumred 32 Changes the font color of negative numbers to red.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fadd 4a Adds the number format code that you entered to the user-defined category.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fdecimalsed 3c Enter the number of decimal places that you want to display.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fdelete 23 Deletes the selected number format.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fleadzerosed 4c Enter the maximum number of zeroes to display in front of the decimal point.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fsourceformat 4b Uses the same number format as the cells containing the data for the chart.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fcategorylb 56 Select a category from the list, and then select a formatting style in the Format box.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Flanguagelb 100 Specifies the language setting for the selected fields. With the language set to Automatic, $[officename] automatically applies the number formats associated with the system default language. Select any language to fix the settings for the selected fields.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fformatlb 49 Select how you want the contents of the selected cell(s) to be displayed.
1e .uno%3ATableNumberFormatDialog 38 Specify the formatting options for the selected cell(s).
25 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fedit 2d Adds a comment to the selected number format.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2Fcurrencylb 71 Select a currency, and then scroll to the top of the Format list to view the formatting options for the currency.
34 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingformatpage%2FNumberingFormatPage 38 Specify the formatting options for the selected cell(s).
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Funvisitedlb c1 Select a formatting style to use for unvisited links from the list. To add or modify a style in this list, close this dialog, and click the Styles and Formatting icon on the Formatting toolbar.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Fvisitedlb bf Select a formatting style to use for visited links from the list. To add or modify a style in this list, close this dialog, and click the Styles and Formatting icon on the Formatting toolbar.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Ftargetfrmlb 71 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Feventpb 3c Specify an event that triggers when you click the hyperlink.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Furlpb 3e Locate the file that you want to link to, and then click Open.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Fnameed 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
2c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Furled 4c Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink.
19 .uno%3AInsertHyperlinkDlg 38 Assigns a new hyperlink or edits the selected hyperlink.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2Ftexted 3a Enter the text that you want to display for the hyperlink.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcharurlpage%2FCharURLPage 38 Assigns a new hyperlink or edits the selected hyperlink.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fkerninglb b2 Specifies the spacing between the characters of the selected text. For expanded or condensed spacing, enter the amount that you want to expand or condense the text in the by box.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fscalewidthsb 66 Enter the percentage of the font width by which to horizontally stretch or compress the selected text.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fpairkerning 4c Automatically adjust the character spacing for specific letter combinations.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Ffontsizesb 50 Enter the amount by which you want to reduce the font size of the selected text.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fraiselowersb 9e Enter the amount by which you want to raise or to lower the selected text in relation to the baseline. One hundred percent is equal to the height of the font.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fsubscript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and lowers the text below the baseline.
10 .uno%3ASubScript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and lowers the text below the baseline.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fnormal 2c Removes superscript or subscript formatting.
12 .uno%3ASuperScript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and raises the text above the baseline.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fkerninged 65 Enter the amount by which you want to expand or condense the character spacing for the selected text.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fautomatic 6a Automatically sets the amount by which the selected text is raised or lowered in relation to the baseline.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2Fsuperscript 52 Reduces the font size of the selected text and raises the text above the baseline.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fpositionpage%2FPositionPage 44 Specify the position, scaling, rotation, and spacing for characters.
24 cui%2Fui%2Ftwolinespage%2Fendbracket 83 Select the character to define the end of the double-lined area. If you want to choose a custom character, select Other Characters.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftwolinespage%2Fstartbracket 85 Select the character to define the start of the double-lined area. If you want to choose a custom character, select Other Characters.
22 cui%2Fui%2Ftwolinespage%2Ftwolines 5a Allows you to write in double lines in the area that you selected in the current document.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftwolinespage%2FTwoLinesPage 7f Sets the options for double-line writing for Asian languages. Select the characters in your text, and then choose this command.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fasiantypography%2FcheckApplySpacing 3c Inserts a space between Asian, Latin and complex characters.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fasiantypography%2FcheckHangPunct 88 Prevents commas and periods from breaking the line. Instead, these characters are added to the end of the line, even in the page margin.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fasiantypography%2FcheckForbidList 89 Prevents the characters in the list from starting or ending a line. The characters are relocated to either the previous or the next line.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fasiantypography%2FAsianTypography f2 Set the typographic options for cells or paragraphs in Asian language files. To enable Asian language support, choose Language Settings - Languages in the Options dialog box, and then select the Enabled box in the Asian language support area.
10 .uno%3AEditStyle 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment.
16 .uno%3AParagraphDialog 4c Modifies the format of the current paragraph, such as indents and alignment.
34 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_LINEDISTMETRIC 45 Nastavte hodnotu, ktorá bude použitá pre vybraný typ riadkovania.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FcomboLB_LINEDIST 2d Určuje vzdialenosť medzi riadkami v odseku.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FcheckCB_CONTEXTUALSPACING 94 Makes any space specified before or after this paragraph not be applied when the preceding and following paragraphs are of the same paragraph style.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_BOTTOMDIST 7f Zadajte veľkosť voľného priestoru, ktorý chcete ponechať pod vybraným odsekom (alebo pod viacerými vybranými odsekmi).
2d cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_TOPDIST 7f Zadajte veľkosť voľného priestoru, ktorý chcete ponechať nad vybraným odsekom (alebo nad viacerými vybranými odsekmi).
2b cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FcheckCB_AUTO 7f Zadajte veľkosť voľného priestoru, ktorý chcete ponechať nad vybraným odsekom (alebo nad viacerými vybranými odsekmi).
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_FLINEINDENT 159 Odsadí prvý riadok odseku o vzdialenosť, ktorú zadáte. Ak chcete vytvoriť vyčnievajúci prvý riadok, zadajte kladné číslo do poľa "Pred text" a záporné číslo do poľa "Prvý riadok". Ak chcete odsadiť prvý riadok odseku, ktorý používa odrážky alebo číslovanie, zvoľte "Formát - Odrážky a číslovanie - Umiestnenie".
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_RIGHTINDENT 176 Zadajte veľkosť voľného miesta, o ktoré chcete odsadiť odsek od okraja strany. Ak chcete aby odsek presahoval za okraj strany, zadajte záporné číslo. Pri jazykoch so smerom textu zľava-doprava bude odsek odsadený sprava, s ohľadom na pravý okraj strany. Pri jazykoch so smerom textu sprava-doľava bude odsek odsadený zľava s ohľadom na ľavý okraj strany.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_LEFTINDENT 172 Zadajte veľkosť voľného miesta, o ktoré chcete odsadiť odsek od okraja strany. Ak chcete aby odsek presahoval za okraj strany, zadajte záporné číslo. V jazykoch so smerom textu zľava-doprava bude odsek odsadený zľava, s ohľadom na ľavý okraj strany. V jazykoch so smerom textu sprava-doľava bude odsek odsadený sprava s ohľadom na pravý okraj strany.
35 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FspinED_LINEDISTPERCENT 45 Nastavte hodnotu, ktorá bude použitá pre vybraný typ riadkovania.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparaindentspacing%2FParaIndentSpacing 40 Nastavuje možnosti odsadenia odseku a rozostupov medzi odsekmi.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FbuttonBTN_DELALL 80 Removes all of the tab stops that you defined under Position. Sets Left tab stops at regular intervals as the default tab stops.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FentryED_FILLCHAR_OTHER 56 Allows you to specify a character to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FbuttonBTN_NEW 3c Adds the tab stop that you defined to the current paragraph.
37 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_OTHER 56 Allows you to specify a character to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.
3c cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_UNDERSCORE 41 Draws a line to fill the empty space to the left of the tab stop.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FentryED_TABTYPE_DECCHAR 4e Enter a character that you want the decimal tab to use as a decimal separator.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_TABTYPE_DECIMAL 63 Aligns the decimal point of a number to the center of the tab stop and text to the left of the tab.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_POINTS 3c Fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dots.
36 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonST_RIGHTTAB_ASIAN 63 Aligns the right edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the left of the tab stop.
34 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_NO 5c Inserts no fill characters, or removes existing fill characters to the left of the tab stop.
37 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_TABTYPE_CENTER 2e Aligns the center of the text to the tab stop.
36 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_TABTYPE_RIGHT 63 Aligns the right edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the left of the tab stop.
35 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonST_LEFTTAB_ASIAN 53 Aligns the left edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the right.
35 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_TABTYPE_LEFT 53 Aligns the left edge of the text to the tab stop and extends the text to the right.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FED_TABPOS fa Select a tab stop type, enter a new measurement, and then click New. If you want, you can also specify the measurement units to use for the tab (cm for centimeter, or " for inches). Existing tabs to the left of the first tab that you set are removed.
3a cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FradiobuttonBTN_FILLCHAR_DASHLINE 3e Fills the empty space to the left of the tab stop with dashes.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fparatabspage%2FParagraphTabsPage 2e Set the position of a tab stop in a paragraph.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fdistancemf 1e Enter the width of the shadow.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fshadows 2e Click a shadow style for the selected borders.
1c cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fsync 5f Applies the same spacing to contents setting to all four borders when you enter a new distance.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fbottommf 65 Enter the distance that you want to have between the bottom border and the contents of the selection.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Frightmf 64 Enter the distance that you want to have between the right border and the contents of the selection.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fleftmf 63 Enter the distance that you want to have between the left border and the contents of the selection.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Flinecolorlb 46 Select the line color that you want to use for the selected border(s).
1d cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Ftopmf 62 Enter the distance that you want to have between the top border and the contents of the selection.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Flinestylelb 6b Click the border style that you want to apply. The style is applied to the borders selected in the preview.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fshadowcolorlb 1e Select a color for the shadow.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2Fpresets 2a Select a predefined border style to apply.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fborderpage%2FBorderPage 43 Sets the border options for the selected objects in Writer or Calc.
18 SVX_HID_POPUP_COLOR_CTRL 71 Click a color. Click No Fill to remove a background or highlighting color. Click Automatic to reset a font color.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Farearb 4b Stretches the graphic to fill the entire background of the selected object.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fwindowpos 43 Select this option, and then click a location in the position grid.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Ftilerb 53 Repeats the graphic so that it covers the entire background of the selected object.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fshowpreview 34 Displays or hides a preview of the selected graphic.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Ftablelb 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fparalb 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Ftransparencymf 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fpositionrb 43 Select this option, and then click a location in the position grid.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Flink 38 Links to or embeds the graphic file in the current file.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fbackgroundcolorset 62 Click the color that you want to use as a background. To remove a background color, click No Fill.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fbrowse 52 Locate the graphic file that you want to use as a background, and then click Open.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2Fselectlb 35 Select the type of background that you want to apply.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fbackgroundpage%2FBackgroundPage 24 Set the background color or graphic.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fcolumnpage%2Ftextdirectionlb 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fformattablepage%2Ftextdirection 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FcomboLB_TEXTDIRECTION 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FcheckCB_EXPAND 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FcomboLB_LASTLINE 99 Specify the text direction for a paragraph that uses complex text layout (CTL). This feature is only available if complex text layout support is enabled.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FradioBTN_JUSTIFYALIGN 3f Aligns the paragraph to the left and to the right page margins.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FradioBTN_CENTERALIGN 32 Centers the contents of the paragraph on the page.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FradioBTN_RIGHTALIGN 2e Aligns the paragraph to the right page margin.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FradioBTN_LEFTALIGN 2d Aligns the paragraph to the left page margin.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fparagalignpage%2FParaAlignPage 44 Sets the alignment of the paragraph relative to the margins of page.
33 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3APB_ORGSIZE 32 Returns the selected graphic to its original size.
32 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_WIDTH 27 Enter a width for the selected graphic.
33 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_HEIGHT 28 Enter a height for the selected graphic.
37 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_HEIGHTZOOM 39 Enter the height of the selected graphic as a percentage.
33 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_BOTTOM 151 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the bottom of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space below the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic.
30 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_TOP 14e If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the top of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space above the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the vertical scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the vertical scale of the graphic.
32 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_RIGHT 163 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the right edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the right of the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic.
31 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_LEFT 161 If the Keep Scale option is selected, enter a positive amount to trim the left edge of the graphic, or a negative amount to add white space to the left of the graphic. If the Keep image size option is selected, enter a positive amount to increase the horizontal scale of the graphic, or a negative amount to decrease the horizontal scale of the graphic.
36 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3AMF_WIDTHZOOM 39 Enter the width for the selected graphic as a percentage.
36 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3ARB_SIZECONST 123 Maintains the original size of the graphic when you crop, so that only the scale of the graphic changes. To reduce the scale of the graphic, select this option and enter negative values in the cropping boxes. To increase the scale of the graphic, enter positive values in the cropping boxes.
36 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_GRFCROP%3ARB_ZOOMCONST 68 Maintains the original scale of the graphic when you crop, so that only the size of the graphic changes.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fdesc 3c Describes the relevant formatting used in the current style.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fcategory 7f Displays the category for the current style. If you are creating or modifying a new style, select 'Custom Style' from the list.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fnextstyle 102 Select an existing style that you want to follow the current style in your document. For paragraph styles, the next style is applied to the paragraph that is created when you press Enter. For page styles, the next style is applied when a new page is created.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fnamero a7 Displays the name of the selected style. If you are creating or modifying a custom style, enter a name for the style. You cannot change the name of a predefined style.
27 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fautoupdate b0 Updates the style when you apply direct formatting to a paragraph using this style in your document. The formatting of all paragraphs using this style is automatically updated.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Fnamerw a7 Displays the name of the selected style. If you are creating or modifying a custom style, enter a name for the style. You cannot change the name of a predefined style.
27 sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2Flinkedwith 69 Select an existing style that you want to base the new style on, or select none to define your own style.
2c sfx%2Fui%2Fmanagestylepage%2FManageStylePage 27 Set the options for the selected style.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcheckAdaptBox 86 Resizes the drawing objects so that they fit on the paper format that you select. The arrangement of the drawing objects is preserved.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboLayoutFormat 51 Select the page numbering format that you want to use for the current page style.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcheckbuttonHorz 33 Centers the cells horizontally on the printed page.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcheckRegisterTrue 43 Aligns the text on the selected Page Style to a vertical page grid.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboRegisterStyle dd Select the Paragraph Style that you want to use as a reference for lining up the text on the selected Page style. The height of the font that is specified in the reference style sets the spacing of the vertical page grid.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinMargBot 5c Enter the amount of space to leave between the lower edge of the page and the document text.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboPageLayout 60 Specify whether the current style should show odd pages, even pages, or both odd and even pages.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinMargRight e8 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the document text. If you are using the Mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the outer text margin and the outer edge of the page.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinMargLeft e7 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the document text. If you are using the Mirrored page layout, enter the amount of space to leave between the inner text margin and the inner edge of the page.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinMargTop 5c Enter the amount of space to leave between the upper edge of the page and the document text.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboTextFlowBox 40 Select the text direction that you want to use in your document.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcheckbuttonVert 31 Centers the cells vertically on the printed page.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FradiobuttonLandscape 4e Displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented horizontally.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboPaperTray ea Select the paper source for your printer. If you want, you can assign different paper trays to different page styles. For example, assign a different tray to the First Page style and load the tray with your company's letterhead paper.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinHeight 61 Displays the height of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a height here.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FspinWidth 5f Displays the width of the selected paper format. To define a custom format, enter a width here.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FradiobuttonPortrait 4c Displays and prints the current document with the paper oriented vertically.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FcomboPageFormat 81 Select a predefined paper size, or create a custom format by entering the dimensions for the paper in the Height and Width boxes.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpageformatpage%2FPageFormatPage 73 Allows you to define page layouts for single and multiple-page documents, as well as a numbering and paper formats.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FbuttonMore 4d Defines a border, a background color, or a background pattern for the header.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckAutofit 51 Automatically adjusts the height of the header to fit the content that you enter.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FspinHeight 2e Enter the height that you want for the header.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FspinMargRight 67 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the right edge of the header.
2f svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckDynSpacing 76 Overrides the Spacing setting, and allows the header to expand into the area between the header and the document text.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FspinMargLeft 65 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the left edge of the header.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckSameFP 30 First and even/odd pages share the same content.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FspinSpacing 80 Enter the amount of space that you want to maintain between the bottom edge of the header and the top edge of the document text.
2b svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckSameLR 2a Even and odd pages share the same content.
2a svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FbuttonEdit 18 Add or edit header text.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckFooterOn 28 Adds a header to the current page style.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FcheckHeaderOn 28 Adds a header to the current page style.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fheadfootformatpage%2FHFFormatPage 78 Adds a header to the current page style. A header is an area in the top page margin, where you can add text or graphics.
15 SC_HID_SC_FOOTER_EDIT 18 Add or edit footer text.
32 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ABTN_EXTRAS 4d Defines a border, a background color, or a background pattern for the footer.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_HEIGHT_DYN 4c Automatically adjusts the height of the footer to fit the content you enter.
32 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3AED_HEIGHT 29 Enter the height you want for the footer.
33 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_DYNSPACING 71 Overrides the Spacing setting and allows the footer to expand into the area between the footer and document text.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3AED_LMARGIN 65 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the page and the left edge of the footer.
35 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_SHARED_FIRST 30 First and even/odd pages share the same content.
30 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3AED_DIST 80 Enter the amount of space that you want to maintain between the bottom edge of the document text and the top edge of the footer.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3AED_RMARGIN 67 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the page and the right edge of the footer.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_SHARED 2a Even and odd pages share the same content.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_FOOTER%3ACB_TURNON 28 Adds a footer to the current page style.
15 SVX_HID_FORMAT_FOOTER 7b Adds a footer to the current page style. A footer is an area in the bottom page margin, where you can add text or graphics.
1b .uno%3AChangeCaseToKatakana 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Katakana characters.
1b .uno%3AChangeCaseToHiragana 3d Changes the selected Asian characters to Hiragana characters.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToFullWidth 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to full width characters.
1d .uno%3AChangeCaseToToggleCase 30 Toggles case of all selected western characters.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToTitleCase 67 Changes the first character of every word of the selected western characters to an uppercase character.
18 .uno%3AChangeCaseToLower 40 Changes the selected western characters to lowercase characters.
18 SID_TRANSLITERATE_TOGGLE 30 Toggles case of all selected western characters.
1f .uno%3AChangeCaseToSentenceCase 56 Changes the first letter of the selected western characters to an uppercase character.
1c SID_TRANSLITERATE_CAPITALIZE 67 Changes the first character of every word of the selected western characters to an uppercase character.
18 .uno%3AChangeCaseToUpper 40 Changes the selected western characters to uppercase characters.
1a SID_TRANSLITERATE_SENTENCE 56 Changes the first letter of the selected western characters to an uppercase character.
1c .uno%3AChangeCaseToHalfWidth 3f Changes the selected Asian characters to half-width characters.
18 .uno%3ATransliterateMenu 88 Changes the case of characters in the selection. If the cursor is within a word and no text is selected, then the word is the selection.
2c svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2Fstyles 60 Opens the Styles and Formatting window where you can select a character style for the ruby text.
30 svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2Fpositionlb 2d Select where you want to place the ruby text.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FRight3ED 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2Fstylelb 2b Select a character style for the ruby text.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FRight2ED 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FLeft4ED 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FRight4ED 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FLeft2ED 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2Fadjustlb 32 Select the horizontal alignment for the Ruby text.
2e svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FRight1ED 4f Enter the text that you want to use as a pronunciation guide for the base text.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FLeft3ED 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
2d svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FLeft1ED 82 Displays the base text that you selected in the current file. If you want, you can modify the base text by entering new text here.
3e svx%2Fui%2Fasianphoneticguidedialog%2FAsianPhoneticGuideDialog 54 Allows you to add comments above Asian characters to serve as a pronunciation guide.
11 .uno%3ARubyDialog 54 Allows you to add comments above Asian characters to serve as a pronunciation guide.
15 .uno%3AAlignFrameMenu 34 Aligns selected objects with respect to one another.
10 .uno%3AAlignLeft a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin.
16 .uno%3AObjectAlignLeft a1 Aligns the left edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the left edge of the object is aligned to the left page margin.
1c .uno%3AAlignHorizontalCenter a7 Horizontally centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the horizontal center of the page.
12 .uno%3AAlignCenter a7 Horizontally centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the horizontal center of the page.
11 .uno%3AAlignRight a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin.
17 .uno%3AObjectAlignRight a4 Aligns the right edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Impress or Draw, the right edge of the object is aligned to the right page margin.
f .uno%3AAlignTop ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin.
e .uno%3AAlignUp ab Vertically aligns the top edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the top edge of the object is aligned to the upper page margin.
1a .uno%3AAlignVerticalCenter a3 Vertically centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the vertical center of the page.
12 .uno%3AAlignMiddle a3 Vertically centers the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the center of the object is aligned to the vertical center of the page.
12 .uno%3AAlignBottom b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin.
10 .uno%3AAlignDown b1 Vertically aligns the bottom edges of the selected objects. If only one object is selected in Draw or Impress, the bottom edge of the object is aligned to the lower page margin.
f .uno%3ALeftPara 39 Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left page margin.
10 .uno%3ARightPara 3a Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the right page margin.
11 .uno%3ACenterPara 2e Centers the selected paragraph(s) on the page.
12 .uno%3AJustifyPara cd Aligns the selected paragraph(s) to the left and the right page margins. If you want, you can also specify the alignment options for the last line of a paragraph by choosing Format - Paragraph - Alignment.
11 .uno%3AMergeCells 45 Combines the contents of the selected table cells into a single cell.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fsplitcellsdialog%2FSplitCellsDialog 62 Rozdelenie bunky alebo skupiny buniek vodorovne alebo zvisle do počtu buniek, ktorý ste určili.
10 .uno%3ASplitCell 62 Rozdelenie bunky alebo skupiny buniek vodorovne alebo zvisle do počtu buniek, ktorý ste určili.
12 .uno%3ACellVertTop 3c Aligns the contents of the cell to the top edge of the cell.
15 .uno%3ACellVertCenter 35 Chránenie obsahu vybraných buniek pred jeho zmenou.
15 .uno%3ACellVertBottom 3f Aligns the contents of the cell to the bottom edge of the cell.
b .uno%3ABold aa Zmení vybraný text na tučný. Ak je kurzor vnútri slova, je celé slovo označené tučne. Ak je slovo alebo výber už tučné, bude toto formátovanie odstránené.
d .uno%3AItalic a2 Makes the selected text italic. If the cursor is in a word, the entire word is made italic. If the selection or word is already italic, the formatting is removed.
16 .uno%3AUnderlineDouble 2c Underlines the selected text with two lines.
10 .uno%3AUnderline 39 Underlines or removes underlining from the selected text.
10 .uno%3AStrikeout 57 Draws a line through the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, the entire word.
f .uno%3AShadowed 56 Adds a shadow to the selected text, or if the cursor is in a word, to the entire word.
15 .uno%3ADistributeRows 53 Upravenie výšky vybraných riadkov podľa výšky najvyššieho riadku z výberu.
11 .uno%3ASpacePara1 52 Applies single line spacing to the current paragraph. This is the default setting.
12 .uno%3ASpacePara15 45 Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to one and half lines.
11 .uno%3ASpacePara2 3c Sets the line spacing of the current paragraph to two lines.
18 .uno%3ADistributeColumns 55 Upravenie šírky vybraných stĺpcov podľa šírky najširšieho stĺpca z výberu.
1f sfx%2Fui%2Fnewstyle%2Fstylename 1f Enter a name for the new Style.
27 sfx%2Fui%2Fnewstyle%2FCreateStyleDialog 1f Enter a name for the new Style.
18 .uno%3AStyleNewByExample 1f Enter a name for the new Style.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fstringinput%2Fedit 37 Enter a name for the new AutoFormat, and then click OK.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fobjectnamedialog%2FObjectNameDialog 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator.
1b SD_HID_SD_NAMEDIALOG_OBJECT 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator.
1e SW_HID_FORMAT_NAME_OBJECT_NAME 50 Enter a name for the selected object. The name will be visible in the Navigator.
13 .uno%3ARenameObject 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator.
10 .uno%3ANameGroup 60 Assigns a name to the selected object, so that you can quickly find the object in the Navigator.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fobjecttitledescdialog%2Fdesc_entry e3 Enter a description text. The long description text can be entered to describe a complex object or group of objects to users with screen reader software. The description is visible as an alternative tag for accessibility tools.
35 cui%2Fui%2Fobjecttitledescdialog%2Fobject_title_entry 7c Enter a title text. This short name is visible as an alternative tag in HTML format. Accessibility tools can read this text.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fobjecttitledescdialog%2FObjectTitleDescDialog 9c Assigns a title and a description to the selected object. These are accessible for accessibility tools and as alternative tags when you export the document.
1d .uno%3AObjectTitleDescription 9c Assigns a title and a description to the selected object. These are accessible for accessibility tools and as alternative tags when you export the document.
11 .uno%3AFormatLine 32 Sets the formatting options for the selected line.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_CAP_STYLE 52 Select the style of the line end caps. The caps are added to inner dashes as well.
26 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_EDGE_STYLE 91 Select the shape to be used at the corners of the line. In case of a small angle between lines, a mitered shape is replaced with a beveled shape.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMF_SYMBOL_WIDTH 1d Enter a width for the symbol.
2a cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_END_WIDTH 20 Enter a width for the arrowhead.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_START_STYLE 41 Select the arrowhead that you want to apply to the selected line.
29 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMF_SYMBOL_HEIGHT 1e Enter a height for the symbol.
2d cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMTR_LINE_TRANSPARENT 71 Enter the transparency of the line, where 100% corresponds to completely transparent and 0% to completely opaque.
29 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FTSB_CENTER_START 4e Places the center of the arrowhead(s) on the endpoint(s) of the selected line.
11 .uno%3AXLineStyle 2b Select the line style that you want to use.
11 .uno%3AXLineColor 1c Select a color for the line.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FCB_SYMBOL_RATIO 53 Maintains the proportions of the symbol when you enter a new height or width value.
29 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMB_SYMBOL_BITMAP 3b Select the symbol style that you want to use in your chart.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FTSB_CENTER_END 4e Places the center of the arrowhead(s) on the endpoint(s) of the selected line.
24 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLineTabPage 93 Set the formatting options for the selected line or the line that you want to draw. You can also add arrowheads to a line, or change chart symbols.
2b cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LINE_WIDTH 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium.
10 .uno%3ALineWidth 99 Select the width for the line. You can append a measurement unit. A zero line width results in a hairline with a width of one pixel of the output medium.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FCBX_SYNCHRONIZE 8a Automatically updates both arrowhead settings when you enter a different width, select a different arrowhead style,or center an arrowhead.
2c cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_START_WIDTH 20 Enter a width for the arrowhead.
26 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_LINE_STYLE 2b Select the line style that you want to use.
21 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_COLOR 1c Select a color for the line.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flinetabpage%2FLB_END_STYLE 41 Select the arrowhead that you want to apply to the selected line.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_MODIFY 8a Updates the selected line style using the current settings. To change the name of the selected line style, enter a new name when prompted.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fnamedialog%2FNameDialog d Enter a name.
2d cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FCBX_SYNCHRONIZE 45 Automatically adjusts the entries relative to the length of the line.
2e cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 48 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between dots or dashes.
2e cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LENGTH_2 1d Enter the length of the dash.
2e cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LENGTH_1 1d Enter the length of the dash.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FNUM_FLD_2 50 Enter the number of times that you want a dot or a dash to appear in a sequence.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FNUM_FLD_1 50 Enter the number of times that you want a dot or a dash to appear in a sequence.
26 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_SAVE 4b Saves the current list of line styles, so that you can load it again later.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FLB_TYPE_2 38 Select the combination of dashes and dots that you want.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FLB_TYPE_1 38 Select the combination of dashes and dots that you want.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_ADD 34 Creates a new line style using the current settings.
2b cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FLB_LINESTYLES 31 Select the style of line that you want to create.
26 cui%2Fui%2Flinestyletabpage%2FBTN_LOAD 1e Imports a list of line styles.
10 CUI_HID_LINE_DEF 2c Edit or create dashed or dotted line styles.
27 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_MODIFY 2d Changes the name of the selected arrow style.
24 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_ADD 5d To define a custom arrow style, select a drawing object in the document, and then click here.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_LOAD 1f Imports a list of arrow styles.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FLB_LINEENDS 39 Choose a predefined arrow style symbol from the list box.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FBTN_SAVE 46 Saves the current list of arrow styles, so that you can load it later.
25 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FEDT_NAME 2e Displays the name of the selected arrow style.
28 cui%2Fui%2Flineendstabpage%2FLineEndPage 1c Edit or create arrow styles.
11 .uno%3AFormatArea 38 Sets the fill properties of the selected drawing object.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FLB_HATCHBCKGRDCOLOR 57 Click the color that you want to use as a background for the selected hatching pattern.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FCB_HATCHBCKGRD 6d Applies a background color to the hatching pattern. Select this checkbox, and then click a color in the list.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FMTR_FLD_X_SIZE 1d Enter a width for the bitmap.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FTSB_TILE 2d Tiles the bitmap to fill the selected object.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FTSB_SCALE fd Rescales the bitmap relative to the size of the selected object by the percentage values that you enter in the Width and Height boxes . Clear this checkbox to resize the selected object with the measurements that you enter in the Width and Height boxes.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FMTR_FLD_Y_SIZE 1e Enter a height for the bitmap.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FMTR_FLD_X_OFFSET 32 Enter the horizontal offset for tiling the bitmap.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FAreaTabPage 35 Set the fill options for the selected drawing object.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FTSB_STEPCOUNT 5d Automatically determines the number of steps for blending the two end colors of the gradient.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FLB_BITMAP 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FLB_COLOR 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FLB_GRADIENT 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FLB_HATCHING 3d Click the fill that you want to apply to the selected object.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FMTR_FLD_Y_OFFSET 30 Enter the vertical offset for tiling the bitmap.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FLB_AREA_TYPE 4e Select the type of fill that you want to apply to the selected drawing object.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FRBT_COLUMN 61 Vertically offsets the original bitmap relative to the bitmap tiles by the amount that you enter.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FRBT_ROW 63 Horizontally offsets the original bitmap relative to the bitmap tiles by the amount that you enter.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FTSB_ORIGINAL 8d Retains the original size of the bitmap when filling the selected object. To resize the bitmap, clear this checkbox, and then click Relative.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FNUM_FLD_STEPCOUNT 4a Enter the number of steps for blending the two end colors of the gradient.
10 .uno%3AFillStyle 4e Select the type of fill that you want to apply to the selected drawing object.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FMTR_FLD_OFFSET 33 Enter the percentage to offset the rows or columns.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fareatabpage%2FTSB_STRETCH 5a Stretches the bitmap to fill the selected object. To use this feature, clear the Tile box.
18 cui%2Fgrdientpage%2Fsave 43 Saves the current list of gradients, so that you can load it later.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fgradientslb 3d Select the type of gradient that you want to apply or create.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fload 23 Load a different list of gradients.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcolortolb 30 Select a color for the endpoint of the gradient.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcolorfrommtr 72 Enter the intensity for the color in the From box, where 0% corresponds to black, and 100 % to the selected color.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fbordermtr 9c Enter the amount by which you want to adjust the area of the endpoint color on the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fadd 6f Adds a custom gradient to the current list. Specify the properties of your gradient, and then click this button
25 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcolorfromlb 37 Select a color for the beginning point of the gradient.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fanglemtr 31 Enter a rotation angle for the selected gradient.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcenterymtr c8 Enter the vertical offset for the gradient, where 0% corresponds to the current vertical location of the endpoint color in the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcenterxmtr cc Enter the horizontal offset for the gradient, where 0% corresponds to the current horizontal location of the endpoint color in the gradient. The endpoint color is the color that is selected in the To box.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fgradienttypelb 2b Select the gradient that you want to apply.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fmodify 80 Applies the current gradient properties to the selected gradient. If you want, you can save the gradient under a different name.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2Fcolortomtr 70 Enter the intensity for the color in the To box, where 0% corresponds to black, and 100 % to the selected color.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fgradientpage%2FGradientPage 42 Set the properties of a gradient, or save and load gradient lists.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fmodify 87 Applies the current hatching properties to the selected hatching pattern. If you want, you can save the pattern under a different name.
1a cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fadd 80 Adds a custom hatching pattern to the current list. Specify the properties of your hatching pattern, and then click this button.
1b cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fload 2c Loads a different list of hatching patterns.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fhatchingslb 6c Lists the available hatching patterns. Click the hatching pattern that you want to apply, and then click OK.
1b cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fsave 4b Saves the current list of hatching patterns, so that you can load it later.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Flinecolorlb 24 Select the color of the hatch lines.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Flinetypelb 34 Select the type of hatch lines that you want to use.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fanglectl 4e Click a position in the grid to define the rotation angle for the hatch lines.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fanglemtr 54 Enter the rotation angle for the hatch lines, or click a position in the angle grid.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2Fdistancemtr 48 Enter the amount of space that you want to have between the hatch lines.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fhatchpage%2FHatchPage 4a Set the properties of a hatching pattern, or save and load hatching lists.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBTN_SAVE 41 Saves the current list of bitmaps, so that you can load it later.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBTN_LOAD 22 Loads a different list of bitmaps.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBTN_IMPORT 80 Locate the bitmap that you want to import, and then click Open. The bitmap is added to the end of the list of available bitmaps.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBTN_ADD 49 Adds a bitmap that you created in the Pattern Editor to the current list.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBTN_MODIFY 97 Replaces a bitmap that you created in the Pattern Editor with the current bitmap pattern. If you want, you can save the pattern under a different name.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FLB_BITMAPS 5b Select a bitmap in the list, and then click OK to apply the pattern to the selected object.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FLB_BACKGROUND_COLOR 32 Select a background color for your bitmap pattern.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FLB_COLOR 54 Select a foreground color, and then click in the grid to add a pixel to the pattern.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fbitmaptabpage%2FBitmapTabPage 95 Select a bitmap that you want to use as a fill pattern, or create your own pixel pattern. You can also import bitmaps, and save or load bitmap lists.
11 .uno%3AFillShadow c9 Adds a shadow to the selected object. If the object already has a shadow, the shadow is removed. If you click this icon when no object is selected, the shadow is added to the next object that you draw.
3f cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SHADOW%3AMTR_SHADOW_TRANSPARENT 64 Enter a percentage from 0% (opaque) to 100% (transparent) to specify the transparency of the shadow.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SHADOW%3ALB_SHADOW_COLOR 1e Select a color for the shadow.
15 CUI_HID_TPSHADOW_CTRL 28 Click where you want to cast the shadow.
38 cui%3ATriStateBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SHADOW%3ATSB_SHOW_SHADOW 2d Adds a shadow to the selected drawing object.
39 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_SHADOW%3AMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 52 Enter the distance that you want the shadow to be offset from the selected object.
13 CUI_HID_AREA_SHADOW 55 Add a shadow to the selected drawing object, and define the properties of the shadow.
33 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_END_VALUE 74 Enter a transparency value for the endpoint of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
35 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_START_VALUE 7b Enter a transparency value for the beginning point of the gradient, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
30 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_BORDER 6b Enter the amount by which you want to adjust the transparent area of the gradient. The default value is 0%.
2f cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_ANGLE 28 Enter a rotation angle for the gradient.
37 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FLB_TRGR_GRADIENT_TYPES 40 Select the type of transparency gradient that you want to apply.
32 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_CENTER_X 2d Enter the horizontal offset for the gradient.
30 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRANSPARENT 6e Adjusts the transparency of the current fill color. Enter a number between 0% (opaque) and 100% (transparent).
31 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FRBT_TRANS_LINEAR 8c Turns on color transparency. Select this option, and then enter a number in the box, where 0% is fully opaque and 100% is fully transparent.
2e cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FRBT_TRANS_OFF 1d Turns off color transparency.
32 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FMTR_TRGR_CENTER_Y 2b Enter the vertical offset for the gradient.
33 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FRBT_TRANS_GRADIENT 74 Applies a transparency gradient to the current fill color. Select this option, and then set the gradient properties.
34 cui%2Fui%2Ftransparencytabpage%2FTransparencyTabPage 50 Set the transparency options for the fill that you apply to the selected object.
2b cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_FULL_WIDTH 52 Vyberie oddeľovač medzi viacnásobnými textovými reťazcami v rovnakom objekte
29 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FCTL_POSITION 36 Click where you want to place the anchor for the text.
2b cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_BOTTOM 7a Enter the amount of space to leave between the bottom edge of the drawing or text object and the lower border of the text.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_TOP 77 Enter the amount of space to leave between the top edge of the drawing or text object and the upper border of the text.
29 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_LEFT 77 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the drawing or text object and the left border of the text.
2e cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_SIZE 56 Resizes a custom shape to fit the text that you enter after double-clicking the shape.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_CONTOUR 54 Adapts the text flow so that it matches the contours of the selected drawing object.
2c cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_FIT_TO_SIZE 46 Resizes the text to fit the entire area of the drawing or text object.
2f cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_WIDTH 61 Expands the width of the object to the width of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
2a cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_RIGHT 79 Enter the amount of space to leave between the right edge of the drawing or text object and the right border of the text.
30 cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_HEIGHT 63 Expands the height of the object to the height of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
2f cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTextAttributesPage 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object.
2e cui%2Fui%2Ftextattrtabpage%2FTSB_WORDWRAP_TEXT 59 Wraps the text that you add after double-clicking a custom shape to fit inside the shape.
15 .uno%3ATextAttributes 59 Sets the layout and anchoring properties for text in the selected drawing or text object.
16 .uno%3ATransformDialog 37 Resizes, moves, rotates, or slants the selected object.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_HEIGHT 63 Expands the height of the object to the height of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FTSB_AUTOGROW_WIDTH 61 Expands the width of the object to the width of the text, if the object is smaller than the text.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FLB_ORIENT 0 
28 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FCTL_SIZERECT 7d Click a base point in the grid, and then enter the new size dimensions for the selected object in the Width and Height boxes.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FTSB_SIZEPROTECT 26 Prevents you from resizing the object.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FCBX_SCALE 3a Maintains proportions when you resize the selected object.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_HEIGHT 27 Enter a height for the selected object.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FTSB_POSPROTECT 44 Prevents changes to the position or the size of the selected object.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_WIDTH 26 Enter a width for the selected object.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FLB_ANCHOR 0 
27 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FCTL_POSRECT f2 Click a base point in the grid, and then enter the amount that you want to shift the object relative to the base point that you selected in the Position Y and Position X boxes. The base points correspond to the selection handles on an object.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_POS_Y 6d Enter the vertical distance that you want to move the object relative to the base point selected in the grid.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FMTR_FLD_POS_X 6f Enter the horizontal distance that you want to move the object relative to the base point selected in the grid.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fpossizetabpage%2FPositionAndSize 25 Resizes or moves the selected object.
26 cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FCTL_ANGLE 3f Click to specify the rotation angle in multiples of 45 degrees.
2a cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_ANGLE 48 Enter the number of degrees that you want to rotate the selected object.
25 cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FCTL_RECT 2e Click where you want to place the pivot point.
2a cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_POS_Y 4d Enter the vertical distance from the top edge of the page to the pivot point.
2a cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_POS_X 50 Enter the horizontal distance from the left edge of the page to the pivot point.
25 cui%2Fui%2Frotationtabpage%2FRotation 1c Rotates the selected object.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fslantcornertabpage%2FMTR_FLD_ANGLE 22 Enter the angle of the slant axis.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fslantcornertabpage%2FMTR_FLD_RADIUS 49 Enter the radius of the circle that you want to use to round the corners.
34 cui%2Fui%2Fslantcornertabpage%2FSlantAndCornerRadius 4a Slants the selected object, or rounds the corners of a rectangular object.
33 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3AMF_LAENGE 73 Enter the length of the callout line segment that extends from the callout box to the inflection point of the line.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3ALB_ANSATZ 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box.
34 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3AMF_ABSTAND 6a Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the end of the callout line, and the callout box.
30 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3ACB_LAENGE 3d Click here to display a single-angled line in an optimal way.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3ALB_ANSATZ_REL 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box.
33 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3AMF_ANSATZ 56 Select where you want to extend the callout line from, in relation to the callout box.
18 CUI_HID_CAPTION_CTL_TYPE 47 Click the Callout style that you want to apply to the selected callout.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_CAPTION%3ALB_WINKEL 47 Click the Callout style that you want to apply to the selected callout.
f .uno%3AFlipMenu 36 Flips the selected object horizontally, or vertically.
1b .uno%3AObjectMirrorVertical 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom.
11 .uno%3AMirrorVert 3b Flips the selected object(s) vertically from top to bottom.
1d .uno%3AObjectMirrorHorizontal 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right.
11 .uno%3AMirrorHorz 3d Flips the selected object(s) horizontally from left to right.
17 .uno%3AArrangeFrameMenu 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s).
12 .uno%3AArrangeMenu 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s).
15 .uno%3AObjectPosition 35 Changes the stacking order of the selected object(s).
13 .uno%3ABringToFront 64 Moves the selected object to the top of the stacking order, so that it is in front of other objects.
17 .uno%3AObjectForwardOne 5a Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to top of the stacking order.
e .uno%3AForward 5a Moves the selected object up one level, so that it is closer to top of the stacking order.
14 .uno%3AObjectBackOne 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order.
f .uno%3ABackward 63 Moves the selected object down one level, so that it is closer to the bottom of the stacking order.
11 .uno%3ASendToBack 66 Moves the selected object to the bottom of the stacking order, so that it is behind the other objects.
1c .uno%3ASetObjectToForeground 2b Moves the selected object in front of text.
1c .uno%3ASetObjectToBackground 26 Moves the selected object behind text.
11 .uno%3AAnchorMenu 33 Sets the anchoring options for the selected object.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToPage 2e Anchors the selected item to the current page.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToPara 33 Anchors the selected item to the current paragraph.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToCell 24 Anchors the selected item to a cell.
17 .uno%3ASetAnchorToFrame 33 Anchors the selected item to the surrounding frame.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorToChar c0 Anchors the selected item as a character in the current text. If the height of the selected item is greater than the current font size, the height of the line containing the item is increased.
16 .uno%3ASetAnchorAsChar c0 Anchors the selected item as a character in the current text. If the height of the selected item is greater than the current font size, the height of the line containing the item is increased.
1d .uno%3AToggleObjectBezierMode 39 Lets you change the shape of the selected drawing object.
36 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3ACLB_SHADOW_COLOR 23 Select a color for the text shadow.
3a svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3AMTR_FLD_SHADOW_Y 53 Enter the vertical distance between the text characters and the edge of the shadow.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_SHADOW_SLANT a2 Adds a slant shadow to the text in the selected object. Click this button, and then enter the dimensions of the shadow in the Distance X and the Distance Y boxes.
22 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_SHADOW_NORMAL 9c Adds a shadow to the text in the selected object. Click this button, and then enter the dimensions of the shadow in the Distance X and the Distance Y boxes.
1f SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_SHADOW_OFF 38 Removes the shadow effects that you applied to the text.
1c SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_OUTLINE 44 Shows or hides the borders of the individual characters in the text.
1e SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_OFF 1c Removes baseline formatting.
3b svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3AMTR_FLD_TEXTSTART 6d Enter the amount of space to leave between the beginning of the text baseline, and the beginning of the text.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_ROTATE 4c Uses the top or the bottom edge of the selected object as the text baseline.
24 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_AUTOSIZE 38 Resizes the text to fit the length of the text baseline.
20 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_LEFT 35 Aligns the text to the left end of the text baseline.
22 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_CENTER 26 Centers the text on the text baseline.
3a svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3AMTR_FLD_DISTANCE 75 Enter the amount of space that you want to leave between the text baseline and the base of the individual characters.
22 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_UPRIGHT 97 Uses the top or the bottom edge of the selected object as the text baseline and preserves the original vertical alignment of the individual characters.
22 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_MIRROR 9c Reverses the text flow direction, and flips the text horizontally or vertically. To use this command, you must first apply a different baseline to the text.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_SLANTY 34 Vertically slants the characters in the text object.
3a svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_FONTWORK%3AMTR_FLD_SHADOW_X 55 Enter the horizontal distance between the text characters and the edge of the shadow.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_STYLE_SLANTX 36 Horizontally slants the characters in the text object.
21 SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_ADJUST_RIGHT 36 Aligns the text to the right end of the text baseline.
1a SVX_HID_FONTWORK_CTL_FORMS 42 Click the shape of the baseline that you want to use for the text.
1d SVX_HID_FONTWORK_TBI_SHOWFORM 46 Shows or hides the text baseline, or the edges of the selected object.
f .uno%3AFontWork 66 Edits Fontwork effects of the selected object that has been created with the previous Fontwork dialog.
10 .uno%3AGroupMenu 61 Groups keep together selected objects, so that they can be moved or formatted as a single object.
12 .uno%3AFormatGroup 4a Groups the selected objects, so that they can be moved as a single object.
14 .uno%3AFormatUngroup 38 Breaks apart the selected group into individual objects.
11 .uno%3AEnterGroup a1 Opens the selected group, so that you can edit the individual objects. If the selected group contains nested group, you can repeat this command on the subgroups.
11 .uno%3ALeaveGroup 54 Exits the group, so that you can no longer edit the individual objects in the group.
2a cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_DELAY 3d Enter the amount of time to wait before repeating the effect.
2b cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FMTR_FLD_AMOUNT 3b Enter the number of increments by which to scroll the text.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_PIXEL 23 Measures increment value in pixels.
2a cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FNUM_FLD_COUNT 47 Enter the number of times that you want the animation effect to repeat.
28 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_ENDLESS 9a Plays the animation effect continuously. To specify the number of times to play the effect, clear this checkbox, and enter a number in the Continuous box.
2c cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_STOP_INSIDE 31 Text remains visible after the effect is applied.
2d cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_START_INSIDE 49 Text is visible and inside the drawing object when the effect is applied.
23 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FBTN_UP 20 Scrolls text from bottom to top.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FBTN_RIGHT 20 Scrolls text from left to right.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FBTN_DOWN 20 Scrolls text from top to bottom.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FBTN_LEFT 20 Scrolls text from right to left.
25 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTSB_AUTO c5 $[officename] automatically determines the amount of time to wait before repeating the effect. To manually assign the delay period, clear this checkbox, and then enter a value in the Automatic box.
26 cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FLB_EFFECT 8f Select the animation effect that you want to apply to the text in the selected drawing object. To remove an animation effect, select No Effect.
2a cui%2Fui%2Ftextanimtabpage%2FTextAnimation 44 Adds an animation effect to the text in the selected drawing object.
31 dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ROWHEIGHT%3ACB_STANDARD c1 Adjusts the row height to the size based on the default template. Existing contents may be shown vertically cropped. The height no longer increases automatically when you enter larger contents.
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_ROW_MAN%3ABTN_DEFVAL c1 Adjusts the row height to the size based on the default template. Existing contents may be shown vertically cropped. The height no longer increases automatically when you enter larger contents.
31 dbaccess%3AMetricField%3ADLG_ROWHEIGHT%3AMF_VALUE 2a Enter the row height that you want to use.
2f sc%3AMetricField%3ARID_SCDLG_ROW_MAN%3AED_VALUE 2a Enter the row height that you want to use.
1e DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_ROWHEIGHT 3c Changes the height of the current row, or the selected rows.
10 .uno%3ARowHeight 3c Changes the height of the current row, or the selected rows.
30 dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_COLWIDTH%3ACB_STANDARD 41 Automatically adjusts the column width based on the current font.
2e sc%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SCDLG_COL_MAN%3ABTN_DEFVAL 41 Automatically adjusts the column width based on the current font.
30 dbaccess%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLWIDTH%3AMF_VALUE 2c Enter the column width that you want to use.
2f sc%3AMetricField%3ARID_SCDLG_COL_MAN%3AED_VALUE 2c Enter the column width that you want to use.
20 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_COLUMNWIDTH 41 Changes the width of the current column, or the selected columns.
12 .uno%3AColumnWidth 41 Changes the width of the current column, or the selected columns.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckShrinkFitCellSize aa Reduces the apparent size of the font so that the contents of the cell fit into the current cell width. You cannot apply this command to a cell that contains line breaks.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckAsianMode 133 Aligns Asian characters one below the other in the selected cell(s). If the cell contains more than one line of text, the lines are converted to text columns that are arranged from right to left. Western characters in the converted text are rotated 90 degrees to the right. Asian characters are not rotated.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckHyphActive 3c Enables word hyphenation for text wrapping to the next line.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2Freferences 3b Specify the cell edge from which to write the rotated text.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FspinDegrees a2 Enter the rotation angle for the text in the selected cell(s). A positive number rotates the text to the left and a negative number rotates the text to the right.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckVertStack 17 Aligns text vertically.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2Fdialcontrol 2e Click in the dial to set the text orientation.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcomboboxVertAlign 51 Select the vertical alignment option that you want to apply to the cell contents.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FspinIndentFrom 44 Indents from the left edge of the cell by the amount that you enter.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcomboboxHorzAlign 53 Select the horizontal alignment option that you want to apply to the cell contents.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FcheckWrapTextAuto 66 Wraps text onto another line at the cell border. The number of lines depends on the width of the cell.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fcellalignment%2FCellsAlignPage 57 Sets the alignment options for the contents of the current cell, or the selected cells.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_NUMBEROFRECORDS b7 Displays the number of records. For example, "Record 7 of 9(2)" indicates that two records (2) are selected in a table containing 9 records, and that the cursor is in record number 7.
17 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEW 2c Inserts a new record into the current table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_LAST 23 Go to the last record in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_NEXT 23 Go to the next record in the table.
18 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_PREV 27 Go to the previous record in the table.
19 SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_FIRST 24 Go to the first record in the table.
1c SVX_HID_GRID_TRAVEL_ABSOLUTE 4d Type the number of the record that you want to display, and then press Enter.
1b DBACCESS_HID_CTL_TABBROWSER 87 Select database records. Drag-and-drop rows or cells to the document to insert contents. Drag-and-drop column headers to insert fields.
20 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLEFORMAT 1c Formats the selected row(s).
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_COLUMNFORMAT 1f Formats the selected column(s).
f .uno%3AWindow3D 41 Specifies the properties of 3D object(s) in the current document.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_DOUBLE_SIDED 60 Closes the shape of a 3D object that was created by extruding a freeform line (Convert - To 3D).
3c svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TWO_SIDED_LIGHTING 8f Lights the object from the outside and the inside. To use an ambient light source, click this button, and then click the Invert Normals button.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_NORMALS_SPHERE 1c Renders a smooth 3D surface.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_NORMALS_FLAT 23 Renders the 3D surface as polygons.
35 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_NORMALS_OBJ 80 Renders the 3D surface according to the shape of the object. For example, a circular shape is rendered with a spherical surface.
33 svx%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ANUM_VERTICAL 4f Enter the number of vertical segments to use in the selected 3D rotation object
2f svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_DEPTH 67 Enter the extrusion depth for the selected 3D object. This option is not valid for 3D rotation objects.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_BACKSCALE 67 Enter the amount by which to increase or decrease the area of the front side of the selected 3D object.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_NORMALS_INVERT 19 Inverts the light source.
33 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_END_ANGLE 45 Enter the angle in degrees to rotate the selected 3D rotation object.
3a svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_PERCENT_DIAGONAL 52 Enter the amount by which you want to round the corners of the selected 3D object.
35 svx%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ANUM_HORIZONTAL 52 Enter the number of horizontal segments to use in the selected 3D rotation object.
2d svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_GEO 108 Adjusts the shape of the selected 3D object. You can only modify the shape of a 3D object that was created by converting a 2D object. To convert a 2D object to 3D, select the object, right-click, and then choose Convert - To 3D, or Convert - To 3D Rotation Object.
36 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_FOCAL_LENGTH 81 Enter the focal length of the camera, where a small value corresponds to a "fisheye" lens, and a large value to a telephoto lens.
32 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_DISTANCE 55 Enter the distance to leave between the camera and the center of the selected object.
33 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_SHADOW_3D 35 Adds or removes a shadow from the selected 3D object.
2e svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_SHADEMODE 135 Select the shading method that you want to use. Flat shading assigns a single color to a single polygon on the surface of the object. Gouraud shading blends colors across the polygons. Phong shading averages the color of each pixel based on the pixels that surround it, and requires the most processing power.
2f svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_SLANT 3b Enter an angle from 0 to 90 degrees for casting the shadow.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_REPRESENTATION 3f Sets the shading and shadow options for the selected 3D object.
31 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_AMBIENTLIGHT 24 Vyberte farbu okolitého osvetlenia.
35 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_COLOR 24 Vyberte farbu okolitého osvetlenia.
2c svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_LIGHT_1 24 Vyberte farbu okolitého osvetlenia.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_8 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_5 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_3 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_4 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_2 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_7 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_6 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT_1 d0 Click twice to turn the light source on, and then select a color for the light from the list. If you want, you can also set the color of the surrounding light, by selecting a color from the Ambient light box.
2f svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_LIGHT 33 Define the light source for the selected 3D object.
34 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_FILTER 37 Blurs the texture slightly to remove unwanted speckles.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_CIRCLE_Y 3f Wraps the vertical axis of the texture pattern around a sphere.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_PARALLEL_Y 32 Applies the texture parallel to the vertical axis.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_OBJECT_Y 4c Automatically adjusts the texture based on the shape and size of the object.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_CIRCLE_X 41 Wraps the horizontal axis of the texture pattern around a sphere.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_PARALLEL_X 34 Applies the texture parallel to the horizontal axis.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_MODULATE 79 Applies the texture with shading. To define the shading options for the texture, click the Shading button in this dialog.
36 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_OBJECT_X 4c Automatically adjusts the texture based on the shape and size of the object.
35 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_REPLACE 24 Applies the texture without shading.
37 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_LUMINANCE 28 Converts the texture to black and white.
33 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEX_COLOR 1e Converts the texture to color.
31 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_TEXTURE 135 Sets the properties of the surface texture for the selected 3D object. This feature is only available after you apply a surface textures to the selected object. To quickly apply a surface texture, open the Gallery, hold down Shift+Ctrl (Mac: Shift+Command), and then drag an image onto the selected 3D object.
40 svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3AMTR_MAT_SPECULAR_INTENSITY 2b Enter the intensity of the specular effect.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_SPECULAR_COLOR 2b Enter the intensity of the specular effect.
38 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_EMISSION_COLOR 35 Select the color that you want the object to reflect.
31 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_MAT_EMISSION 2a Select the color to illuminate the object.
33 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_MAT_COLOR 2a Select the color to illuminate the object.
2e svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_MAT_COLOR 36 Select the color that you want to apply to the object.
32 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_MAT_FAVORITES 59 Select a predefined color scheme, or select User-defined to define a custom color scheme.
31 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ALB_MAT_SPECULAR 35 Select the color that you want the object to reflect.
32 svx%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXFLOAT_3D%3ABTN_MATERIAL 2f Changes the coloring of the selected 3D object.
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_DISTANCE 64 Distributes the selected objects vertically, so that the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
38 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_TOP 6a Distributes the selected objects, so that the top edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
3b cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_CENTER 71 Distributes the selected objects, so that the vertical centers of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_NONE 2b Does not distribute the objects vertically.
3b cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_VER_BOTTOM 6d Distributes the selected objects, so that the bottom edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
3a cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_RIGHT 6c Distributes the selected objects, so that the right edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
3d cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_DISTANCE 66 Distributes the selected objects horizontally, so that the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_LEFT 6b Distributes the selected objects, so that the left edges of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
3b cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_CENTER 73 Distributes the selected objects, so that the horizontal centers of the objects are evenly spaced from one another.
39 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_DISTRIBUTE%3ABTN_HOR_NONE 2d Does not distribute the objects horizontally.
1a .uno%3ADistributeSelection 9d Distributes three or more selected objects evenly along the horizontal axis or the vertical axis. You can also evenly distribute the spacing between objects.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3APB_UNDO 74 Click to undo the last change in the current sentence. Click again to undo the previous change in the same sentence.
1c CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_CHANGE 8a Replaces the unknown word with the current suggestion. If you changed more than just the misspelled word, the entire sentence is replaced.
1f CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_IGNOREALL 7e Skips all occurrences of the unknown word until the end of the current %PRODUCTNAME session and continues with the spellcheck.
1f CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_CHANGEALL 49 Replaces all occurrences of the unknown word with the current suggestion.
20 CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_IGNORERULE 74 While performing a grammar check, click Ignore Rule to ignore the rule that is currently flagged as a grammar error.
1c CUI_HID_SPLDLG_BUTTON_IGNORE 39 Skips the unknown word and continues with the spellcheck.
35 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3APB_OPTIONS 6c Opens a dialog, where you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for the spellchecking.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3APB_AUTOCORR 6c Opens a dialog, where you can select the user-defined dictionaries, and set the rules for the spellchecking.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ALB_LANGUAGE 34 Specifies the language to use to check the spelling.
37 cui%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3AMB_ADDTODICT 33 Adds the unknown word to a user-defined dictionary.
35 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ALB_SUGGESTION 80 Lists suggested words to replace the misspelled word. Select the word that you want to use, and then click Change or Change All.
38 cui%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3AED_NEWWORD 91 Displays the sentence with the misspelled word highlighted. Edit the word or the sentence, or click one of the suggestions in the text box below.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SPELLCHECK%3ACB_CHECK_GRAMMAR 58 Enable Check grammar to work first on all spellcheck errors, then on all grammar errors.
1f .uno%3ASpellingAndGrammarDialog 9a Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialog also checks for grammar errors.
f .uno%3ASpelling 9a Checks the document or the current selection for spelling errors. If a grammar checking extension is installed, the dialog also checks for grammar errors.
17 .uno%3AMoreDictionaries 3d Opens the default browser on the dictionaries extension page.
13 .uno%3ALanguageMenu 40 Opens a submenu where you can choose language specific commands.
3c svx%2Fui%2Fchineseconversiondialog%2FChineseConversionDialog 8a Converts the selected Chinese text from one Chinese writing system to the other. If no text is selected, the entire document is converted.
18 .uno%3AChineseConversion 8a Converts the selected Chinese text from one Chinese writing system to the other. If no text is selected, the entire document is converted.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Flangcb 24 Select a language for the thesaurus.
1b cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Fleft 3d Recalls the previous contents of the "Current word" text box.
1d cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Fwordcb b6 Displays the current word, or the related term that you selected by double-clicking a line in the Alternatives list. You can also type text directly in this box to look up your text.
10 .uno%3AThesaurus 51 Opens a dialog box to replace the current word with a synonym, or a related term.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Freplaceed af The word or words in the "Replace with" text box will replace the original word in the document when you click the Replace button. You can also type text directly in this box.
16 .uno%3AThesaurusDialog 51 Opens a dialog box to replace the current word with a synonym, or a related term.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2Falternatives c8 Click an entry in the Alternatives list to copy the related term to the "Replace with" text box. Double-click an entry to copy the related term to the "Current word" text box and to look up that term.
26 cui%2Fui%2Fthesaurus%2FThesaurusDialog 51 Opens a dialog box to replace the current word with a synonym, or a related term.
2d svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_TRANS 47 Select the color to replace the transparent areas in the current image.
2f svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_TRANS 4f Replaces transparent areas in the current image with the color that you select.
29 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_2 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab.
2d svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ASP_3 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value.
29 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_1 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab.
2d svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ASP_4 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value.
29 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_4 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab.
2d svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ASP_1 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value.
1a SVX_HID_BMPMASK_CTL_QCOL_1 af Displays the color in the selected image that you want to replace. To set the source color, click here, click the Color Replacer, and then click a color in the selected image.
2d svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ASP_2 d3 Set the tolerance for replacing a source color in the source image. To replace colors that are similar to the color that you selected, enter a low value. To replace a wider range of colors, enter a higher value.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_4 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_3 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box.
e .uno%3ABmpMask 6e Otvorí okno Písmomaľba- rozostup znakov kde môžete zadávať nové hodnoty rozostupu znakov písmomaľby.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_1 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ACBX_2 71 Select this checkbox to replace the current Source color with the color that you specify in the Replace with box.
29 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ALB_3 96 Lists the available replacement colors. To modify the current list of colors, deselect the image, choose Format - Area, and then click the Colors tab.
1b SVX_HID_BMPMASK_TBI_PIPETTE 8d Select one of the four source color boxes. Move the mouse pointer over the selected image, and then click the color that you want to replace.
30 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_BMPMASK%3ABTN_EXEC 74 Replaces the selected source colors in the current image with the colors that you specify in the Replace with boxes.
1b SVX_HID_BMPMASK_CTL_PIPETTE a5 Displays the color in the selected image that directly underlies the current mouse pointer position. This features only works if the Color Replacer tool is selected.
15 .uno%3AAutoCorrectDlg 90 Nastaví možnosti pre automatické nahrádzanie textu počas písania alebo pre hromadné použitie automatických opráv v existujúcom texte.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fapplyautofmtpage%2Fedit 2f Upraví možnosti zvolenej Automatickej opravy.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fapplyautofmtpage%2FApplyAutoFmtPage 87 Nastavte možnosti pre automatické opravy chýb počas písania textu alebo pre hromadnú opravu existujúceho textu a kliknite na OK.
33 cui%2Fui%2Facoroptionspage%2FAutocorrectOptionsPage 87 Nastavte možnosti pre automatické opravy chýb počas písania textu alebo pre hromadnú opravu existujúceho textu a kliknite na OK.
24 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Freplace 32 Pridá alebo nahradí položku v tabuľke náhrad.
20 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Fnew 32 Pridá alebo nahradí položku v tabuľke náhrad.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Ftextonly 10c Ak je toto pole zakliknuté, po kliknutí na tlačidlo Nový sa položka v poli S: uloží bez formátovania, grafiky a objektov. Pri použití takejto automatickej náhrady sa použije predvolené formátovanie (znakový štýl), aké bude používať text dokumentu.
24 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Fnewtext eb Zadajte text, grafiku, rámec, alebo OLE objekt, ktorými chcete nahradiť text v poli Nahradiť. Ak ste označili text, grafiku, rámec, alebo OLE objekt vo vašom dokumente, všetky potrebné informácie sú už v tomto poli zadané.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Forigtext 257 Enter the word or abbreviation that you want to replace while you type. Wildcard character * in the end of word results the replacement of the word before arbitrary suffixes, too. Wildcard character * before the word results the replacement after arbitrary prefixes, too. For example, the pattern "i18n*" with the replacement text "internationalization" will find and replace "i18ns" with "internationalizations", or the pattern "*..." with the replacement text "…" will find and replace three dots in "word..." with the typographically correct precomposed Unicode horizontal ellipsis ("word…").
24 cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2Ftabview 1b1 Zobrazuje zoznam pre automatické náhrady slov, znakov alebo skratiek. Pre pridanie novej položky vložte nahrádzaný text do poľa Nahradiť, text náhrady do poľa S: a kliknite na tlačidlo Nový. Pre úpravu existujúcej náhrady označte položku v zozname, zmeňte text v poli S: a následne kliknite na tlačidlo Nahradiť. Pre odstránenie existujúcej náhrady označte položku v zozname a kliknite na tlačidlo Zmazať.
2c cui%2Fui%2Facorreplacepage%2FAcorReplacePage 68 Umožňuje upraviť tabuľku náhrad pre automatické opravy alebo náhrady slov, znakov alebo skratiek.
26 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fautodouble 177 Automaticky pridáva skratky zakončené bodkou alebo slová s dvoma začiatočnými veľkými písmenami do príslušného zoznamu výnimiek. Táto funkcia pracuje len v prípade, ak je zakliknutá možnosť Opraviť PRvé DVe veľké písmená alebo možnosť Každé prvé písmeno vety veľkým v stĺpci [T] na záložke Možnosti dialógového okna Automatické opravy.
26 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fautoabbrev 177 Automaticky pridáva skratky zakončené bodkou alebo slová s dvoma začiatočnými veľkými písmenami do príslušného zoznamu výnimiek. Táto funkcia pracuje len v prípade, ak je zakliknutá možnosť Opraviť PRvé DVe veľké písmená alebo možnosť Každé prvé písmeno vety veľkým v stĺpci [T] na záložke Možnosti dialógového okna Automatické opravy.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fnewdouble 38 Pridá zadanú skratku alebo slovo do zoznamu výnimiek.
26 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fdoublelist 9f Toto okno obsahuje zoznam slov a skratiek začínajúcich dvoma veľkými písmenami, v ktorých nebude automaticky opravené druhé veľké písmeno na malé.
25 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fnewabbrev 38 Pridá zadanú skratku alebo slovo do zoznamu výnimiek.
22 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fdouble 130 Napíšte slovo alebo skratku začínajúcu dvoma veľkými písmenami, v ktorej $[officename] nemá automaticky zmeniť druhé veľké písmeno na malé v prípade zapnutej funkcie "Opraviť PRvé DVe veľké písmená". Zadajte napríklad text "PC", aby $[officename] automaticky nezmenil "PC" na "Pc".
22 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fabbrev 11a Napíšte skratku zakončenú bodkou a kliknite na tlačidlo Nový. Táto funkcia zabezpečuje, že $[officename] nebude pri zapnutej funkcii "Každé prvé písmeno vety veľkým" automaticky meniť prvé písmeno slova nasledujúceho po bodke na konci skratky na veľké písmeno.
26 cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2Fabbrevlist 6e Táto tabuľka obsahuje zoznam skratiek, po ktorých nebudú automaticky opravené malé písmená na veľké.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fautocorrectdialog%2Flang 79 Vyberte jazyk, pre ktorý chcete vytvoriť alebo upraviť položky v tabuľke náhrad a výnimky pre automatické opravy.
2a cui%2Fui%2Facorexceptpage%2FAcorExceptPage 5d Určuje, ktoré skratky alebo kombinácie znakov nebude $[officename] automaticky opravovať.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fdefaultsingle 31 Nastaví znaky úvodzoviek na východzie symboly.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fenddouble d3 Vyberte špeciálny znak, ktorý automaticky nahradí aktuálne systémové znaky pravých úvodzoviek počas ich písania, alebo v celom vašom dokumente keď spustíte Formát - Automatické opravy - Použiť.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fendsingle d3 Vyberte špeciálny znak, ktorý automaticky nahradí aktuálne systémové znaky pravých úvodzoviek počas ich písania, alebo v celom vašom dokumente keď spustíte Formát - Automatické opravy - Použiť.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fstartdouble d3 Vyberte špeciálny znak, ktorý automaticky nahradí aktuálne systémové znaky ľavých úvodzoviek počas ich písania, alebo v celom vašom dokumente keď vyberiete Formát - Automatické opravy - Použiť.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fdoubledouble 31 Nastaví znaky úvodzoviek na východzie symboly.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fstartsingle d3 Vyberte špeciálny znak, ktorý automaticky nahradí aktuálne systémové znaky ľavých úvodzoviek počas ich písania, alebo v celom vašom dokumente keď vyberiete Formát - Automatické opravy - Použiť.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fdoublereplace 68 Automaticky nahrádza predvolený systémový symbol pre jednoduché úvodzovky znakom, ktorý určíte.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fsinglereplace 68 Automaticky nahrádza predvolený systémový symbol pre jednoduché úvodzovky znakom, ktorý určíte.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Fchecklist db Vyberte, či sa majú automatické náhrady používať vždy počas písania [T], alebo sa po jednorazovom spustení cez menu "Formát/Automatické opravy/Použiť" majú použiť hromadne v už existujúcom texte [M].
24 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2Flist db Vyberte, či sa majú automatické náhrady používať vždy počas písania [T], alebo sa po jednorazovom spustení cez menu "Formát/Automatické opravy/Použiť" majú použiť hromadne v už existujúcom texte [M].
32 cui%2Fui%2Fapplylocalizedpage%2FApplyLocalizedPage db Vyberte, či sa majú automatické náhrady používať vždy počas písania [T], alebo sa po jednorazovom spustení cez menu "Formát/Automatické opravy/Použiť" majú použiť hromadne v už existujúcom texte [M].
1a SW_HID_LINGU_WORD_LANGUAGE 63 Changes the language settings for the highlighted word, if the word is found in another dictionary.
1a SW_HID_LINGU_PARA_LANGUAGE 7e Changes the language setting for the paragraph that contains the highlighted word, if the word is found in another dictionary.
27 EDITENG_HID_EDITENG_SPELLER_AUTOCORRECT 9f To always replace the highlighted word, click a word in the list. The word pair is stored in the replacement table under Tools - AutoCorrect Options - Replace.
18 SW_HID_LINGU_IGNORE_WORD 46 Ignores all instances of the highlighted word in the current document.
15 SW_HID_LINGU_ADD_WORD 37 Adds the highlighted word to a user-defined dictionary.
23 EDITENG_HID_EDITENG_SPELLER_ADDWORD 37 Adds the highlighted word to a user-defined dictionary.
22 EDITENG_HID_EDITENG_SPELLER_IGNORE 46 Ignores all instances of the highlighted word in the current document.
19 SW_HID_LINGU_SPELLING_DLG 1c Opens the Spellcheck dialog.
21 EDITENG_HID_EDITENG_SPELLER_START 1c Opens the Spellcheck dialog.
15 SW_HID_LINGU_AUTOCORR 9f To always replace the highlighted word, click a word in the list. The word pair is stored in the replacement table under Tools - AutoCorrect Options - Replace.
14 SW_HID_LINGU_REPLACE 66 Click the word to replace the highlighted word. Use the AutoCorrect submenu for permanent replacement.
40 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3APB_ENTRIES 41 Removes the selected word or words from the Word Completion list.
46 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ANF_MAX_ENTRIES 55 Enter the maximum number of words that you want to store in the Word Completion list.
46 cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ANF_MIN_WORDLEN 5c Enter the minimum word length for a word to become eligible for the word completion feature.
41 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ADCB_EXPAND_KEY 4c Select the key that you want to use to accept the automatic word completion.
42 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_REMOVE_LIST f7 When enabled, the list gets cleared when closing the current document. When disabled, makes the current Word Completion list available to other documents after you close the current document. The list remains available until you exit %PRODUCTNAME.
3e cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_COLLECT 87 Adds the frequently used words to a list. To remove a word from the Word Completion list, select the word, and then click Delete Entry.
42 cui%3AMultiListBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ALB_ENTRIES ed Lists the collected words. The list is valid until you close the current document. To make the list available to other documents in the current session, disable "When closing a document, remove the words collected from it from the list".
3d cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_AS_TIP 2a Displays the completed word as a Help Tip.
43 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_APPEND_SPACE 49 If you do not add punctuation after the word, $[officename] adds a space.
3c cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_OFAPAGE_AUTOCOMPLETE_OPTIONS%3ACB_ACTIV 92 Stores frequently used words, and automatically completes a word after you type three letters that match the first three letters of a stored word.
38 SVX_PUSHBUTTON_RID_OFAPAGE_SMARTTAG_OPTIONS_PB_SMARTTAGS 78 To configure a Smart Tag, select the name of the Smart Tag, then click Properties. Not all Smart Tags can be configured.
36 SVX_CHECKBOX_RID_OFAPAGE_SMARTTAG_OPTIONS_CB_SMARTTAGS 43 Enables Smart Tags to be evaluated and shown in your text document.
20 .uno%3ABulletsAndNumberingDialog 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets.
14 .uno%3AOutlineBullet 69 Adds numbering or bullets to the current paragraph, and lets you edit format of the numbering or bullets.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fpickbulletpage%2Fvalueset 2c Click the bullet style that you want to use.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fpickbulletpage%2FPickBulletPage 38 Displays the different bullet styles that you can apply.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fpicknumberingpage%2Fvalueset 2f Click the numbering style that you want to use.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fpicknumberingpage%2FPickNumberingPage 3b Displays the different numbering styles that you can apply.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpickoutlinepage%2Fvalueset 2d Click the outline style that you want to use.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fpickoutlinepage%2FPickOutlinePage 8e Displays the different styles that you can apply to a hierarchical list. $[officename] supports up to nine outline levels in a list hierarchy.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fpickgraphicpage%2Flinkgraphics 6c If enabled, the graphics are inserted as links. If not enabled, the graphics are embedded into the document.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fpickgraphicpage%2Fvalueset 33 Click the graphics that you want to use as bullets.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fpickgraphicpage%2FPickGraphicPage 4f Displays the different graphics that you can use as bullets in a bulleted list.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Forientlb 2c Select the alignment option for the graphic.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fkeepratio 2e Maintains the size proportions of the graphic.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fheightmf 1f Enter a height for the graphic.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fwidthmf 1e Enter a width for the graphic.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fbullet 4a Opens the Special Characters dialog, where you can select a bullet symbol.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fsublevels 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fcolor 2f Select a color for the current numbering style.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fcharstyle 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fsuffix a0 Enter a character or the text to display behind the number in the list. If you want to create a numbered list that uses the style "1.)", enter ".)" in this box.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fbitmap 50 Select the graphic, or locate the graphic file that you want to use as a bullet.
28 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fprefix 4c Enter a character or the text to display in front of the number in the list.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fstartat 32 Enter a new starting number for the current level.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Fnumfmtlb 31 Select a numbering style for the selected levels.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Flevellb 47 Select the level(s) that you want to define the formatting options for.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2Frelsize 7b Enter the amount by which you want to resize the bullet character with respect to the font height of the current paragraph.
36 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingoptionspage%2FNumberingOptionsPage 47 Select the level(s) that you want to define the formatting options for.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Fstandard 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fstandard 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fnumdistmf 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Findentatmf 6f Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the numbering symbol and the left edge of the text.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2FNumberingPositionPage 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Findentmf f1 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left page margin (or the left edge of the text object) and the left edge of the numbering symbol. If the current paragraph style uses an indent, the amount you enter here is added to the indent.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Fnumdistmf 3f Resets the indent and the spacing values to the default values.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Flevellb 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Falignedatmf 5b Enter the distance from the left page margin at which the numbering symbol will be aligned.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Findentmf f1 Enter the amount of space to leave between the left page margin (or the left edge of the text object) and the left edge of the numbering symbol. If the current paragraph style uses an indent, the amount you enter here is added to the indent.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Frelative 4f Indents the current level relative to the previous level in the list hierarchy.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fnum2alignlb 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fnumalignlb 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Findentatmf 7c Enter the distance from the left page margin to the start of all lines in the numbered paragraph that follow the first line.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fatmf 6e If you select a tab stop to follow the numbering, you can enter a non-negative value as the tab stop position.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Frelative 4f Indents the current level relative to the previous level in the list hierarchy.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Flevellb 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2FOutlinePositionPage 2c Select the level(s) that you want to modify.
33 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fnumberingwidthmf 6f Enter the amount of space to leave between the left edge of the numbering symbol and the left edge of the text.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foutlinepositionpage%2Fnumalignlb 125 Set the alignment of the numbering symbols. Select "Left" to align the numbering symbol to start directly at the "Aligned at" position. Select "Right" to align the symbol to end directly before the "Aligned at" position. Select "Centered" to center the symbol around the "Aligned at" position.
32 cui%2Fui%2Fnumberingpositionpage%2Fnumfollowedbylb 53 Select the element that will follow the numbering: a tab stop, a space, or nothing.
33 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fassign 6e Opens the Customize dialog, where you can assign the selected macro to a menu command, a toolbar, or an event.
1d BASCTL_HID_BASICIDE_LIBS_TREE 56 Lists the existing macro libraries for the current application and any open documents.
39 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_CREATE 15 Creates a new script.
30 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Frun 20 Runs or saves the current macro.
37 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fnewlibrary 2a Saves the recorded macro in a new library.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_NEWLIB 19 Vytvorí novú knižnicu.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_RUN 41 To run a script, select a script in the list, and then click Run.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_DEL 2a Prompts you to delete the selected script.
2f basctl%3AEdit%3ARID_DLG_NEWLIB%3ARID_ED_LIBNAME 2b Enter a name for the new library or module.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_PASSWORD 37 Assigns or edits the password for the selected library.
37 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_EDIT 3a Opens the default script editor for your operating system.
39 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SCRIPTORGANIZER%3ASF_PB_RENAME 44 Opens a dialog where you can change the name of the selected script.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_APPEND 6c Nájdite knižnicu $[officename] Basic, ktorú chcete pridať do aktuálneho zoznamu a kliknite na Otvoriť.
2e basctl%3AListBox%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_LB_BASICS 60 Select the application or the document containing the macro libraries that you want to organize.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_DLGS%3ARID_PB_NEWDLG 2a Opens the editor and creates a new dialog.
3a modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fmacronameedit 67 Displays the name of the selected macro. To create or to change the name of a macro, enter a name here.
31 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fedit 59 Starts the $[officename] Basic editor and opens the selected macro or dialog for editing.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_MODULS%3ARID_PB_NEWDLG 2a Opens the editor and creates a new dialog.
20 BASCTL_HID_BASICIDE_MODULES_TREE 27 Vypíše existujúce makrá a dialógy.
2f basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_DLGS%3ARID_PB_EDIT 59 Starts the $[officename] Basic editor and opens the selected macro or dialog for editing.
35 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Forganize 89 Otvorí dialóg Správca makier, v ktorom je možné pridať, upraviť alebo zmazať existujúce moduly makier, dialógy alebo knižnice.
33 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_MODULS%3ARID_PB_NEWMOD 2a Opens the editor and creates a new module.
36 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fnewmodule 29 Saves the recorded macro in a new module.
33 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fdelete 33 Creates a new macro, or deletes the selected macro.
36 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Flibraries b2 Vypíše knižnice a moduly v ktorých je možné otvárať a ukladať vaše makrá. Pre uloženie modulu s konkrétnym dokumentom otvorte dokument a potom otvorte tento dialóg.
12 CUI_HID_SCRIPTSBOX 83 Select a macro or script from "user", "share", or an open document. To view the available macros or scripts, double-click an entry.
31 basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_MODULS%3ARID_PB_EDIT 32 Otvorí označené makro alebo dialóg na úpravu.
33 modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2Fmacros 52 Lists the macros that are contained in the module selected in the Macro from list.
3d modules%2FBasicIDE%2Fui%2Fbasicmacrodialog%2FBasicMacroDialog 22 Opens a dialog to organize macros.
2f basctl%3APushButton%3ARID_TP_LIBS%3ARID_PB_EDIT 54 Otvorí editor $[officename] Basic, v ktorom je možné upraviť vybranú knižnicu.
12 .uno%3AMacroDialog 22 Opens a dialog to organize macros.
27 .uno%3AMacroOrganizer%3FTabId%3Ashort=1 32 Opens the Dialogs tab page of the Macro Organizer.
15 .uno%3AMacroSignature 6e Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your macros. You can also use the dialog to view certificates.
f .uno%3ARunMacro 2b Opens a dialog where you can start a macro.
14 .uno%3AStopRecording 18 Stops recording a macro.
14 .uno%3AMacroRecorder 14 Records a new macro.
24 svx%2Fui%2Fpasswd%2FconfirmpassEntry 32 Reenter the new password for the selected library.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fpasswd%2FnewpassEntry 2b Zadajte nové heslo pre vybranú knižnicu.
20 svx%2Fui%2Fpasswd%2FoldpassEntry 2c Zadajte staré heslo pre vybranú knižnicu.
22 svx%2Fui%2Fpasswd%2FPasswordDialog 22 Chráni vybranú knižnicu heslom.
44 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer%3FScriptOrganizer.Language%3Astring=BeanShell 2e Opens a dialog where you can organize scripts.
45 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer%3FScriptOrganizer.Language%3Astring=JavaScript 2e Opens a dialog where you can organize scripts.
16 .uno%3AScriptOrganizer 50 Opens a submenu with links to dialogs where you can organize macros and scripts.
2d basctl%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_LIBS%3ARID_CB_REF 73 Pridá vybranú knižnicu ako súbor len na čítanie. Knižnica je načítaná pri každom spustení %PRODUCTNAME.
2e basctl%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_LIBS%3ARID_CB_REPL 47 Nahradí knižnicu, ktorá má rovnaký názov ako aktuálna knižnica.
20 BASCTL_HID_BASICIDE_LIBSDLG_TREE 6d Enter a name or the path to the library that you want to append. You can also select a library from the list.
12 .uno%3ALoadToolBox 59 Customizes $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events.
16 .uno%3AConfigureDialog 59 Customizes $[officename] menus, shortcut keys, toolbars, and macro assignments to events.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fmacroselectordialog%2Fcommands 5e Select any command, then click Add or drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog box.
37 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_ADD_COMMANDS 7d Opens the Add Commands dialog. Select any command, then click Add or drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog box.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fmacroselectordialog%2Fcategories 5e Select any command, then click Add or drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog box.
35 cui%3AImageButton%3AMD_MENU_ORGANISER%3ABTN_MENU_DOWN 2a Moves the selected item down one position.
37 cui%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_CHANGE_ENTRY 2f Opens a menu that contains additional commands.
33 cui%3AImageButton%3AMD_MENU_ORGANISER%3ABTN_MENU_UP 28 Moves the selected item up one position.
31 cui%3AMenuButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_CHANGE 29 Opens a submenu with additional commands.
2e cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_NEW 71 Opens the New Menu dialog where you can enter the name of a new menu as well as select the location for the menu.
2d cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ALB_SAVEIN 47 Select the application or open document where you want to add the menu.
2c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ALB_MENUS 32 Select the menu and submenu that you want to edit.
2f cui%3AEdit%3AMD_MENU_ORGANISER%3AEDIT_MENU_NAME 76 Enter a name for the menu. To specify a letter in the name as an accelerator key, enter a tilde (~) before the letter.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fmovemenu%2FMoveMenuDialog 6e Moves the selected menu entry up one position or down one position in the menu when you click an arrow button.
33 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_RESET 32 Resets modified values back to the default values.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_LOAD 4b Replaces the shortcut key configuration with one that was previously saved.
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_SAVE 4c Saves the current shortcut key configuration, so that you can load it later.
38 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_ACC_CHANGE 6c Assigns the key combination selected in the Shortcut keys list to the command selected in the Function list.
38 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ABTN_ACC_REMOVE 48 Deletes the selected element or elements without requiring confirmation.
22 CUI_HID_CONFIGFUNCTION_ACC_LISTBOX dd Select a function that you want to assign a shortcut key to, click a key combination in the Shortcut keys list, and then click Modify. If the selected function already has a shortcut key, it is displayed in the Keys list.
1f CUI_HID_CONFIGGROUP_ACC_LISTBOX 63 Lists the available function categories. To assign shortcuts to Styles, open the "Styles" category.
1b CUI_HID_ACCELCONFIG_LISTBOX be Lists the shortcut keys and the associated commands. To assign or modify the shortcut key for the command selected in the Function list, click a shortcut in this list, and then click Modify.
34 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ARB_MODULE 41 Displays shortcut keys for the current $[officename] application.
34 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_KEYBOARD%3ARB_OFFICE 49 Displays shortcut keys that are common to all $[officename] applications.
14 CUI_HID_CONFIG_ACCEL 5d Assigns or edits the shortcut keys for $[officename] commands, or $[officename] Basic macros.
13 CUI_HID_SVX_SAVE_IN 49 Select the location where to load the configuration and where to save it.
1c CUI_HID_SVX_NEW_TOOLBAR_ITEM 79 Opens the Add Commands dialog. Select any command, then click Add or drag-and-drop the command into the Customize dialog.
30 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_DOWN 2f Upraví možnosti zvolenej Automatickej opravy.
2e cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MENUS%3ABTN_UP 2f Upraví možnosti zvolenej Automatickej opravy.
1a CUI_HID_SVX_MODIFY_TOOLBAR 22 The Toolbar button opens a submenu
1f CUI_HID_SVX_MODIFY_TOOLBAR_ITEM 21 The Modify button opens a submenu
17 CUI_HID_SVX_NEW_TOOLBAR 6c Opens the Name dialog, where you enter the name of a new toolbar and select the location of the new toolbar.
2f cui%3APushButton%3AMD_ICONSELECTOR%3ABTN_DELETE 58 Click to remove the selected icon from the list. Only user-defined icons can be removed.
2f cui%3APushButton%3AMD_ICONSELECTOR%3ABTN_IMPORT 99 Adds new icons to the list of icons. You see a file open dialog that imports the selected icon or icons into the internal icon directory of %PRODUCTNAME.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_EVENTS%3APB_ASSIGN 41 Opens the Macro Selector to assign a macro to the selected event.
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_EVENTS%3APB_DELETE 34 Deletes the macro assignment for the selected event.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MACROASSIGN%3APB_ASSIGN 41 Opens the Macro Selector to assign a macro to the selected event.
1a CUI_HID_SVX_MACRO_LB_EVENT b1 The big list box lists the events and the assigned macros. After you selected the location in the Save In list box, select an event in the big list box. Then click Assign Macro.
2e cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_EVENTS%3ALB_SAVEIN 59 Select first where to save the event binding, in the current document or in %PRODUCTNAME.
36 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_MACROASSIGN%3APB_DELETE 34 Deletes the macro assignment for the selected event.
12 .uno%3ATableEvents 90 Nastaví možnosti pre automatické nahrádzanie textu počas písania alebo pre hromadné použitie automatických opráv v existujúcom texte.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fclose 12 Closes the dialog.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fopen 4d Displays an Open dialog to open a filter from an XSLT filter package (*.jar).
28 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fdelete 44 Deletes the selected file after you confirm the dialog that follows.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Ftest 32 Opens a dialog with the name of the selected file.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fedit 32 Opens a dialog with the name of the selected file.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fsave 56 Displays a Save as dialog to save the selected file as an XSLT filter package (*.jar).
31 filter%2Fui%2Fxsltfilterdialog%2FXSLTFilterDialog 2d Opens a dialog with the name of a new filter.
25 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fnew 2d Opens a dialog with the name of a new filter.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Ffilterlist 3a Select one or more filters, then click one of the buttons.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2FXMLFilterSettingsDialog 7d Opens the XML Filter Settings dialog, where you can create, edit, delete, and test filters to import and to export XML files.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltersettings%2Fhelp 27 Displays the help page for this dialog.
1c .uno%3AOpenXMLFilterSettings 7d Opens the XML Filter Settings dialog, where you can create, edit, delete, and test filters to import and to export XML files.
33 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Fdescription 1b Enter a comment (optional).
35 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Finterfacename 4d Enter the name that you want to display in the File type box in file dialogs.
31 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Fextension 99 Enter the file extension to use when you open a file without specifying a filter. $[officename] uses the file extension to determine which filter to use.
32 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Ffiltername 5a Enter the name that you want to display in the list box of the XML Filter Settings dialog.
33 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2Fapplication 3c Select the application that you want to use with the filter.
3f filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagegeneral%2FXmlFilterTabPageGeneral 34 Enter or edit general information for an XML filter.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fxsltimport 6b If this is an import filter, enter the file name of the XSLT stylesheet that you want to use for importing.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Ftempimport 7b Enter the name of the template that you want to use for importing. In the template, styles are defined to display XML tags.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fxsltexport 6b If this is an export filter, enter the file name of the XSLT stylesheet that you want to use for exporting.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fbrowsetemp 1e Opens a file selection dialog.
3b filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fbrowseimport 1e Opens a file selection dialog.
3b filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fbrowseexport 1e Opens a file selection dialog.
32 filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2Fdoc 22 Enter the DOCTYPE of the XML file.
4d filter%2Fui%2Fxmlfiltertabpagetransformation%2FXmlFilterTabPageTransformation 31 Enter or edit file information for an XML filter.
28 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_RECENT 3c Re-opens the document that was last opened with this dialog.
28 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_BROWSE 5f Opens a file selection dialog. The selected file is opened using the current XML import filter.
2b FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_XSLT_FILE 5a Displays the file name of the XSLT filter that you entered on the Transformation tab page.
30 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_DISPLAY_SOURCE 59 Opens the XML source of the selected document in your default XML editor after importing.
2f FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_TEMPLATE_FILE 57 Displays the file name of the template that you entered on the Transformation tab page.
29 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_CURRENT d9 The front-most open file that matches the XML filter criteria will be used to test the filter. The current XML export filter transforms the file and the resulting XML code is displayed in the XML Filter output window.
2d FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_IMPORT_RECENT_FILE 3c Re-opens the document that was last opened with this dialog.
28 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_BROWSE a0 Locate the file that you want to apply the XML export filter to. The XML code of the transformed file is opened in your default XML editor after transformation.
2b FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_EXPORT_XSLT_FILE 5a Displays the file name of the XSLT filter that you entered on the Transformation tab page.
23 FILTER_HID_XML_SOURCE_FILE_VALIDATE 27 Validuje obsah okna Výstup XML Filtra.
23 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_OUTPUT_WINDOW 28 Lists the test results of an XML filter.
29 FILTER_HID_XML_FILTER_TEST_VALIDATE_OUPUT 28 Lists the test results of an XML filter.
20 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_OPTIONS 26 Opens the Hangul/Hanja Options dialog.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANJA_HANGUL_ABOVE 44 The Hangul part will be displayed as ruby text above the Hanja part.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANJA_HANGUL_BELOW 44 The Hangul part will be displayed as ruby text below the Hanja part.
18 CUI_HID_SPELLDLG_SETWORD 1f Displays the current selection.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANGUL_HANJA_BELOW 44 The Hanja part will be displayed as ruby text below the Hangul part.
1e CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CLOSE 12 Closes the dialog.
39 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ACB_HANJA_ONLY 33 Check to convert only Hanja. Do not convert Hangul.
3a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ACB_HANGUL_ONLY 33 Check to convert only Hangul. Do not convert Hanja.
22 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_SUGGESTIONS_LIST 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANGUL_HANJA_ABOVE 44 The Hanja part will be displayed as ruby text above the Hangul part.
22 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CHANGEALL aa Replaces the selection with the suggested characters or word according to the format options. Every time the same selection is detected it will be replaced automatically.
48 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANGUL_HANJA_BRACKETED 43 The Hanja part will be displayed in brackets after the Hangul part.
43 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ACB_REPLACE_BY_CHARACTER 68 Check to move character-by-character through the selected text. If not checked, full words are replaced.
1f CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_CHANGE 5d Replaces the selection with the suggested characters or word according to the format options.
43 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_SIMPLE_CONVERSION 41 The original characters are replaced by the suggested characters.
48 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3ARB_HANJA_HANGUL_BRACKETED 43 The Hangul part will be displayed in brackets after the Hanja part.
22 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_SUGGESTIONS_GRID 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary.
1d CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_SUGGESTIONS 36 Displays all available replacements in the dictionary.
35 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA%3APB_FIND 57 Finds your Hangul input in the dictionary and replaces it with the corresponding Hanja.
22 CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_IGNOREALL 81 No changes will be made to the current selection, and every time the same selection is detected it will be skipped automatically.
1f CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_BUTTON_IGNORE 6d No changes will be made to the current selection. The next word or character will be selected for conversion.
1e CUI_HID_HANGULDLG_EDIT_NEWWORD 3e Displays the first replacement suggestion from the dictionary.
1c .uno%3AHangulHanjaConversion 4f Converts the selected Korean text from Hangul to Hanja or from Hanja to Hangul.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3ACB_AUTOREPLACEUNIQUE 4b Automatically replaces words that only have one suggested word replacement.
44 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3ACB_SHOWRECENTLYFIRST 60 Shows the replacement suggestion that you selected the last time as the first entry on the list.
3d cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3ACB_IGNOREPOST 56 Ignores positional characters at the end of Korean words when you search a dictionary.
3f cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3APB_HHO_DELETE 2d Deletes the selected user-defined dictionary.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3APB_HHO_EDIT 57 Opens the Edit Custom Dictionary dialog where you can edit any user-defined dictionary.
3b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_NEWDICT%3AED_DICTNAME 20 Enter a name for the dictionary.
3c cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_OPT%3APB_HHO_NEW 4b Opens the New dictionary dialog box, where you can create a new dictionary.
20 CUI_HID_HANGULHANJA_OPT_DICTS_LB ae Lists all user-defined dictionaries. Select the check box next to the dictionary that you want to use. Clear the check box next to the dictionary that you do not want to use.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3AED_4 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3AED_3 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
3d cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3APB_HHE_NEW 3a Adds the current replacement definition to the dictionary.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3AED_2 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
40 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3APB_HHE_DELETE 1b Deletes the selected entry.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3AED_1 95 Type a suggested replacement for the entry that is selected in the Original text box. The replacement word can contain a maximum of eight characters.
3c cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3ALB_ORIGINAL 79 Select the entry in the current dictionary that you want to edit. If you want, you can also type a new entry in this box.
37 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_HANGULHANJA_EDIT%3ALB_BOOK 39 Select the user-defined dictionary that you want to edit.
12 .uno%3ASpellDialog 19 Checks spelling manually.
10 .uno%3ANewWindow 44 Opens a new window that displays the contents of the current window.
33 padmin%3APushButton%3ARID_PADIALOG%3ARID_PA_BTN_DEL 2a Removes the selected source from the list.
33 padmin%3APushButton%3ARID_PADIALOG%3ARID_PA_BTN_STD 24 Opens the Select Certificate dialog.
3e xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECDLG_DIGSIG%3ABTN_VIEWCERT 22 Opens the View Certificate dialog.
29 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_SIGNATURESDLG 36 Lists the digital signatures for the current document.
31 sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_DOCINFODOC%3ABTN_SIGNATURE 70 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialog to view certificates.
10 .uno%3ASignature 70 Adds and removes digital signatures to and from your document. You can also use the dialog to view certificates.
38 desktop%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE_ALL 8c By default, only the downloadable extensions are shown in the dialog. Mark Show all Updates to see also other extensions and error messages.
39 desktop%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE_OK 54 When you click the Install button the Download and Installation dialog is displayed.
46 desktop%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE%3ARID_DLG_UPDATE_DESCRIPTIONS 95 While checking for updates, you see a progress indicator. Wait for some messages to show up in the dialog, or click Cancel to abort the update check.
28 DESKTOP_HID_DEPLOYMENT_GUI_UPDATEINSTALL ec Click the Check for Updates button in the Extension Manager to check for online updates for all installed extensions. To check for online updates for only the selected extension, right-click to open the context menu, then choose Update.
21 DESKTOP_HID_DEPLOYMENT_GUI_UPDATE ec Click the Check for Updates button in the Extension Manager to check for online updates for all installed extensions. To check for online updates for only the selected extension, right-click to open the context menu, then choose Update.
10 .uno%3AInsertRLM 92 Inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
10 .uno%3AInsertLRM 92 Inserts a text direction mark that affects the text direction of any text following the mark. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
13 .uno%3AInsertZWNBSP 94 Inserts an invisible space within a word that will keep the word together at the end of a line. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
11 .uno%3AInsertZWSP a9 Inserts an invisible space within a word that will insert a line break once it becomes the last character in a line. Available when complex text layout (CTL) is enabled.
17 .uno%3AInsertSoftHyphen 80 Inserts an invisible hyphen within a word that will appear and create a line break once it becomes the last character in a line.
17 .uno%3AInsertHardHyphen 4d Inserts a hyphen that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks.
1d .uno%3AInsertNonBreakingSpace 4c Inserts a space that will keep bordering characters together on line breaks.
19 .uno%3AFormattingMarkMenu 51 Opens a submenu to insert special formatting marks. Enable CTL for more commands.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_NEWTHEME 56 Adds a new theme to the Gallery and lets you choose the files to include in the theme.
16 SVX_HID_GALLERY_WINDOW 52 To insert a Gallery object, select the object, and then drag it into the document.
19 SVX_HID_GALLERY_THEMELIST 3c Click a theme to view the objects associated with the theme.
e .uno%3AGallery 59 Opens the Gallery, where you can select graphics and sounds to insert into your document.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_LISTVIEW 55 Displays the contents of the Gallery as small icons, with title and path information.
18 SVX_HID_GALLERY_ICONVIEW 2e Displays the contents of the Gallery as icons.
40 cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ACBX_PREVIEW 31 Displays or hides a preview of the selected file.
42 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ABTN_TAKEALL 37 Adds all of the files in the list to the current theme.
3f cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ABTN_TAKE 2f Adds the selected file(s) to the current theme.
41 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ABTN_SEARCH 52 Locate the directory containing the files that you want to add, and then click OK.
42 cui%3AMultiListBox%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ALBX_FOUND 8b Lists the available files. Select the file(s) that you want to add, and then click Add. To add all of the files in the list, click Add All.
41 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXTABPAGE_GALLERYTHEME_FILES%3ACBB_FILETYPE 2d Select the type of file that you want to add.
f .uno%3AGridMenu 26 Sets the display properties of a grid.
14 .uno%3ASnapLinesMenu 3a Špecifikuje možnosti na zobrazovanie záchytných čiar.
14 .uno%3AAVMediaPlayer 82 Opens the Media Player window where you can preview movie and sound files as well as insert these files into the current document.
14 .uno%3AInsertAVMedia 31 Inserts a video or sound file into your document.
36 desktop%3ACheckBox%3ATP_UPDATE_CHECK%3ACB_UPDATE_CHECK 34 You can check for updates manually or automatically.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fchangepath 2f Click to select a folder to download the files.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fautodownload 90 Mark to enable the automatic check for updates. Choose %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update in the Options dialog box to disable or enable this feature.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_CANCEL 3b Aborts the download and deletes the partly downloaded file.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_RESUME 1c Continues a paused download.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_PAUSE 40 Pauses the download. Later click Resume to continue downloading.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_INSTALL 1f Installs the downloaded update.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DOWNLOAD 9c Downloads and saves the update files to the desktop or a folder of your choice. Select the folder in %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update in the Options dialog box.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DOWNLOAD2 9c Downloads and saves the update files to the desktop or a folder of your choice. Select the folder in %PRODUCTNAME - Online Update in the Options dialog box.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_CHECK_FOR_UPD_DLG f2 Checks for available updates to your version of %PRODUCTNAME. If a newer version is available, you can choose to download the update. After downloading, if you have write permissions for the installation directory, you can install the update.
21 SFX2_HID_DLG_CHECKFORONLINEUPDATE f2 Checks for available updates to your version of %PRODUCTNAME. If a newer version is available, you can choose to download the update. After downloading, if you have write permissions for the installation directory, you can install the update.
2d DESKTOP_HID_EXTENSION_MANAGER_LISTBOX_DISABLE 20 Enable or disable the extension.
2c DESKTOP_HID_EXTENSION_MANAGER_LISTBOX_REMOVE 44 Select the extension that you want to remove, and then click Remove.
2d DESKTOP_HID_EXTENSION_MANAGER_LISTBOX_OPTIONS 57 Select an installed extension, then click to open the Options dialog for the extension.
38 desktop%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_LICENSE%3APB_LICENSE_DOWN 87 Read the license. Click the Scroll Down button to scroll down if necessary. Click Accept to continue the installation of the extension.
36 desktop%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_DLG_LICENSE%3AML_LICENSE 87 Read the license. Click the Scroll Down button to scroll down if necessary. Click Accept to continue the installation of the extension.
2c desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2Fextensions 7b Select the extension that you want to remove, enable, or disable. For some extensions, you can also open an Options dialog.
39 service%3Acom.sun.star.deployment.ui.PackageManagerDialog 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions.
38 desktop%2Fui%2Fextensionmanager%2FExtensionManagerDialog 5c The Extension Manager adds, removes, disables, enables, and updates %PRODUCTNAME extensions.
36 uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_PASSWORD_CRT%3AED_PASSWORD_REPEAT 16 Re-enter the password.
11 SC_HID_PASSWD_DOC 16 Re-enter the password.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fconfirm2ed 16 Re-enter the password.
24 HID_DLG_PASSWORD_TO_OPEN_MODIFY_MORE 33 Po kliknutí prejdete na danú stránku sprievodcu.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fconfirm1ed 16 Re-enter the password.
33 uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_PASSWORD_CRT%3AED_PASSWORD_CRT 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
2b uui%3AEdit%3ADLG_UUI_PASSWORD%3AED_PASSWORD 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
1d sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fpass2ed 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
1d sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fpass1ed 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
13 SC_HID_PASSWD_TABLE 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2FPasswordDialog 2e Type a password. A password is case sensitive.
2a filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fenablea11y 35 Select to enable text access for accessibility tools.
2a filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangeform 29 Only filling in form fields is permitted.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangeinsdel 3a Only inserting, deleting, and rotating pages is permitted.
2a filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangenone 28 No changes of the content are permitted.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fprinthigh 2f The document can be printed in high resolution.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fprintnone 27 Printing the document is not permitted.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fopeninternet 94 Cross-document links are opened with the Internet browser. The Internet browser must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fopenpdf c2 Cross-document links are opened with the PDF reader application that currently shows the document. The PDF reader application must be able to handle the specified file type inside the hyperlink.
20 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fpage 41 Select to show the given page when the reader opens the PDF file.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fexporturl 82 Enable this checkbox to export URLs to other documents as relative URLs in the file system. See "relative hyperlinks" in the Help.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fexport 141 The bookmarks (targets of references) in PDF files can be defined as rectangular areas. Additionally, bookmarks to named objects can be defined by their names. Enable the checkbox to export the names of objects in your document as valid bookmark targets. This allows to link to those objects by name from other documents.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fpageonly 40 Select to generate a PDF file that shows only the page contents.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Feffects 4d Selects to export Impress slide transition effects to respective PDF effects.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fdisplay 5e Select to generate a PDF file that is shown with the document title in the reader's title bar.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fcenter 52 Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a reader window centered on screen.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fresize 5a Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a window displaying the whole initial page.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fconvert d2 Enable this checkbox to convert the URLs referencing other ODF files to PDF files with the same name. In the referencing URLs the extensions .odt, .odp, .ods, .odg, and .odm are converted to the extension .pdf.
39 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2FPdfUserInterfacePage 5a Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a window displaying the whole initial page.
34 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fvisiblebookmark 5d Select to show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fdefaultlayout 6a Select to generate a PDF file that shows the pages according to the layout setting of the reader software.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fprintlow 65 The document can only be printed in low resolution (150 dpi). Not all PDF readers honor this setting.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitzoom 3e Select a given zoom factor when the reader opens the PDF file.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitwidth 61 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit the width of the reader's window.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fquality 2d Enter the quality level for JPEG compression.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fjpegcompress ca Selects a JPEG compression of images. With a high quality level, almost all pixels are preserved. With a low quality level, some pixels get lost and artefacts are introduced, but file sizes are reduced.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitwin 62 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page zoomed to fit entirely into the reader's window.
31 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fvisiblelevel 5d Select to show bookmark levels down to the selected level when the reader opens the PDF file.
31 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fallbookmarks 46 Select to show all bookmark levels when the reader opens the PDF file.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fopen 69 Select to generate a PDF file that is shown in a full screen reader window in front of all other windows.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitdefault b7 Select to generate a PDF file that shows the page contents without zooming. If the reader software is configured to use a zoom factor by default, the page shows with that zoom factor.
26 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fcontlayout 4f Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages in a continuous vertical column.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fthumbs 54 Select to generate a PDF file that shows a thumbnails palette and the page contents.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2FPdfViewPage 40 Select to generate a PDF file that shows only the page contents.
2f filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Flosslesscompress 43 Selects a lossless compression of images. All pixels are preserved.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fpdfa ea Converts to the PDF/A-1a format. This is defined as an electronic document file format for long term preservation. All fonts that were used in the source document will be embedded into the generated PDF file. PDF tags will be written.
23 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Foutline 53 Select to generate a PDF file that shows a bookmarks palette and the page contents.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Ftoolbar 40 Select to hide the reader's toolbar when the document is active.
2a filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fenablecopy 35 Select to enable copying of content to the clipboard.
20 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fzoom 3e Select a given zoom factor when the reader opens the PDF file.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Femptypages 190 If switched on, automatically inserted blank pages are being exported to pdf file. This is best if you are printing the pdf file double-sided. Example: In a book a chapter paragraph style is set to always start with an odd numbered page. The previous chapter ends on an odd page. %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to export that even numbered page or not.
2d filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2FPdfGeneralPage 5c Exports all defined print ranges. If no print range is defined, exports the entire document.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffirstonleft 101 Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the left. You must enable support for complex text layout on Language settings - Languages in the Options dialog box.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Frange 26 Exports the pages you type in the box.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fforms 6e Zvoľte pre vytvorenie PDF formulára. Tento môže byt vyplnený a vytlačený používateľom PDF dokumentu.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2FPdfLinksPage 141 The bookmarks (targets of references) in PDF files can be defined as rectangular areas. Additionally, bookmarks to named objects can be defined by their names. Enable the checkbox to export the names of objects in your document as valid bookmark targets. This allows to link to those objects by name from other documents.
2f filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Freduceresolution 51 Selects to resample or down-size the images to a lower number of pixels per inch.
27 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fcomments 45 Selects to export comments of Writer and Calc documents as PDF notes.
25 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Ftagged 58 Zapíše do PDF súboru PDF tagy. Toto môže značne zväčšiť veľkosť PDF súboru.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fallowdups 98 Allows to use the same field name for multiple fields in the generated PDF file. If disabled, field names will be exported using generated unique names.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fcontfacinglayout 96 Select to generate a PDF file that shows pages side by side in a continuous column. For more than two pages, the first page is displayed on the right.
2d filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangecomment 38 Only commenting and filling in form fields is permitted.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fsetpassword 57 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno pracovníkov.
2f filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2FPdfSecurityPage 57 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno pracovníkov.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fembed 68 This setting enables you to export the document as a .pdf file containing two file formats: PDF and ODF.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Ffitvis 7a Select to generate a PDF file that shows the text and graphics on the page zoomed to fit the width of the reader's window.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fbookmarks f0 Selects to export bookmarks of Writer documents as PDF bookmarks. Bookmarks are created for all outline paragraphs (Tools - Outline Numbering) and for all table of contents entries for which you did assign hyperlinks in the source document.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fresolution 2c Select the target resolution for the images.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdflinkspage%2Fdefault 6c Links from your PDF document to other documents will be handled as it is specified in your operating system.
2b filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fwindow 41 Select to hide the reader's controls when the document is active.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fselection 1e Exports the current selection.
25 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fformat 36 Vyberte formát odosielania formulárov z PDF súboru.
28 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfviewpage%2Fsinglelayout 3c Select to generate a PDF file that shows one page at a time.
24 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fpages 26 Exports the pages you type in the box.
29 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfsecuritypage%2Fchangeany 33 All changes are permitted, except extracting pages.
22 filter%2Fui%2Fpdfgeneralpage%2Fall 5c Exports all defined print ranges. If no print range is defined, exports the entire document.
2c filter%2Fui%2Fpdfuserinterfacepage%2Fmenubar 41 Select to hide the reader's menu bar when the document is active.
12 .uno%3AExportToPDF 45 Saves the current file to Portable Document Format (PDF) version 1.4.
17 .uno%3ASendMailDocAsPDF a6 Shows the Export as PDF dialog, exports the current document to Portable Document Format (PDF), and then opens an e-mail sending window with the PDF as an attachment.
1b UUI_HID_XMLSECDLG_MACROWARN 6a Enable or disable the macros. Choose %PRODUCTNAME - Security in the Options dialog box to set the options.
23 SFX2_HID_WARNING_SECURITY_HYPERLINK 6a Enable or disable the macros. Choose %PRODUCTNAME - Security in the Options dialog box to set the options.
43 xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECDLG_CERTCHOOSER%3ABTN_VIEWCERT 51 Opens the View Certificate dialog where you can examine the selected certificate.
3f xmlsecurity%3APushButton%3ARID_XMLSECTP_CERTPATH%3ABTN_VIEWCERT 51 Opens the View Certificate dialog where you can examine the selected certificate.
2c XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_CHOOSESIGNATURES 51 Select the certificate that you want to digitally sign the current document with.
e .uno%3AWebHtml 95 Creates a temporary copy of the current document in HTML format, opens the system default Web browser, and displays the HTML file in the Web browser.
20 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_EDIT 56 Opens a dialog to edit the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding).
29 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD_ATTRIBUTE 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
20 SVX_HID_XFORMS_INSTANCES_MENUBTN 3a This button has submenus to add, edit or remove instances.
22 SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_INSTANCES_REMOVE 42 Deletes the current instance. You cannot delete the last instance.
20 SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_INSTANCES_EDIT 39 Opens a dialog where you can modify the current instance.
22 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_REMOVE 47 Deletes the selected item (element, attribute, submission, or binding).
1f SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_INSTANCES_ADD 30 Opens a dialog where you can add a new instance.
1a SVX_HID_XFORMS_TAB_CONTROL 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
1f SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
27 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX_ITEM_ADD_ELEMENT 70 Opens a dialog to add a new item (element, attribute, submission, or binding) as a sub-item of the current item.
19 SVX_HID_XFORMS_ITEMS_LIST 34 Lists the items that belong to the current instance.
1d SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_MODELS_EDIT 21 Renames the selected Xform model.
18 .uno%3AShowDataNavigator 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
16 SVX_HID_XFORMS_TOOLBOX 3c Specifies the data structure of the current XForms document.
3c svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_MODEL%3ACB_MODIFIES_DOCUMENT d4 When enabled, the document status will be set to "modified" when you change any form control that is bound to any data in the model. When not enabled, such a change does not set the document status to "modified".
1c SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_MODELS_ADD 3c Opens the Add Model dialog where you can add an XForm model.
30 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_MODEL%3AED_INST_NAME 18 Vyberte formát súboru.
1d SVX_HID_XFORMS_MODELS_MENUBTN 29 Adds, renames, and removes XForms models.
1e SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_SHOW_DETAILS 2d Switches the display to show or hide details.
1a SVX_HID_XFORMS_MODELS_LIST 2e Selects the XForms model that you want to use.
1f SVX_HID_MN_XFORMS_MODELS_REMOVE 43 Deletes the selected XForm model. You cannot delete the last model.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CALCULATION 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
37 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_CALCULATE 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
3a svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3APB_CONSTRAINT 1f Declares the item as read-only.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_READONLY 1f Declares the item as read-only.
38 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_CONSTRAINT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
38 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3APB_RELEVANT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
38 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3APB_READONLY 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CONSTRAINT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_RELEVANT 1e Declares the item as relevant.
38 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3APB_REQUIRED 1e Declares the item as relevant.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_REQUIRED 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_READONLY 1f Declares the item as read-only.
36 svx%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ACB_REQUIRED 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
35 svx%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3ALB_DATATYPE 2b Select the data type for the selected item.
31 svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3AED_DEFAULT 2c Enter a default value for the selected item.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_RELEVANT 1e Declares the item as relevant.
2e svx%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_DATAITEM%3AED_NAME 1b Enter the name of the item.
40 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_CONDITION%3APB_EDIT_NAMESPACES 4f Opens the Form Namespaces dialog where you can add, edit, or delete namespaces.
3d svx%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_SVXDLG_ADD_CONDITION%3AED_CONDITION 12 Enter a condition.
42 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_NAMESPACE_ITEM%3APB_DELETE_NAMESPACE 1f Deletes the selected namespace.
3f svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_NAMESPACE_ITEM%3APB_ADD_NAMESPACE 21 Adds a new namespace to the list.
40 svx%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_NAMESPACE_ITEM%3APB_EDIT_NAMESPACE 1d Edits the selected namespace.
21 SVX_HID_XFORMS_NAMESPACEITEM_LIST 34 Lists the currently defined namespaces for the form.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_LENGTH 38 Specifies the maximum number of characters for a string.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_LENGTH 30 Specifies the number of characters for a string.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MIN_INCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an inclusive lower bound for values.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_TOTAL_DIGITS 5b Specifies the maximum total number of digits that values of the decimal data type can have.
21 EXTENSIONS_UID_PROP_ADD_DATA_TYPE ac Click the button to open a dialog where you can enter the name of a new user-defined data type. The new data type inherits all facets from the currently selected data type.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_REQUIRED 34 Specifies if the item must be included on the XForm.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_PATTERN 125 Specifies a regular expression pattern. Strings validated against the data type must conform to this pattern to be valid. The XSD data type syntax for regular expressions is different from the regular expression syntax used elseswhere in %PRODUCTNAME, for example in the Find & Replace dialog.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_DATA_TYPE 41 Select a data type which the control should be validated against.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BIND_EXPRESSION 71 Enter the DOM node to bind the control model to. Click the ... button for a dialog to enter the XPath expression.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CALCULATION 25 Declares that the item is calculated.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_CONSTRAINT 22 Declares the item as a constraint.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_EXCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an exclusive upper bound for values.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_WHITESPACES f3 Specifies how whitespaces are to be handled when a string of the current data type is being processed. Possible values are Preserve, Replace, and Collapse. The semantics follow the definition at http://www.w3.org/TR/xmlschema-2/#rf-whiteSpace.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_READONLY 1f Declares the item as read-only.
27 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_FRACTION_DIGITS 66 Specifies the maximum total number of fractional digits that values of the decimal data type can have.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_RELEVANT 1e Declares the item as relevant.
24 EXTENSIONS_UID_PROP_REMOVE_DATA_TYPE 5a Select a user-defined data type and click the button to delete the user-defined data type.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BINDING_NAME d1 Select or enter the name of a binding. Selecting the name of an existing binding associates the binding with the form control. Entering a new name creates a new binding and associates it with the form control.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MAX_INCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an inclusive upper bound for values.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XSD_MIN_EXCLUSIVE 2e Specifies an exclusive lower bound for values.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_XML_DATA_MODEL 43 Select a model from the list of all models in the current document.
13 .uno%3APrintDefault 68 Ak chcete vytlačiť dokument s aktuálnymi nastaveniami tlače, kliknite na ikonu  Tlač súboru priamo
16 .uno%3AVerticalCaption 1ab Draws a line that ends in a rectangular callout with vertical text direction from where you drag in the current document. Drag a handle of the callout to resize the callout. To add text, click the edge of the callout, and then type or paste your text. To change a rectangular callout to a rounded callout, drag the largest corner handle when the pointer changes to a hand. Only available when Asian language support is enabled.
13 .uno%3AVerticalText f6 Nakreslí textové pole so zvislou orientáciou textu. Kliknite do dokumentu a potom napíšte alebo vložte text. Tiež je možné natiahnuť textové pole do požadovanej veľkosti. Je k dispozícii len pri zapnutej podpore ázijských jazykov.
f .uno%3ADrawText b5 Nakreslí textové pole s vodorovnou orientáciou textu. Natiahnite pole do veľkosti, akú potrebujete, a potom napíšte alebo vložte text. Ak chcete otočiť text, otočte pole.
a .uno%3APie 1b8 Nakreslí vyplnený tvar, ktorý je definovaný oblúkom oválu a dvomi úsečkami polomeru zo stredu. Keď chcete nakresliť oblúk elipsy, natiahnite ovál do požadovanej veľkosti a potom kliknutím definujte prvú úsečku. Potom presuňte ukazovateľ myši na miesto, kde chcete ukončiť druhú úsečku, a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť priamo na ovál. Keď chcete nakresliť kruhový oblúk, podržte počas ťahania kláves Shift.
a .uno%3AArc 170 Nakreslí v aktuálnom dokumente oblúk. Ak chcete nakresliť oblúk elipsy, natiahnite ovál do požadovanej veľkosti a potom kliknutím definujte počiatočný bod. Potom presuňte ukazovateľ myši na miesto, kde chcete oblúk ukončiť, a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť priamo na ovál. Ak chcete nakresliť kruhový oblúk, podržte počas ťahania kláves Shift.
10 .uno%3ACircleCut 19e Nakreslí vyplnený tvar, ktorý je definovaný kruhovým oblúkom a jednou úsečkou. Ak chcete nakresliť kruhový oblúk, natiahnite kruh do požadovanej veľkosti a potom kliknutím definujte počiatok úsečky. Potom presuňte kurzor myši na miesto, kde chcete úsečku ukončiť, a kliknite. Nemusíte kliknúť priamo na kruh. Ak chcete nakresliť eliptický oblúk, podržte počas ťahania kláves Shift.
18 .uno%3AFreeline_Unfilled be Draws a freeform line where you drag in the current document. To end the line, release the mouse button. To draw a closed shape, release the mouse button near the starting point of the line.
16 .uno%3ABezier_Unfilled 19f Nakreslí tvar, ktorý je založený na Bézierovej krivke. Kliknite na miesto, kde chcete krivku začať, ťahajte, uvoľnite tlačidlo myši a potom presuňte ukazovateľ na miesto, kde chcete krivku ukončiť, a kliknite. Presunutím ukazovateľa a kliknutím pridáte na krivku rovný úsek. Dvojklikom ukončíte kresbu krivky. Ak chcete vytvoriť uzavretý tvar, dvakrát kliknite na počiatočný bod krivky.
12 .uno%3ADrawCaption 176 Draws a line that ends in a rectangular callout with horizontal text direction from where you drag in the current document. Drag a handle of the callout to resize the callout. To add text, click the edge of the callout, and then type or paste your text. To change a rectangular callout to a rounded callout, drag the largest corner handle when the pointer changes to a hand.
13 .uno%3AText_Marquee cf Vloží do dokumentu animovaný text s vodorovnou orientáciou. Natiahnite textové pole a potom napíšte alebo vložte do neho text. Na priradenie efektu animácie zvoľte Formát - Text - Animácia textu.
b .uno%3ARect e1 Nakreslí na určené miesto obdĺžnik. Kliknite na miesto, kde chcete umiestniť roh obdĺžniku, a potom ťahajte obdĺžnik do požadovanej veľkosti. Ak chcete nakresliť štvorec, podržte počas ťahania kláves Shift.
e .uno%3AEllipse c6 Nakreslí na určené miesto ovál. Kliknite na miesto, kde chcete ovál nakresliť  a potom ho ťahajte do požadovanej veľkosti. Ak chcete nakresliť kruh, podržte počas ťahania kláves Shift.
b .uno%3ALine 69 Nakreslí rovnú úsečku. Na obmedzenie čiary na uhol 45 stupňov, podržte pri ťahaní kláves Shift.
17 .uno%3APolygon_Unfilled 15b Nakreslí čiaru zloženú z postupnosti rovných úsečiek. Kliknite na miesto, kde chcete začať, a ťahaním nakreslite úsečku. Kliknutím definujete koniec úsečky a rovnako pokračujte pri určení zostávajúcich častí. Dvojklikom ukončíte kreslenie čiary. Ak chcete vytvoriť uzavretý tvar, dvakrát kliknite na počiatočný bod.
11 .uno%3AInsertDraw 83 Kliknutím otvoríte panel Kresba, pomocou ktorého je možné pridávať tvary, úsečky, text a bubliny do aktuálneho dokumentu.
16 .uno%3AFormDesignTools 20 Otvorí panel Návrh formulára.
e .uno%3AListBox 16 Vytvorí pole zoznamu.
12 .uno%3ARadioButton 1e Vytvorí tlačidlo možností.
12 .uno%3ARadiobutton 1e Vytvorí tlačidlo možností.
11 .uno%3APushbutton 13 Vytvorí tlačidlo.
f .uno%3AComboBox 14 Vytvorí Combo pole.
15 .uno%3AFormattedField 1c Vytvorí formátované pole.
f .uno%3ACombobox 14 Vytvorí Combo pole.
b .uno%3AEdit 17 Vytvorí textové pole.
c .uno%3ALabel 22 Vytvorí pole na zobrazenie textu.
f .uno%3ACheckBox 22 Vytvorí zaškrtávacie políčko.
13 .uno%3AMoreControls 27 Otvorí panel Viac ovládacích prvkov.
f .uno%3ACheckbox 22 Vytvorí zaškrtávacie políčko.
d .uno%3AConfig 55 The Form Controls toolbar contains tools that you need to create an interactive form.
1c .uno%3AConvertToImageControl 42 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na ovládacie pole obrázku.
17 .uno%3AConvertToPattern 35 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na pole vzorky.
17 .uno%3AConvertToNumeric 39 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na číselné pole.
14 .uno%3AConvertToTime 37 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na časové pole.
14 .uno%3AConvertToDate 39 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na dátumové pole.
1b .uno%3AConvertToFileControl 38 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na výber súboru.
19 .uno%3AConvertToFormatted 3c Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na formátované pole.
15 .uno%3AConvertToRadio 3e Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na tlačidlo možností.
15 .uno%3AConvertToCombo 42 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na zaškrtávacie políčko.
18 .uno%3AConvertToCheckBox 42 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na zaškrtávacie políčko.
14 .uno%3AConvertToList 36 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na pole zoznamu.
18 .uno%3AConvertToImageBtn 3f Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na obrázkové tlačidlo.
15 .uno%3AConvertToFixed 34 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na označenie.
18 .uno%3AConvertToCurrency 36 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na menové pole.
16 .uno%3AConvertToButton 33 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na tlačidlo.
14 .uno%3AConvertToEdit 37 Vybraný ovládací prvok sa premení na textové pole.
18 .uno%3AChangeControlType 87 Otvorí podponuku, kde si je možné vybrať druh ovládacieho prvku, ktorým chcete nahradiť ovládací prvok označený v dokumente.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVX_DLG_SHOWGRIDCOLUMNS%3A1 8d In the Show Columns dialog you can select the columns to be shown. Hold down the Shift or Ctrl (Mac: Command) key to select multiple entries.
13 SVX_HID_FM_SHOWCOLS 48 Otvorí podponuku, kde je možné vybrať zobrazenie skrytých stĺpcov.
12 SVX_HID_FM_HIDECOL 1a Skryje označený stĺpec.
14 SVX_HID_FM_DELETECOL 1d Odstráni označený stĺpec.
16 SVX_HID_FM_SHOWALLCOLS 39 Kliknite na Všetko, ak chcete zobraziť všetky stĺpce.
18 SVX_HID_FM_SHOWCOLS_MORE 22 Otvorí dialóg Zobraziť stĺpce.
14 SVX_HID_FM_CHANGECOL 71 Otvorí podponuku na výber dátového poľa, ktorým chcete nahradiť vybrané pole v ovládacom prvku tabuľky.
14 SVX_HID_FM_INSERTCOL 64 Otvorí podponuku pre výber dátového poľa, ktoré chcete pridať do ovládacieho prvku tabuľky.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_FM_PROPDLG_TABCTR 46 Otvorí dialóg pre úpravu vlastností vybraného ovládacieho prvku.
18 .uno%3AControlProperties 46 Otvorí dialóg pre úpravu vlastností vybraného ovládacieho prvku.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_POSITION 69 Určuje, či sa na Navigačnom paneli majú zobraziť alebo skryť prvky určujúce umiestnenie záznamu.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VISIBLESIZE e0 Určuje veľkosť posuvníka posuvného panelu v "hodnotových jednotkách". Napr. hodnota ("Max. hodnota posunu" mínus "Min. hodnota posunu") / 2 bude mať za následok posuvník, ktoré zaberie polovicu posuvného panelu.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ICONSIZE 48 Určuje, či majú byť ikony na Navigačnom paneli malé alebo veľké.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FORMATKEY 65 Určuje formátovací kód pre ovládací prvok. Kliknutím na tlačidlo ... je možné kód vybrať.
17 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TAG 4a Určuje doplňujúce informácie alebo popisný text pre ovládací prvok.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPINVALUE_MAX 4f Definuje hodnotu ovládacieho prvku, ktorú používateľ nemôže prekročiť.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LITERALMASK 75 Definuje znakovú masku. Znaková maska obsahuje východzie hodnoty a je viditeľná vždy po načítaní formulára.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATEMAX 39 Používateľ nemôže zadať vyšší dátum než tento.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ECHO_CHAR 96 Ak textové pole bude použité k zadávaniu hesla, zadajte ASCII kód zobrazovaného znaku. Zobrazí sa namiesto znakov zadávaných používateľom.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HIDDEN_VALUE 50 Umožňuje zadať hodnotu, ktorá bude pridaná ku skrytému ovládaciemu prvku.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CURRENCYSYMBOL 36 Umožňuje zadať znak alebo reťazec pre symbol meny.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WORDBREAK 24 Displays text on more than one line.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CURRSYM_POSITION 4b Určuje, či sa symbol meny v menovom poli zobrazí pred alebo za číslom.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TEXT 37 Nastaví východzí text pre textové alebo combo pole.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_NAME 78 Na záložke Vlastnosti určuje názov ovládacieho prvku. Na záložke Vlastnosti formulára určuje názov formulára.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_RECORDACTIONS 50 Určuje, či sa majú zobraziť alebo skryť prvky akcií na Navigačnom paneli.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LINEEND_FORMAT 60 Pre textové polia vyberte kód konca riadku, ktorý sa použije pri zápise textu do databázy.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TOGGLE 122 Specifies if a Push Button behaves as a Toggle Button. If you set Toggle to "Yes", you can switch between the "selected" and "not selected" control states when you click the button or press the spacebar while the control has the focus. A button in the "selected" state appears "pressed in".
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_DATE 1b Nastaví východzí dátum.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_TIME 19 Nastaví východzí čas.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SCALEIMAGE 47 Zmení veľkosť obrázku, aby zodpovedal veľkosti ovládacieho prvku.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TABSTOP 62 Vlastnosť Krok tabulátora určuje, či je možné ovládací prvok vybrať pomocou klávesa Tab.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SCROLLVALUE_MIN 2e Určuje minimálnu hodnotu pre posuvný panel.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEDEFAULT 2f Nastaví východziu hodnotu ovládacieho prvku.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TABINDEX 70 Vlastnosť Poradie aktivácie určuje poradie, v akom sa aktivujú ovládacie prvky pri stlačení klávesu Tab.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BORDER 4f Určuje, či sa má okraj poľa zobraziť "Bez rámca", v "3D" alebo "Plochý".
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CONTROLLABEL 30 Určuje zdroj pre označenie ovládacieho prvku.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ENABLE_VISIBLE 68 Defines whether the control will be visible in live mode. In design mode, the control is always visible.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_NAVIGATIONBAR 60 Určuje, či sa pri spodnom ohraničení ovládacieho prvku tabuľky zobrazí navigačný panel.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TIMEFORMAT 31 Umožňuje definovať požadovaný formát času.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_PRINTABLE 32 Určuje, či sa má toto ovládacie pole tlačiť.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATEMIN 3f Určuje najnižší dátum, ktorý môže používateľ zadať.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ROWHEIGHT 33 Určuje výšku riadku v ovládacom prvku tabuľky.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOWTHOUSANDSEP 1d Vloží oddeľovač tisícok.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FOCUSONCLICK 5a Ak je táto voľba nastavená na "Áno", tlačidlo získa zameranie, keď naňho kliknete.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MULTILINE b1 Umožňuje v poliach (napr. textových alebo označení) používať zalomenie riadku a formátovanie. Pre zadanie formátovaného textu zvoľte "Viac riadkov s formátovaním".
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEMAX 4f Definuje hodnotu ovládacieho prvku, ktorú používateľ nemôže prekročiť.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VALUEMAX 4f Definuje hodnotu ovládacieho prvku, ktorú používateľ nemôže prekročiť.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_NAVIGATION 57 Určuje, či sa na Navigačnom paneli majú zobraziť alebo skryť prvky na navigáciu.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EDITMASK 61 Definuje vstupnú masku. Zadaním masky určíte, čo môže používateľ do tohto poľa zadať.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BUTTONTYPE 4e Vlastnosť Činnosť určuje, aká činnosť nastane pri aktivácii tlačidla.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VALUESTEP 1f Určuje intervaly číselníku.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPININCREMENT 43 Určuje intervaly pre zvýšenie a zníženie hodnoty číselníku.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPINVALUE_MIN 76 Umožňuje určiť najnižšiu možnú hodnotu poľa. To znamená, že používateľ nemôže zadať nižšiu hodnotu.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HSCROLL 29 Pridá k textovému poľu posuvný panel.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_SCROLLBARS 29 Pridá k textovému poľu posuvný panel.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FONT 2b Vyberte písmo pre text v ovládacom prvku.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SCROLLVALUE_MAX 2e Určuje maximálnu hodnotu pre posuvný panel.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ORIENTATION 5d Určuje, či bude posuvný panel či rolovacie tlačidlo orientované zvisle alebo vodorovne.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SPIN 65 Možnosť "Áno" zmení ovládací prvok na rolovacie tlačidlo a pridajú sa zodpovedajúce šípky.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_STRICTFORMAT 4b Ak je aktívny presný formát (Áno), prijímané sú len povolené znaky.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SYMBOLCOLOR 4c Určuje farbu symbolov na ovládacom prvku, napr. šípok posuvného panelu.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VSCROLL 29 Pridá k textovému poľu posuvný panel.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BACKGROUNDCOLOR 2a Nastaví farbu pozadia ovládacieho prvku.
27 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SCROLLVALUE 2f Nastaví východziu hodnotu pre posuvný panel.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_IMAGE_URL 65 Vlastnosť Obrázky určuje cestu a názov súboru s obrázkom, ktorý chcete zobraziť na tlačidle.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TEXTTYPE b1 Umožňuje v poliach (napr. textových alebo označení) používať zalomenie riadku a formátovanie. Pre zadanie formátovaného textu zvoľte "Viac riadkov s formátovaním".
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BLOCKINCREMENT 74 Určuje hodnotu, ktorá sa pričíta alebo odčíta, keď používateľ klikne vedľa posuvníka na posuvnom paneli.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_POSITIONX 3e Defines the X position of the control, relative to the anchor.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULTVALUE 2f Nastaví východziu hodnotu ovládacieho prvku.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EFFECTIVEMIN 76 Umožňuje určiť najnižšiu možnú hodnotu poľa. To znamená, že používateľ nemôže zadať nižšiu hodnotu.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_RECORDMARKER 70 Určuje, či sa má prvý stĺpec zobraziť so štítkami riadkov, kde je aktuálny záznam označený šípkou.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ALIGN 48 Určuje zarovnanie pre text alebo obrázok použitý v ovládacom prvku.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SELECT_SEQ 45 Určuje položky poľa zoznamu, ktoré sa majú implicitne označiť.
29 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HIDEINACTIVESELECTION 71 Určuje, či označený text v ovládacom prvku zostane označený, aj keď ovládací prvok už nie je aktívny.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TIMEMIN 3d Určuje najnižší čas, ktorý môže používateľ zadať.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VALUEMIN 76 Umožňuje určiť najnižšiu možnú hodnotu poľa. To znamená, že používateľ nemôže zadať nižšiu hodnotu.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_STRINGITEMLIST 5e Definuje zoznam položiek viditeľných v dokumente. Otvorte tento zoznam a zadajte svoj text.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LINECOUNT 8b Specifies how many lines should be displayed in the dropdown list. This setting is only active if you chose "Yes" in the "Dropdown" option.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SHOW_FILTERSORT 5f Specifies to show or hide the filtering and sorting items in a selected Navigation Bar control.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TARGET_FRAME 72 Určuje cieľový rámec, v ktorom sa zobrazí dokument otvorený z ponuky "Otvoriť dokument / webovú stránku".
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_REPEAT_DELAY 41 Určuje pozdržanie v milisekundách medzi opakovaním udalostí.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HELPURL 5e Určuje URL odkaz na dokument pomocníka, ktorý sa zobrazí ako pomocník ovládacieho prvku.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DECIMAL_ACCURACY 41 Určuje počet číslic zobrazených v desatinnej časti čísla.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DROPDOWN 3b Určuje, či sa combo pole má stránkovať dole alebo nie.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WIDTH 21 Defines the width of the control.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TARGET_URL 70 Určuje URL adresu, ktorá bude otvorená po kliknutí na tlačidlo typu "Otvoriť dokument / webovú stránku".
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HEIGHT 22 Defines the height of the control.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BORDERCOLOR 62 Určuje farbu okrajov pre ovládacie prvky, ktoré majú nastavenú vlastnosť Okraj na "plochý".
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_READONLY 55 Určuje, či je ovládací prvok len na čítanie (Áno) alebo sa dá upraviť (Nie).
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_POSITIONY 3e Defines the Y position of the control, relative to the anchor.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATEFORMAT 34 Zadajte požadovaný formát pre zobrazenie dátumu.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ENABLED 6b Ak je vlastnosť "Povolené" nastavená na (Áno), používateľ môže tento ovládací prvok používať.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LINEINCREMENT 6c Určuje hodnotu, ktorá sa pričíta alebo odčíta, keď používateľ klikne na šípku posuvného panelu.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_WHEEL_BEHAVIOR 165 Sets whether the value changes when the user scrolls a mouse wheel. Never: No change of the value. When focused: (default) The value changes when the control has the focus and the wheel is pointing at the control and gets scrolled. Always: The value changes when the wheel is pointing at the control and gets scrolled, no matter which control has the focus.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MAXTEXTLEN 46 Definuje maximálny počet znakov, ktoré môže používateľ zadať.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_REPEAT 9b Určuje, či sa má opakovať akcia ovládacieho prvku, ak naňho kliknete a držíte tlačidlo myši (napr. pre rolovacie tlačidlo alebo posuvný panel).
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_BUTTON 64 Vlastnosť Východzie tlačidlo určuje, ktoré tlačidlo sa použije pri stlačení klávesu Enter.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VISUALEFFECT 6e Určuje, či sa zaškrtávacie políčka a tlačidlá možností zobrazujú ako 3D (východzie) alebo ploché.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DEFAULT_SPINVALUE 2f Nastaví východziu hodnotu ovládacieho prvku.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ANCHOR_TYPE 2b Defines where the control will be anchored.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LABEL 4f Vlastnosť Popisné pole nastavuje označenie ovládacieho prvku vo formulári.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TRISTATE 73 Určuje, či môže zaškrtávacie políčko reprezentovať okrem hodnôt PRAVDA a NEPRAVDA naviac hodnotu NULOVÉ.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_TIMEMAX 45 Určuje maximálnu hodnotu času, ktorú môže používateľ zadať.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_AUTOCOMPLETE 2f Priradí combo poľu automatické vyplňovanie.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MULTISELECTION 34 Umožňuje vybrať viac než jednu položku zoznamu.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_HELPTEXT 4f Umožňuje zadať pomocný text, ktorý sa zobrazí ako tip ovládacieho prvku.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_IMAGEPOSITION 48 Určuje zarovnanie pre text alebo obrázok použitý v ovládacom prvku.
26 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CELL_EXCHANGE_TYPE 39 Určuje režim prepojenia poľa zoznamu s bunkou zošitu.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BOUND_CELL 6d Určuje odkaz na prepojenú bunku v zošite. Prepojí sa stav alebo obsah ovládacieho prvku s obsahom bunky.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_FILTERPROPOSAL fc Pri návrhu formulára je možné v dialógu Vlastnosti formulára na záložke Dáta nastaviť textovým poliam vlastnosť "Filter". V režime filtru si potom je možné pri hľadaní vybrať zo všetkých informácií obsiahnutých v týchto poliach.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_EMPTY_IS_NULL c9 Defines how an empty string input should be handled. If set to Yes, an input string of length zero will be treated as a value NULL. If set to No, any input will be treated as-is without any conversion.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LISTSOURCE c6 V databázových formulároch určuje zdroj dát zoznam položiek pre ovládací prvok. Toto pole je možné použiť pre zadanie zoznamu hodnôt do dokumentov, ktoré nie sú spojené s databázou.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LISTSOURCETYPE 39 Určuje dáta pre vyplnenie polí zoznamov a combo polí.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_BOUNDCOLUMN 8e Pomocou indexu určíte pole tabuľky alebo SQL dotazu, ktoré sa spojí s poľom určeným v Dátové pole. Platné hodnoty sú 1, 2, 3 atď.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CONTROLSOURCE 4f Určuje pole v tabuľke zdroja dát, na ktoré odkazuje tento ovládací prvok.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_REFVALUE e6 Umožňuje zadať referenčnú hodnotu pre webové formuláre, ktorá sa odovzdá serveru pri odoslaní formulára. V databázových formulároch sa zadaná hodnota zapíše do databázového poľa priradeného ovládaciemu prvku.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_LIST_CELL_RANGE 5e Zadajte rozsah buniek zo zošitu, ktoré obsahujú položky pre pole zoznamu alebo combo pole.
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_UNCHECKEDREFVALUE 12f Zaškrtávacie políčka a prepínače v zošitoch je možné prepojiť s bunkami v aktuálnom dokumente. Ak je ovládací prvok zapnutý, skopíruje sa do bunky hodnota z Referenčnej hodnoty (zapnutá). Ak je ovládací prvok vypnutý, skopíruje sa do bunky hodnota z Referenčnej hodnoty (vypnutá).
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEEXITED 50 The Mouse outside event takes place when the mouse is outside the control field.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEPRESSED 6f The Mouse button pressed event occurs if the mouse button is pressed while the mouse pointer is on the control.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEDRAGGED 65 The Mouse moved while key pressed event takes place when the mouse is dragged while a key is pressed.
18 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_KEYUP 5d The Key released event occurs when the user releases any key while the control has the focus.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEMOVED 41 The Mouse moved event occurs if the mouse moves over the control.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_KEYTYPED 5b The Key pressed event occurs when the user presses any key while the control has the focus.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_FOCUSGAINED 51 The When receiving focus event takes place if a control field receives the focus.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_ITEMSTATECHANGED 59 The Item status changed event takes place if the status of the control field has changed.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_TEXTCHANGED 53 Udalosť Text zmenený nastane, keď zadáte alebo upravíte text vo vstupnom poli.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSEENTERED 4c The Mouse inside event takes place if the mouse is inside the control field.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_FOCUSLOST 4c The When losing focus event takes place if a control field looses the focus.
1a EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_CHANGED 82 The Changed event takes place when the control loses the focus and the content of the control has changed since it lost the focus.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_ACTIONPERFORMED 3a The Execute action event occurs when an action is started.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_MOUSERELEASED 71 The Mouse button released event occurs if the mouse button is released while the mouse pointer is on the control.
29 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_APPROVEACTIONPERFORMED 4d This event takes place before an action is triggered by clicking the control.
15 .uno%3AFormProperties 61 In this dialog you can specify, among others,  the data source and the events for the whole form.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SUBMIT_ENCODING 32 Specifies the type for encoding the data transfer.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SUBMIT_METHOD 3f Upresní metódu prenosu informácií z vyplneného formulára.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_ERROROCCURRED 58 The Error occurred event is activated if an error occurs when accessing the data source.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_POSITIONED 60 The After record change event occurs directly after the current record pointer has been changed.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_ROWCHANGE 58 The After record action event occurs directly after the current record has been changed.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_APPROVEROWCHANGE 4b The Before record action event occurs before the current record is changed.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_UNLOADING 67 The Before unloading event occurs before the form is unloaded; that is, separated from its data source.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_APPROVEPARAMETER 63 The Fill parameters event occurs when the form to be loaded has parameters that must be filled out.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_RELOADED 4a The When reloading event occurs directly after the form has been reloaded.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_LOADED 46 The When loading event occurs directly after the form has been loaded.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_POSITIONING 53 The Before record change event occurs before the current record pointer is changed.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_SUBMITTED 40 The Before submitting event occurs before the form data is sent.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_CONFIRMDELETE 51 The Confirm deletion event occurs as soon as data has been deleted from the form.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_RESETTED 3d The After resetting event occurs after a form has been reset.
1b EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_UNLOADED 73 The When unloading event occurs directly after the form has been unloaded; that is, separated from its data source.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_RELOADING 3e The Before reloading event occurs before the form is reloaded.
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_APPROVERESETTED 37 The Prior to reset event occurs before a form is reset.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_EVT_AFTERUPDATE 72 The After update event occurs after the control content changed by the user has been written into the data source.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_MASTERFIELDS 80 If you create a subform, enter the data field of the parent form responsible for the synchronization between parent and subform.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ALLOW_EDITS 27 Determines if the data can be modified.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ALLOW_DELETIONS 26 Determines if the data can be deleted.
23 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ALLOW_ADDITIONS 20 Determines if data can be added.
19 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CYCLE 3f Determines how the navigation should be done using the tab key.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_NAVIGATION 4d Specifies whether the navigation functions in the lower form bar can be used.
1d EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATAENTRY 70 Determines if the form only allows the addition of new data (Yes) or if it allows other properties as well (No).
25 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_ESCAPE_PROCESSING 46 Specifies whether the SQL statement is to be analyzed by %PRODUCTNAME.
24 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CURSORSOURCETYPE 8a Defines whether the data source is to be an existing database table or query, or if the form is to be generated based on an SQL statement.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SORT_CRITERIA 9c Specifies the conditions to sort the data in the form. The specification of the sorting conditions follows SQL rules without the use of the ORDER BY clause.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_CURSORSOURCE fd Determines the content to be used for the form. The content can be an existing table or a query (previously created in the database), or it can be defined by an SQL-statement. Before you enter a content you have to define the exact type in Content type.
1f EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_SLAVEFIELDS 6b If you create a subform, enter the variable where possible values from the parent form field can be stored.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_DATASOURCE 37 Defines the data source to which the form should refer.
2f modules%2Fspropctrlr%2Fui%2Ftaborder%2FCTRLtree 76 Lists all controls in the form. These controls can be selected with the tab key in the given order from top to bottom.
10 .uno%3ATabDialog 79 In the Tab Order dialog you can modify the order in which control fields get the focus when the user presses the tab key.
11 SVX_HID_FIELD_SEL 88 The field selection window lists all database fields of the table or query that was specified as the data source in the Form Properties.
f .uno%3AAddField 52 Opens a window where you can select a database field to add to the form or report.
1d .uno%3ASwitchXFormsDesignMode b1 Toggles the Design mode on or off. This function is used to switch quickly between Design and User mode. Activate to edit the form controls, deactivate to use the form controls.
1e .uno%3ASwitchControlDesignMode b1 Toggles the Design mode on or off. This function is used to switch quickly between Design and User mode. Activate to edit the form controls, deactivate to use the form controls.
18 SVX_HID_FM_RENAME_OBJECT 1c Renames the selected object.
11 SVX_HID_FM_DELETE 1b Deletes the selected entry.
15 SVX_HID_FM_NEW_HIDDEN a6 Creates a hidden control in the selected form that is not displayed on the screen. A hidden control serves to include data that is transmitted together with the form.
13 SVX_HID_FM_NEW_FORM 23 Creates a new form in the document.
e SVX_HID_FM_NEW 6f Adds new elements to the form. The Add function can only be called if a form is selected in the Form Navigator.
1a .uno%3AShowPropertyBrowser 34 Starts the Properties dialog for the selected entry.
16 SVX_HID_FORM_NAVIGATOR 68 The Form Navigator contains a list of all created (logical) forms with the corresponding control fields.
15 .uno%3AShowFmExplorer 84 Opens the Form Navigator. The Form Navigator displays all forms and subforms of the current document with their respective controls.
13 .uno%3AOpenReadOnly 3a Opens forms in Design Mode so that the form can be edited.
11 .uno%3AUseWizards 51 Specifies whether to start the wizard automatically when inserting a new control.
15 .uno%3ADesignerDialog 76 Specifies whether to show or hide the Styles and Formatting window, which is where you can assign and organize Styles.
11 .uno%3AStyleApply 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object.
16 .uno%3AStyleApplyState 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object.
15 SVX_HID_STYLE_LISTBOX 57 Assigns a style to the current paragraph, selected paragraphs, or to a selected object.
13 .uno%3ACharFontName 4d Allows you to select a font name from the list or enter a font name directly.
11 .uno%3AFontHeight 5d Allows you to choose between different font sizes from the list, or to enter a size manually.
1f .uno%3ATextdirectionLeftToRight 2f Specifies the horizontal direction of the text.
1f .uno%3ATextdirectionTopToBottom 2d Specifies the vertical direction of the text.
16 .uno%3ADecrementIndent 92 Click the Decrease Indent icon to reduce the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the previous default tab position.
16 .uno%3AIncrementIndent 90 Click the Increase Indent icon to increase the left indent of the current paragraph or cell content and set it to the next default tab position.
10 .uno%3ABackColor 14d Applies the current highlight color to the background of a text selection. If no text is selected, click the Highlighting icon, select the text that you want to highlight, and then click the Highlighting icon again. To change the highlight color, click the arrow next to the Highlighting icon, and then click the color that you want.
16 .uno%3ABackgroundColor ab Click to open a toolbar where you can click a background color for a paragraph. The color is applied to the background of the current paragraph or the selected paragraphs.
18 .uno%3AParaspaceIncrease 5f Click the Increase Spacing icon to increase the paragraph spacing above the selected paragraph.
18 .uno%3AParaspaceDecrease 5f Click the Decrease Spacing icon to decrease the paragraph spacing above the selected paragraph.
15 .uno%3ASetBorderStyle 71 Click the Borders icon to open the Borders toolbar, where you can modify the border of a sheet area or an object.
10 .uno%3ALineStyle 5b Click this icon to open the Line Style toolbar, where you can modify the border line style.
15 .uno%3AFrameLineColor 86 Click the Line Color (of the border) icon to open the Border Color toolbar, which enables you to change the border color of an object.
17 .uno%3AToggleAnchorType 2f Allows you to switch between anchoring options.
14 .uno%3AOptimizeTable 60 Otvorí panel nástrojov, ktorý obsahuje funkcie na optimalizáciu riadkov a stĺpcov tabuľky.
13 .uno%3ALineEndStyle 69 Opens the Arrowheads toolbar. Use the symbols shown to define the style for the end of the selected line.
1d .uno%3AToggleObjectRotateMode 1c Rotates the selected object.
12 .uno%3AObjectAlign 2b Modifies the alignment of selected objects.
15 .uno%3ADecrementLevel 50 Moves the selected paragraph down one level in a numbering or bullets hierarchy.
13 .uno%3AOutlineRight 50 Moves the selected paragraph down one level in a numbering or bullets hierarchy.
15 .uno%3AIncrementLevel 50 Moves the selected paragraph up one level in the numbering or bullets hierarchy.
12 .uno%3AOutlineLeft 50 Moves the selected paragraph up one level in the numbering or bullets hierarchy.
d .uno%3AMoveUp 39 Positions the selected paragraph before the one above it.
10 .uno%3AOutlineUp 39 Positions the selected paragraph before the one above it.
f .uno%3AMoveDown 38 Positions the selected paragraph after the one below it.
12 .uno%3AOutlineDown 38 Positions the selected paragraph after the one below it.
14 .uno%3ADefaultBullet 5b Assigns bullet points to the selected paragraphs, or removes them from bulleted paragraphs.
e .uno%3AOpenUrl 9f Loads a document specified by an entered URL. You can type a new URL, edit an URL, or select one from the list. Displays the full path of the current document.
d .uno%3AReload 3a Replaces the current document with the last saved version.
a SID_RELOAD 3a Replaces the current document with the last saved version.
21 SFX2_HID_HELP_TEXT_SELECTION_MODE d6 You can enable a selection cursor in a read-only text document or in the Help. Choose Edit - Select Text or open the context menu of a read-only document and choose Select Text. The selection cursor does not blink.
15 .uno%3ASelectTextMode d6 You can enable a selection cursor in a read-only text document or in the Help. Choose Edit - Select Text or open the context menu of a read-only document and choose Select Text. The selection cursor does not blink.
e .uno%3AEditDoc 3b Enables you to edit a read-only document or database table.
11 .uno%3ADSBEditDoc 3d Turns the edit mode for the current database table on or off.
b .uno%3AStop 73 Click to interrupt the current loading process, Ctrl-click (Mac: Command-click) to interrupt all loading processes.
f SID_BROWSE_STOP 73 Click to interrupt the current loading process, Ctrl-click (Mac: Command-click) to interrupt all loading processes.
18 .uno%3AExportDirectToPDF 4a Exports the current document directly as PDF. No settings dialog is shown.
15 .uno%3AStatusGetTitle 42 Displays information about the active %PRODUCTNAME Basic document.
18 .uno%3AStatusGetPosition 7d Displays the current cursor position in the %PRODUCTNAME Basic document. The row number is specified, then the column number.
1b CUI_HID_ICCDIALOG_RESET_BTN 39 Resets the entries in the dialog to their original state.
18 CUI_HID_ICCDIALOG_OK_BTN 22 Applies the data to your document.
16 .uno%3ARemoveHyperlink 2a Removes the hyperlink, leaving plain text.
1c .uno%3ACopyHyperlinkLocation 20 Copies the URL to the clipboard.
1c .uno%3AOpenHyperlinkOnCursor 30 Opens the hyperlink in your default web browser.
1c CUI_HID_ICCDIALOG_CANCEL_BTN 21 Closes the dialog without saving.
1c CUI_HID_ICCDIALOG_CHOICECTRL 2c Select the type of hyperlink to be inserted.
14 .uno%3AEditHyperlink 1b Opens the Hyperlink dialog.
16 .uno%3AHyperlinkDialog 3e Opens a dialog that enables you to create and edit hyperlinks.
35 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3AED_TEXT 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ABTN_SCRIPT 87 Opens the Assign Macro dialog, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes.
31 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3AED_TEXT 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
34 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ALB_FORM 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button.
3b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3AED_INDICATION 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink.
35 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3AED_TEXT 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
3b cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ABTN_SCRIPT 87 Opens the Assign Macro dialog, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ABTN_SCRIPT 87 Opens the Assign Macro dialog, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes.
3b cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ALB_FORM 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button.
1e CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_MARKWND_TREE 48 Specifies the position in the target document where you wish to jump to.
38 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ALB_FORM 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button.
38 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ALB_FORM 43 Specifies whether the hyperlink is inserted as text or as a button.
3d cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ACB_FRAME c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window.
3e cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3AED_INDICATION 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink.
3a cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ACB_FRAME c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window.
3f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ACBX_ANONYMOUS 3d Allows you to log in to the FTP address as an anonymous user.
37 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3AED_INDICATION 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink.
1f CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_MARKWND_APPLY 3f Inserts the target in the Target field of the Hyperlink dialog.
42 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ABTN_SCRIPT 87 Opens the Assign Macro dialog, in which you can give events such as "mouse over object" or "trigger hyperlink" their own program codes.
3a cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ACB_FRAME c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window.
36 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3AED_LOGIN 41 Specifies your login name, if you are working with FTP addresses.
36 cui%3AComboBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ACB_FRAME c3 Enter the name of the frame that you want the linked file to open in, or select a predefined frame from the list. If you leave this box blank, the linked file opens in the current browser window.
3b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3AED_INDICATION 3f Specifies the visible text or button caption for the hyperlink.
37 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3AED_PASSWD 3f Specifies your password, if you are working with FTP addresses.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ABTN_BROWSE 3d Opens a web browser, into which you can load the desired URL.
48 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ARB_LINKTYP_INTERNET 1a Creates an http hyperlink.
1f CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_MARKWND_CLOSE 64 Once the hyperlink has been completely entered, click on Close to set the link and leave the dialog.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_INTERNET 1a Creates an http hyperlink.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_INET_PATH a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
38 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3AED_TEXT 1f Enter a name for the hyperlink.
43 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_INTERNET%3ARB_LINKTYP_FTP 19 Creates an FTP hyperlink.
34 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3AED_SUBJECT 57 Specifies the subject that is inserted in the subject line of the new message document.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ABTN_ADRESSBOOK 27 Hides or shows the data source browser.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_MAIL_PATH 67 Specifies the full URL of the addressee, in the form mailto:name@provider.com or news:group.server.com.
40 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ARB_LINKTYP_NEWS 28 Assigns a news address to the hyperlink.
40 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_MAIL%3ARB_LINKTYP_MAIL 36 Assigns the specified e-mail address to the hyperlink.
16 CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_MAIL 36 Assigns the specified e-mail address to the hyperlink.
3f cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ABTN_BROWSE 24 Opens the Target in Document dialog.
3b cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3AED_TARGET_DOC 4c Specifies a target for the hyperlink into the document specified under Path.
41 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT%3ABTN_FILEOPEN 33 Opens the Open dialog, where you can select a file.
19 CUI_HID_HYPERDLG_DOC_PATH a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
1a CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_DOCUMENT a3 Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink. If you do not specify a target frame, the file opens in the current document or frame.
45 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ALB_DOCUMENT_TYPES 2d Specifies the file type for the new document.
42 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ABTN_CREATE 3a Opens the Select Path dialog, where you can select a path.
3f cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3AED_PATH_NEWDOC 4c Enter a URL for the file that you want to open when you click the hyperlink.
42 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ARB_EDITNOW 4e Specifies that the new document is created and immediately opened for editing.
44 cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT%3ARB_EDITLATER 48 Specifies that the document is created but it is not immediately opened.
1d CUI_HID_HYPERLINK_NEWDOCUMENT 4e Specifies that the new document is created and immediately opened for editing.
13 .uno%3APreviousPage 30 Moves back to the previous page in the document.
d .uno%3APageUp 30 Moves back to the previous page in the document.
f .uno%3ANextPage 2f Moves forward to the next page in the document.
f .uno%3APageDown 2f Moves forward to the next page in the document.
10 .uno%3AFirstPage 28 Moves to the first page of the document.
15 .uno%3AGoToStartOfDoc 28 Moves to the first page of the document.
f .uno%3ALastPage 27 Moves to the last page of the document.
13 .uno%3AGoToEndOfDoc 27 Moves to the last page of the document.
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_ADMINISTRATE b3 Opens a dialog to add/edit/remove a database file from the list of registered databases. The same dialog opens by choosing %PRODUCTNAME Base - Databases in the Options dialog box.
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_RENAME_ENTRY c5 To rename an entry, call this command and enter the new name. You can also do this by selecting the entry and pressing F2. The database must support renaming, otherwise this command is not enabled.
1e DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_CLOSECONN 68 Closes the connection to the data source. See %PRODUCTNAME Base - Connections in the Options dialog box.
22 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_EDIT_DATABASE 2d Opens the selected database file for editing.
18 .uno%3ADSBrowserExplorer 36 Turns on and off the view of the data source explorer.
f .uno%3ASortDown 39 Sorts the data of the selected field in descending order.
11 .uno%3AAutoFilter 4f Filters the records, based on the content of the currently selected data field.
17 .uno%3ARemoveFilterSort 51 Cancels the filter settings and displays all of the records in the current table.
28 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_REFRESH_REBUILDVIEW 6b Rebuilds the view of the database table. Use this command when you have changed the structure of the table.
e .uno%3ARefresh 1d Refreshes the displayed data.
13 .uno%3ASbaBrwInsert 59 Inserts all fields of the marked record into the current document at the cursor position.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fautoformat 79 Opens the AutoFormat dialog, in which you can select format styles that are immediately applied when inserting the table.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Frowonly 32 Inserts an empty heading line into the text table.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fcolumnname 5a Uses the field names of the database table as headings for each of the text table columns.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftableheading 4d Specifies whether to insert a heading line for the columns in the text table.
3d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ffromdatabase 1d Accepts the database formats.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fallleft 3e Removes all database fields from the Table column(s) list box.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fallright 43 Moves all listed database fields into the Table column(s) list box.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftableformat 7e Opens the Table Format dialog, which enables you to define the table properties such as borders, background, and column width.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Foneleft 45 Removes the selected database field from the Table column(s) list box
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftablecols 3c Lists all database columns to be inserted into the document.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fuserdefined 63 Specifies a format from the list, if the format information of certain data fields is not accepted.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Foneright 44 Moves the selected database field into the Table column(s) list box.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Ftabledbcols 42 Specifies the database columns to be inserted into the text table.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fastable 50 Inserts data selected from the data source browser into the document as a table.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Finsertdbcolumnsdialog%2Fastext 4d Inserts data selected from the data source browser into the document as text.
17 .uno%3ADSBInsertContent 4b Updates the contents of the existing database fields by the marked records.
28 .uno%3ADataSourceBrowser%2FInsertContent 4b Updates the contents of the existing database fields by the marked records.
11 .uno%3AFilterCrit 28 Allows you to set the filtering options.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DLG_FILTERCRIT 28 Allows you to set the filtering options.
31 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3AET_WHEREVALUE3 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
31 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3AET_WHEREVALUE2 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fval3 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fval1 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fcond1 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOMP2 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fcond3 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fval2 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Ffield1 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOMP1 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fcond2 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
34 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHEREFIELD3 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOND2 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Ffield3 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
34 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHEREFIELD2 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOND3 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Ffield2 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fconnect2 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2Fconnect1 53 For the following arguments, you can choose between the logical operators AND / OR.
42 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fstandardfilterdialog%2FStandardFilterDialog 3b Specifies the logical conditions to filter your table data.
34 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHEREFIELD1 4d Specifies the field names from the current table to set them in the argument.
31 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3AET_WHEREVALUE1 26 Specifies a value to filter the field.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_FILTERCRIT%3ALB_WHERECOMP3 6f Specifies the comparative operators through which the entries in the Field name and Value fields can be linked.
1f .uno%3ADataFilterStandardFilter 3b Specifies the logical conditions to filter your table data.
10 .uno%3AOrderCrit 31 Specifies the sort criteria for the data display.
1a DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ORDERCRIT 31 Specifies the sort criteria for the data display.
18 CUI_HID_SEARCH_BTN_CLOSE 5d Closes the dialog. The settings of the last search will be saved until you quit %PRODUCTNAME.
17 CUI_HID_SEARCH_POSITION 45 Specifies the relationship of the search term and the field contents.
19 CUI_HID_SEARCH_BTN_SEARCH 1d Starts or cancels the search.
18 CUI_HID_SEARCH_ALLFIELDS 1c Searches through all fields.
17 CUI_HID_SEARCH_WILDCARD 27 Allows a search with a * or ? wildcard.
16 CUI_HID_SEARCH_REGULAR 22 Searches with regular expressions.
17 CUI_HID_SEARCH_BACKWARD 63 Specifies that the search process will run in reverse direction, from the last to the first record.
13 CUI_HID_SEARCH_TEXT 3c Enter the search term in the box or select it from the list.
13 CUI_HID_SEARCH_CASE 53 Specifies that upper and lower case are taken into consideration during the search.
18 CUI_HID_SEARCH_FORMATTER 57 Specifies that all field formats are considered when searching in the current document.
18 CUI_HID_SEARCH_STARTOVER 77 Restarts the search. A forward search restarts with the first record. A backwards search restarts with the last record.
3a cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ARB_SINGLEFIELD 28 Searches through a specified data field.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ARB_SEARCHFORNULL 39 Specifies that fields will be found that contain no data.
1d CUI_HID_SEARCH_FIELDSELECTION 28 Searches through a specified data field.
3f cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ARB_SEARCHFORNOTNULL 36 Specifies that fields will be found that contain data.
2f cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ALB_FORM 46 Specifies the logical form in which you want the search to take place.
3c cui%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_SEARCHFORM%3ARB_SEARCHFORTEXT 3c Enter the search term in the box or select it from the list.
10 .uno%3ARecSearch 23 Searches database tables and forms.
11 .uno%3AFormFilter 4d Prompts the database server to filter the visible data by specified criteria.
13 .uno%3AFormFiltered 3f Switches between the filtered and unfiltered view of the table.
15 .uno%3AViewFormAsGrid 39 Activates an additional table view when in the form view.
1c .uno%3ADSBDocumentDataSource 57 Displays, in the data source browser, the table that is linked to the current document.
2d .uno%3ADataSourceBrowser%2FDocumentDataSource 57 Displays, in the data source browser, the table that is linked to the current document.
14 .uno%3ASbaExecuteSql 31 Runs the SQL query and displays the query result.
13 .uno%3ADBClearQuery 3f Clears the query and removes all tables from the design window.
35 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ADLG_JOIN_TABADD%3APB_ADDTABLE 25 Inserts the currently selected table.
20 DBACCESS_HID_JOINSH_ADDTAB_CLOSE 1d Closes the Add Tables dialog.
3a dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_JOIN_TABADD%3ARB_CASE_QUERIES 13 Shows only queries.
39 dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_JOIN_TABADD%3ARB_CASE_TABLES 12 Shows only tables.
24 DBACCESS_HID_JOINSH_ADDTAB_TABLELIST 3b Specifies the tables to be inserted into the design window.
f .uno%3AAddTable 3b Specifies the tables to be inserted into the design window.
19 .uno%3ADBChangeDesignMode 36 Displays the design view or the SQL view of the query.
13 .uno%3ASbaNativeSql 8c In Native SQL mode you can enter SQL commands that are not interpreted by $[officename], but are instead passed directly to the data source.
16 .uno%3ADBViewFunctions 5c Displays the "Function" row in the lower part of the design view of the Query Design window.
17 .uno%3ADBViewTableNames 3f Displays the "Table" row in the lower part of the Query Design.
14 .uno%3ADBViewAliases 3f Displays the "Alias" row in the lower part of the Query Design.
17 .uno%3ADBDistinctValues 66 Expands the created select statement of the SQL Query in the current column by the parameter DISTINCT.
13 .uno%3ASelectObject 35 Allows you to select objects in the current document.
11 .uno%3ASourceView 9b Displays the source text of the current HTML document. To view the HTML source of a new document, you must first save the new document as an HTML document.
11 SW_HID_SOURCEVIEW 9b Displays the source text of the current HTML document. To view the HTML source of a new document, you must first save the new document as an HTML document.
13 .uno%3ALayoutStatus 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style.
16 .uno%3AStatusPageStyle 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style.
14 .uno%3APageStyleName 65 Displays the current Page Style. Double-click to edit the style, right-click to select another style.
10 .uno%3AStateZoom 2f Specifies the current page display zoom factor.
11 .uno%3AInsertMode 5d Displays the current insert mode. You can toggle between INSRT = insert and OVER = overwrite.
1a .uno%3AStatusSelectionMode 36 Here you can switch between different selection modes.
14 .uno%3ASelectionMode 36 Here you can switch between different selection modes.
13 .uno%3AModifyStatus 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents.
f .uno%3AModified 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents.
15 .uno%3AModifiedStatus 9a If changes to the document have not yet been saved, a "*" is displayed in this field on the Status Bar. This also applies to new, not yet saved documents.
12 .uno%3ACurrentTime 1a Displays the current time.
12 .uno%3ACurrentDate 1a Displays the current date.
4a cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_MOSAIC%3ADLG_FILTERMOSAIC_CBX_EDGES 2f Enhances, or sharpens, the edges of the object.
4e cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_MOSAIC%3ADLG_FILTERMOSAIC_MTR_HEIGHT 2b Defines the height of the individual tiles.
4d cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_MOSAIC%3ADLG_FILTERMOSAIC_MTR_WIDTH 2a Defines the width of the individual tiles.
19 .uno%3AGraphicFilterSobel 7e Displays the image as a charcoal sketch. The contours of the image are drawn in black, and the original colors are suppressed.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterMosaic 46 Joins small groups of pixels into rectangular areas of the same color.
4b cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_SEPIA%3ADLG_FILTERSEPIA_MTR_SEPIA 84 Defines the intensity of aging, in percent. At 0% you see the gray values of all pixels. At 100% only the red color channel remains.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterPopart 26 Converts an image to a pop-art format.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterPoster 38 Opens a dialog to determine the number of poster colors.
19 .uno%3AGraphicFilterSepia a0 All pixels are set to their gray values, and then the green and blue color channels are reduced by the amount you specify. The red color channel is not changed.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterSmooth 39 Softens or blurs the image by applying a low pass filter.
55 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_SOLARIZE%3ADLG_FILTERSOLARIZE_MTR_THRESHOLD 5b Specifies the degree of brightness, in percent, above which the pixels are to be solarized.
1c .uno%3AGraphicFilterSolarize c4 Opens a dialog for defining solarization. Solarization refers to an effect that looks like what can happen when there is too much light during photo development. The colors become partly inverted.
1b .uno%3AGraphicFilterToolbox 75 This icon on the Picture bar opens the Graphic Filter bar, where you can use various filters on the selected picture.
4f cui%3ANumericField%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_POSTER%3ADLG_FILTERPOSTER_NUM_POSTER 43 Specifies the number of colors to which the image is to be reduced.
1f .uno%3AGraphicFilterRemoveNoise 2a Removes noise by applying a median filter.
4f cui%3ACheckBox%3ARID_SVX_GRFFILTER_DLG_SOLARIZE%3ADLG_FILTERSOLARIZE_CBX_INVERT 24 Specifies to also invert all pixels.
1b .uno%3AGraphicFilterSharpen 32 Sharpens the image by applying a high pass filter.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterInvert 86 Inverts the color values of a color image, or the brightness values of a grayscale image. Apply the filter again to revert the effect.
1a .uno%3AGraphicFilterRelief 27 Displays a dialog for creating reliefs.
f .uno%3AGrafMode a2 Lists view attributes for the selected graphic object. The embedded or linked graphic object in the current file will not be changed, only the view of the object.
e .uno%3AGrafRed 55 Specifies the proportion of red RGB color components for the selected graphic object.
10 .uno%3AGrafGreen 57 Specifies the proportion of green RGB color components for the selected graphic object.
f .uno%3AGrafBlue 4f Specifies the proportion of blue RGB color components for the selected graphic.
14 .uno%3AGrafLuminance 39 Specifies the brightness for the selected graphic object.
13 .uno%3AGrafContrast 3e Specifies the contrast for viewing the selected graphic image.
10 .uno%3AGrafGamma 72 Specifies the gamma value for the view of the selected object, which affects the brightness of the midtone values.
17 .uno%3AGrafTransparence 31 Specifies the transparency in the graphic object.
b .uno%3ACrop 3b Drag any of the eight cropping handles to crop the picture.
13 .uno%3AGrafAttrCrop 76 Allows to crop the display of an inserted picture. Only the display gets cropped, the inserted picture is not changed.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.frame 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.paper 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ABasicShapes.cube 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3ABasicShapes.can 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ABasicShapes.cross 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1b .uno%3ABasicShapes.pentagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.block-arc 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.diamond 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.trapezoid 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3ABasicShapes.isosceles-triangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3ABasicShapes.round-rectangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.octagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ABasicShapes.parallelogram 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3ABasicShapes.circle-pie 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.ellipse 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ABasicShapes.ring 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ABasicShapes.circle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.hexagon 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ABasicShapes.round-quadrat 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ABasicShapes.quadrat 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ABasicShapes.right-triangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1c .uno%3ABasicShapes.rectangle 5b Click an icon on the Basic Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
12 .uno%3ABasicShapes 57 Opens the Basic Shapes toolbar which you can use to insert graphics into your document.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.circular-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.quad-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-down--arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2b .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
24 .uno%3AArrowShapes.split-round-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.right-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3AArrowShapes.s-sharped-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3AArrowShapes.chevron 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.pentagon-right 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.striped-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.down-arrow-callout 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3AArrowShapes.right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AArrowShapes.notched-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
12 .uno%3AArrowShapes 55 Opens the Block Arrows toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.left-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3AArrowShapes.split-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.down-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1b .uno%3AArrowShapes.up-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AArrowShapes.corner-right-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3AArrowShapes.quad-arrow 59 Click an icon from the Block Arrows toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-2 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.cloud-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2e .uno%3ACalloutShapes.round-rectangular-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-1 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
22 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.round-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.rectangular-callout 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3ACalloutShapes.line-callout-3 55 Click an icon from the Callouts toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
14 .uno%3ACalloutShapes 51 Opens the Callouts toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
14 .uno%3AColorSettings 4b With the Color toolbar you can edit some properties of the selected object.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-display 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-delay 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-extract 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-sort 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2e .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-magnetic-disk 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-or 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2c .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-stored-data 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
26 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-merge 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-summing-junction 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
36 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-direct-access-storage 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
33 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-off-page-connector 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-card 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2c .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-preparation 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-document 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2b .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-terminator 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2a .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-connector 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2d .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-manual-input 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-internal-storage 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
33 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-predefined-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
28 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-collate 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2e .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-multidocument 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
31 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-manual-operation 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
25 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-data 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
2d .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-punched-tape 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
32 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-sequential-access 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
29 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-decision 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
32 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes.flowchart-alternate-process 56 Click an icon from the Flowchart toolbar, then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3AFlowChartShapes 52 Opens the Flowchart toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
1d .uno%3AFontworkGalleryFloater 64 The icon opens the Fontwork Gallery from which you can insert graphical text art into your document.
e .uno%3ADBLimit 4b Expands the created select statement of the SQL Query by the LIMIT X clause
17 .uno%3AFormatPaintbrush 9b Najskôr označte text alebo objekt a potom kliknite na túto ikonu. Následným kliknutím na iný text nebo iný objekt vložíte rovnaké formátovanie.
33 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fquerypropertiesdialog%2Fnondistinct 21 Not use distinct values in query.
30 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fquerypropertiesdialog%2Fdistinct 1d Use distinct values in query.
3d dbaccess%2Fui%2Fquerypropertiesdialog%2FQueryPropertiesDialog 1d Use distinct values in query.
1b .uno%3AStarShapes.doorplate 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.signet 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
23 .uno%3AStarShapes.horizontal-scroll 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3AStarShapes.vertical-scroll 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1f .uno%3AStarShapes.concave-star6 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.star24 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3AStarShapes.star12 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star6 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star5 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star4 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3AStarShapes.star8 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
16 .uno%3AStarShapes.bang 60 Click an icon on the Stars and Banners toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
11 .uno%3AStarShapes 5a Opens the Stars and Banners toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.octagon-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.quad-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.right-bracket 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.bracket-pair 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
20 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.left-bracket 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1f .uno%3ASymbolShapes.right-brace 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
21 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.diamond-bevel 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.cloud 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
19 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.heart 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3ASymbolShapes.forbidden 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.flower 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.left-brace 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.puzzle 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
18 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.moon 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
17 .uno%3ASymbolShapes.sun 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1e .uno%3ASymbolShapes.brace-pair 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1a .uno%3ASymbolShapes.smiley 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
1d .uno%3ASymbolShapes.lightning 5c Click an icon on the Symbol Shapes toolbar, and then drag in the document to draw the shape.
13 .uno%3ASymbolShapes 56 Opens the Symbol Shapes toolbar from which you can insert graphics into your document.
15 SFX2_HID_HELP_LISTBOX 5d The list box located at the very top is where you can select other %PRODUCTNAME Help modules.
30 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3ACB_WRAPAROUND 4e Searches the entire Help page, starting at the current position of the cursor.
2f sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3ACB_MATCHCASE 38 Distinguishes between uppercase text and lowercase text.
30 sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3ACB_WHOLEWORDS 1a Finds complete words only.
2f sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3ACB_BACKWARDS 3b Searches backwards from the current position of the cursor.
2c sfx2%3AComboBox%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3AED_SEARCH 4e Enter the text that you want to search for or select a text entry in the list.
23 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_BOOKMARKS 20 Adds this page to your bookmarks
18 SFX2_HID_HELP_TABCONTROL 62 The navigation pane of the Help window contains the tab pages Contents, Index, Find and Bookmarks.
2c sfx2%3APushButton%3ARID_DLG_SEARCH%3APB_FIND 2d Finds the next occurrence of the search term.
1f SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_PRINT 17 Prints the current page
1f SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_START 31 Moves to the first page of the current Help topic
26 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_SEARCHDIALOG 23 Opens the Find on this page dialog.
21 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_FORWARD 1e Moves forward to the next page
22 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_BACKWARD 1f Moves back to the previous page
1f SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOXITEM_INDEX 23 Hides and shows the navigation pane
15 SFX2_HID_HELP_TOOLBOX 48 The Toolbar contains important functions for controlling the Help system
11 .uno%3AHelpOnHelp 27 Provides an overview of the Help system
31 sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_HELP_INDEX%3APB_OPEN_INDEX 24 Click to display the selected topic.
2a sfx2%3AComboBox%3ATP_HELP_INDEX%3ACB_INDEX 45 Double-click an entry or type the word you want to find in the index.
33 sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3APB_OPEN_SEARCH 28 Displays the entry selected in the list.
2b sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3ACB_SCOPE 4a Specifies whether to only search in document headings for the search term.
2f sfx2%3ACheckBox%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3ACB_FULLWORDS 6c Specifies whether to carry out an exact search for the word you entered. Incomplete words will not be found.
2b sfx2%3AListBox%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3ALB_RESULT 6a Lists the headings of the pages found in your full-text search. To display a page, double-click its entry.
2e sfx2%3APushButton%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3APB_SEARCH 3b Click to start a full-text search for the term you entered.
2c sfx2%3AComboBox%3ATP_HELP_SEARCH%3AED_SEARCH 3d Enter the search term here. The search is not case-sensitive.
1e SFX2_HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_DELETE 1d deletes the bookmark selected
1e SFX2_HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_RENAME 39 opens a dialog for entering another name for the bookmark
1c SFX2_HID_HELP_BOOKMARKS_OPEN 22 displays the selected help subject
31 sfx2%3AListBox%3ATP_HELP_BOOKMARKS%3ALB_BOOKMARKS 7c Double-clicking a bookmark or pressing the Return key opens the assigned page in Help. A right-click opens the context menu.
36 sfx2%3AEdit%3ADLG_HELP_ADDBOOKMARK%3AED_BOOKMARK_TITLE 58 Displays the name of the bookmarked page. You can also type a new name for the bookmark.
1e SFX2_HID_HELP_TABPAGE_CONTENTS 56 Displays the main help themes, arranged in a similar way to folders in a file manager.
17 .uno%3AExtrusion3DColor 1d Otvorí okno Farba vysunutia.
1f .uno%3AExtrusionLightingFloater 18 Otvorí okno Osvetlenie.
1a SVX_HID_POPUP_LINEEND_CTRL d Zvoľte smer.
20 .uno%3AExtrusionDirectionFloater 1c Otvorí okno Smer vysunutia.
1c .uno%3AExtrusionDepthFloater 1e Otvorí okno Hĺbka vysunutia.
19 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltRight 31 Nakloní vybraný objekt vpravo o päť stupňov.
16 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltUp 37 Nakloní vybraný objekt smerom nahor o päť stupňov.
18 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltLeft 31 Nakloní vybraný objekt vľavo o päť stupňov.
18 .uno%3AExtrusionTiltDown 37 Nakloní vybraný objekt smerom nadol o päť stupňov.
1e .uno%3AExtrusionSurfaceFloater 14 Otvorí okno Povrch.
3c svx%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVX_MDLG_EXTRUSION_DEPTH%3AMTR_DEPTH 19 Zadajte hĺbku vysunutia.
16 .uno%3AExtrusionToggle 3f Zapne alebo vypne používanie 3D efektov pre vybrané objekty.
14 .uno%3AAutoPilotMenu 67 Prevedú vás vytvorením pracovných a osobných listov, faxov, programov, prezentácií a ďalších.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDNEXT 3f Uloží aktuálne nastavenia a pokračuje na ďalšiu stránku.
1c WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZARD_CREATE 73 V závislosti na vašich voľbách sprievodca vytvorí novú šablónu dokumentu a uloží ju na váš pevný disk.
1c EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT_NEXT 3f Uloží aktuálne nastavenia a pokračuje na ďalšiu stránku.
1a WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZARD_NEXT 3f Uloží aktuálne nastavenia a pokračuje na ďalšiu stránku.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDPREV 39 Umožnia vám zobraziť voľby predchádzajúcich krokov.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT_PREVIOUS 39 Umožnia vám zobraziť voľby predchádzajúcich krokov.
1a WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZARD_BACK 39 Umožnia vám zobraziť voľby predchádzajúcich krokov.
38 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.letter.CallWizard%3Fstart 2e Spustí sprievodcu a vytvorí šablónu listu.
16 .uno%3AAutoPilotLetter 2e Spustí sprievodcu a vytvorí šablónu listu.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTPRIVATESTYLE 2a Vyberte vzhľad pre vašu šablónu listu.
27 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTPRIVOFFICIALSTYLE 2a Vyberte vzhľad pre vašu šablónu listu.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTBUSINESSSTYLE 2a Vyberte vzhľad pre vašu šablónu listu.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTPRIVATELETTER 2d Spresnite, či chcete vytvoriť osobný list.
28 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTPRIVOFFICIALLETTER 37 Spresnite, či chcete vytvoriť formálny osobný list.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKBUSINESSPAPER 97 Spresnite, či použitý papier obsahuje logo, adresu alebo pätu stránky. Sprievodca zobrazí vzhľad hlavičkového papiera na nasledujúcej strane.
24 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTBUSINESSLETTER 3c Spresnite, či chcete vytvoriť šablónu pracovného listu.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE1 3c Spresnite či chcete vytvoriť osobný alebo pracovný list.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMFOOTERHEIGHT 7f Zadajte výšku oblasti päty, ktorá je už predtlačená na hlavičkovom papieri. %PRODUCTNAME nebude tlačiť túto oblasť.
25 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKCOMPANYRECEIVER 6a Určuje, či je už vaša adresa predtlačená nad adresou adresáta. %PRODUCTNAME nebude tlačiť adresu.
29 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERCOMPANYADDRESS 66 Určuje, či je na hlavičkovom papieri už predtlačená adresa. %PRODUCTNAME nebude tlačiť adresu.
1e WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMADDRESSX 3b Nastavuje vzdialenosť objektu od ľavého okraja stránky.
1b WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOX 3b Nastavuje vzdialenosť objektu od ľavého okraja stránky.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMADDRESSWIDTH 18 Určuje šírku objektu.
1f WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOWIDTH 18 Určuje šírku objektu.
1e WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMADDRESSY 3b Nastavuje vzdialenosť objektu od horného okraja stránky.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOHEIGHT 18 Určuje výšku objektu.
21 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERFOOTER 64 Určuje, či je už na hlavičkovom papieri predtlačená päta. %PRODUCTNAME nebude tlačiť pätu.
1b WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMLOGOY 3b Nastavuje vzdialenosť objektu od horného okraja stránky.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_NUMADDRESSHEIGHT 18 Určuje výšku objektu.
26 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKPAPERCOMPANYLOGO 5f Spresnite, či je na hlavičkovom papieri už predtlačené logo. %PRODUCTNAME netlačiť logo.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE2 4f Umožňuje určiť prvky, ktoré sú už predtlačené na hlavičkovom papieri.
1f WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEFOOTER 1f Šablóna listu obsahuje pätu.
1e WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTGREETING 4e Obsahuje zdvorilostné zakončenie v šablóne listu. Vyberte text zo zoznamu.
21 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEGREETING 4e Obsahuje zdvorilostné zakončenie v šablóne listu. Vyberte text zo zoznamu.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEBENDMARKS 29 Obsahuje značky ohybu v šablóne listu.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_LSTSALUTATION 43 Obsahuje oslovenie v šablóne listu. Vyberte oslovenie zo zoznamu.
23 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESALUTATION 43 Obsahuje oslovenie v šablóne listu. Vyberte oslovenie zo zoznamu.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESUBJECT 2b Obsahuje riadok predmetu v šablóne listu.
1e WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSESIGNS 3e Obsahuje riadok s odkazom na pracovný list v šablóne listu.
28 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSEADDRESSRECEIVER 40 Obsahuje   spiatočnú adresu malej veľkosti v šablóne listu.
1d WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKUSELOGO 20 Obsahuje logo v šablóne listu.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE3 41 Určuje položky, ktoré majú byť zahrnuté do šablóny listu.
29 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTRECEIVERPLACEHOLDER 3a Určuje, či šablóna listu obsahuje pole pre vlastníka.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERCITY 1d Určuje adresu odosielateľa.
26 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERSTATE_TEXT 1d Určuje adresu odosielateľa.
26 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTRECEIVERDATABASE 37 Do šablóny listu sa vložia polia z databázy adries.
24 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERPOSTCODE 1d Určuje adresu odosielateľa.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERSTREET 1c Určuje ulicu odosielateľa.
20 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTSENDERNAME 1b Určuje meno odosielateľa.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTSENDERDEFINE 41 Použiť informácie o adrese z následujúcich textových polí.
27 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTSENDERPLACEHOLDER 4d Use the address data from %PRODUCTNAME - User Data in the Options dialog box.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE4 3b Spresňuje informácie o odosielateľovi a prijímateľovi.
27 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKFOOTERPAGENUMBERS 28 Šablóna listu obsahuje čísla strán.
25 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CHKFOOTERNEXTPAGES 1d Skryť pätu na prvej strane.
1c WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTFOOTER 17 Vložte text pre pätu.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE5 43 Určuje informácie, ktoré majú byť zahrnuté v priestore päty.
21 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTMAKECHANGES 3f Uloží šablónu a ponechá ju otvorenú pre ďalšie úpravy.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_OPTCREATELETTER 5e Uložiť a zavrieť šablónu a otvoriť nový nepomenovaný dokument založený na šablóne.
1a WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_CMDPATH 5f Zadajte cestu a meno šablóny alebo kliknite na tlačidlo ... pre výber mena cesty k súboru.
22 WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTTEMPLATENAME 23 Určuje názov šablóny dokumentu.
1a WIZARDS_HID_LTRWIZ_TXTPATH 5f Zadajte cestu a meno šablóny alebo kliknite na tlačidlo ... pre výber mena cesty k súboru.
13 SW_HID_LETTER_PAGE6 42 Určuje kde a pod akým menom bude dokument a šablóna uložená.
1a WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_NEXT 80 Sprievodca uloží aktuálne nastavenia a prejde na ďalšiu stranu. Tlačidlo Ďalšia sa stane na poslednej strane neaktívne.
1c WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_CREATE b2 Podľa zvolených nastavení sprievodca vytvorí šablónu dokumentu a uloží ju. Na pracovnej ploche sa objaví nový dokument založený na šablóne s názvom "Bez názvu X".
35 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.fax.CallWizard%3Fstart 1c Otvorí sprievodcu pre faxy.
1a WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZARD_BACK d6 Pre zobrazenie zvolených nastavení z predchádzajúcej strany kliknite na tlačidlo Späť. Aktuálne nastavenia ostanú po kliknutí na toto tlačidlo nezmenené. Tlačidlo Späť bude aktívne od druhej strany.
13 .uno%3AAutoPilotFax 1c Otvorí sprievodcu pre faxy.
1b WIZARDS_HID_LSTPRIVATESTYLE 1f Určuje preddefinovaný štýl.
20 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_OPTPRIVATEFAX 2b Vytvára šablónu faxu pre súkromný fax.
23 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_LSTBUSINESSSTYLE 1f Určuje preddefinovaný štýl.
21 WIZARDS_HID_FAXWIZ_OPTBUSINESSFAX 37 Vytvára šablónu faxu pre pracovne štylizovaný fax.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE1 2c Definuje štýl vášho faxového dokumentu.
1b WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERSTREET e Vloží pätu.
20 WIZARDS_HID_OPTSENDERPLACEHOLDER 2c Vloží pozdrav. Vyberte pozdrav zo zoznamu.
18 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSEFOOTER 2c Vloží pozdrav. Vyberte pozdrav zo zoznamu.
1b WIZARDS_HID_OPTSENDERDEFINE 2c Vloží pozdrav. Vyberte pozdrav zo zoznamu.
17 WIZARDS_HID_LSTGREETING 18 Vloží riadok predmetu.
19 WIZARDS_HID_LSTSALUTATION 3d Vloží riadok komunikačného typu. Vyberte text zo zoznamu.
1a WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSEGREETING 3d Vloží riadok komunikačného typu. Vyberte text zo zoznamu.
1c WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSESALUTATION 18 Obsahuje pole na dátum.
19 WIZARDS_HID_CHKUSESUBJECT 1b Obsahuje logo spoločnosti.
19 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERNAME 2c Vloží pozdrav. Vyberte pozdrav zo zoznamu.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE2 32 Určuje, ktoré prvky faxu majú byť vytlačené.
1c WIZARDS_HID_FILETEMPLATEPATH 57 Vloží databázové polia, ktoré sa použijú neskôr pri hromadnej korešpondencií.
20 WIZARDS_HID_CHKFOOTERPAGENUMBERS 1d Vložte adresu odosielateľa.
1e WIZARDS_HID_CHKFOOTERNEXTPAGES 1d Vložte adresu odosielateľa.
22 WIZARDS_HID_OPTRECEIVERPLACEHOLDER 1d Vložte adresu odosielateľa.
18 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERFAX 1d Vložte adresu odosielateľa.
1b WIZARDS_HID_TXTTEMPLATENAME 83 Vloží do šablóny faxu zástupné pole pre adresu. Neskôr v dokumentu kliknite na zástupné pole a zadajte skutočné hodnoty.
19 WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERCITY 7a Vyberte, ak chcete zadať adresu do následujúcich textových polí. Údaje sa do fax dokumentu vložia ako bežný text.
15 WIZARDS_HID_TXTFOOTER 1d Vložte adresu odosielateľa.
1f WIZARDS_HID_OPTRECEIVERDATABASE 1d Vložte adresu odosielateľa.
1a WIZARDS_HID_TXTSENDERSTATE 83 Vloží do šablóny faxu zástupné pole pre adresu. Neskôr v dokumentu kliknite na zástupné pole a zadajte skutočné hodnoty.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE3 27 Určuje príjemcu a odosielateľa faxu.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE4 16 Určuje dáta v päte.
10 SW_HID_FAX_PAGE5 26 Definuje meno a umiestnenie šablóny.
38 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.agenda.CallWizard%3Fstart 44 Spustí sprievodcu, ktorý vám pomôže vytvoriť šablónu porady.
16 .uno%3AAutoPilotAgenda 44 Spustí sprievodcu, ktorý vám pomôže vytvoriť šablónu porady.
1f WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_1_CHK_MINUTES 4b Vytlačí stranu, na ktorej si môžete robiť poznámky v priebehu porady.
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_1_LIST_PAGEDESIGN 24 Zo zoznamu vyberte vzhľad stránky.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE1 22 Určuje vzhľad strany pre poradu.
20 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_LOCATION 1a Určuje miesto stretnutia.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_TIME 18 Určuje čas stretnutia.
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_TITLE 1a Určuje nadpis stretnutia.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_2_TXT_DATE 1a Určuje dátum stretnutia.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE2 31 Určuje dátum, čas, názov a miesto stretnutia.
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_NOTES 30 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok Poznámky.
1d WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_BRING 32 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok Prineste si.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_READ 38 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok prosím čítajte.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_3_CHK_MEETING_TYPE 35 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok typ stretnutia.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE3 35 Určuje záhlavia, ktoré chcete zahrnúť do porady.
27 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_RESOURCEPERSONS 58 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno účastníkov.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_OBSERVERS 59 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno pozorovateľov.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_ATTENDEES 57 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno pracovníkov.
22 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_TIMEKEEPER 56 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno moderátora.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_NOTETAKER 58 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno zapisovateľa.
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_FACILITATOR 5f Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno predsedajúcej osoby.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_4_CHK_CALLED_BY 67 Určuje, či sa má vytlačiť riadok, do ktorého môžete vložiť meno osoby, ktorá poradu zvolala.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE4 36 Určuje mená, ktoré majú byť vytlačené v porade.
1a WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_UP 2c Posunie vyššie aktuálnu tému programu ..
1e WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_REMOVE 23 Odstráni aktuálnu tému programu.
25 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_RESPONSIBLE_1 57 Zadajte témy programu. Pre zmenu poradia tém programu použite tlačidla Hore a Dole.
1c WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_DOWN 2b Presunie nižšie aktuálnu tému programu.
1e WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_BTN_INSERT 36 Vloží prázdny riadok pre tému za aktuálny riadok.
1f WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_TOPIC_1 57 Zadajte témy programu. Pre zmenu poradia tém programu použite tlačidla Hore a Dole.
21 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_5_TXT_MINUTES_1 57 Zadajte témy programu. Pre zmenu poradia tém programu použite tlačidla Hore a Dole.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE5 46 Určuje témy programu, ktoré sa majú v šablóne porady vytlačiť.
23 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_OPT_MAKECHANGES 52 Vytvorí a uloží šablónu porady, potom otvorí šablónu pre ďalšie úpravy.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_OPT_CREATEAGENDA 70 Vytvorí a uloží šablónu porady, potom otvorí nový dokument programu porady založený na tejto šablóne.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_BTN_TEMPLATEPATH 40 Určuje úplnú cestu, vrátane názvu súboru šablóny porady.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_TXT_TEMPLATEPATH 40 Určuje úplnú cestu, vrátane názvu súboru šablóny porady.
24 WIZARDS_HID_AGWIZ_6_TXT_TEMPLATENAME 1e Určuje meno šablóny porady.
13 SW_HID_AGENDA_PAGE6 32 Vyberte nadpis a umiestnenie pre šablónu porady.
24 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ABUT_NEXT 3b Akceptuje nové nastavenia a presune sa na ďalšiu stranu.
24 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ABUT_LAST 45 Vráti sa na predchádzajúci krok bez straty aktuálnych nastavení.
16 .uno%3ANewPresentation 8d Použiť sprievodcu na interaktívne vytvorenie prezentácie. So sprievodcom môžete upravovať ukážkové šablóny podľa vašich potrieb
1d .uno%3AAutoPilotPresentations 8d Použiť sprievodcu na interaktívne vytvorenie prezentácie. So sprievodcom môžete upravovať ukážkové šablóny podľa vašich potrieb
c slot%3A10425 8d Použiť sprievodcu na interaktívne vytvorenie prezentácie. So sprievodcom môžete upravovať ukážkové šablóny podľa vašich potrieb
24 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ACB_PREVIEW 33 Určuje, či sa šablóna objaví v okne náhľadu.
18 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_OPEN 108 Lists the presentations that you created and saved to the Templates directory that is specified under %PRODUCTNAME - Paths in the Options dialog box. To edit the layout and formatting of a presentation with the wizard, select the presentation, and then click Next.
29 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_ASS%3APB_PAGE1_OPEN 3f Kliknutím na Otvoriť sa zobrazí dialóg pre výber súborov.
2a sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE1_OPEN 31 Zobrazí zoznam skôr vytvorených prezentácií.
1d SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_TEMPLATES 38 Vypíše dostupné kategórie šablón pre prezentácie.
1a SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_REGION 38 Vypíše dostupné kategórie šablón pre prezentácie.
2e sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE1_TEMPLATE 36 Otvorí zoznam obsahujúci upraviteľné prezentácie.
26 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ACB_STARTWITH 71 Specifies that you only want the Wizard to start when you expressly request it with File - Wizard - Presentation.
2b sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE1_EMPTY 27 Vytvára novú (prázdnu) prezentáciu.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE1 36 Určuje typ prezentácie a umožní vybrať šablónu.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM2 39 Vytvára prezentáciu, ktorá bude použitá ako snímky.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM1 3f Vytvára prezentáciu určenú len na premietania na obrazovke.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM4 40 Vytvorí prezentáciu, ktorá môže byť vytlačená na papier.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM5 2f Použije sa pôvodný formát strany šablóny.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE2_MEDIUM3 40 Vytvorí prezentáciu na priehľadný materiál pre premietanie.
28 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ALB_PAGE2_LAYOUT 63 Dovoľuje vám vybrať vzhľad snímok prezentácie, ktorú ste vybrali na prvej strane sprievodcu.
21 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGETEMPLATES 63 Dovoľuje vám vybrať vzhľad snímok prezentácie, ktorú ste vybrali na prvej strane sprievodcu.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE2 63 Dovoľuje vám vybrať vzhľad snímok prezentácie, ktorú ste vybrali na prvej strane sprievodcu.
2a sd%3ATimeField%3ADLG_ASS%3ATMF_PAGE3_BREAK 30 Definuje prestávku medzi každou prezentáciou.
29 sd%3ATimeField%3ADLG_ASS%3ATMF_PAGE3_TIME 35 Definuje dĺžku trvania každej strany prezentácie.
2b sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE3_KIOSK 49 Runs the presentation automatically, and restarts it again after a break.
2a sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_ASS%3ARB_PAGE3_LIVE 56 Možnosť Základné spustí prezentáciu cez celú obrazovku s určenou rýchlosťou.
27 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ACB_PAGE3_LOGO 55 Určuje, či sa má v prestávkach medzi prezentáciami zobraziť $[officename] logo.
27 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ALB_PAGE3_SPEED 1b Nastaví rýchlosť efektu.
28 sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ALB_PAGE3_EFFECT 23 Určuje vašej prezentácií efekt.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE3 49 Priradí vašej prezentácií špeciálne efekty a určí jej rýchlosť.
37 sd%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_ASS%3AEDT_PAGE4_ASKINFORMATION 6a Toto pole použite pre zaznamenanie myšlienok a nápadov, ktoré chcete povedať vo vašej prezentácií.
28 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_ASS%3AEDT_PAGE4_ASKTOPIC 22 Určuje tému vašej prezentácie.
27 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_ASS%3AEDT_PAGE4_ASKNAME 32 Určuje vaše meno alebo meno vašej spoločnosti.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE4 32 Určuje vaše meno alebo meno vašej spoločnosti.
2a sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_ASS%3ACB_PAGE5_SUMMARY 3e Vytvorí súhrn všetkých zahrnutých strán v prezentácií.
19 SD_HID_SD_AUTOPILOT_PAGE5 3e Vytvorí súhrn všetkých zahrnutých strán v prezentácií.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDFINISH 44 Kliknutím vytvoríte formulár bez zodpovedania ďalších otázok.
1a WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_DIALOG 2b Aktivuje sprievodcu pre tvorbu formulárov.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_FIELDSSELECTED 22 Zobrazí polia v novom formulári.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEDOWN 36 Pre presunutie vybraného poľa nižšie kliknite sem.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEDOWN 36 Pre presunutie vybraného poľa nižšie kliknite sem.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEDOWN 36 Pre presunutie vybraného poľa nižšie kliknite sem.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEUP 2b Pre presunutie poľa vyššie kliknite sem.
19 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_DOC_DOWN 36 Pre presunutie vybraného poľa nižšie kliknite sem.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDREMOVEALL 40 Kliknutím presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVEALL 40 Kliknutím presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDREMOVEALL 40 Kliknutím presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEUP 2b Pre presunutie poľa vyššie kliknite sem.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEALL 40 Kliknutím presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVESELECTED 41 Kliknutím presuniete vybrané polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVEDOWN 36 Pre presunutie vybraného poľa nižšie kliknite sem.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEDOWN 36 Pre presunutie vybraného poľa nižšie kliknite sem.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
2c WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDREMOVESELECTED 41 Kliknutím presuniete vybrané polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
1e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEUP 2b Pre presunutie poľa vyššie kliknite sem.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDREMOVESELECTED 41 Kliknutím presuniete vybrané polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
17 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_DOC_UP 2b Pre presunutie poľa vyššie kliknite sem.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVESELECTED 40 Kliknutím  presuniete vybrané pole do poľa kam mieri šípka.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDS 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
2d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVESELECTED 40 Kliknutím  presuniete vybrané pole do poľa kam mieri šípka.
2c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEDOWN_PK_SELECTED 36 Pre presunutie vybraného poľa nižšie kliknite sem.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERMOVEUP 2b Pre presunutie poľa vyššie kliknite sem.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDREMOVESELECTED 41 Kliknutím presuniete vybrané polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVEALL 40 Kliknutím presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEUP_PK_SELECTED 2b Pre presunutie poľa vyššie kliknite sem.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVEALL 40 Kliknutím presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
2f WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDFILTERREMOVESELECTED 41 Kliknutím presuniete vybrané polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDS 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMOVESELECTED 40 Kliknutím  presuniete vybrané pole do poľa kam mieri šípka.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_CMDMOVESELECTED 40 Kliknutím  presuniete vybrané pole do poľa kam mieri šípka.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_MASTER_LBTABLES 36 Určuje tabuľku, z ktorej chcete vytvoriť formulár.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVEUP 2b Pre presunutie poľa vyššie kliknite sem.
24 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDREMOVEALL 40 Kliknutím presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_CMDMOVEALL 40 Kliknutím presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_CMDMOVESELECTED 40 Kliknutím  presuniete vybrané pole do poľa kam mieri šípka.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDSAVAILABLE 47 Lists the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTSELECTMANUALLY 4a Kliknite pre pridanie podformulára založeného na ručnom výbere polí.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_lstRELATIONS 37 Vyberte reláciu, na ktorej je podformulár založený.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTONEXISTINGRELATION 4b Kliknite pre pridanie podformulára založeného na existujúcej relácií.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKCREATESUBFORM 23 Vyberte pre pridanie podformulára.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_FIELDSSELECTED 45 Zobrazí všetky polia, ktoré budú zahrnuté v novom podformulári.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_SUB_LBTABLES 46 Určuje tabuľku alebo dotaz, pre ktorý bude podformulár vytvorený.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK4 72 Vyberte pole podformulára, ktoré bude spojené s poľom hlavného formulára vybraného z vedľajšieho zoznamu.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK3 72 Vyberte pole hlavného formulára, ktoré bude spojené s poľom podformulára vybraného z vedľajšieho zoznamu.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK3 72 Vyberte pole podformulára, ktoré bude spojené s poľom hlavného formulára vybraného z vedľajšieho zoznamu.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK2 72 Vyberte pole hlavného formulára, ktoré bude spojené s poľom podformulára vybraného z vedľajšieho zoznamu.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK2 72 Vyberte pole podformulára, ktoré bude spojené s poľom hlavného formulára vybraného z vedľajšieho zoznamu.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK1 72 Vyberte pole hlavného formulára, ktoré bude spojené s poľom podformulára vybraného z vedľajšieho zoznamu.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTMASTERLINK4 72 Vyberte pole hlavného formulára, ktoré bude spojené s poľom podformulára vybraného z vedľajšieho zoznamu.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LINKER_LSTSLAVELINK1 72 Vyberte pole podformulára, ktoré bude spojené s poľom hlavného formulára vybraného z vedľajšieho zoznamu.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTOPJUSTIFIED 2c Zarovná označenia nad odpovedajúce dáta.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTABLESTYLE 25 Zarovná polia databázy do tabuľky.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDTOPLABELED 3e Zarovná polia databázy do stĺpcov pričom popisky sú hore.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDLEFTLABELED 40 Zarovná polia databázy do stĺpcov pričom popisky sú vľavo.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDALIGNRIGHT 21 Označenia sú zarovnané vpravo.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDALIGNLEFT 21 Označenia sú zarovnané vľavo.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNOADDITION 2f Vyberte pre zákaz pridávania nových údajov.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNODELETION 23 Vyberte pre zákaz mazania údajov.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTDISPLAYALLDATA 72 Vytvorí formulár, ktorý sa bude používať na zobrazovanie existujúcich údajov ako aj na zadávanie nových.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CHKNOMODIFICATION 22 Vyberte pre zákaz úprav údajov.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTNEWDATAONLY 4f Vytvorí formulár, ktorý sa bude používať len pre zadávanie nových dát.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDSIMPLEBORDER 30 Určuje, že okraje polí majú plochý vzhľad.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMD3DBORDER 2b Určuje, že okraje polí majú 3D vzhľad.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_CMDNOBORDER 22 Určuje, že polia nemajú okraje.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_LSTSTYLES 21 Určuje štýl strany formulára.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTMODIFYFORM 37 Uloží formulár a otvorí ho pre úpravy rozvrhnutia.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_OPTWORKWITHFORM 5f Uloží formulár a otvorí ho ako formulárový dokument pre vkladanie a zobrazovanie údajov.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGFORM_TXTPATH 1a Určuje názov formulára.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_DIALOG 1b Vyberte vlastnosti správy.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DOCUMENT_CREATE_REPWIZ 28 Aktivuje sprievodcu vytvorením správy.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDREMOVEALL 41 Kliknutím  presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDMOVEALL 41 Kliknutím  presuniete všetky polia do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDMOVESELECTED 41 Kliknutím  presuniete vybrané pole do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_FIELDSSELECTED 32 Zobrazí všetky polia zahrnuté do novej správy.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_FIELDSAVAILABLE 4a Displays the names of the data base fields in the selected table or query.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_CMDREMOVESELECTED 41 Kliknutím  presuniete vybrané pole do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_1_LBTABLES 41 Vyberte tabuľku alebo dotaz, pre ktorý bude správa vytvorená.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_6 8d Zobrazuje názvy polí zahrnutých do správy. Pre každé pole, ktoré bude vytlačené v správe, je možné vpravo od neho vložiť popis.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_5 8d Zobrazuje názvy polí zahrnutých do správy. Pre každé pole, ktoré bude vytlačené v správe, je možné vpravo od neho vložiť popis.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_3 8d Zobrazuje názvy polí zahrnutých do správy. Pre každé pole, ktoré bude vytlačené v správe, je možné vpravo od neho vložiť popis.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_2 8d Zobrazuje názvy polí zahrnutých do správy. Pre každé pole, ktoré bude vytlačené v správe, je možné vpravo od neho vložiť popis.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_4 8d Zobrazuje názvy polí zahrnutých do správy. Pre každé pole, ktoré bude vytlačené v správe, je možné vpravo od neho vložiť popis.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_6_TXTTITLE_1 8d Zobrazuje názvy polí zahrnutých do správy. Pre každé pole, ktoré bude vytlačené v správe, je možné vpravo od neho vložiť popis.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_2_CMDUNGROUP 40 Kliknutím presuniete vybrané pole do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_2_PREGROUPINGDEST c2 Zobrazí polia, podľa ktorých bude správa zoskupená. Pre odobratie jednej úrovne zoskupenia vyberte názov poľa a kliknite na tlačidlo <. Je možné vybrať až štyri úrovne zoskupenia.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_2_CMDGROUP 40 Kliknutím presuniete vybrané pole do poľa, kam mieri šípka.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_2_GROUPING d5 Zobrazí zoznam polí vybraných na predchádzajúcej strane sprievodcu. Pre zoskupenie správ podľa poľa vyberte názov poľa v zozname a kliknite na tlačidlo >. Môžete vybrať až štyri úrovne zoskupení.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND4 1d Zoradí obsah polí zostupne.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND1 1d Zoradí obsah polí zostupne.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND3 1d Zoradí obsah polí zostupne.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND3 1e Zoradí obsah polí vzostupne.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND2 1e Zoradí obsah polí vzostupne.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND1 1e Zoradí obsah polí vzostupne.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTDESCEND2 1d Zoradí obsah polí zostupne.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT4 43 Vyberte dodatočné pole, podľa ktorého sa bude správa zoradiť.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT3 43 Vyberte dodatočné pole, podľa ktorého sa bude správa zoradiť.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_OPTASCEND4 1e Zoradí obsah polí vzostupne.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT2 43 Vyberte dodatočné pole, podľa ktorého sa bude správa zoradiť.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_3_SORT1 3d Vyberte prvé pole, podľa ktorého sa bude správa zoradiť.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_PORTRAIT 31 Zvolí orientáciu strany pre správu na výšku.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_LANDSCAPE 31 Zvolí orientáciu strany pre správu na šírku.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_PAGELAYOUT 90 Definuje vzhľad strany pre správu. Vzhľady strán sú načítané zo súborov šablón, ktoré priraďujú záhlavie, pätu a pozadie strany.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_DATALAYOUT 63 Definuje súbor štýlov pre správu. Štýly priraďujú písmo, odsadenie, pozadie tabuľky atď.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTUSETEMPLATE 2d Kliknutím na Dokončiť, sa správa uloží.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTEDITTEMPLATE 54 Kliknutím na Dokončiť, sa správa uloží a následne bude otvorená pre úpravy.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTDYNTEMPLATE 64 Uloží správu ako šablónu. Keď otvoríte dynamickú správu, budú zobrazené aktuálne údaje.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_5_OPTSTATDOCUMENT 7c Uloží správu ako statickú. Keď otvoríte takúto správu, vždy sa zobrazia údaje, z ktorých bola správa vytvorená.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGREPORT_4_TITLE 4b Určuje titulok, ktorý bude vytlačený na titulnom riadku každej strany.
33 sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE1_DEL_DESIGN 25 Odstráni vybraný návrh zo zoznamu.
2d sd%3AListBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE1_DESIGNS 25 Zobrazí všetky existujúce návrhy.
34 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE1_OLD_DESIGN 82 Zo zoznamu načíta existujúci návrh pre použitie ako počiatočný stav pre ďalšie kroky na ďalších stranách sprievodcu.
34 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE1_NEW_DESIGN 35 Vytvoriť nový návrh na ďalšej strane sprievodcu.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE1 35 Vytvoriť nový návrh na ďalšej strane sprievodcu.
26 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_CGI 4a Určuje URL (absolútnu alebo relatívnu) pre vygenerované skripty Perlu.
28 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_INDEX 55 Určuje URL  (absolútnu alebo relatívnu), ktorú musia zadať diváci prezentácie.
26 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_URL 5f Určuje URL (absolútnu alebo relatívnu), kde bude na WWW serveru HTML prezentácia uložená.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_WEBCAST 61 V exporte pro WebCast budú vygenerované automatické skripty s podporou jazykov Perl alebo ASP.
2e sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_PERL 4f Použite export pre WebCast pre vytvorenie HTML stránky a skripty jazyka Perl.
34 sd%3ATimeField%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_DURATION_TMF 3e Určuje čas, počas ktorého bude každý snímok zobrazený.
32 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_CHG_AUTO 62 Snímky sa menia automaticky po uplynutí určitého času a nezávisí na časovaní prezentácie
35 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_CHG_DEFAULT f3 Prechod medzi snímkami závisí na časovaní, ktoré ste jednotlivým snímkam priradili v prezentácií. Ak ste nastavili ručný prechod medzi snímkami, v HTML prezentácií bude nový snímok uvedený po stlačení ľubovoľnej klávesy.
2f sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_KIOSK 84 Vytvorí základnú HTML prezentáciu, v ktorej budú za sebou snímky automaticky nasledovať po určitých časových jednotkách.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_ASP a3 Ak vyberiete možnosť ASP, export pre WebCast vytvorí stránky ASP. HTML prezentácia môže byť potom umiestená len na serveri podporujúcom technológiu ASP.
2c sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_NOTES 36 Určuje, či majú byť zobrazené aj vaše poznámky.
2e sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_CONTENT 2b Vytvorí titulnú stranu vášho dokumentu.
2e sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_ENDLESS 4c Po zobrazení posledného snímku sa prezentácia automaticky spustí znova.
30 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_FRAMES b1 Vytvorí štandardné HTML stránky s rámcami. Exportovaná stránka bude zobrazená v hlavnom rámci a rámec vľavo bude slúžiť ako obsah vo forme hypertextových odkazov.
32 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE2_STANDARD 37 Zo strán pre export vytvorí štandardné HTML strany.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE2 37 Zo strán pre export vytvorí štandardné HTML strany.
30 sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_SLD_SOUND 63 Určuje, či budú exportované zvukové súbory, ktoré definujú zvuky prechodov medzi snímkami.
36 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_RESOLUTION_2 3f Vyberie stredné rozlíšenie pre stredne veľké prezentácie.
36 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_RESOLUTION_3 47 Vyberie vysoké rozlíšenie pre zobrazenie snímok vo vysokej kvalite.
36 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_RESOLUTION_1 7c Vyberte nízke rozlíšenie aby ste zachovali malú veľkosť súborov aj pri prezentáciách s veľkým množstvom snímok.
2e sd%3AComboBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_QUALITY c2 Určuje kompresný faktor JPEG obrázkov. Hodnota 100% ponúka najlepšiu kvalitu, ale výsledná veľkosť súboru je väčšia. Hodnota 25% ponúka menšie súbory v podstatne horšej kvalite.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_JPG 9a Obrázky budú exportované ako JPEG súbory. Súbory JPEG sú komprimované nastaviteľnou stratovou kompresiou a môžu obsahovať viac než 256 farieb.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_GIF 82 Obrázky budú exportované ako GIF súbory. Súbory GIF sú komprimované bezstratovou kompresiou a môžu obsahovať 256 farieb.
2d sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE3_PNG 7f Obrázky budú exportované ako PNG súbory. PNG sú komprimované bez straty údajov a môžu obsahovať viac než 256 farieb.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE3 7f Obrázky budú exportované ako PNG súbory. PNG sú komprimované bez straty údajov a môžu obsahovať viac než 256 farieb.
30 sd%3AMultiLineEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE4_MISC 41 Určuje ďalší text, ktorý bude zobrazený na titulnej strane.
2b sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE4_WWW_EDIT 5c Určuje adresu vašej domovskej stránky. Hypertextový odkaz bude vložený do publikácie.
2d sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE4_EMAIL_EDIT 24 Určuje adresu elektronickej pošty.
29 sd%3AEdit%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE4_AUTHOR 20 Určuje meno autora publikácie.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE4 20 Určuje meno autora publikácie.
2f sd%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE5_TEXTONLY 35 Namiesto tlačidiel vloží iba hypertextové odkazy.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE5 35 Namiesto tlačidiel vloží iba hypertextové odkazy.
2d sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_BACK 4e Otvorí dialóg Farba, v ktorom je možné zvoliť farba pozadia prezentácie.
2e sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_VLINK 62 Otvorí dialóg Farba, vo ktorom je možné vybrať farbu navštívených hypertextových odkazov.
2e sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_ALINK 5c Otvorí dialóg Farba, v ktorom je možné vybrať farbu aktívnych hypertextových odkazov.
2d sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_LINK 4c Otvorí dialóg Farba, v ktorom je možné vybrať farbu textu prezentácie.
2d sd%3APushButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_TEXT 4c Otvorí dialóg Farba, v ktorom je možné vybrať farbu textu prezentácie.
31 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_DEFAULT 3c Použiť základné farby divákovho webového prehliadača.
2e sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_USER 4b Umožní vám pre niektoré objekty prezentácie definovať vlastné farby.
33 sd%3ARadioButton%3ADLG_PUBLISHING%3APAGE6_DOCCOLORS 4c Rozhoduje o použití farieb zo štýlov použitých v aktuálnom dokumente.
1a SD_HID_SD_HTMLEXPORT_PAGE6 4c Rozhoduje o použití farieb zo štýlov použitých v aktuálnom dokumente.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_LISTWIZARD_FINISH 13 Creates the object.
20 EXTENSIONS_HID_GRIDWIZARD_FINISH 13 Creates the object.
21 EXTENSIONS_HID_GROUPWIZARD_FINISH 13 Creates the object.
27 macro%3A%2F%2F%2FImportWizard.Main.Main 68 Kopíruje a konvertuje dokumenty do formátu OpenDocument XML, používaného aplikáciou $[officename].
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_DIALOG 68 Kopíruje a konvertuje dokumenty do formátu OpenDocument XML, používaného aplikáciou $[officename].
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CMDHELP 68 Kopíruje a konvertuje dokumenty do formátu OpenDocument XML, používaného aplikáciou $[officename].
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_CHKLOGFILE 6b Vytvorí vo vašom pracovnom adresári protokolový súbor ukazujúci, ktoré dokumenty boli konvertované.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKPOWERPOINT 5b Konvertuje dokumenty vo formáte Microsoft PowerPoint *.ppt do formátu OpenDocument *.odp.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKEXCEL 53 Konvertuje dokumenty formátu Microsoft Excel *.xls do formátu OpenDocument *.ods.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CHKWORD 55 Konvertuje dokumenty vo formáte Microsoft Word *.doc do formátu OpenDocument *.odt.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_0_OPTMSDOCUMENTS 55 Konvertuje dokumenty vo formáte Microsoft Word *.doc do formátu OpenDocument *.odt.
2d WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CMDDOCUMENTPATHSELECT 30 Otvorí dialóg pre vybratie požadovanej cesty.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBDOCUMENT 2b Určuje, či budú dokumenty konvertované.
2d WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CMDTEMPLATEPATHSELECT 30 Otvorí dialóg pre vybratie požadovanej cesty.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_EDTEMPLATEPATH 41 Určuje adresár, do ktorého budú uložené výsledné súbory.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_LBDOCUMENTPATH 2f Určuje adresár obsahujúci zdrojové súbory.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_LBTEMPLATEPATH 2f Určuje adresár obsahujúci zdrojové súbory.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBDOCUMENTRECURSE 59 Udáva, či sa hľadané súbory budú hľadať aj v podadresároch vybraného adresára.
29 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBTEMPLATERECURSE 59 Udáva, či sa hľadané súbory budú hľadať aj v podadresároch vybraného adresára.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_EDDOCUMENTPATH 41 Určuje adresár, do ktorého budú uložené výsledné súbory.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGIMPORT_2_CBTEMPLATE 2b Určuje, či budú konvertované šablóny.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_LISTBOX1 38 Zobrazuje rozsahy z listu, ktoré sa budú konvertovať.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON3 3e Všetky bunky meny v aktuálnom dokumente budú konvertované.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON2 3c Všetky bunky meny v aktuálnom zošite budú konvertované.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON1 3f Všetky bunky s vybratými štýlmi buniek budú konvertované.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_COMBOBOX1 32 Určuje menu, ktorá sa bude prevádzať na eurá.
14 .uno%3AEuroConverter 96 Konvertuje sumy v menách nájdených  v dokumentoch aplikácie $[officename] Calc a v poliach a tabuľkách aplikácie $[officename] Writer na eurá.
21 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHKPROTECT a6 Určuje, či budú počas konverzie zamknuté listy dočasne odomknuté a potom naspäť zamknuté. Ak sú listy chránené heslom, uvidíte dialóg pre jeho zadanie.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBTARGETOPEN 50 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom je možné vybrať adresár pre konvertované súbory.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBGOON 11 Začne konverziu.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBCANCEL 15 Zavrie Eurokonvertor.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_TBTARGET 45 Určuje adresár a cestu, kam budú skonvertované súbory uložené.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBBACK 2b Vráti sa na prvú stránku Eurokonvertoru.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHECKRECURSIVE 4a Určuje, či budú zahrnuté aj všetky podadresáre vybratého adresára.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBHELP 1e Aktivuje nápoveď k dialógu.
27 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHKTEXTDOCUMENTS 5d Konvertuje sumy v menách nájdených v poliach a tabuľkách $[officename] Writer dokumentu.
31 macro%3A%2F%2F%2FEuro.AutoPilotRun.StartAutoPilot 96 Konvertuje sumy v menách nájdených  v dokumentoch aplikácie $[officename] Calc a v poliach a tabuľkách aplikácie $[officename] Writer na eurá.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OBDIR 73 Konvertuje všetky súbory $[officename] Calc a $[officename] Writer dokumenty a šablóny   vo vybranom adresári.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CBSOURCEOPEN 44 Otvorí dialóg pre výber požadovaného adresára alebo dokumentu.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_TBSOURCE 53 Udáva názov adresára alebo samostatného súboru, ktorý má byť konvertovaný.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OPTIONBUTTON4 55 Všetky bunky meny v rozsahu vybratom pred spustením konvertoru budú konvertované.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_CHECKBOX1 1a Konvertuje celý dokument.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_OBFILE 31 Konvertuje samostatný $[officename] Calc súbor.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGCONVERT_DIALOG 96 Konvertuje sumy v menách nájdených  v dokumentoch aplikácie $[officename] Calc a v poliach a tabuľkách aplikácie $[officename] Writer na eurá.
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT_FINISH 3d Vytvorí spojenie na dátový zdroj a ukončí tento dialóg.
44 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_EVOLUTION_LDAP 58 Ak používate databázu kontaktov z aplikácie Evolution LDAP, zvoľte túto možnosť.
3f extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_EVOLUTION 52 Ak používate databázu kontaktov z aplikácie Evolution zvoľte túto možnosť.
3b extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_MACAB 43 Ak používate databázu kontaktov z OS X, zvoľte túto možnosť.
3b extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_OTHER 70 Ak si prajete zaregistrovať ako databázu kontaktov $[officename] iný dátový zdroj, zvoľte túto možnosť.
39 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_KAB 4b Ak používate databázu kontaktov prostredia KDE, zvoľte túto možnosť.
44 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_OUTLOOKEXPRESS 62 Ak používate databázu kontaktov z aplikácie Microsoft Outlook Express zvoľte túto možnosť.
3d extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_OUTLOOK 71 Ak používate databázu kontaktov z aplikácie Microsoft Outlook (nie Outlook Express), zvoľte túto možnosť.
3a extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_LDAP 4c Ak používate databázu kontaktov na serveri LDAP, zvoľte túto možnosť.
3a extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_MORK 61 Ak používate databázu kontaktov z aplikácií Mozilla alebo Netscape, zvoľte túto možnosť.
21 .uno%3AAutoPilotAddressDataSource 54 Tento sprievodca zaregistruje existujúci adresár ako dátový zdroj $[officename].
41 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_THUNDERBIRD 55 Ak používate databázu kontaktov z aplikácie Thunderbird, zvoľte túto možnosť.
17 EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT 54 Tento sprievodca zaregistruje existujúci adresár ako dátový zdroj $[officename].
1e EXTENSIONS_HID_ABSPILOT_CANCEL 3a Ukončí sprievodcu bez uskutočnenia akýchkoľvek zmien.
49 extensions%3ARadioButton%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE%3ARB_EVOLUTION_GROUPWISE 46 Ak používate databázu kontaktov Groupwise, zvoľte túto možnosť.
c slot%3A10934 54 Tento sprievodca zaregistruje existujúci adresár ako dátový zdroj $[officename].
2c extensions%3ATabPage%3ARID_PAGE_SELECTABTYPE 54 Tento sprievodca zaregistruje existujúci adresár ako dátový zdroj $[officename].
4b extensions%3APushButton%3ARID_PAGE_ADMININVOKATION%3APB_INVOKE_ADMIN_DIALOG 40 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom je možné zadať ďalšie nastavenia.
3d extensions%3AListBox%3ARID_PAGE_TABLESELECTION%3ALB_TABLELIST 56 Určuje tabuľku, ktorá bude slúžiť ako zoznam adries v šablónach $[officename].
37 extensions%3ACheckBox%3ARID_PAGE_FINAL%3ACB_REGISTER_DS d9 Zaregistruje novo vytvorený databázový súbor v %PRODUCTNAME. Databáza bude potom zobrazená v okne zdroja dát (F4). Ak toto pole nie je zaškrtnuté, databáza bude dostupná iba spustením súboru s databázou.
36 extensions%3AEdit%3ARID_PAGE_FINAL%3AET_DATASOURCENAME 1b Určuje názov zdroja dát.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_BROWSECONN 29 Určuje umiestenie dialógového súboru.
34 extensions%3APushButton%3ARID_PAGE_FINAL%3APB_BROWSE 29 Určuje umiestenie dialógového súboru.
49 extensions%3APushButton%3ARID_PAGE_FIELDMAPPING%3APB_INVOKE_FIELDS_DIALOG 35 Otvorí dialóg Šablóny: Priradenie zoznamu adries.
35 service%3Acom.sun.star.wizards.web.CallWizard%3Fstart 78 Sprievodca vytvorením webovej strany vám umožňuje spravovať webovú prezentáciu uloženú na internetovom serveri.
16 WIZARDS_HID0_WEBWIZARD 78 Sprievodca vytvorením webovej strany vám umožňuje spravovať webovú prezentáciu uloženú na internetovom serveri.
18 WIZARDS_HID1_BTN_DEL_SES 1c Vymaže vybraté nastavenia.
19 WIZARDS_HID1_LST_SESSIONS 7f Select the settings that you want to load and then click Load. To start the wizard with the default settings, select "default".
1a WIZARDS_HID2_TXT_DOC_TITLE 72 Vyberte titulok vybratého dokumentu. Titulok sa objaví ako hypertextový odkaz v obsahu vašej webovej stránky.
1b WIZARDS_HID2_LST_DOC_EXPORT 4c Vyberte formát súboru, do ktorého si prajete exportovať vybratý súbor.
1b WIZARDS_HID2_TXT_DOC_AUTHOR 29 Zadajte meno autora vybratého dokumentu.
18 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_REM_DOC 25 Odstráni vybratý súbor zo zoznamu.
18 WIZARDS_HID2_BTN_ADD_DOC d9 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom je možné vybrať súbory, ktoré si prajete mať na vašej webovej stránke. Hypertextové odkazy na indexovej stránke vášho webu budú zobrazené v rovnakom poradí ako v tomto zoznamu.
19 WIZARDS_HID2_TXT_DOC_DESC 21 Zadajte popis vybratého súboru.
15 WIZARDS_HID2_LST_DOCS 144 Zobrazí zoznam dokumentov, ktoré si prajete publikovať na vašej webovej stránke. Sprievodca môže dokumenty %PRODUCTNAME pred tým, než budú odoslané na server, previesť do formátu HTML, PDF alebo v niektorých prípadoch i do formátu Flash. Všetky ostatné súbory budú odoslané v pôvodnom formáte súboru.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG9 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG8 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG6 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG5 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG3 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG7 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG2 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG4 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1c WIZARDS_HID3_IL_LAYOUTS_IMG1 24 Vyberte vzhľad obsahu vášho webu.
1e WIZARDS_HID4_GRP_OPTIMAIZE_800 4f Optimalizuje vašu webovú stránku pre rozlíšenie obrazovky 800x600 pixelov.
1e WIZARDS_HID4_GRP_OPTIMAIZE_640 4f Optimalizuje vašu webovú stránku pre rozlíšenie obrazovky 640x480 pixelov.
1e WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_PAGES 2d Zobrazí v obsahu počet strán vášho webu.
1f WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_F_ICON 2a Zobrazí v obsahu ikonu formátu súborov.
1f WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_FORMAT 23 Zobrazí v obsahu formát súborov.
20 WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_UP_DATE 3d Vloží do obsahu dátum poslednej zmeny každého dokumentu.
20 WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_CR_DATE 3d Vloží do obsahu dátum vytvorenia jednotlivých dokumentov.
1f WIZARDS_HID4_GRP_OPTIMAIZE_1024 50 Optimalizuje vašu webovú stránku pre rozlíšenie obrazovky 1024x768 pixelov.
1d WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_SIZE 33 Zobrazí v obsahu veľkosť súborov v kilobajtoch.
1f WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_AUTHOR 3b Vloží do obsahu mená ľudí, ktorí dokumenty vytvorili.
24 WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_DESCRIPTION 20 Obsah obsahuje popis dokumentov.
21 WIZARDS_HID4_CHK_DISPLAY_FILENAME 2c Obsahuje mená súborov dokumentov v obsahu.
16 WIZARDS_HID5_BTN_ICONS 5d Vyberte Ikony, ktoré si prajete použiť pre navigačné prvky na vašej stránke s obsahom.
18 WIZARDS_HID5_BTN_BACKGND 2f Vyberte obrázok na pozadí stránky s obsahom.
17 WIZARDS_HID5_LST_STYLES 30 Vyberte farebnú schému pre stránku s obsahom.
17 WIZARDS_HID_BG_BTN_NONE 2d Odstráni obrázok z pozadia stránky obsahu.
18 WIZARDS_HID_BG_BTN_OTHER 68 Otvorí dialóg otvorenia súboru, v ktorom vyberiete súbor s obrázkom na pozadí pre stránku obsahu.
e WIZARDS_HID_BG 4d Určuje obrázok na pozadí pre štýl Sprievodcu vytvorením webovej strany.
17 WIZARDS_HID_IS_BTN_NONE 27 Odstráni sadu ikon zo stránky obsahu.
e WIZARDS_HID_IS 5a Vyberte sadu ikon pre navigáciu na vašom webe pre Sprievodcu vytvorením webovej strany.
1f WIZARDS_HID6_TXT_SITE_COPYRIGHT 78 Zadajte Informácie o autorských právach pre stránku s obsahom. Informácia bude uložená medzi HTML meta značkami.
1b WIZARDS_HID6_TXT_SITE_EMAIL 69 Zadajte adresu elektronickej pošty pre stránku obsahu. Adresa bude uložená medzi HTML meta značkami.
1e WIZARDS_HID6_DATE_SITE_UPDATED 5a Zadajte dátum poslednej zmeny dokumentu. Dátum bude uložený medzi HTML meta značkami.
1a WIZARDS_HID6_TXT_SITE_DESC 4e Zadajte popis stránky obsahu. Popis bude uložený medzi HTML meta značkami.
1e WIZARDS_HID6_DATE_SITE_CREATED 5b Zadajte dátum vytvorenia stránky obsahu. Dátum bude uložený medzi HTML meta značkami.
1b WIZARDS_HID6_TXT_SITE_TITLE 63 Zadajte názov vášho webu. Tento prvok bude zobrazený na titulnom paneli webového prehliadača.
14 WIZARDS_HID7_TXT_FTP d5 Odošle vaše súbory na FTP server. Stránka s obsahom bude uložená do adresára, ktorý ste určili. Všetky ostatné súbory budú uložené do adresára "môjWeb" v adresári obsahujúcom stránku s obsahom.
15 WIZARDS_HID7_TXT_SAVE 26 Zadajte názov súboru s nastaveniami.
14 WIZARDS_HID7_BTN_ZIP 4e Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom je možné upresniť umiestenie súboru s archívom.
14 WIZARDS_HID7_TXT_ZIP 116 Pridá stránku s obsahom a súbory do komprimovaného archívu a odošle ich na vašu webovú stránku. Stránka s obsahom bude odoslaná na miesto, ktoré ste určili. Všetky ostatné súbory budú odoslané do adresára "môjWeb" v adresári obsahujúcom stránku s obsahom.
1c WIZARDS_HID7_CHK_PUBLISH_ZIP 116 Pridá stránku s obsahom a súbory do komprimovaného archívu a odošle ich na vašu webovú stránku. Stránka s obsahom bude odoslaná na miesto, ktoré ste určili. Všetky ostatné súbory budú odoslané do adresára "môjWeb" v adresári obsahujúcom stránku s obsahom.
16 WIZARDS_HID7_TXT_LOCAL ee Nahrá vašu stránku s obsahom a súbory do lokálneho adresára. Súbor s obsahom bude uložený na miesto, ktoré ste určili. Všetky ostatné súbory budú uložené do adresára "môjWeb" v adresári obsahujúcom stránku s obsahom.
14 WIZARDS_HID7_BTN_FTP 63 Otvorí dialóg FTP pripojenie,  v ktorom je možné nastaviť a otestovať nastavenie FTP serveru.
1c WIZARDS_HID7_CHK_PUBLISH_FTP d5 Odošle vaše súbory na FTP server. Stránka s obsahom bude uložená do adresára, ktorý ste určili. Všetky ostatné súbory budú uložené do adresára "môjWeb" v adresári obsahujúcom stránku s obsahom.
16 WIZARDS_HID7_BTN_LOCAL 25 Otvorí dialóg pre výber adresára.
1e WIZARDS_HID7_CHK_PUBLISH_LOCAL ee Nahrá vašu stránku s obsahom a súbory do lokálneho adresára. Súbor s obsahom bude uložený na miesto, ktoré ste určili. Všetky ostatné súbory budú uložené do adresára "môjWeb" v adresári obsahujúcom stránku s obsahom.
15 WIZARDS_HID7_CHK_SAVE 3c Uloží nastavenia, ktoré ste určili v tomto sprievodcovi.
18 WIZARDS_HID7_BTN_PREVIEW 61 Otvorí vašu webovú stránku vo východzom  webovom prehliadači vášho operačného systému.
18 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_BTN_PATH 67 Otvorí dialóg, v ktorom je možné upresniť adresár na FTP serveri, do ktorého sa uložia súbory.
18 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_TXT_PATH 54 Zadajte umiestnenie adresára na FTP serveri, kam si prajete uložiť vaše súbory.
14 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_TEST 33 Otestuje FTP pripojenie s aktuálnymi nastaveniami.
14 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_PASS 3b Zadajte heslo, ktoré je nutné pre prístup k FTP serveru.
18 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_USERNAME 4c Zadajte používateľské meno, ktoré je nutné pre prístup k FTP serveru.
16 WIZARDS_HID_FTP_SERVER 2b Zadajte názov alebo IP adresu FTP serveru.
f WIZARDS_HID_FTP 57 Upravte a otestujte pripojenie k FTP serveru pre Sprievodcu vytvorením webovej strany.
20 DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_FUNCTION 2f Tu vyberte funkciu, ktorá sa spustí v dotaze.
1f DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_VISIBLE 47 Ak zaškrtnete vlastnosť Viditeľné, dané pole sa zobrazí v dotaze.
1d DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_ORDER 50 V tejto bunke je možné zvoliť zoraďovanie: vzostupne, zostupne a nezoradiť.
1d DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_TABLE 44 Databázová tabuľka, v ktorej sa nachádza vybrané dátové pole.
1d DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_FIELD 7c Enter the name of the data field that you referred to in the Query. All settings made in the lower rows refer to this field.
28 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_SAVE_AS%3AET_TITLE 25 Zadajte názov dotazu alebo pohľadu.
1c DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_CRIT 47 Určuje Kritérium, podľa ktorého sa filtruje obsah dátového poľa.
2d dbaccess%3AComboBox%3ADLG_SAVE_AS%3AET_SCHEMA 41 Zadajte názov schémy, ktorá sa priradí dotazu alebo pohľadu.
26 DBACCESS_HID_QUERY_EDIT_JOINCONNECTION 1d Upraviť vlastnosti relácie.
1d DBACCESS_HID_QRYDGN_ROW_ALIAS 64 Zadajte alias dátového poľa. V dotaze sa namiesto skutočného názvu poľa použije tento alias.
1b DBACCESS_HID_CTL_QRYDGNCRIT 27 Vyberte podmienky na definíciu dotazu.
1a DBACCESS_HID_CTL_QRYDGNTAB 54 Dvojitým kliknutím na pole ho pridáte do dotazu. Pretiahnutím určíte relácie.
21 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_QRY_JOIN_CONTROL f7 Inserts the keyword NATURAL into the SQL statement that defines the relation. The relation joins all columns that have the same column name in both tables. The resulting joined table contains only one column for each pair of equally named columns.
1d DBACCESS_HID_DLG_QRY_JOINTYPE 1e Určuje typ vybranej relácie.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_QRY_RIGHT_TABLE 3a Určuje dve rôzne tabuľky, ktoré si želáte prepojiť.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DLG_QRY_LEFT_TABLE 3a Určuje dve rôzne tabuľky, ktoré si želáte prepojiť.
2c dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWORD%3AED_PASSWORD 14 Vložte nové heslo.
2f dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWORD%3AED_OLDPASSWORD 15 Vložte staré heslo.
33 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_PASSWORD%3AED_PASSWORD_REPEAT 1a Vložte znovu nové heslo.
1c sfx%2Fui%2Fpassword%2Fusered 24 Určuje meno nového používateľa.
25 DBACCESS_HID_TABLE_DESIGN_HELP_WINDOW 1a Zobrazuje texty nápovedy.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_FORMAT_SAMPLE 44 Zobrazuje kód formátu, ktorý je možné vybrať tlačidlom  ... .
1c DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_DEFAULT 37 Určuje východziu hodnotu pre nové dátové záznamy.
29 DBACCESS_HID_TABLEDESIGN_TABED_PRIMARYKEY 40 Ak je zaškrtnuté toto pole, je dátove pole primárny kľúč.
23 DBACCESS_HID_TABLEDESIGN_INSERTROWS 9b Vloží prázdny riadok nad aktuálny riadok, pokiaľ tabuľka ešte nebola uložená.  Pokiaľ bola uložená, vloží prázdny riadok na koniec tabuľky.
1f DBACCESS_HID_TABDESIGN_TYPECELL 12 Určuje typ poľa.
1b DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_FORMAT 2d Toto tlačidlo otvorí dialóg Formát poľa.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TABDESIGN_COMMENTCELL 1a Zadajte voliteľný popis.
1f DBACCESS_HID_TABDESIGN_NAMECELL 85 Určuje názov dátového poľa. Pri zadávaní názvu platí obmedzenie databázy, napr. dĺžka názvu, zvláštne znaky a medzery.
21 DBACCESS_HID_TABDESIGN_BACKGROUND 2f V tejto oblasti určujete štruktúru tabuľky.
32 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ADLG_INDEXDESIGN%3APB_CLOSE 11 Zatvorí dialóg.
2c DBACCESS_HID_DLGINDEX_INDEXDETAILS_SORTORDER 1d Určuje poradie zoraďovania.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DLGINDEX_INDEXDETAILS_FIELD 4d Zobrazuje zoznam polí aktuálnej tabuľky. Je možné vybrať aj viac polí.
31 dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_INDEXDESIGN%3ACB_UNIQUE 46 Určuje, že aktuálny register môže mať iba Jednoznačné hodnoty.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_RESETINDEX 49 Obnoví aktuálny index na nastavenia, ktoré mal pri otvorení dialógu.
1d DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_SAVEINDEX 27 Uloží aktuálny index do zdroja dát.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_RENAMEINDEX 1a Premenuje aktuálny index.
1c DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_NEWINDEX 15 Vytvorí nový index.
14 .uno%3ADBIndexDesign 48 V dialógu Návrh indexu je možné upraviť indexy aktuálnej tabuľky.
1d DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_DROPINDEX 1a Odstráni aktuálny index.
1d DBACCESS_HID_DLGIDX_INDEXLIST a7 Zobrazuje dostupné indexy. Vyberte zo zoznamu index, ktorý si prajete upraviť. Na pravej strane dialógu sú zobrazené podrobnejšie informácie o vybranom indexe.
28 dbaccess%3AModalDialog%3ADLG_INDEXDESIGN 48 V dialógu Návrh indexu je možné upraviť indexy aktuálnej tabuľky.
1c DBACCESS_HID_CTL_RELATIONTAB 63 Pomocou spoločných dátových polí je možné navzájom prepojiť tabuľky aktuálnej databázy.
2a DBACCESS_HID_RELATIONDIALOG_RIGHTFIELDCELL 48 Ako názvy stĺpcov sa zobrazia názvy tabuliek vybraných pre spojenie.
29 DBACCESS_HID_RELATIONDIALOG_LEFTFIELDCELL 48 Ako názvy stĺpcov sa zobrazia názvy tabuliek vybraných pre spojenie.
1d DBACCESS_HID_RELDLG_KEYFIELDS 21 Určuje polia kľúčov relácii.
14 .uno%3ADBAddRelation 44 Reláciu medzi dvoma tabuľkami je možné nastaviť alebo upraviť.
30 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3AET_KEYNAME 51 Určuje názov vygenerovaného primárneho kľúča. Tento názov je voliteľný.
3a dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ARB_APPENDDATA 40 Pripojí dáta z kopírovanej tabuľky do existujúcej tabuľky.
34 dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ARB_VIEW 70 Ak databáza podporuje pohľady, je možné pri kopírovaní dotazu do zložky tabuliek zvoliť túto možnosť.
3b dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ACB_PRIMARY_COLUMN 4a Automatically generates a primary key data field and fills it with values.
33 dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ARB_DEF 30 Zkopíruje len definíciu tabuľky a nie údaje.
37 dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COPYTABLE%3ARB_DEFDATA 2e Vytvorí presnú kópiu databázovej tabuľky.
23 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_WIZ_TABLENAME_EDIT 16 Zadajte názov kópie.
3e dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3AIB_COLUMNS_LH 67 Pridá alebo odstráni vybrané pole (tlačidlo > alebo <) alebo všetky polia (tlačidlo << alebo >>).
3d dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3AIB_COLUMN_LH 67 Pridá alebo odstráni vybrané pole (tlačidlo > alebo <) alebo všetky polia (tlačidlo << alebo >>).
3e dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3AIB_COLUMNS_RH 67 Pridá alebo odstráni vybrané pole (tlačidlo > alebo <) alebo všetky polia (tlačidlo << alebo >>).
3d dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3AIB_COLUMN_RH 67 Pridá alebo odstráni vybrané pole (tlačidlo > alebo <) alebo všetky polia (tlačidlo << alebo >>).
45 dbaccess%3AMultiListBox%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3ALB_NEW_COLUMN_NAMES 3f Zoznam polí, ktoré chcete zahrnúť do kopírovanej tabuľky.
45 dbaccess%3AMultiListBox%3ATAB_WIZ_COLUMN_SELECT%3ALB_ORG_COLUMN_NAMES ff Vypíše zoznam dostupných dátových polí, ktoré je možné vložiť do kopírovanej tabuľky.  Ak chcete skopírovať dátové pole, kliknite na jeho názov a potom kliknite na tlačidlo >. Pre skopírovanie všetkých polí kliknite na tlačidlo >>.
35 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ATAB_WIZ_TYPE_SELECT%3APB_AUTO 28 Umožnuje automatické rozpoznanie typu.
37 dbaccess%3ANumericField%3ATAB_WIZ_TYPE_SELECT%3AET_AUTO 4e Zadajte počet riadkov, ktoré sa použijú na automatické rozpoznánie typu.
21 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_BOOL_DEFAULT 31 Vyberte výchoziu hodnotu pre pole typu Áno/Nie.
1a DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_SCALE 67 Zadajte počet desetinných miest dátového poľa. Táto voľba je dostupná len pre číselné polia.
18 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_LEN 27 Zadajte počet znakov dátového poľa.
19 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_TYPE 12 Vyberte typ poľa.
1d DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_TEXT_LEN 27 Zadajte počet znakov dátového poľa.
1f DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_COLUMNNAME 56 Zobrazuje názov vybraného dátového poľa. Taktiež je možné zadať nový názov.
43 dbaccess%3AMultiListBox%3ATAB_WIZ_TYPE_SELECT%3ALB_NEW_COLUMN_NAMES 49 Zoznam dátových polí, ktoré budú zahrnuté do kopírovanej tabuľky.
37 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3APB_NONE 35 Zruší výber všetkých dátových polí v zozname.
36 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3APB_ALL 29 Vyberie všetky dátové polia v zozname.
45 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3AIB_COLUMN_DOWN_RIGHT 34 Posunie vybranú položku o jednu pozíciu nižšie.
3f dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3AIB_COLUMN_DOWN 34 Posunie vybranú položku o jednu pozíciu nižšie.
3d dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3AIB_COLUMN_UP 34 Posunie vybranú položku o jednu pozíciu vyššie.
43 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ATAB_WIZ_NAME_MATCHING%3AIB_COLUMN_UP_RIGHT 34 Posunie vybranú položku o jednu pozíciu vyššie.
29 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_NAMEMATCHING_COLS_ASSIGN a3 Zoznam možných dátových polí v cieľovej tabuľke. Do cieľovej tabuľky sa pridajú len dátové polia, ktoré sú zaškrtnuté v zozname zdrojové tabuľky.
28 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_NAMEMATCHING_COLS_AVAIL 17b Zoznam dátových polí v zdrojovej tabuľke. Ak chcete vložiť dátové pole zo zdrojovej tabuľky do cieľovej tabuľky, zaškrtnite pole pred názvom dátového poľa. Ak chcete priradiť obsah dátového poľa zdrojovej tabuľky inému dátovému poľu v cieľovej tabuľke, kliknite na dátové pole v zozname zdrojovej tabuľky a potom kliknite na šípku hore alebo dole.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_USECATALOG b1 Použije súčasný zdroj dát ako katalóg. To je užitočné, ak je zdrojom dát databázový server ODBC. Ak je zdrojom dát ODBC ovládač dBASE, toto pole nezaškrtávajte.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SQL92CHECK 5f Povoľuje iba názvy, ktoré v zdroji dát používajú znaky zodpovedajúce obmedzeniam SQL92.
22 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_RETRIEVE_AUTO 73 Zadajte SQL dotaz, ktorý vracia poslednú hodnotu automatického zvýšenia dátového poľa primárneho kľúča.
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_AUTOINCREMENTVALUE 65 Zadajte SQL príkaz, ktorý zdroju dát určí automaticky zvyšovať dané číselné dátové pole.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_AUTORETRIEVEENABLED 75 Zapíná podporu $[officename] pre automatické zvyšovanie dátových polí pre aktuálny ODBC nebo JDBC zdroj dát.
21 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_ODBC_OPTIONS 59 Do tohoto textového poľa zadajte prípadné daľšie voliteľné nastavenia ovládača.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DBASE_INDICIES 64 Otvorí dialóg Indexy, v kterom je možné spravovať indexy tabuliek v aktuálnej databáze dBASE.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SHOWDELETED 9b Zobrazí všetky záznamy v súbore, vrátane tých, ktoré sú označené ako odstránené. Ak zaškrtnete toto pole, nie je možné záznamy odstrániť.
39 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3AIB_REMOVEALL 3b Presunie všetky indexy tabuľky do zoznamu Voľné indexy.
36 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3AIB_REMOVE 3b Presunie vybraný index tabuľky do zoznamu Voľné indexy.
36 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3AIB_ADDALL 3b Presunie všetky voľné indexy do zoznamu Indexy tabuľky.
33 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3AIB_ADD 33 Presunie vybraný index do zoznamu Indexy tabuľky.
37 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3ALB_FREEINDEXES 4a Zobrazí zoznam dostupných indexov, ktoré je možné priradiť tabuľke.
38 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3ALB_TABLEINDEXES 47 Zobrazí zoznam aktuálnych indexov pre vybranú databázovú tabuľku.
33 dbaccess%3AComboBox%3ADLG_DBASE_INDEXES%3ACB_TABLES 42 Vyberte databázovú tabuľku, pre ktorú chcete vytvoriť indexy.
29 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2Fexecute 41 Spustí príkaz, ktorý ste zadali do poľa Príkaz na spustenie.
2c dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2Fsqlhistory 7b Zoznam skôr spustených SQL príkazov. K opätovnému spusteniu príkazu kliknite na príkaz a potom kliknite na Spustiť.
25 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2Fsql 3f Zadajte administrátorský príkaz SQL, ktorý chcete spustiť.
28 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2Fstatus 3e Zobrazuje výsledky, vrátane chýb, spusteného SQL príkazu.
31 dbaccess%2Fui%2Fdirectsqldialog%2FDirectSQLDialog 55 Otvorte dialóg, v ktorom je možné zadať SQL príkaz pre administráciu databázy.
d .uno%3ASortup 45 Zoradí zoznam názvov tabuliek vo vzostupnom poradí podľa abecedy.
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SUPPRESS_VERSIONCL de Niektoré databázy môžu sledovať zmeny záznamov priradením čísla verzie upraveným poliam. Toto číslo sa pri každej zmene pola zvýši o 1.  Zobrazuje se interné číslo verzie záznamu v databázovej  tabulke.
1f DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_TBLGRANTS 55 Zobrazí prístupové práva daného uživateľa. Je tu tiež možnosť ich upraviť.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_PBUSERDELETE 21 Odstráni vybraného uživateľa.
1e DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_PBCHGPWD 41 Zmení heslo aktuálneho používateľa pre prístup k databáze.
1c DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_PBUSER 41 Zadejte nového používateľa pre prístup k vybranej databáze.
1c DBACCESS_HID_TAB_PAGE_LBUSER 3c Vyberte používateľa, ktorého nastavenia chcete upraviť.
2e dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_FREESIZE 4d Zobrazí voľné miesto (v megabajtoch), ktoré je v databáze k dispozícii.
2a dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_SIZE 36 Zobrazí celkovú veľkosť databázy (v megabajtoch).
39 dbaccess%3ANumericField%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_MEMORYUSING 40 Zobrazí množstvo využitého miesta v databáze v percentách.
31 dbaccess%3AListBox%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3ALB_DATADEVS 2d Zobrazí cestu a názov súboru DATADEVSPACE.
34 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_TRANSACTIONLOG 2f Zobrazí cestu a názov súboru TRANSACTIONLOG.
31 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_ADABASSTAT%3AET_SYSDEVSPACE 2c Zobrazí cestu a názov súboru SYSDEVSPACE.
22 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_CACHE_SIZE 2e Enter the size of the data cache in megabytes.
2b DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_TRANSACTIONLOG_SIZE 34 Enter the size of the transaction file in megabytes.
29 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_DATADEVSPACE_SIZE 4d Enter the size of the database in megabytes here. The maximum size is 100 MB.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_PBDATADEVSPACE 48 Locate the directory where you want to save the file, and then click OK.
24 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_DATADEVSPACE 25 Enter the path for the data DEVSPACE.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_TRANSACTIONLOG 2c Enter the path for the transaction log file.
25 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_PBSYSDEVSPACE 48 Locate the directory where you want to save the file, and then click OK.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_SYSDEVSPACE 27 Enter the path for the system DEVSPACE.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_PBTRANSACTIONLOG 48 Locate the directory where you want to save the file, and then click OK.
21 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_DOMAINPWD e Zadajte heslo.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_CONPWD e Zadajte heslo.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_SYSPWD e Zadajte heslo.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_USR 9e Zadajte meno doménového používateľa, ktoré Adabas používá interne. Obvykle sa východzie nastavenia mena a hesla doménového používateľa nemenia.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_SYSUSR 27 Zadajte meno administrátora databázy.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_CONUSR c5 Zadajte meno používateľa, ktorému chcete udeľiť obmedzenú možnosť upravovať niektoré parametre databázy. Obvykle sa východzie nastavenia mena a hesla riadiaceho používateľa nemenia.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DLG_ADABAS_DBNAME 19 Zadajte názov databázy.
1f HID_DSADMIN_PRIMARY_KEY_SUPPORT 39 Umožňuje používateľovi zmazať štruktúru tabuľky.
2a DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CHECK_REQUIRED_FIELDS d8 When you enter a new record or update an existing record in a form, and you leave a field empty which is bound to a database column which requires input, then you will see a message complaining about the empty field.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_IGNOREINDEXAPPENDIX 2d Creates an index with ASC or DESC statements.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SCHEMA 37 Allows you to use the schema name in SELECT statements.
1c DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CATALOG b7 Uses the current data source of the catalog. This option is useful when the ODBC data source is a database server. Do not select this option if the ODBC data source is a dBASE driver.
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SUPPRESS_VERSIONCL 49 Displays the internal version number of the record in the database table.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_IGNOREDRIVER_PRIV 43 Ignores access privileges that are provided by the database driver.
1b HID_DSADMIN_ESCAPE_DATETIME 22 Určuje, že polia nemajú okraje.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_BOOLEANCOMPARISON 3b Select the type of Boolean comparison that you want to use.
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_ENABLEOUTERJOIN 5c Use escape sequences for outer joins. The syntax for this escape sequence is {oj outer-join}
25 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_APPENDTABLEALIAS 39 Appends the alias to the table name in SELECT statements.
27 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_PARAMETERNAMESUBST 44 Replaces named parameters in a data source with a question mark (?).
20 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DOSLINEENDS 6d Select to use the CR + LF code pair to end every text line (preferred for DOS and Windows operating systems).
26 HID_DSADMIN_AS_BEFORE_CORRELATION_NAME 9b Some databases use the keyword "AS" between a name and its alias, while other databases use a whitespace. Enable this option to insert AS before the alias.
1c DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CHARSET 54 Select the character set that you want to use to view the database in $[officename].
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_SPECIAL_MESSAGE 38 Select the type of database that you want to connect to.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_PB_TESTMYSQLCLASS 3c Tests the database connection through the JDBC driver class.
3c dbaccess%3ACheckBox%3APAGE_CONNECTION%3ACB_PASSWORD_REQUIRED 61 If checked, the user will be asked to enter the password that is required to access the database.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_CALC_PATH 4e Enter the path to the spreadsheet document that you want to use as a database.
2d DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLCLASS 49 Enter the name of the JDBC driver class that connects to the data source.
2e DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLDBNAME 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
1e DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_FLAT_PATH 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
3b dbaccess%3APushButton%3APAGE_CONNECTION%3APB_TESTCONNECTION 38 Tests the database connection with the current settings.
1f DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DBASE_PATH 3e Enter the path to the directory that contains the dBASE files.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DLG_DATABASE_WIZARD 57 The Database Wizard creates a database file that contains information about a database.
1b DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DSTYPE 3e Select the database type for the existing database connection.
39 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_GENERAL_RB_GETEXISTINGDATABASE 49 Select to create a database document for an existing database connection.
33 dbaccess%3AListBox%3APAGE_GENERAL%3ALB_DOCUMENTLIST 86 Select a database file to open from the list of recently used files. Click Finish to open the file immediately and to exit the wizard.
36 dbaccess%3APushButton%3APAGE_GENERAL%3APB_OPENDOCUMENT a6 Opens a file selection dialog where you can select a database file. Click Open or OK in the file selection dialog to open the file immediately and to exit the wizard.
3a dbaccess%3ARadioButton%3APAGE_GENERAL%3ARB_OPENEXISTINGDOC 62 Select to open a database file from a list of recently used files or from a file selection dialog.
36 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_GENERAL_RB_CREATEDBDATABASE 20 Select to create a new database.
34 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_FINAL_CB_STARTTABLEWIZARD 46 Select to call the Table Wizard after the Database Wizard is finished.
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_FINAL_CB_OPENAFTERWARDS 4f Select to display the database file, where you can edit the database structure.
3a DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_FINAL_RB_DONTREGISTERDATASOURCE 4e Select to keep the database information only within the created database file.
36 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_FINAL_RB_REGISTERDATASOURCE 118 Select to register the database within your user copy of %PRODUCTNAME. After registering, the database is displayed in the View - Data Sources window. You must register a database to be able to insert the database fields in a document (Insert - Fields - Other) or in a mail merge.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MSACCESS_PB_MSACCESSLOCATION 26 Click to open a file selection dialog.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MSACCESS_ET_MSACCESSLOCATION 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADABAS_PB_ADABASNAME 26 Click to open a file selection dialog.
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADABAS_ET_ADABASNAME 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
46 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_AUTHENTIFICATION_CB_GENERALPASSWORDREQUIRED 2b A password must contain 3 to 18 characters.
3e DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_AUTHENTIFICATION_ET_GENERALUSERNAME 30 A user name can have a maximum of 18 characters.
28 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADO_PB_ADOURL 2a Click to open a database selection dialog.
28 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ADO_ET_ADOURL 1a Enter the data source URL.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_DBASE_PB_DBASELOCATION 1d Open a path selection dialog.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_DBASE_ET_DBASELOCATION 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
20 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DRIVERCLASS 22 Enter the name of the JDBC driver.
2c DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLPORT df Enter the URL for the database. For example, for the MySQL JDBC driver, enter "jdbc:mysql://<Servername>/<name of the database>". For more information on the JDBC driver, consult the documentation that came with the driver.
2a DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_JDBCURL df Enter the URL for the database. For example, for the MySQL JDBC driver, enter "jdbc:mysql://<Servername>/<name of the database>". For more information on the JDBC driver, consult the documentation that came with the driver.
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_JDBC_ET_MYSQLHOSTSERVER 41 hostname is the name of the machine that runs the MySQL database.
29 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_LDAP_CB_USESSL 56 Creates a secure connection to the LDAP server through the Secure Sockets Layer (SSL).
2d DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_LDAP_ET_PORTNUMBER 30 Enter the port of the LDAP server, normally 389.
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_PORTNUMBER 30 Enter the port of the LDAP server, normally 389.
29 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_LDAP_ET_BASEDN 4c Enter the starting point to search the LDAP database, for example, "dc=com".
20 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_BASEDN 4c Enter the starting point to search the LDAP database, for example, "dc=com".
2d DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_LDAP_ET_HOSTSERVER 45 Enter the name of the LDAP server using the format "ldap.server.com".
22 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_LDAP_HOSTNAME 45 Enter the name of the LDAP server using the format "ldap.server.com".
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MYSQL_RB_CONNECTVIAJDBC 48 Connects to an existing JDBC data source that was set on a system level.
32 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_MYSQL_RB_CONNECTVIAODBC 48 Connects to an existing ODBC data source that was set on a system level.
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ODBC_PB_NAMEOFODBCDATASOURCE 33 Click to open an ODBC data source selection dialog:
37 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ODBC_ET_NAMEOFODBCDATASOURCE 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLEPORT 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
30 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLECLASS 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
35 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_ORACLE_ET_ORACLEHOSTSERVER 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
45 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_SPREADSHEET_CB_SPREADSHEETPASSWORDREQUIRED 44 Select to request a password from the user of the database document.
39 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_SPREADSHEET_PB_SPREADSHEETPATH 26 Click to open a file selection dialog.
39 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_SPREADSHEET_ET_SPREADSHEETPATH 35 Enter the path and file name to the spreadsheet file.
26 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_DECIMAL_SEPARATOR 81 Enter or select the character that is used as a decimal separator in the text file, for example, a period (0.5) or a comma (0,5).
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_FIELD_SEPARATOR 4a Enter or select the character that separates data fields in the text file.
28 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_THOUSANDS_SEPARATOR 87 Enter or select the character that is used as a thousands separator in the text file, for example a comma (1,000), or a period (1.000).
33 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_RB_ACCESSOTHERFILES 42 Click to access custom files. Enter the extension in the text box.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_RB_ACCESSCSVFILES 1a Click to access csv files.
31 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_RB_ACCESSTXTFILES 1a Click to access txt files.
33 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_PB_LOCATIONTEXTFILE 26 Click to open a file selection dialog.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_TEXT_SEPARATOR 4c Enter or select the character that identifies a text field in the text file.
2f DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_ET_OWNEXTENSION 42 Click to access custom files. Enter the extension in the text box.
33 DBACCESS_HID_PAGE_DBWIZARD_TEXT_ET_LOCATIONTEXTFILE fd Enter the path to the text file or files. If you just want one text file, you can use any extension of the file name. If you enter a folder name, the text files in that folder must have the extension *.csv to be recognized as files of the text database.
19 .uno%3ADBDSConnectionType 21 Opens the Connection Type Wizard.
1f .uno%3ADBDatabasePropertiesMenu 10 Opens a submenu.
2b .uno%3ADBNewReportAutoPilotWithPreSelection 40 Starts the Report Wizard for the selected table, query, or view.
15 .uno%3ADBDSProperties 25 Opens the Database Properties dialog.
29 .uno%3ADBNewFormAutoPilotWithPreSelection 3e Starts the Form Wizard for the selected table, query, or view.
16 .uno%3ADBConvertToView cf Converts the selected query to a view. The original query remains in your database file and an additional view is generated on the database server. You must have write permission to add a view to a database.
1b .uno%3ADBDSAdvancedSettings 25 Opens the Advanced Properties dialog.
d .uno%3ADBOpen 32 Opens the selected object in the last saved state.
f .uno%3ADBRename 71 Renames the selected object. Depending on the database, some names, characters, and name length might be invalid.
f .uno%3ADBDelete 33 Deletes the selected table, query, form, or report.
21 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLE_DELETE 33 Deletes the selected table, query, form, or report.
d .uno%3ADBEdit 4d Opens a window where you can edit the selected table, query, form, or report.
1f DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLE_EDIT 4d Opens a window where you can edit the selected table, query, form, or report.
1b .uno%3ADBSendReportToWriter 86 Exports the selected report to a text document. A dynamic report is exported as a copy of the database contents at the time of export.
19 .uno%3ADBSendReportAsMail fe Opens the default e-mail application to send a new e-mail. The selected report is appended as an attachment. You can enter the subject, the recipients and a mail body. A dynamic report is exported as a copy of the database contents at the time of export.
43 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ADLG_COLLECTION_VIEW%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_SAVE 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
40 dbaccess%3AEdit%3ADLG_COLLECTION_VIEW%3AED_EXPLORERFILE_FILENAME 2f Zadajte názov súboru pre ukladaný formulár.
42 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_COLLECTION_VIEW%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_UP 31 Click to go up one level in the folder hierarchy.
49 dbaccess%3AImageButton%3ADLG_COLLECTION_VIEW%3ABTN_EXPLORERFILE_NEWFOLDER 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
12 .uno%3ADBNewFolder 44 Opens a dialog where you can save a new folder in the database file.
13 .uno%3ADBNewViewSQL 1d Opens a new view in SQL mode.
10 .uno%3ADBNewView 20 Opens a new view in design mode.
11 .uno%3ADBNewTable 1c Opens the table design view.
14 .uno%3ADBNewQuerySql 1e Opens a new query in SQL mode.
11 .uno%3ADBNewQuery 21 Opens a new query in design mode.
12 .uno%3ADBNewReport 48 Starts the Report Builder window for the selected table, view, or query.
28 DBACCESS_HID_BROWSER_TABLE_CREATE_DESIGN 1c Opens the table design view.
10 .uno%3ADBNewForm 27 Opens a new text document in form mode.
12 .uno%3ADBDirectSQL 38 Opens the SQL dialog where you can enter SQL statements.
14 .uno%3ADBTableFilter 64 Opens the Table Filter dialog where you can specify which tables of the database to show or to hide.
23 DBACCESS_HID_DSADMIN_TABLE_SELECTOR 64 Opens the Table Filter dialog where you can specify which tables of the database to show or to hide.
12 .uno%3ADBUserAdmin 4b Opens the User Administration dialog if the database supports this feature.
17 .uno%3ADBRelationDesign 5d Opens the Relation Design view and checks whether the database connection supports relations.
16 .uno%3ADBRefreshTables 15 Refreshes the tables.
17 .uno%3ADBShowDocPreview 36 The preview displays the document of a form or report.
17 .uno%3ADBDisablePreview 2c Disables the preview in the database window.
d .uno%3ADBSort 10 Opens a submenu.
13 .uno%3ADBViewTables 45 Selects the tables container and shows all tables in the detail view.
10 .uno%3ADBPreview 10 Opens a submenu.
14 .uno%3ADBViewQueries 47 Selects the queries container and shows all queries in the detail view.
1b .uno%3ADBShowDocInfoPreview 49 The preview window displays the document information of a form or report.
14 .uno%3ADBViewReports 47 Selects the reports container and shows all reports in the detail view.
12 .uno%3ADBViewForms 43 Selects the forms container and shows all forms in the detail view.
1c .uno%3ADBDatabaseObjectsMenu 10 Opens a submenu.
32 dbaccess%3AMultiLineEdit%3ATP_SUMMARY%3AED_CHANGES 42 The list shows all changes that were applied to the database file.
45 dbaccess%3APushButton%3ATP_SAVE_DBDOC_AS%3APB_BROWSE_SAVE_AS_LOCATION c1 Choose a location and file name to save the new database file. By default, the new file gets the same name as the old file, while the old file gets renamed with the string "backup" in the name.
17 .uno%3ADBMigrateScripts 96 The Database Document Macro Migration Wizard moves existing macros from sub-documents of an old Base file into the new Base file's macro storage area.
36 svtools%3ACheckBox%3ADLG_LOGIN%3ACB_LOGIN_SAVEPASSWORD 99 Select to use the same user name and password without further dialog, when you connect again to the same data source in the current %PRODUCTNAME session.
2e svtools%3AEdit%3ADLG_LOGIN%3AED_LOGIN_PASSWORD 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
2e svtools%3AEdit%3ADLG_LOGIN%3AED_LOGIN_USERNAME 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
17 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD 36 The Query Wizard helps you to design a database query.
24 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTSELFIELDS 3b Displays all fields that will be included in the new query.
21 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTTABLES 39 Specifies the table for which the query is to be created.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND4 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND3 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND2 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDESCEND1 40 Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically descending order.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT4 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT3 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND4 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND3 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND2 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTASCEND1 3f Click to sort in alphabetically or numerically ascending order.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT2 64 Specifies additional fields by which the created query is sorted, if previous sort fields are equal.
1d WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_SORT1 39 Specifies the field by which the created query is sorted.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_2 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_3 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTVALUE_1 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_3 24 Select the condition for the filter.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_1 24 Select the condition for the filter.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTOPERATOR_2 24 Select the condition for the filter.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_3 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_1 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFIELDNAME_2 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMATCHANY 47 Select to filter the query by any of the conditions using a logical OR.
23 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMATCHALL 45 Select to filter the query by all the conditions using a logical AND.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_BTNAGGREGATEPLUS 1e Appends a new row of controls.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTAGGREGATEFIELDS_1 1e Select the numeric field name.
2e WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTAGGREGATEFUNCTION_1 1e Select the aggregate function.
29 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_BTNAGGREGATEMINUS 21 Removes the last row of controls.
30 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTAGGREGATESUMMARYQUERY 33 Select to show only results of aggregate functions.
2f WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTAGGREGATEDETAILQUERY 28 Select to show all records of the query.
2a WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERSELFIELDS 3b Displays all fields that are to be used to group the query.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_1 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_3 26 Select the condition for the grouping.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_2 26 Select the condition for the grouping.
2b WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTEROPERATOR_1 26 Select the condition for the grouping.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_3 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_3 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_1 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTFILTERVALUE_2 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
2c WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_LSTFILTERFIELDNAME_2 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTGROUPMATCHANY 46 Select to group the query by any of the conditions using a logical OR.
28 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTGROUPMATCHALL 44 Select to group the query by all the conditions using a logical AND.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTTITLE_1 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
26 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTMODIFYQUERY 31 Select to save the query and open it for editing.
22 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTSUMMARY 20 Displays a summary of the query.
27 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_OPTDISPLAYQUERY 25 Select to save and display the query.
25 WIZARDS_HID_QUERYWIZARD_TXTQUERYTITLE 34 Zadajte uživateľské meno na prístup k databáze.
2f modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fdatetimedialog%2Ftime 94 Enable Include Time to insert a time field into the active area of the report. The time field displays the current time when the report is executed.
2f modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fdatetimedialog%2Fdate 94 Enable Include Date to insert a date field into the active area of the report. The date field displays the current date when the report is executed.
39 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fdatetimedialog%2FDateTimeDialog 5f You can open the Date and Time dialog of the Report Builder by choosing Insert - Date and Time.
1a .uno%3AInsertDateTimeField 5f You can open the Date and Time dialog of the Report Builder by choosing Insert - Date and Time.
1a .uno%3ASectionShrinkBottom 3a Shrinks the selected section to remove bottom empty space.
17 .uno%3ASectionShrinkTop 37 Shrinks the selected section to remove top empty space.
11 .uno%3AHFixedLine 2e Inserts a horizontal line to the current area.
11 .uno%3AVFixedLine 2c Inserts a vertical line to the current area.
14 .uno%3AGreatestWidth 5b Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the greatest width.
14 .uno%3ASmallestWidth 5b Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the smallest width.
19 .uno%3ASectionAlignBottom 65 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the bottom margin of the area.
14 .uno%3ASectionShrink 42 Shrinks the selected section to remove top and bottom empty space.
16 .uno%3ASectionAlignTop 62 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the top margin of the area.
18 .uno%3ASectionAlignRight 64 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the right margin of the area.
15 .uno%3AGreatestHeight 5c Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the greatest height.
15 .uno%3ASmallestHeight 5c Select two or more objects and click this icon to resize the objects to the smallest height.
17 .uno%3ASectionAlignLeft 63 Select two or more objects and click this icon to align the objects at the left margin of the area.
28 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_INITIALFORMULA 5a Enter the initial value for the evaluation of the formula. Often this is set to 0 or to 1.
12 .uno%3ANewFunction a9 In the context menu of the Report Navigator, you see the same commands as in the Report Builder view, plus additional commands to create new functions or to delete them.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PREEVALUATED 57 If Pre evaluation is enabled, functions are evaluated only when the report is finished.
28 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_DEEPTRAVERSING e8 If Deep traversing is enabled, functions are evaluated considering all lower levels of hierarchy. This would be used for instance for line numbering. If Deep traversing is not enabled, only the first level of hierarchy is evaluated.
21 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_FORMULA 44 Enter the formula that defines the function. Use OpenFormula syntax.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_REPORT_NAVIGATOR_TREE 9f Click an entry in the Report Navigator. The corresponding object or area is selected in the Report Builder view. Right-click an entry to open the context menu.
16 .uno%3AReportNavigator 7f The Report Navigator reveals the structure of the report. You can use the Report Navigator to insert functions into the report.
36 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Falignment 9 Alignment
34 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Ftoppage 14 Top of Page (Header)
37 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Fbottompage 17 Bottom of Page (Footer)
35 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Fpagenofm b Page N of M
32 modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2Fpagen 6 Page N
3d modules%2Fdbreport%2Fui%2Fpagenumberdialog%2FPageNumberDialog 5d You can open the Page Numbers dialog of the Report Builder by choosing Insert - Page Numbers.
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_DATAFIELD 43 On the Data tab page, you can change the data contents to be shown.
22 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_FONT 2d Select the font for the selected text object.
27 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_POSITIONY 2a Set the Y Position for the selected object
22 EXTENSIONS_HID_PROP_VERTICAL_ALIGN f Vert. Alignment
27 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_POSITIONX 2a Set the X Position for the selected object
25 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRESERVEIRI f5 For a picture, you can specify to either insert the picture as a link to a file or only as an embedded object in the Base file. The embedded option increases the size of the Base file, while the link option is not as portable to other computers.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_FORCENEWPAGE 66 Force New Page specifies whether the current section and/or the next section is printed on a new page.
34 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_CONDITIONALPRINTEXPRESSION 5b If the Conditional Print Expression evaluates to TRUE, the selected object will be printed.
29 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_BACKTRANSPARENT 51 Specifies whether the background of the selected object is transparent or opaque.
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_WIDTH 26 Sets the width of the selected object.
23 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_BACKCOLOR 53 Sets the background color for the selected object, both on screen and for printing.
21 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_VISIBLE 68 An invisible object is not shown in the executed report. It is still visible in the Report Builder view.
25 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_NEWROWORCOL 93 New Row Or Column specifies, for a multi-column design, whether the current section and/or the next section will be printed on a new row or column.
2b REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_GROUPKEEPTOGETHER 5c Groups are kept together by page or by column (default). You must enable Keep Together also.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_KEEPTOGETHER 78 Keep Together specifies to print the current object starting on top of a new page if it doesn't fit on the current page.
2d REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRINTREPEATEDVALUES 23 Specifies to print repeated values.
2a REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PAGEFOOTEROPTION 78 Specifies in which context the page footer will be printed: on all pages, or not on pages with a report header or footer
2a REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PAGEHEADEROPTION 79 Specifies in which context the page header will be printed: on all pages, or not on pages with a report header or footer.
24 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_RPT_HEIGHT 2a Defines the height of the selected object.
13 .uno%3ASelectReport 5a To display the Data or General tab page for the whole report, choose Edit - Select Report.
2e REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_PROP_PRINTWHENGROUPCHANGE 17 Print when group change
1e REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_FIELD_SEL c4 The Add Field window is shown automatically when you have selected a table in the Contents box and leave that box. You can also click the Add Field icon on the toolbar, or choose View - Add Field.
41 reportdesign%3AListBox%3ARID_GROUPS_SORTING%3ALST_KEEPTOGETHERLST 4e Select the level of detail by which a group is kept together on the same page.
25 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_GROUPSORT_DELETE 29 Removes the selected field from the list.
40 REPORTDESIGN_NUMERICFIELD_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_ED_GROUPINTERVALLST 3b Enter the group interval value that records are grouped by.
36 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_LST_GROUPONLST 4b Select to create a new group on each changed value, or on other properties.
35 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_LST_FOOTERLST 28 Select to show or hide the Group Footer.
35 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_LST_HEADERLST 28 Select to show or hide the Group Header.
31 REPORTDESIGN_LISTBOX_RID_GROUPS_SORTING_LST_ORDER 19 Select the sorting order.
28 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_GROUPSORT_MOVE_DOWN 2a Moves the selected field down in the list.
26 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_GROUPSORT_MOVE_UP 28 Moves the selected field up in the list.
24 REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_FIELDEXPRESSION 37 Click to open a list from which you can select a field.
1e REPORTDESIGN_HID_RPT_GROUPSBRW 9f Lists the fields that will be used for sorting or grouping. The field at the top has the highest priority, the second field has the second priority, and so on.
1b .uno%3ADbSortingAndGrouping b2 In the Sorting and Grouping dialog of Report Builder, you can define the fields that should be sorted in your report, and the fields that should be kept together to form a group.
1b WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_DIALOG 36 The Table Wizard helps you to create a database table.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDSSELECTED 3b Displays all fields that will be included in the new table.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LBTABLES a2 Select one of the sample tables. Then select fields from that table from the left list box. Repeat this step until you have selected all the fields that you need.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPTPRIVATE 3e Select the private category to see only private sample tables.
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPTBUSINESS 40 Select the business category to see only business sample tables.
23 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_AUTOINCREMENTVALUE 70 Enter the SQL command specifier that instructs the data source to auto-increment a specified Integer data field.
1d DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_REQUIRED 2c If set to Yes, this field must not be empty.
22 DBACCESS_HID_TAB_ENT_AUTOINCREMENT 53 If set to Yes, the values for this data field are generated by the database engine.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_COLNAME 56 Zobrazuje názov vybraného dátového poľa. Taktiež je možné zadať nový názov.
1c WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDPLUS 25 Add a new data field to the list box.
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDMINUS 2c Remove the selected field from the list box.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LB_SELFIELDNAMES 36 Select a field in order to edit the field information.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_FIELDS_PK_AVAILABLE 47 Select a field and click > to add it to the list of primary key fields.
2e WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CK_PK_AUTOVALUE_AUTOMATIC b6 Select to automatically insert a value and increment the field's value for each new record. The database must support automatic incrementation in order to use the Auto value feature.
2a WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CMDREMOVE_PK_SELECTED aa Select a field and click < to remove it from the list of primary key fields. The primary key is created as a concatenation of the fields in this list, from top to bottom.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CK_PK_AUTOVALUE b6 Select to automatically insert a value and increment the field's value for each new record. The database must support automatic incrementation in order to use the Auto value feature.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LB_PK_FIELDNAME 16 Select the field name.
23 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_SEVERAL 4d Select to create a primary key from a combination of several existing fields.
22 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_SINGLE 44 Select to use an existing field with unique values as a primary key.
25 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_PK_AUTOMATIC 41 Select to automatically add a primary key as an additional field.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_CHK_USEPRIMEKEY cd Select to create a primary key. Add a primary key to every database table to uniquely identify each record. For some database systems within %PRODUCTNAME, a primary key is mandatory for editing the tables.
28 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_STARTFORMWIZARD 83 Select to create a form based on this table. The form is created on a text document with the last used settings of the Form Wizard.
24 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_MODIFYTABLE 41 Select to save the table design and open the table to enter data.
26 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_OPT_WORKWITHTABLE 29 Select to save and edit the table design.
1f WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LST_SCHEMA 52 Select the schema for the table. (Available only if the database supports schemas)
20 WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_LST_CATALOG 54 Select the catalog for the table. (Available only if the database supports catalogs)
1d WIZARDS_HID_DLGTABLE_TXT_NAME 19 Specifies the table name.
15 .uno%3ADBReportDelete 24 Odstráni vybraného používateľa.
13 .uno%3ADBReportEdit 37 Opens the selected report so you can change the layout.
13 .uno%3ADBFormRename 24 Odstráni vybraného používateľa.
13 .uno%3ADBFormDelete 24 Odstráni vybraného používateľa.
13 .uno%3ADBReportOpen 57 Otvorí vybraný dotaz tak, aby ste mohli zadávať, upravovať alebo zmazať záznamy.
11 .uno%3ADBFormEdit 35 Opens the selected form so you can change the layout.
11 .uno%3ADBFormOpen 57 Otvorí vybraný dotaz tak, aby ste mohli zadávať, upravovať alebo zmazať záznamy.
14 .uno%3ADBQueryDelete 24 Odstráni vybraného používateľa.
15 .uno%3ADBReportRename 24 Odstráni vybraného používateľa.
12 .uno%3ADBQueryEdit 39 Opens the selected query so you can change the structure.
14 .uno%3ADBQueryRename 24 Odstráni vybraného používateľa.
12 .uno%3ADBQueryOpen 57 Otvorí vybraný dotaz tak, aby ste mohli zadávať, upravovať alebo zmazať záznamy.
14 .uno%3ADBTableRename 24 Odstráni vybraného používateľa.
14 .uno%3ADBTableDelete 24 Odstráni vybraného používateľa.
12 .uno%3ADBTableEdit 39 Opens the selected table so you can change the structure.
12 .uno%3ADBTableOpen 57 Otvorí vybraný dotaz tak, aby ste mohli zadávať, upravovať alebo zmazať záznamy.
c FontWork2TBO 25 Zadajte rozostup znakov písmomaľby.
26 .uno%3AFontworkCharacterSpacingFloater 2a Otvorí okno Písmomaľba-rozostup znakov.
c FontWork1TBO 42 Kliknutím aplikujete zarovnanie na vybrané objekty písmomaľby.
3c SVX_HID_SVX_CHINESE_TRANSLATION_RB_CONVERSION_TO_TRADITIONAL 4c Kliknite pre použitie rozostupu znakov písmomaľby na vyznačené objekty.
1f .uno%3AFontworkAlignmentFloater 25 Otvorí okno Zarovnanie písmomaľby.
20 .uno%3AFontworkSameLetterHeights 6c Prepne výšku písmen vybraného objektu písmomaľby z normálnej na rovnakú výšku pre všetky objekty.
19 .uno%3AFontworkShapeTypes 64 Otvorí panel Tvar písmomaľby. Kliknite na tvar na jeho použitie na všetky objekty písmomaľby.
39 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS%3ABTN_KEEPALLOTHERS 55 Zachovajte všetky zmeny ostatných používateľov, odstráňte všetky vaše zmeny.
35 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS%3ABTN_KEEPOTHER 40 Zachovajte zmenu iného používateľa, odstráňte vašu zmenu.
37 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS%3ABTN_KEEPALLMINE 39 Zachovajte všetky vaše zmeny, zrušte všetky ostatné.
34 sc%3APushButton%3ARID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS%3ABTN_KEEPMINE 30 Zachovajte vaše zmeny, zrušte ostatné zmeny .
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fsharedocumentdlg%2Fshare 10f Povolenie zdieľať ten istý dokument s inými používateľmi. Zakázať použitie nezdieľaných dokumentov. Toto môže zrušiť platnosť doteraz neuložených úprav, ktoré vykonali iní používatelia od doby, čo bol dokument naposledy otvorený alebo uložený.
16 SC_HID_SCDLG_CONFLICTS a5 Ak sú rovnaké obsahy zmenené rôznymi používateľmi, otvorí sa dialóg Riešenie Konfliktov. Pri každom konflikte rozhodnite, ktoré zmeny sa majú zachovať.
3d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fsharedocumentdlg%2FShareDocumentDialog 80 Otvorenie dialógu na nastavenie zdieľania dokumentu, kde sa dá povoliť alebo zakázať spoluprácu so zdieľaním dokumentu.
14 .uno%3AShareDocument 80 Otvorenie dialógu na nastavenie zdieľania dokumentu, kde sa dá povoliť alebo zakázať spoluprácu so zdieľaním dokumentu.
15 .uno%3AFormFilterExit 6a Pokiaľ kliknete na tlačidlo Zavrieť na paneli Filtrovanie formulára, zobrazí sa formulár bez filtru.
18 .uno%3AFormFilterExecute 5f Pokiaľ kliknete na ikonu Použiť filter na paneli Filtrovanie formulára, použije sa filter.
1e .uno%3AConfigureToolboxVisible 47 Otvorte okno, v ktorom môžete pridať, upraviť alebo odobrať ikony.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fnewtoolbardialog%2FNewToolbarDialog 47 Otvorte okno, v ktorom môžete pridať, upraviť alebo odobrať ikony.
16 SVX_HID_FM_IS_NOT_NULL d3 Podmienku filtra môžete upraviť priamo ako text. Pokiaľ chcete testovať, či pole má alebo nemá obsah, môžete vybrať podmienku filtra "prázdne" (SQL:"Is Null") alebo "neprázdne" (SQL: "Is not Null").
19 SVX_HID_FM_FILTER_IS_NULL d3 Podmienku filtra môžete upraviť priamo ako text. Pokiaľ chcete testovať, či pole má alebo nemá obsah, môžete vybrať podmienku filtra "prázdne" (SQL:"Is Null") alebo "neprázdne" (SQL: "Is not Null").
f SVX_HID_FM_EDIT d3 Podmienku filtra môžete upraviť priamo ako text. Pokiaľ chcete testovať, či pole má alebo nemá obsah, môžete vybrať podmienku filtra "prázdne" (SQL:"Is Null") alebo "neprázdne" (SQL: "Is not Null").
18 SVX_HID_FILTER_NAVIGATOR 195 The filter conditions that have been set appear in the Filter navigator. As soon as a filter is set, you see a blank filter entry at the bottom of the Filter navigator . You can select this entry by clicking the word "Or". Once you have selected the blank filter entry, you can enter additional filter conditions in the form. These conditions are linked by Boolean OR to the previously defined conditions.
1a .uno%3AFormFilterNavigator 7a Ak chcete spojiť viac podmienok pre filtre booleovským OR, kliknite na Navigácia filtra na paneli Formulárový Filter.
1e SVX_HID_CTL_FONTWORK_FAVORITES bc Select a Fontwork style and click OK to insert the Fontwork into your document. Double-click or Ctrl+double-click the Fontwork in your document to enter text edit mode and change the text.
12 .uno%3ASaveGraphic 99 To export a bitmap in Writer: Right-click the bitmap, choose Save Graphics. You see the Graphics Export dialog. Enter a file name and select a file type.
1c .uno%3APreviousTrackedChange 41 Jumps to and selects the previous change in the document, if any.
18 .uno%3ANextTrackedChange 3d Jumps to and selects the next change in the document, if any.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AOpenButton 35 The Open a Document icon presents a file open dialog.
26 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3ATemplateButton 3c The Templates icon opens the Templates and Documents dialog.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AMathButton 3f Všetky tlačidlá dokumentov otvárajú dokument daného typu.
25 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AImpressButton 3f Všetky tlačidlá dokumentov otvárajú dokument daného typu.
20 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3ADBButton 3f Všetky tlačidlá dokumentov otvárajú dokument daného typu.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3ACalcButton 3f Všetky tlačidlá dokumentov otvárajú dokument daného typu.
24 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AWriterButton 3f Všetky tlačidlá dokumentov otvárajú dokument daného typu.
24 sfx2%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2Fall_recent 36 Click an icon to open a new document or a file dialog.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AExtensions 36 Click an icon to open a new document or a file dialog.
1c .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3AInfo 36 Click an icon to open a new document or a file dialog.
22 .HelpId%3AStartCenter%3ADrawButton 3f Všetky tlačidlá dokumentov otvárajú dokument daného typu.
25 sfx2%2Fui%2Fstartcenter%2FStartCenter 36 Click an icon to open a new document or a file dialog.
15 FWK_HID_BACKINGWINDOW 36 Click an icon to open a new document or a file dialog.
c .uno%3AAbout 52 Zobrazí všeobecné informácie o programe ako číslo verzie a autorské práva.
13 .uno%3AOnlineUpdate 10a Povoľte pre %PRODUCTNAME prístup na Internet. Ak potrebujete použiť proxy, zadajte potrebné údaje v nastavení proxy podNástroje - Možnosti - Internet. Potom zvoľte možnosť Online aktualizácia pre overenie dostupnosti novej verzie kancelárskeho balíka.
12 .uno%3AShowCredits c9 Zobrazí dokument CREDITS.odt, ktorý obsahuje zoznam jednotlivcov, ktorí od 28. 9. 2010 prispeli do zdrojového kódu OpenOffice.org (a ich príspevky boli importované do LibreOffice) a LibreOffice.
12 .uno%3AShowLicense 32 Zobrazí dialóg Licenčné a právne informácie.
10 .uno%3AHelpIndex 51 Otvorí hlavnú stránku pomocníka $[officename] pre práve bežiacu aplikáciu.
13 .uno%3ASendFeedback 60 Otvorí vo webovom prehliadači formulár, pomocou ktorého môžete nahlásiť chyby softvéru.
f .uno%3AHelpMenu 50 Menu Pomocník umožňuje spustiť a ovládať systém pomocníka $[officename].
13 .uno%3AExtendedHelp 54 Povolí rozšírené tipy pomocníka pod kurzorom myši až do ďalšieho kliknutia.
e RID_ENVTOOLBOX 43 Štandardný panel je dostupný v každej aplikácii $[officename].
18 .HelpId%3Atableobjectbar 7e Panel Tabuľka obsahuje funkcie, ktoré potrebujete na prácu s tabuľkou. Zobrazí sa, pokiaľ umiestnite kurzor do tabuľky.
14 .uno%3ADSBFormLetter 5e Spustí Sprievodcu hromadnou korešpondenciou, ktorý vám pomôže vytvoriť hromadné listy.
17 .uno%3ADSBInsertColumns 5b Vloží všetky polia z označeného záznamu do aktuálneho dokumentu na pozíciu kurzoru.
10 .uno%3ANewRecord 17 Vytvorí nový záznam.
e .uno%3ARecUndo 33 Umožňuje vám vrátiť zmenu v dátovej položke.
e .uno%3ARecSave 44 Uloží novú dátovú položku. Zmena je zaznamenaná do databázy.
11 .uno%3ALastRecord 23 Presunie vás na posledný záznam.
11 .uno%3ANextRecord 26 Presunie vás na nasledujúci záznam.
13 .uno%3ADeleteRecord 41 Odstráni záznam. Príkaz je treba pred odstránením potvrdiť.
11 .uno%3APrevRecord 2a Presunie vás na predchádzajúci záznam.
12 .uno%3AFirstRecord 1f Presunie vás na prvý záznam.
15 .uno%3AAbsoluteRecord 54 Zobrazuje číslo aktuálneho záznamu. Zadajte číslo k prechodu na daný záznam.
e .uno%3AGridUse 45 Určuje, že je možné pohybovať objektmi len medzi bodmi mriežky.
12 .uno%3ABezierClose 1c Uzavrie čiaru alebo krivku.
16 .uno%3ABezierSymmetric 3a Prevedie rohový bod alebo hladký bod na symetrický bod.
13 .uno%3ABezierSmooth 38 Prevedie uhlový bod alebo súmerný bod na hladký bod.
1c .uno%3ABezierEliminatePoints 3b Označí aktuálny bod alebo vybrané body na odstránenie.
11 .uno%3ABezierEdge 31 Prevedie vybratý bod alebo body na uhlové body.
14 .uno%3ABezierCutLine 70 Ikona Rozdeliť krivku rozdelí krivku. Vyberte bod alebo body, kde chcete krivku rozdeliť a kliknite na ikonu.
14 .uno%3ABezierConvert 33 Prevedie krivku na priamku alebo priamku na krivku.
13 .uno%3ABezierDelete 9c Pomocou ikony Zmazať body odstránite jeden alebo viac vybraných bodov. Ak chcete vybrať niekoľko bodov, podržte Shift a kliknite na požadované body.
13 .uno%3ABezierInsert 44 Aktivuje režim vkladania. V tomto režime je možné vkladať body.
11 .uno%3ABezierMove 34 Aktivuje režim, v ktorom je možné presúvat body.
12 HID_BEZIER_TOOLBOX 65 Panel Upraviť body sa zobrazí, keď vyberiete objekt zložený z bodov a kliknete na Upraviť body.
1a CUI_HID_OFADLG_TREELISTBOX 18 Select an entry to edit.
18 .uno%3AOptionsTreeDialog 43 This command opens a dialog for a customized program configuration.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Femail 19 Type your e-mail address.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Femail 19 Type your e-mail address.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Ffax 23 Type your fax number in this field.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fwork 24 Type your work number in this field.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fhome 31 Type your private telephone number in this field.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fposition 30 Type your position in the company in this field.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fposition 30 Type your position in the company in this field.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Ftitle 1e Type your title in this field.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Ffax 23 Type your fax number in this field.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Feastfirstname 15 Type your first name.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fstate 10 Type your state.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Feastlastname 14 Type your last name.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Ficity 1d Type the city where you live.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Ficity 1d Type the city where you live.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fizip 1c Type your ZIP in this field.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fstreet 2b Type the name of your street in this field.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fizip 1c Type your ZIP in this field.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fcompany 2c Type the name of your company in this field.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Ftitle 1e Type your title in this field.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fstreet 2b Type the name of your street in this field.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Frusshortname 13 Type your initials.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Flastname 14 Type your last name.
1c cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Ffax 23 Type your fax number in this field.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fshortname 13 Type your initials.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Feastshortname 13 Type your initials.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fshortname 13 Type your initials.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Frusfirstname 15 Type your first name.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fstreet 2b Type the name of your street in this field.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fizip 1c Type your ZIP in this field.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fruslastname 14 Type your last name.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Ficity 1d Type the city where you live.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Flastname 14 Type your last name.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fstate 10 Type your state.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Femail 19 Type your e-mail address.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fbusinessdatapage%2Fcompany 2c Type the name of your company in this field.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fcity 1d Type the city where you live.
1c cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Fzip 1c Type your ZIP in this field.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2FOptUserPage 2d Use this tab page to enter or edit user data.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Fstate 10 Type your state.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptuserpage%2Ffirstname 15 Type your first name.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprivateuserpage%2Ffirstname 15 Type your first name.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fsaveas b1 Specifies how documents of the type selected on the left will always be saved as this file type. You may select another file type for the current document in the Save as dialog.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Frelative_inet 3c Select this box for relative saving of URLs to the Internet.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fdoctype 51 Specifies the document type for which you want to define the default file format.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Frelative_fsys 3f Select this box for relative saving of URLs in the file system.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fuserautosave 8d Specifies that %PRODUCTNAME saves all open documents when saving auto recovery information. Uses the same time interval as AutoRecovery does.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fautosave_spin 49 Specifies the time interval in minutes for the automatic recovery option.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fodfversion fc Some companies or organizations may require ODF documents in the ODF 1.0/1.1 format. You can select that format to save in the listbox. This older format cannot store all new features, so the new format ODF 1.2 (Extended) is recommended where possible.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fautosave 94 Specifies that %PRODUCTNAME saves the information needed to restore all open documents in case of a crash. You can specify the saving time interval.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fbackup d5 Saves the previous version of a document as a backup copy whenever you save a document. Every time %PRODUCTNAME creates a backup copy, the previous backup copy is replaced. The backup copy gets the extension .BAK.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fwarnalienformat c2 You can choose to get a warning message when you save a document in a format that is not OpenDocument or which you did not set as default format in Load/Save - General in the Options dialog box.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fdocinfo 5b Specifies that the Properties dialog will appear every time you select the Save As command.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fload_docprinter 16c If enabled, the printer settings will be loaded with the document. This can cause a document to be printed on a distant printer, if you do not change the printer manually in the Print dialog. If disabled, your standard printer will be used to print this document. The current printer settings will be stored with the document whether or not this option is checked.
20 sfx%2Fui%2Falienwarndialog%2Fask c2 You can choose to get a warning message when you save a document in a format that is not OpenDocument or which you did not set as default format in Load/Save - General in the Options dialog box.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2Fload_settings 47 Loads the user-specific settings saved in a document with the document.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptsavepage%2FOptSavePage 72 In the General section, you can select default settings for saving documents, and can select default file formats.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptpathspage%2Fedit 36 Click to display the Select Path or Edit Paths dialog.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptpathspage%2Fdefault 48 The Default button resets the predefined paths for all selected entries.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptpathspage%2Fpaths 65 To modify an entry in this list, click the entry and click Edit. You can also double click the entry.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptpathspage%2FOptPathsPage 75 This section contains the default paths to important folders in $[officename]. These paths can be edited by the user.
3b cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_MULTIPATH%3ABTN_ADD_MULTIPATH 60 Opens the Select Path dialog to select another folder or the Open dialog to select another file.
33 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_MULTIPATH%3ALB_MULTIPATH 5f Contains a list of the paths that have already been added. Mark the default path for new files.
12 .uno%3ASpellOnline 41 Automatically checks spelling as you type, and underlines errors.
19 CUI_HID_CLB_LINGU_OPTIONS 37 Defines the options for the spellcheck and hyphenation.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingudictsdelete 59 Deletes the selected dictionary after a confirmation, provided it is not write-protected.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fbreaknumberoptions%2FBreakNumberOption 50 Type the minimum number of characters that must come before or after the hyphen.
2c cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Fnewreplace a0 Adds the word in the Word text field to your current custom dictionary. The word in the Suggestion field is also added when working with exception dictionaries.
19 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_DICT_EDIT 71 Opens the Edit custom dictionary dialog, in which you can add to your custom dictionary or edit existing entries.
36 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2FEditDictionaryDialog 20 Specifies the book to be edited.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flinguoptionsedit 44 If you want to change a value, select the entry and then click Edit.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingudictsedit 71 Opens the Edit custom dictionary dialog, in which you can add to your custom dictionary or edit existing entries.
26 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Fbook 20 Specifies the book to be edited.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptnewdictionarydialog%2Fexcept 44 Specifies whether you wish to avoid certain words in your documents.
1d CUI_HID_CLB_EDIT_MODULES_DICS 26 Lists the available user dictionaries.
26 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Flang 38 Assigns a new language to the current custom dictionary.
28 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Fdelete 3b Removes the marked word from the current custom dictionary.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptnewdictionarydialog%2Fnameedit 30 Specifies the name of the new custom dictionary.
3a cui%2Fui%2Foptnewdictionarydialog%2FOptNewDictionaryDialog 30 Specifies the name of the new custom dictionary.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingudictsnew 8a Opens the New Dictionary dialog, in which you can name a new user-defined dictionary or dictionary of exceptions and specify the language.
18 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_DICT_NEW 8a Opens the New Dictionary dialog, in which you can name a new user-defined dictionary or dictionary of exceptions and specify the language.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptnewdictionarydialog%2Flanguage 4f By selecting a certain language you can limit the use of the custom dictionary.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlingupage%2Flingumodulesedit 34 To edit a language module, select it and click Edit.
26 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Fword 86 You can type a new word for inclusion in the dictionary. In the list below you will see the contents of the current custom dictionary.
19 CUI_HID_CLB_LINGU_MODULES 28 Contains the installed language modules.
29 cui%2Fui%2Feditdictionarydialog%2Freplace a6 This input field is only available if you are editing an exception dictionary. The field shows the alternative suggestion for the current word in the "Word" text box.
15 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_LINGU 46 Specifies the properties of the spellcheck, thesaurus and hyphenation.
46 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_EDIT_MODULES%3APB_EDIT_MODULES_PRIO_BACK 37 Click here to undo the current changes in the list box.
46 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_EDIT_MODULES%3APB_EDIT_MODULES_PRIO_DOWN 4b Decreases the priority of the module selected in the list box by one level.
44 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXDLG_EDIT_MODULES%3APB_EDIT_MODULES_PRIO_UP 4b Increases the priority of the module selected in the list box by one level.
42 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXDLG_EDIT_MODULES%3ALB_EDIT_MODULES_LANGUAGE 25 Specifies the language of the module.
20 CUI_HID_CLB_EDIT_MODULES_MODULES 71 Specifies the language and the available spelling, hyphenation and Thesaurus sub-modules for the selected module.
30 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_SAVE 63 Opens the Save As dialog, which enables you to save the current color table under a specified name.
30 cui%3AImageButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_LOAD 44 Accesses the Open dialog, which allows you to select a color palette
32 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_WORK_ON 44 Accesses the Open dialog, which allows you to select a color palette
31 cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_MODIFY 1a Changes the current color.
2e cui%3APushButton%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ABTN_ADD 11 Adds a new color.
15 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_RGB_2 5 Green
15 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_RGB_1 3 Red
31 cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ALB_COLORMODEL 5c To modify, select the color model: Red-Green-Blue (RGB) or Cyan-Magenta-Yellow-BlacK (CMYK).
15 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_RGB_3 4 Blue
2c cui%3AListBox%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3ALB_COLOR 51 Contains a list of available colors. To select a color, choose one from the list.
29 cui%3AEdit%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3AEDT_NAME 69 Specifies the name of a selected color. You can also type a name in this field when defining a new color.
15 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_COLOR 5e Allows you to select a color from a color table, edit an existing color, or define new colors.
2b svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_KEY 42 Sets the Black color value or key (black) in the CMYK color model.
32 svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_LUMINANCE 2b Sets the Brightness in the HSB color model.
2c svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_HUE 24 Sets the Hue in the HSB color model.
31 cui%3AMetricField%3ARID_SVXPAGE_COLOR%3AMTR_FLD_4 42 Sets the Black color value or key (black) in the CMYK color model.
2d svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_BLUE 31 Sets the Blue color value in the RGB color model.
2e svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_YELLOW 34 Sets the Yellow color value in the CMYK color model.
16 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_CMYK_3 34 Sets the Yellow color value in the CMYK color model.
2e svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_GREEN 32 Sets the Green color value in the RGB color model.
2c svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_RED 30 Sets the Red color value in the RGB color model.
2f svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_MAGENTA 35 Sets the Magenta color value in the CMYK color model.
16 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_CMYK_2 35 Sets the Magenta color value in the CMYK color model.
2c svtools%3AMetricField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_CYAN 32 Sets the Cyan color value in the CMYK color model.
33 svtools%3ANumericField%3ADLG_COLOR%3ANUM_SATURATION 2b Sets the Saturation in the HSB color model.
16 CUI_HID_TPCOLOR_CMYK_1 32 Sets the Cyan color value in the CMYK color model.
28 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_COLOR%3ABTN_2 b7 Sets the small selection cursor in the right window on the color, which corresponds to the selected color in the left window and updates the respective values in the numerical fields.
28 svtools%3APushButton%3ADLG_COLOR%3ABTN_1 b7 Click the <-- button to replace the selected color in the color palette with the color selected at the right. The button is enabled when you select a color in one of the four corners.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fyear 4a Defines a date range, within which the system recognizes a two-digit year.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Ffiledlg 84 Specifies whether $[officename] dialogs are used to open and save documents. Otherwise the dialogs of the operating system are used.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fdocstatus 48 Specifies whether the printing of the document counts as a modification.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fexthelp 63 Displays a help text when you rest the cursor on an icon, a menu command, or a control on a dialog.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Ftooltips 86 Displays the icon names and more bubble help information, for example, chapter names when you scroll through a document with chapters.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2FOptGeneralPage 31 Specifies the general settings for $[officename].
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Ffontheight 41 Select a font size for the display of HTML and Basic source code.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fnonpropfontonly 43 Check to display only non-proportional fonts in the Fonts list box.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Ffontname 3e Select the font for the display of HTML and Basic source code.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fdelete 26 Deletes the selected font replacement.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fapply 26 Applies the selected font replacement.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Ffont2 31 Enter or select the name of the replacement font.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Ffont1 3e Enter or select the name of the font that you want to replace.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fchecklb f0 Lists the original font and the font that will replace it. Select Always to replace the font, even if the original font is installed on your system. Select Screen only to replace the screen font only and never replace the font for printing.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2Fusetable 36 Enables the font replacement settings that you define.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptfontspage%2FOptFontsPage e6 Substitutes a font with a font of your choice. The substitution replaces a font only when it is displayed on screen, or on screen and when printing. The replacement does not change the font settings that are saved in the document.
2e svx%3AMetricField%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3AMF_SELECTION 7a Select the transparency level for transparent selections. The default value is 75%. You can select values from 10% to 90%.
30 cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_USE_HARDACCELL 63 Directly accesses hardware features of the graphical display adapter to improve the screen display.
2e cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_FONT_HISTORY 82 Lists the last five fonts that you used in the current document at the top of the list in the Font Name box on the Formatting bar.
29 cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_MOUSEPOS 52 Specifies if and how the mouse pointer will be positioned in newly opened dialogs.
19 .uno%3ARestoreEditingView 87 Specifies whether to restore the last used document view. Many view properties valid when the document was last saved will be restored.
12 .uno%3ARefreshView 4a Press Shift+Ctrl+R to restore or refresh the view of the current document.
2c cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_MOUSEMIDDLE 30 Defines the function of the middle mouse button.
2b cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_FONT_SHOW 7b Displays the names of selectable fonts in the corresponding font, for example, fonts in the Font box on the Formatting bar.
24 SVX_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_LB_ICONSTYLE 38 Select the icon style for icons in toolbars and dialogs.
2b svx%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_SELECTION b0 If enabled, the text selection in Writer and the cell selection in Calc will be shown using a transparent color. If not enabled, the selection will be shown by inverted colors.
27 SVX_CHECKBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_CB_SYSTEM_FONT 67 Specifies to use the system font to display all menus and dialogs. Else another installed font is used.
30 svx%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_USE_ANTIALIASE af When supported, you can enable and disable anti-aliasing of graphics. With anti-aliasing enabled, the display of most graphical objects looks smoother and with less artifacts.
2d cui%3ACheckBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ACB_SYSTEM_FONT 67 Specifies to use the system font to display all menus and dialogs. Else another installed font is used.
29 cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_ICONSIZE 2c Specifies the display size of toolbar icons.
2a cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_ICONSTYLE 38 Select the icon style for icons in toolbars and dialogs.
23 SVX_LISTBOX_OFA_TP_VIEW_LB_ICONSIZE 2c Specifies the display size of toolbar icons.
2f cui%3AMetricField%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3AMF_WINDOWSIZE 62 Uses percentile scaling for font size in user interface elements, such as dialogs and icon labels.
2b cui%3AListBox%3AOFA_TP_VIEW%3ALB_MENU_ICONS a4 Displays icons next to the corresponding menu items. Select from "Automatic", "Hide" and "Show". "Automatic" displays icons according to system settings and themes.
13 CUI_HID_OFA_TP_VIEW 17 Specifies view options.
23 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fpapersize 58 Mark this check box if a certain paper size is needed for printing the current document.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducegradcolor 49 Specifies that gradients are only printed in a single intermediate color.
2b sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducegradstripes 3e Specifies the maximum number of gradient stripes for printing.
1f sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Ftrans 69 Mark this check box if you always want to be warned if transparent objects are contained in the document.
2b sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmaptrans 75 If this field is marked, the reduction in print quality for bitmaps also applies to the transparent areas of objects.
2b sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmapresol 61 Specifies the maximum print quality in dpi. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmapdpi 61 Specifies the maximum print quality in dpi. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased.
2d sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmapoptimal 75 High print quality corresponds to a resolution of 300dpi. Normal print quality corresponds to a resolution of 200dpi.
28 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducegradstep 3e Specifies the maximum number of gradient stripes for printing.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmap 6e Specifies that bitmaps are printed with reduced quality. The resolution can only be reduced and not increased.
27 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fconverttogray 38 Specifies that all colors are printed only as grayscale.
21 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fprinter 57 Specifies whether the print settings apply to direct printing or to printing to a file.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducetransnone 2f With this option transparency is never printed.
2c sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducebitmapnormal 75 High print quality corresponds to a resolution of 300dpi. Normal print quality corresponds to a resolution of 200dpi.
29 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducetransauto 76 Specifies that the transparency is only printed if the transparent area covers less than a quarter of the entire page.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Fpaperorient 5e Mark this check box if you need a certain paper orientation for printing the current document.
25 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducetrans a5 If you mark this field the transparent objects will be printed like normal, non-transparent objects, depending on your selection in the following two option buttons.
1e sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Ffile 57 Specifies whether the print settings apply to direct printing or to printing to a file.
24 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2Freducegrad 44 If this field is marked, gradients are printed with reduced quality.
26 sfx%2Fui%2Foptprintpage%2FOptPrintPage 24 Specifies the print setting options.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptmemorypage%2Fsystray 89 Mark this check box if you want $[officename] to enable quickstart. This option is available if the Quickstart module has been installed.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptmemorypage%2Folecache 46 Choose the maximum number of OLE objects that are pooled in the cache.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptmemorypage%2Fobjecttime 4f Specifies the time that each graphic remains in the cache in hours and minutes.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptmemorypage%2Fquicklaunch 89 Mark this check box if you want $[officename] to enable quickstart. This option is available if the Quickstart module has been installed.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptmemorypage%2Fobjectcache 64 Specifies that objects which are larger than the selected megabytes will not be placed in the cache.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptmemorypage%2Fgraphiccache 30 Specifies the total cache size for all graphics.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptmemorypage%2Fundo 5b You can specify the number of steps which can be undone by selecting a number from the box.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptmemoryspage%2FOptMemoryPage 51 Defines the settings for the graphics cache and the number of steps you can undo.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2Fdelete 57 Deletes the color scheme shown in the Scheme box. You cannot delete the Default scheme.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2Fcolorconfig 32 Select the colors for the user interface elements.
27 CUI_HID_OPTIONS_COLORCONFIG_NAME_SCHEME 22 Enter a name for the color scheme.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2Fsave 47 Saves the current settings as a color scheme that you can reload later.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2Fcolorschemelb 29 Selects the color scheme you want to use.
30 cui%2Fui%2Foptappearancepage%2FOptAppearancePage 35 Sets the colors for the $[officename] user interface.
38 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fsystempagepreviewcolor 4c Applies the high contrast settings of the operating system to page previews.
2f cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fautofontcolor 6c Displays fonts in %PRODUCTNAME using the system color settings. This option only affects the screen display.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fautodetecthc 5c Switches %PRODUCTNAME into high contrast mode when the system background color is very dark.
32 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Ftiphelptimeoutnf 35 Enter the number of seconds to display the Help tips.
30 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Ftiphelptimeout 3f Hides the Help tips after the number of seconds that you enter.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fanimatedtext 48 Previews animated text, such as blinking and scrolling, in %PRODUCTNAME.
32 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Fanimatedgraphics 40 Previews animated graphics, such as GIF images, in %PRODUCTNAME.
33 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Ftextselinreadonly 27 Displays cursor in read-only documents.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2Facctool e1 Allows you to use assistive tools, such as external screen readers, Braille devices or speech recognition input devices. The Java Runtime Environment must be installed on your computer before you can enable assistive support.
36 cui%2Fui%2Foptaccessibilitypage%2FOptAccessibilityPage 83 Sets options that make %PRODUCTNAME programs more accessible for users with reduced sight, limited dexterity or other disabilities.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fftpport 31 Type the port for the corresponding proxy server.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fhttpsport 31 Type the port for the corresponding proxy server.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fnoproxy 62 Specifies the names of the servers that do not require any proxy servers, separated by semicolons.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fftp 2a Type the name of the proxy server for FTP.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fhttps 53 Type the name of the proxy server for HTTPS. Type the port in the right-hand field.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fhttpport 31 Type the port for the corresponding proxy server.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fproxymode 27 Specifies the type of proxy definition.
1e cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2Fhttp 2b Type the name of the proxy server for HTTP.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptproxypage%2FOptProxyPage 27 Specifies the type of proxy definition.
23 cui%2Fui%2Foptbrowserpage%2Fdisplay c4 Enables the Browser Plug-in to show %PRODUCTNAME documents in a browser window. Select, click OK, then restart your browser. Then, in the browser window, click any %PRODUCTNAME document hyperlink.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptbrowserpage%2FOptBrowserPage c4 Enables the Browser Plug-in to show %PRODUCTNAME documents in a browser window. Select, click OK, then restart your browser. Then, in the browser window, click any %PRODUCTNAME document hyperlink.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fmacro 20 Opens the Macro Security dialog.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fstoredwebconnectiondialog%2Fchange 51 Opens a dialog where you can view and change the password for the selected entry.
30 cui%2Fui%2Fstoredwebconnectiondialog%2Fremoveall 22 Removes all entries from the list.
40 cui%2Fui%2Fstoredwebconnectiondialog%2FStoredWebConnectionDialog 29 Removes the selected entry from the list.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Foptions 30 Opens the "Security options and warning" dialog.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fconnections 70 Asks for the master password. If master password is correct, shows the Stored Web Connection Information dialog.
2b uui%2Fui%2Fsetmasterpassworddlg%2Fpassword1 1a Enter the master password.
2b uui%2Fui%2Fsetmasterpassworddlg%2Fpassword2 20 Enter the master password again.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fwhenpdf 93 Select to see a warning dialog when you try to export a document to PDF format that displays recorded changes in Writer, or that displays comments.
39 cui%2Fui%2Fsetmasterpassworddlg%2FSetMasterPasswordDialog 1a Enter the master password.
38 cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2FSecurityOptionsDialog 7d Select to see a warning dialog when you try to save or send a document that contains recorded changes, versions, or comments.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fsavepassword bb If enabled, %PRODUCTNAME will securely store all passwords that you use to access files from web servers. You can retrieve the passwords from the list after you enter the master password.
2b cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fpassword 8e Select to always enable the Save with password option in the file save dialogs. Deselect the option to save files by default without password.
31 cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fremovepersonal d8 Select to always remove user data from the file properties. If this option is not selected, you can still remove the personal information for the current document with the Reset button on File - Properties - General.
2d cui%2Fui%2Fstoredwebconnectiondialog%2Fremove 29 Removes the selected entry from the list.
33 uui%2Fui%2Fmasterpassworddlg%2FMasterPasswordDialog 26 Enter the master password to continue.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fsavesenddocs 7d Select to see a warning dialog when you try to save or send a document that contains recorded changes, versions, or comments.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fwhensigning cb Select to see a warning dialog when you try to sign a document that contains recorded changes, versions, fields, references to other sources (for example linked sections or linked pictures), or comments.
2c cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fctrlclick 88 If enabled, you must hold down the Ctrl key while clicking a hyperlink to follow that link. If not enabled, a click opens the hyperlink.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2FOptSecurityPage 76 Defines the security options for saving documents, for web connections, and for opening documents that contain macros.
2f cui%2Fui%2Fsecurityoptionsdialog%2Fwhenprinting 6b Select to see a warning dialog when you try to print a document that contains recorded changes or comments.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptsecuritypage%2Fmasterpassword 27 Opens the Enter Master Password dialog.
27 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fprintextension 55 If you mark this field, the print layout of the current document is exported as well.
25 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsavegrflocal dd Mark this check box to automatically upload the embedded pictures to the Internet server when uploading using FTP. Use the Save As dialog to save the document and enter a complete FTP URL as the file name in the Internet.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fstarbasic 62 Mark this check box to include the $[officename] Basic instructions when exporting to HTML format.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fcharset 33 Select the appropriate character set for the export
28 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fignorefontnames 97 Mark this check box to ignore all font settings when importing. The fonts that were defined in the HTML Page Style will be the fonts that will be used.
23 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Funknowntag 67 Mark this check box if you want tags that are not recognized by $[officename] to be imported as fields.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fexport 32 Defines the settings for exporting HTML documents.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsize7 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML <font size=1> to <font size=7> tags.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsize6 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML <font size=1> to <font size=7> tags.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsize5 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML <font size=1> to <font size=7> tags.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fstarbasicwarning 6f If this field is marked, when exporting to HTML a warning is shown that %PRODUCTNAME Basic macros will be lost.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsize4 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML <font size=1> to <font size=7> tags.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsize3 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML <font size=1> to <font size=7> tags.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsize2 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML <font size=1> to <font size=7> tags.
29 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fnumbersenglishus d6 If not checked, numbers will be interpreted according to the setting in Language Settings - Language of - Locale setting in the Options dialog box. If checked, numbers will be interpreted as 'English (USA)' locale.
1e cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2Fsize1 7b Use the spin buttons Size 1 to Size 7 to define the respective font sizes for the HTML <font size=1> to <font size=7> tags.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fopthtmlpage%2FOptHtmlPage 20 Defines settings for HTML pages.
14 .uno%3ASwEditOptions a4 These settings determine the way text documents that are created in $[officename] are handled. It is also possible to define settings for the current text document.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fmeasureunit 26 Specifies the Unit for HTML documents.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fdrawings 3e Displays the drawings and controls contained in your document.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Ffieldcodes 4f Displays the field names in the document instead of the contents of the fields.
16 .uno%3ATableBoundaries 8c To display the table boundaries, right-click any table and choose Table Boundaries, or choose Table - Table Boundaries in a Writer document.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Ftables 2f Displays the tables contained in your document.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fgraphics 40 Specifies whether to display graphics and objects on the screen.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fvrulerright 30 Aligns the vertical ruler with the right border.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fhelplines ab Displays snap lines around the frames when frames are moved. You can select the Helplines While Moving option to show the exact position of the object using lineal values.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fhruler 5f Displays the horizontal ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fvrulercombobox 5d Displays the vertical ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fruler 59 Enables the rulers. Use the following two check boxes to select the ruler(s) to be shown.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fsmoothscroll 2d Activates the smooth page scrolling function.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fcomments dc Displays comments. Click a comment to edit the text. Use the context menu in Navigator to locate or delete a comment. Use the comments's context menu to delete this comment or all comments or all comments of this author.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fvscrollbar 20 Displays the vertical scrollbar.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fvruler 5d Displays the vertical ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fhscrollbar 22 Displays the horizontal scrollbar.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2Fhrulercombobox 5f Displays the horizontal ruler. Select the desired measurement unit from the corresponding list.
3a modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fviewoptionspage%2FViewOptionsPage 81 Defines the default settings for displaying objects in your text documents and also the default settings for the window elements.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Fdoconly 3f Specifies that the settings apply to the current document only.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Flabelbox 3e Specifies the font used for the captions of images and tables.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Ftitlebox 2b Specifies the font to be used for headings.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Findexheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Fidxbox 52 Specifies the font used for indexes, alphabetical indexes, and tables of contents.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Flistheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Ftitleheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Flistbox 43 Specifies the fonts for lists and numbering and all derived styles.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Flabelheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Fstandardheight 1f Specifies the size of the font.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2Fstandardbox 3e Specifies the font to be used for the Default Paragraph Style.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptfonttabpage%2FOptFontTabPage 3d Specifies the settings for the basic fonts in your documents.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fpapertray a9 For printers with multiple trays, the "Paper tray from printer settings" option specifies whether the paper tray used is specified by the system settings of the printer.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintEmptyPages%3ACheckBox 190 If this option is enabled, automatically-inserted blank pages are being printed. This is best if you are printing double-sided. For example, in a book, a "chapter" paragraph style has been set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to print that even numbered page or not.
3b .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintAnnotationMode%3AListBox 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fendpage 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fend 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fonly 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fnone 38 Specifies whether comments in your document are printed.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fleftpages 4a Specifies whether to print all left (even numbered) pages of the document.
3b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Ftextplaceholder 78 Enable this option to print text placeholders. Disable this option to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Frightpages 4a Specifies whether to print all right (odd numbered) pages of the document.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Ffax 84 If you have installed fax software on your computer and wish to fax directly from the text document, select the desired fax machine.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Frtl 59 Check to print the pages of the brochure in the correct order for a right-to-left script.
38 .HelpID%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintHiddenText%3ACheckBox 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fbackground 95 Specifies whether to include colors and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background) in the printed document.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2FPrintOptionsPage 38 Specifies print settings within a text or HTML document.
3c .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPageBackground%3ACheckBox 95 Specifies whether to include colors and objects that are inserted to the background of the page (Format - Page - Background) in the printed document.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fbrochure 45 Select the Brochure option to print your document in brochure format.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fhiddentext 3a Enable this option to print text that is marked as hidden.
38 .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintBlackFonts%3ACheckBox 30 Specifies whether to always print text in black.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fformcontrols 4b Specifies whether the form control fields of the text document are printed.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Finblack 30 Specifies whether to always print text in black.
36 .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintControls%3ACheckBox 4b Specifies whether the form control fields of the text document are printed.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fgraphics 41 Specifies whether the graphics of your text document are printed.
3d .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintTextPlaceholder%3ACheckBox 78 Enable this option to print text placeholders. Disable this option to leave the text placeholders blank in the printout.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fprintoptionspage%2Fblankpages 190 If this option is enabled, automatically-inserted blank pages are being printed. This is best if you are printing double-sided. For example, in a book, a "chapter" paragraph style has been set to always start with an odd numbered page. If the previous chapter ends on an odd page, %PRODUCTNAME inserts an even numbered blank page. This option controls whether to print that even numbered page or not.
40 .HelpId%3Avcl%3APrintDialog%3APrintPicturesAndObjects%3ACheckBox 41 Specifies whether the graphics of your text document are printed.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Ffix 56 Specifies that changes to a row or column only affect the corresponding adjacent area.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Ffixprop 4d Specifies that changes to a row or column have an effect on the entire table.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fcolinsert 32 Specifies the default value for inserting columns.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Frowmove 30 Specifies the value to be used for moving a row.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fnumalignment 43 Specifies that numbers are always bottom right aligned in the cell.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fnumformatting 4f Specifies that numbers in a text table are recognized and formatted as numbers.
2b modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fvar 40 Specifies that changes to a row or column affect the table size.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Frowinsert 2f Specifies the default value for inserting rows.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fnumfmtformatting 9a If Number format recognition is not marked, only input in the format that has been set at the cell is accepted. Any other input resets the format to Text.
1d .uno%3ATableNumberRecognition 4f Specifies that numbers in a text table are recognized and formatted as numbers.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fborder 34 Specifies that table cells have a border by default.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fdontsplit 43 Specifies that tables are not split by any type of text flow break.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Frepeatheader 59 Specifies whether the table heading is carried over onto the new page after a page break.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fcolmove 33 Specifies the value to be used for moving a column.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2Fheader 60 Specifies that the first row of the table is formatted with the "Table heading" Paragraph Style.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fopttablepage%2FOptTablePage 33 Defines the attributes of tables in text documents.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ffillspace 9f When the Direct Cursor is used, a corresponding number of tabs and spaces are inserted in the new paragraph as necessary until the clicked position is reached.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ffillmargin 102 Sets the paragraph alignment when the direct cursor is used. Depending on where the mouse is clicked, the paragraph is formatted left aligned, centered or right aligned. The cursor before the mouse-click shows, by means of a triangle, which alignment is set.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fcursoronoff 1c Activates the direct cursor.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fhiddentextfield 47 Displays text that is hidden by Conditional Text or Hidden Text fields.
39 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fcursorinprot 57 Specifies that you can set the cursor in a protected area, but cannot make any changes.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fbreak 82 Displays all line breaks inserted with the Shift+Enter shortcut. These breaks create a new line, but do not start a new paragraph.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ffillindent 9d When the direct cursor is used, the left paragraph indent is set at the horizontal position where you click the direct cursor. The paragraph is left aligned.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ftabs 37 Specifies that tab stops are displayed as small arrows.
37 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fhiddentext 66 Displays text that uses the character format "hidden", when View - Non-printing Characters is enabled.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fnonbreak af Specifies that non-breaking spaces are shown as gray boxes. Non-breaking spaces are not broken at the end of a line and are entered with the Ctrl+Shift+Spacebar shortcut keys.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fhiddenparafield 6e If you have inserted text using the Hidden Paragraph field, specifies whether to display the hidden paragraph.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fspaces 42 Specifies whether to represent every space in the text with a dot.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Ffilltab 7f When the direct cursor is used, as many tabs as necessary are added in the new paragraph until the clicked position is reached.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fhyphens 166 Specifies whether user-defined delimiters are displayed. These are hidden delimiters that you enter within a word by pressing Ctrl+Hyphen(-). Words with user-defined delimiters are only separated at the end of a line at the point where a user-defined delimiter has been inserted, irrespective of whether the automatic hyphenation is activated or deactivated.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2Fparagraph 79 Specifies whether paragraph delimiters are displayed. The paragraph delimiters also contain paragraph format information.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptformataidspage%2FOptFormatAidsPage 6f In $[officename] text and HTML documents, defines the display for certain characters and for the direct cursor.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fmarkcolor 43 Specifies the color for highlighting the changed lines in the text.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fchangedcolor e8 You can also choose a color to display each type of recorded change. When you choose the condition "By author" in the list, the color is automatically determined by $[officename], then modified to match to the author of each change.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fdeletedcolor e8 You can also choose a color to display each type of recorded change. When you choose the condition "By author" in the list, the color is automatically determined by $[officename], then modified to match to the author of each change.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fmarkpos 3e Defines if and where changed lines in the document are marked.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Finsertcolor e8 You can also choose a color to display each type of recorded change. When you choose the condition "By author" in the list, the color is automatically determined by $[officename], then modified to match to the author of each change.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fchanged 88 Defines how changes to text attributes are displayed in the document. These changes affect attributes such as bold, italic or underline.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Fdeleted ca Specifies how changes in the document are displayed when text is deleted. If you record text deletions, the text is displayed with the selected attribute (for example, strikethrough) and is not deleted.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2Finsert 4a Specifies how changes in the document are displayed when text is inserted.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptredlinepage%2FOptRedLinePage 32 Defines the appearance of changes in the document.
34 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fsquaremode 47 When this setting is enabled, the text grid will look like square page.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fmetric 35 Specifies the unit of measurement for text documents.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fupdatefields c8 The contents of all fields are updated automatically whenever the screen contents are displayed as new. Even with this box unchecked, some fields are updated each time a special condition takes place.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fnever 31 Links are never updated while loading a document.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fupdatecharts be Specifies whether to automatically update charts. Whenever a Writer table cell value changes and the cursor leaves that cell, the chart that displays the cell value is updated automatically.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Fneverrb 31 Links are never updated while loading a document.
2d modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Ftab 37 Specifies the spacing between the individual tab stops.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fonrequest 37 Updates links only on request while loading a document.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Frequestrb 37 Updates links only on request while loading a document.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Falways 2e Always updates links while loading a document.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Falwaysrb 2e Always updates links while loading a document.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2Fusecharunit 99 When this setting is enabled, the measurement units of indents and spacing on Format - Paragraph - Indents & Spacing tab will be character (ch) and line.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptgeneralpage%2FOptGeneralPage 2e Specifies general settings for text documents.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcompatpage%2Fdefault 69 Click to use the current settings on this tab page as the default for further sessions with %PRODUCTNAME.
38 sd%3ACheckBox%3ATP_OPTIONS_MISC%3ACB_USE_PRINTER_METRICS 6a Specifies that printer metrics are applied for printing and also for formatting the display on the screen.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcompatpage%2FOptCompatPage 8c Specifies compatibility settings for text documents. These options help in fine-tuning %PRODUCTNAME when importing Microsoft Word documents.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fcharstyle 1d Špecifikuje znakový štýl.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fposition 42 Determines the position of the caption with respect to the object.
36 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fnumseparator 57 Defines the character to be displayed after the number of the heading or chapter level.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fseparator 57 Defines the character to be displayed after the number of the heading or chapter level.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fnumbering 29 Specifies the type of numbering required.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fcategory 2e Specifies the category of the selected object.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fapplyborder 41 Applies the border and shadow of the object to the caption frame.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Fobjects 4a Select the object type for which the AutoCaption settings are to be valid.
2f modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2Flevel 4f Specifies the headings or chapter levels where you want the numbering to start.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Foptcaptionpage%2FOptCaptionPage 4a Select the object type for which the AutoCaption settings are to be valid.
10 .uno%3AGridFront 2e Sets the visible grid in front of all objects.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsynchronize 44 Specifies whether to change the current grid settings symmetrically.
15 .uno%3AHelplinesFront 2c Sets the snap lines in front of all objects.
28 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fnumflddivisiony 45 Určuje maximálny počet znakov, ktoré môže používateľ zadať.
28 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fnumflddivisionx 45 Určuje maximálny počet znakov, ktoré môže používateľ zadať.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrflddrawx 4e Defines the unit of measure for the spacing between grid points on the X-axis.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fgridvisible 26 Specifies whether to display the grid.
12 .uno%3AGridVisible 26 Specifies whether to display the grid.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrflddrawy 51 Defines the grid points spacing in the desired unit of measurement on the Y-axis.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fusegridsnap 5a Specifies whether to move frames, drawing elements, and controls only between grid points.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2FOptGridPage cc Specifies the settings for the configurable grid on your document pages. This grid helps you determine the exact position of your objects. You can also set this grid in line with the "magnetic" snap grid.
13 .uno%3AToolsOptions f4 Defines various settings for spreadsheets, contents to be displayed, and the cursor direction after a cell entry. You can also define sorting lists, determine the number of decimal places and the settings for recording and highlighting changes.
14 .uno%3AScEditOptions f4 Defines various settings for spreadsheets, contents to be displayed, and the cursor direction after a cell entry. You can also define sorting lists, determine the number of decimal places and the settings for recording and highlighting changes.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Ftblreg 56 Specifies whether to display the sheet tabs at the bottom of the spreadsheet document.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fhscroll 59 Specifies whether to display a horizontal scrollbar at the bottom of the document window.
28 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fdraw 40 Defines if drawing objects in your document are shown or hidden.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fsynczoom 74 If checked, all sheets are shown with the same zoom factor. If not checked, each sheet can have its own zoom factor.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fvscroll 56 Specifies whether to display a vertical scrollbar at the right of the document window.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Frowcolheader 34 Specifies whether to display row and column headers.
27 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fnil 36 Specifies whether to show numbers with the value of 0.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fdiagram 37 Defines if charts in your document are shown or hidden.
12 .uno%3ANoteVisible 5f To display a comment permanently, select the Show comment command from the cell's context menu.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fvalue 111 Mark the Value highlighting box to show the cell contents in different colors, depending on type. Text cells are formatted in black, formulas in green, number cells in blue, and protected cells are shown with light grey background, no matter how their display is formatted.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fannot d1 Specifies that a small rectangle in the top right corner of the cell indicates that a comment exists. The comment will be shown only when you enable tips under %PRODUCTNAME - General in the Options dialog box.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fclipmark f3 If a cell contains text that is wider than the width of the cell, the text is displayed over empty neighboring cells in the same row. If there is no empty neighboring cell, a small triangle at the cell border indicates that the text continues.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fobjgrf 34 Defines if objects and graphics are shown or hidden.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fformula 43 Specifies whether to show formulas instead of results in the cells.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Frangefind bf Specifies that each reference is highlighted in color in the formula. The cell range is also enclosed by a colored border as soon as the cell containing the reference is selected for editing.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fbreak 46 Specifies whether to view the page breaks within a defined print area.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fanchor 67 Specifies whether the anchor icon is displayed when an inserted object, such as a graphic, is selected.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fcolor 3d Specifies a color for the grid lines in the current document.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Foutline 84 If you have defined an outline, the Outline symbols option specifies whether to view the outline symbols at the border of the sheet.
28 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fgrid db Specifies when grid lines will be displayed. Default is to display grid lines only on cells that do not have a background color. You can choose to also display grid lines on cells with background color, or to hide them.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2Fguideline 5a Specifies whether to view guides when moving drawings, frames, graphics and other objects.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Ftpviewpage%2FTpViewPage 86 Defines which elements of the %PRODUCTNAME Calc main window are displayed. You can also show or hide highlighting of values in tables.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Freplwarncb 6d Specifies that, when you paste cells from the clipboard to a cell range that is not empty, a warning appears.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Fmarkhdrcb 56 Specifies whether to highlight column and row headers in the selected columns or rows.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Fformatcb 74 Specifies whether to automatically apply the formatting attributes of the selected cell to the empty adjacent cells.
13 .uno%3ASetInputMode 4e Allows you to immediately edit the selected cell after pressing the Enter key.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Feditmodecb 4e Allows you to immediately edit the selected cell after pressing the Enter key.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Falignlb 64 Determines the direction that the cursor in the spreadsheet will move after you press the Enter key.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Faligncb 64 Determines the direction that the cursor in the spreadsheet will move after you press the Enter key.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Ftabmf 1f Defines the tab stops distance.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Ftextfmtcb 6a Specifies that printer metrics are applied for printing and also for formatting the display on the screen.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Fexprefcb f9 Specifies whether to expand references when inserting columns or rows adjacent to the reference range. This is only possible if the reference range, where the column or row is inserted, originally spanned at least two cells in the desired direction.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2Funitlb 2c Defines the unit of measure in spreadsheets.
34 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Fscgeneralpage%2FScGeneralPage 2c Defines the unit of measure in spreadsheets.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fadd 23 Adds a new list into the Lists box.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fdiscard 37 Enters the contents of a new list into the Entries box.
29 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fnew 37 Enters the contents of a new list into the Entries box.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fcopy 10d Copies the contents of the cells in the Copy list from box. If you select a reference to related rows and columns, the Copy List dialog appears after clicking the button. You can use this dialog to define if the reference is converted to sort lists by row or by column.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fcopyfrom 99 Defines the spreadsheet and the cells to copy, in order to include them in the Lists box. The currently selected range in the spreadsheet is the default.
2d modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fentries 50 Displays the content of the currently selected list. This content can be edited.
2c modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Fdelete 23 Adds a new list into the Lists box.
2b modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2Flists 4a Displays all the available lists. These lists can be selected for editing.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptsortslist%2FOptSortLists 9c All user-defined lists are displayed in the Sort Lists dialog. You can also define and edit your own lists. Only text can be used as sort lists, no numbers.
36 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_COLORROW%3ABTN_GROUP_COLS 56 Select the Columns option to summarize the contents of the selected columns in a list.
36 sc%3ARadioButton%3ARID_SCDLG_COLORROW%3ABTN_GROUP_ROWS 50 Select the Rows option to summarize the contents of the selected rows in a list.
25 sc%3AModalDialog%3ARID_SCDLG_COLORROW 2f Allows you to copy marked cells to a sort list.
35 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fgeneralprec dd You can specify the maximum number of decimal places that are shown by default for cells with General number format. If not enabled, cells with General number format show as many decimal places as the column width allows.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fprec ae Defines the number of decimals to be displayed for numbers with the General number format. The numbers are displayed as rounded numbers, but are not saved as rounded numbers.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Flookup cc Specifies that you can use the text in any cell as a label for the column below the text or the row to the right of the text. The text must consist of at least one word and must not contain any operators.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fregex 68 Specifies that regular expressions are enabled when searching and also for character string comparisons.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fmatch 117 Specifies that the search criteria you set for the Calc database functions must match the whole cell exactly. When the Search criteria = and <> must apply to whole cells box is marked, $[officename] Calc behaves exactly as MS Excel when searching cells in the database functions.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fcalc 11b Specifies whether to make calculations using the rounded values displayed in the sheet. Charts will be shown with the displayed values. If the Precision as shown option is not marked, the displayed numbers are rounded, but they are calculated internally using the non-rounded number.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fcase 64 Specifies whether to distinguish between upper and lower case in texts when comparing cell contents.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fdate1904 63 Sets 1/1/1904 as day zero. Use this setting for spreadsheets that are imported in a foreign format.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fdatesc10 62 Sets 1/1/1900 as day zero. Use this setting for StarCalc 1.0 spreadsheets containing date entries.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fdatestd 1c Sets 12/30/1899 as day zero.
33 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fminchange ad Specifies the difference between two consecutive iteration step results. If the result of the iteration is lower than the minimum change value, then the iteration will stop.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fiterate b1 Specifies whether formulas with iterative references (formulas that are continuously repeated until the problem is solved) are calculated after a specific number of repetitions.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2Fsteps 2b Sets the maximum number of iteration steps.
3a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcalculatepage%2FOptCalculatePage 32 Defines the calculation settings for spreadsheets.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2Fentries 35 Specifies the color to highlight moved cell contents.
32 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2Finsertions 3a Specifies the color to highlight insertions in a document.
31 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2Fdeletions 39 Specifies the color to highlight deletions in a document.
2f modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2Fchanges 31 Specifies the color for changes of cell contents.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptchangespage%2FOptChangesPage 5c The Changes dialog specifies various options for highlighting recorded changes in documents.
27 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptdlg%2FprintCB e3 Specifies that only contents from selected sheets are printed, even if you specify a wider range in the File - Print dialog or in the Format - Print Ranges dialog. Contents from sheets that are not selected will not be printed.
2a modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptdlg%2FsuppressCB 56 Specifies that empty pages that have no cell contents or draw objects are not printed.
30 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptdlg%2FoptCalcPrintPage 31 Determines the printer settings for spreadsheets.
42 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptcompatibilitypage%2FOptCompatibilityPage 34 Defines compatibility options for %PRODUCTNAME Calc.
2e modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptformula%2FOptFormula 35 Defines formula syntax options for %PRODUCTNAME Calc.
36 modules%2Fscalc%2Fui%2Foptdefaultpage%2FOptDefaultPage 37 Defines default settings for new spreadsheet documents.
14 .uno%3ASdEditOptions ad Defines various settings for newly created presentation documents, such as the contents to be displayed, the measurement unit used, if and how grid alignment is carried out.
34 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2Fhandlesbezier ec Displays the control points of all Bézier points if you have previously selected a Bézier curve. If the All control points in Bézier editor option is not marked, only the control points of the selected Bézier points will be visible.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2Fdragstripes 3a Specifies whether to display guides when moving an object.
14 .uno%3AHelplinesMove 3a Specifies whether to display guides when moving an object.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2Fmoveoutline 59 %PRODUCTNAME displays the contour line of each individual object when moving this object.
2c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2Fruler 54 Specifies whether to display the rulers at the top and to the left of the work area.
31 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fsdviewpage%2FSdViewPage 26 Specifies the available display modes.
24 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrfldangle 7c Specifies that graphic objects can only be rotated within the rotation angle that you selected in the When rotating control.
21 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fbigortho 16b Specifies that a square is created based on the longer side of a rectangle when the Shift key is pressed before you release the mouse button. This also applies to an ellipse (a circle will be created based on the longest diameter of the ellipse). When the Extend edges box is not marked, a square or a circle will be created based on the shorter side or diameter.
27 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrfldsnaparea cc Defines the snap distance between the mouse pointer and the object contour. $[officename] Impress snaps to a snap point if the mouse pointer is nearer than the distance selected in the Snap range control.
23 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsnappoints 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the points of the nearest graphic object.
11 .uno%3ASnapPoints 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the points of the nearest graphic object.
22 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsnapframe 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the border of the nearest graphic object.
27 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fmtrfldbezangle 26 Defines the angle for point reduction.
10 .uno%3ASnapFrame 69 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the border of the nearest graphic object.
1f svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Frotate 7c Specifies that graphic objects can only be rotated within the rotation angle that you selected in the When rotating control.
1e svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fortho 79 Specifies that graphic objects are restricted vertically, horizontally or diagonally (45°) when creating or moving them.
23 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsnapborder 58 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the nearest page margin.
26 svx%2Fui%2Foptgridpage%2Fsnaphelplines 57 Snaps the edge of a dragged object to the nearest snap line when you release the mouse.
11 .uno%3ASnapBorder 58 Specifies whether to align the contour of the graphic object to the nearest page margin.
13 .uno%3AHelplinesUse 57 Snaps the edge of a dragged object to the nearest snap line when you release the mouse.
16 SD_HID_SD_OPTIONS_SNAP 3a Defines the grid settings for creating and moving objects.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fpapertryfrmprntrcb 52 Determines that the paper tray to be used is the one defined in the printer setup.
2b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fbackcb 2c Select Back to print the back of a brochure.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fbrouchrb 44 Select the Brochure option to print the document in brochure format.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Ftilepgrb a8 Specifies that pages are to be printed in tiled format. If the pages or slides are smaller than the paper, several pages or slides will be printed on one page of paper.
2e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Ffittopgrb 89 Specifies whether to scale down objects that are beyond the margins of the current printer, so that they fit on the paper in the printer.
32 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fpagedefaultrb 44 Specifies that you do not want to further scale pages when printing.
31 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fblackwhiterb 41 Specifies that you want to print the document in black and white.
2c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Ffrontcb 2e Select Front to print the front of a brochure.
30 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fgrayscalerb 35 Specifies that you want to print colors as grayscale.
2e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fdefaultrb 34 Specifies that you want to print in original colors.
2b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Ftimecb 2c Specifies whether to print the current time.
2f modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fhiddenpgcb 55 Specifies whether to print the pages that are currently hidden from the presentation.
2b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fdatecb 2c Specifies whether to print the current date.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fpagenmcb 29 Specifies whether to print the page name.
2d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Fprntopts%2Fprntopts 43 Specifies print settings within a drawing or presentation document.
3a modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FscaleBox 2b Determines the drawing scale on the rulers.
37 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Funits 35 Determines the Unit of measurement for presentations.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FstrtwithPag 4e Specifies that you always want a presentation to start with the current slide.
3b modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fdistrotcb 70 Maintains relative alignment of Bézier points and 2D drawing objects to each other when you distort the object.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fcopywhenmove 69 If enabled, a copy is created when you move an object while holding down the Ctrl key (Mac: Command key).
40 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fbackgroundback 4d Specifies whether to use the cache for displaying objects on the master page.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fstartwithwizard 64 Specifies whether to activate the Wizard when opening a presentation with File - New - Presentation.
12 .uno%3APickThrough 3e Specifies whether to select a text frame by clicking the text.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FmetricFields 26 Defines the spacing between tab stops.
3c modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fobjalwymov a6 Specifies that you want to move an object with the Rotate tool enabled. If Object always moveable is not marked, the Rotate tool can only be used to rotate an object.
10 .uno%3AQuickEdit 6e If on, you can edit text immediately after clicking a text object. If off, you must double-click to edit text.
3e modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Ftextselected 3e Specifies whether to select a text frame by clicking the text.
3a modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2Fqickedit 6e If on, you can edit text immediately after clicking a text object. If off, you must double-click to edit text.
41 modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FcbCompatibility 68 Specifies that $[officename] Impress calculates the paragraph spacing exactly like Microsoft PowerPoint.
3d modules%2Fsimpress%2Fui%2Foptimpressgeneralpage%2FOptSavePage 42 Defines the general options for drawing or presentation documents.
17 .uno%3ASdGraphicOptions ae Defines the global settings for drawing documents, including the contents to be displayed, the scale to be used, the grid alignment and the contents to be printed by default.
14 .uno%3ASmEditOptions 97 Defines the print format and print options for all new formula documents. These options apply when you print a formula directly from %PRODUCTNAME Math.
d tobeannounced 49 Saves only those symbols with each formula that are used in that formula.
2b modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fzoom 56 Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified enlargement factor.
2c modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fframe 3a Applies a thin border to the formula area in the printout.
34 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fnorightspaces 56 Specifies that these space wildcards will be removed if they are at the end of a line.
2b modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Ftext 5f Specifies whether to include the contents of the Commands window at the bottom of the printout.
31 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fsizenormal 3b Prints the formula without adjusting the current font size.
2c modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Ftitle 53 Specifies whether you want the name of the document to be included in the printout.
31 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fsizezoomed 56 Reduces or enlarges the size of the printed formula by a specified enlargement factor.
31 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2Fsizescaled 3c Adjusts the formula to the page format used in the printout.
34 modules%2Fsmath%2Fui%2Fsmathsettings%2FSmathSettings 3e Defines formula settings that will be valid for all documents.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptchartcolorspage%2Fdefault 4d Restores the color settings that were defined when the program was installed.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptchartcolorspage%2Fcolors 36 Displays all the colors available for the data series.
32 cui%2Fui%2Foptchartcolorspage%2FOptChartColorsPage 36 Displays all the colors available for the data series.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fwo_exec bf The VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code will be loaded ready to be executed. If this checkbox is not checked, the VBA code will be commented out so it can be inspected, but will not run.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fex_saveorig 120 Specifies that the original Microsoft Basic code contained in the document is held in a special internal memory for as long as the document remains loaded in $[officename]. When saving the document in Microsoft format the Microsoft Basic is saved again with the code in an unchanged form.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fwo_saveorig 120 Specifies that the original Microsoft Basic code contained in the document is held in a special internal memory for as long as the document remains loaded in $[officename]. When saving the document in Microsoft format the Microsoft Basic is saved again with the code in an unchanged form.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fpp_basic d8 Loads and saves the Basic code from a Microsoft document as a special $[officename] Basic module with the document. The disabled Microsoft Basic code is visible in the $[officename] Basic IDE between Sub and End Sub.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fex_basic d8 Loads and saves the Basic code from a Microsoft document as a special $[officename] Basic module with the document. The disabled Microsoft Basic code is visible in the $[officename] Basic IDE between Sub and End Sub.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fpp_saveorig 120 Specifies that the original Microsoft Basic code contained in the document is held in a special internal memory for as long as the document remains loaded in $[officename]. When saving the document in Microsoft format the Microsoft Basic is saved again with the code in an unchanged form.
21 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fwo_basic d8 Loads and saves the Basic code from a Microsoft document as a special $[officename] Basic module with the document. The disabled Microsoft Basic code is visible in the $[officename] Basic IDE between Sub and End Sub.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2Fex_exec bf The VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code will be loaded ready to be executed. If this checkbox is not checked, the VBA code will be commented out so it can be inspected, but will not run.
24 cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrpage%2FOptFltrPage 81 Specifies the general properties for loading and saving Microsoft Office documents with VBA (Visual Basic for Applications) code.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptfltrembedpage%2Fchecklbcontainer ad The List Box field displays the entries for the pair of OLE objects that can be converted when loading into $[officename] (L) and/or when saving into a Microsoft format (S).
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fasiansupport 70 Activates Asian languages support. You can now modify the corresponding Asian language settings in %PRODUCTNAME.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fcurrentdoc 5a Specifies that the settings for default languages are valid only for the current document.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fcomplexlanguage 3e Specifies the language for the complex text layout spellcheck.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fasianlanguage 4b Specifies the language used for the spellcheck function in Asian alphabets.
32 cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fignorelanguagechange dd Indicates whether changes to the system input language/keyboard will be ignored. If ignored, when new text is typed that text will follow the language of the document or current paragraph, not the current system language.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fdatepatterns cd Specifies the date acceptance patterns for the current locale. Calc spreadsheet and Writer table cell input needs to match locale dependent date acceptance patterns before it is recognized as a valid date.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fcurrencylb 5c Specifies the default currency that is used for the currency format and the currency fields.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fctlsupport 7c Activates complex text layout support. You can now modify the settings corresponding to complex text layout in %PRODUCTNAME.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fwesternlanguage 4d Specifies the language used for the spellcheck function in western alphabets.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fdecimalseparator 7a Specifies to use the decimal separator key that is set in your system when you press the respective key on the number pad.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Flocalesetting 7b Specifies the locale setting of the country setting. This influences settings for numbering, currency and units of measure.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2Fuserinterface c3 Select the language used for the user interface, for example menus, dialogs, help files. You must have installed at least one additional language pack or a multi-language version of %PRODUCTNAME.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptlanguagespage%2FOptLanguagesPage 4b Defines the default languages and some other locale settings for documents.
1d cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fend 4b Specifies the characters that should not appear alone at the end of a line.
1f cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fstart 51 Specifies the characters that should not appear alone at the beginning of a line.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fstandard 75 When you mark Default, the following two text boxes are filled with the default characters for the selected language:
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fpunctkanacompression 3c Specifies that punctuation and Japanese Kana are compressed.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fpunctcompression 32 Specifies that only the punctuation is compressed.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Flanguage 4e Specifies the language for which you want to define first and last characters.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fnocompression 30 Specifies that no compression at all will occur.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fcharpunctkerning 4d Specifies that kerning is applied to both western text and Asian punctuation.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2Fcharkerning 37 Specifies that kerning is only applied to western text.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptasianpage%2FOptAsianPage 37 Specifies that kerning is only applied to western text.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fignorepunctuation 27 Specifies the characters to be ignored.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchbavahafa 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchiaiya 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchseshezeje 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchkiku 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2f cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchtsithichidhizi 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fignoremiddledot 27 Specifies the characters to be ignored.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchdiziduzu 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchcontractions 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
31 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchvariantformkanji 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatcholdkanaforms 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
30 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchrepeatcharmarks 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2f cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchminusdashchoon 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
31 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchhiraganakatakana 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
33 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchprolongedsoundmark 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2c cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fignorewhitespace 27 Specifies the characters to be ignored.
2e cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchfullhalfwidth 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2d cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchhyuiyubyuvyu 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
25 cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2Fmatchcase 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptjsearchpage%2FOptJSearchPage 39 Specifies the options to be treated as equal in a search.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Fnumerals ac Selects the type of numerals used within text, text in objects, fields, and controls, in all %PRODUCTNAME modules. Only cell contents of %PRODUCTNAME Calc are not affected.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Fmovementvisual 9d Pressing the Right Arrow key moves the text cursor in the right-hand direction. Pressing the Left Arrow key moves the text cursor in the left-hand direction.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Fmovementlogical b2 Pressing the Right Arrow key moves the text cursor toward the end of the current text. Pressing the Left Arrow key moves the text cursor toward the beginning of the current text.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Frestricted 4b Prevents the use as well as the printing of illegal character combinations.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2Fsequencechecking 3b Enables sequence input checking for languages such as Thai.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptctlpage%2FOptCTLPage 3c Defines the options for documents with complex text layouts.
24 cui%2Fui%2Fconnpooloptions%2Ftimeout 45 Defines the time in seconds after which a pooled connection is freed.
2a cui%2Fui%2Fconnpooloptions%2Fenablepooling 73 Select a driver from the list and mark the Enable pooling for this driver checkbox in order to pool its connection.
2e cui%2Fui%2Fconnpooloptions%2Fconnectionpooling 34 Specifies whether the chosen connections are pooled.
24 DBACCESS_HID_DSBROWSER_DISCONNECTING 34 Specifies whether the chosen connections are pooled.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fdbregisterpage%2Fdelete 29 Removes the selected entry from the list.
1f cui%2Fui%2Fdbregisterpage%2Fnew 35 Opens the Database Link dialog to create a new entry.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fdbregisterpage%2Fedit 3a Opens the Database Link dialog to edit the selected entry.
17 CUI_HID_DBPATH_CTL_PATH 67 Lists the registered name and database file of all registered databases. Double-click an entry to edit.
27 cui%3AEdit%3ADLG_DOCUMENTLINK%3AET_NAME 52 Enter a name for the database. %PRODUCTNAME uses this name to access the database.
33 cui%3APushButton%3ADLG_DOCUMENTLINK%3APB_BROWSEFILE 3b Opens a file dialog where you can select the database file.
26 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fclasspath 1c Opens the Class Path dialog.
22 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fjavas b7 Select the JRE that you want to use. On some systems, you must wait a minute until the list gets populated. On some systems, you must restart %PRODUCTNAME to use your changed setting.
27 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fparameters 27 Opens the Java Start Parameters dialog.
20 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fadd 38 Add a path to the root folder of a JRE on your computer.
28 cui%2Fui%2Foptadvancedpage%2Fjavaenabled 34 Allows you to run Java applications in %PRODUCTNAME.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fjavaclasspath%2Fremove 64 Select an archive or a folder in the list and click Remove to remove the object from the class path.
21 cui%2Fui%2Fjavaclasspath%2Ffolder 35 Select a folder and add the folder to the class path.
22 cui%2Fui%2Fjavaclasspath%2Farchive 4f Select an archive file in jar or zip format and add the file to the class path.
20 cui%2Fui%2Fjavaclasspath%2Fpaths 3f Specifies the location of Java classes or Java class libraries.
2a cui%2Fui%2FJavaStartParameters%2Fremovebtn 29 Deletes the selected JRE start parameter.
2a cui%2Fui%2FJavaStartParameters%2Fassignbtn 31 Adds the current JRE start parameter to the list.
2b cui%2Fui%2FJavaStartParameters%2Fassignlist 72 Lists the assigned JRE start parameters. To remove a start parameter, select the parameter, and then click Remove.
2f cui%2Fui%2FJavaStartParameters%2Fparameterfield 8e Enter a start parameter for a JRE as you would on a command line. Click Assign to add the parameter to the list of available start parameters.
25 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2Flow c5 A macro can be set to auto-start, and it can perform potentially damaging actions, as for example delete or rename files. This setting is not recommended when you open documents from other authors.
25 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2Fmed e6 Trusted sources can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Signed macros from a trusted source are allowed to run. In addition, any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run. All other macros require your confirmation.
26 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2Fhigh bf Trusted sources can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Only signed macros from a trusted source are allowed to run. In addition, any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run.
27 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2Fvhigh 7c Trusted file locations can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run.
33 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritylevelpage%2FSecurityLevelPage 7c Trusted file locations can be set on the Trusted Sources tab page. Any macro from a trusted file location is allowed to run.
2c xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Fremovefile 44 Removes the selected folder from the list of trusted file locations.
29 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Faddfile 5e Opens a folder selection dialog. Select a folder from which all macros are allowed to execute.
2b xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Flocations 5f Document macros are only executed if they have been opened from one of the following locations.
2a xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Fviewcert 3f Opens the View Certificate dialog for the selected certificate.
2e xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Fcertificates 1f Lists the trusted certificates.
2c xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2Fremovecert 47 Removes the selected certificate from the list of trusted certificates.
33 xmlsec%2Fui%2Fsecuritytrustpage%2FSecurityTrustPage 1f Lists the trusted certificates.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Ftest 44 Opens the Test Account Settings dialog to test the current settings.
2e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fport 14 Enter the SMTP port.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Freplyto 2c Enter the address to use for e-mail replies.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fserver 1b Enter the SMTP server name.
33 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Freplytocb 64 Uses the e-mail address that you enter in the Reply address text box as the reply-to e-mail address.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fserverauthentication 72 Opens the Server Authentication dialog where you can specify the server authentication settings for secure e-mail.
31 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Faddress 26 Enter your e-mail address for replies.
35 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fdisplayname 10 Enter your name.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2Fsecure 39 When available, uses a secure connection to send e-mails.
38 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fmailconfigpage%2FMailConfigPage 10 Enter your name.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fchecknow 1e A check will be performed now.
2b cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Feverymonth 27 A check will be performed once a month.
29 cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Feveryday 25 A check will be performed once a day.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Fautocheck 82 Mark to check for online updates periodically, then select the time interval how often %PRODUCTNAME will check for online updates.
2a cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2Feveryweek 43 A check will be performed once a week. This is the default setting.
34 cui%2Fui%2Foptonlineupdatepage%2FOptOnlineUpdatePage 82 Mark to check for online updates periodically, then select the time interval how often %PRODUCTNAME will check for online updates.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Finpassword 13 Enter the password.
42 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Finusername 28 Enter the user name for the IMAP server.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fimap 32 Specifies that the incoming mail server uses IMAP.
3e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fserver 38 Enter the server name of your POP 3 or IMAP mail server.
44 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fsmtpafterpop 50 Select if you are required to first read your e-mail before you can send e-mail.
43 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Foutpassword 25 Enter the password for the user name.
40 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fusername 28 Enter the user name for the SMTP server.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fport 2a Enter the port on the POP3 or IMAP server.
4e modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fseperateauthentication 3d Select if your SMTP server requires a user name and password.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fpop3 33 Specifies that the incoming mail server uses POP 3.
46 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2Fauthentication 43 Enables the authentication that is required to send e-mail by SMTP.
54 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Fauthenticationsettingsdialog%2FAuthenticationSettingsDialog 43 Enables the authentication that is required to send e-mail by SMTP.
30 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftestmailsettings%2Fstop 36 Click the Stop button to stop a test session manually.
32 modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftestmailsettings%2Ferrors 68 In the Errors list box you can read an explanation of any errors encountered while testing the settings.
3c modules%2Fswriter%2Fui%2Ftestmailsettings%2FTestMailSettings 68 In the Errors list box you can read an explanation of any errors encountered while testing the settings.
22 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_TP_CERTPATH 71 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialog displays the location and the status of the certificate.
43 xmlsecurity%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_XMLSECTP_CERTPATH%3AML_CERTSTATUS 71 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialog displays the location and the status of the certificate.
2a XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_VIEWSIGNATURES 71 The Certificate Path page of the View Certificate dialog displays the location and the status of the certificate.
3f xmlsecurity%3AMultiLineEdit%3ARID_XMLSECTP_DETAILS%3AML_ELEMENT 45 Use the value list box to view values and copy them to the clipboard.
21 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_TP_DETAILS 64 The Details page of the View Certificate dialog displays detailed information about the certificate.
24 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_CTRL_ELEMENTS 64 The Details page of the View Certificate dialog displays detailed information about the certificate.
21 XMLSECURITY_HID_XMLSEC_TP_GENERAL 61 The General page of the View Certificate dialog displays basic information about the certificate.